Update get_standard_cache_dir for macOS
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3186 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3187 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3188 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3189 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3190
3191 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3192 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3193 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3194 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3195
3196 @table @code
3197 @item -c
3198 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3199 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3200 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3201 @item -s
3202 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3203 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3204 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3205 are not printed.
3206 @item -q
3207 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3208 information.
3209 @end table
3210
3211 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3212
3213 @kindex taas
3214 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3215 @item taas @var{command}
3216 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3217 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3218
3219 @kindex tfaas
3220 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item tfaas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3224 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3225 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3226 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3227 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3228 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3229 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3230
3231 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3232 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3233 is, using:
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3236 @end smallexample
3237
3238
3239 @kindex thread name
3240 @cindex name a thread
3241 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3242 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3243 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3244 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3245
3246 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3247 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3248 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3249 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3250 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3251
3252 @kindex thread find
3253 @cindex search for a thread
3254 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3255 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3256 matches the supplied regular expression.
3257
3258 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3259 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3260 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3261 is the LWP id.
3262
3263 @smallexample
3264 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3265 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3266 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3267 Id Target Id Frame
3268 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @kindex set print thread-events
3272 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3273 @item set print thread-events
3274 @itemx set print thread-events on
3275 @itemx set print thread-events off
3276 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3277 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3278 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3279 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3280 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3281
3282 @kindex show print thread-events
3283 @item show print thread-events
3284 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3285 have started and exited.
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3289 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3290 programs with multiple threads.
3291
3292 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3293 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3294
3295 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3298 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3299 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3300 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3301 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3302 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3303 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3304 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3305 macro.
3306
3307 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3308 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3309 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3310 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3311 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3312 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3313
3314 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3315 refers to the default system directories that are
3316 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3317 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3318 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3322 was loaded in the inferior process.
3323
3324 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3325 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3326 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3327 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3328 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3329 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3330 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3331
3332 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3333 only on some platforms.
3334
3335 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3336 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3337 Display current libthread_db search path.
3338
3339 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3340 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3341 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3342 @item set debug libthread-db
3343 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3344 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3345 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Forks
3349 @section Debugging Forks
3350
3351 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3352 @cindex multiple processes
3353 @cindex processes, multiple
3354 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3355 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3356 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3357 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3358 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3359 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3360 will cause it to terminate.
3361
3362 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3363 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3364 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3365 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3366 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3367 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3368 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3369 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3370 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3371 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3372
3373 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3374 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3375 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3376 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3377
3378 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3379 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3383 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3384
3385 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3386 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3390 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3391 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3392 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3393 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3394
3395 @table @code
3396 @item parent
3397 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3398 unimpeded. This is the default.
3399
3400 @item child
3401 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3402 unimpeded.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3407 @item show follow-fork-mode
3408 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3409 @end table
3410
3411 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3412 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3413 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3417 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3418 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3419 retain debugger control over them both.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @item on
3423 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3424 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3425 independently. This is the default.
3426
3427 @item off
3428 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3429 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3431 is held suspended.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3436 @item show detach-on-fork
3437 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3441 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3442 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3443 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3444 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3445 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3446
3447 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3448 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3449 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3450 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3451 and Programs}.
3452
3453 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3454 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3455 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3456 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3457 the child process's @code{main}.
3458
3459 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3460 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3461
3462 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3463 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3464 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3465 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3466 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3467 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3468 command.
3469
3470 @table @code
3471 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3472 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3473
3474 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3475 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3476
3477 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3478
3479 @table @code
3480 @item new
3481 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3482 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3483 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3484 original inferior.
3485
3486 For example:
3487
3488 @smallexample
3489 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3490 (gdb) info inferior
3491 Id Description Executable
3492 * 1 <null> prog1
3493 (@value{GDBP}) run
3494 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3495 Program exited normally.
3496 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 1 <null> prog1
3499 * 2 <null> prog2
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @item same
3503 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3504 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3505 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3506 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3507 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3508
3509 For example:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3513 Id Description Executable
3514 * 1 <null> prog1
3515 (@value{GDBP}) run
3516 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3517 Program exited normally.
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog2
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @end table
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3527 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3528
3529 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3530 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3531 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3532
3533 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3534 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3535
3536 @cindex checkpoint
3537 @cindex restart
3538 @cindex bookmark
3539 @cindex snapshot of a process
3540 @cindex rewind program state
3541
3542 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3543 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3544 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3545 later.
3546
3547 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3548 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3549 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3550 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3551 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3552
3553 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3554 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3555 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3556 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3557 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3558 start again from there.
3559
3560 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3561 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3562
3563 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex checkpoint
3567 @item checkpoint
3568 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3569 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3570 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3571
3572 @kindex info checkpoints
3573 @item info checkpoints
3574 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3575 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3576 listed:
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @item Checkpoint ID
3580 @item Process ID
3581 @item Code Address
3582 @item Source line, or label
3583 @end table
3584
3585 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3586 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3587 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3588 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3589 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3590 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3591 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3592
3593 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3594 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3595 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3596 the debugger.
3597
3598 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3599 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3600 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3601
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3605 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3606 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3607 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3608 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3609 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3610 previously read data can be read again.
3611
3612 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3613 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3614 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3615 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3616 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3617 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3618
3619 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3620 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3621 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3622 different execution path this time.
3623
3624 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3625 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3626 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3627 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3628 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3629 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3630 potentially pose a problem.
3631
3632 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3633
3634 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3635 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3636 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3637 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3638 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3639 next.
3640
3641 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3642 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3643 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3644 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3645 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3646
3647 @node Stopping
3648 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3649
3650 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3651 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3652 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3653
3654 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3655 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3656 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3657 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3658 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3659 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3660 explicitly request this information at any time.
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @kindex info program
3664 @item info program
3665 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3666 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @menu
3670 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3671 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3672 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3673 Skipping over functions and files
3674 * Signals:: Signals
3675 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3676 @end menu
3677
3678 @node Breakpoints
3679 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3680
3681 @cindex breakpoints
3682 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3683 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3684 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3685 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3686 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3687 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3688 program.
3689
3690 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3691 the executable is run.
3692
3693 @cindex watchpoints
3694 @cindex data breakpoints
3695 @cindex memory tracing
3696 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3697 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3698 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3699 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3700 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3701 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3702 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3703 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3704 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3705 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3706 same commands.
3707
3708 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3709 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3710 Automatic Display}.
3711
3712 @cindex catchpoints
3713 @cindex breakpoint on events
3714 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3715 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3716 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3717 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3718 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3719 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3720 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3721
3722 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3723 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3724 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3725 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3726 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3727 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3728 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3729 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3730 enable it again.
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3733 @cindex breakpoint lists
3734 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3735 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3736 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3737 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3738 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3739 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3740 are operated on.
3741
3742 @menu
3743 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3744 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3745 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3746 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3747 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3748 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3749 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3750 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3751 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3752 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3753 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3754 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3755 @end menu
3756
3757 @node Set Breaks
3758 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3759
3760 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3761 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3762 @c
3763 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3764
3765 @kindex break
3766 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3767 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3768 @cindex latest breakpoint
3769 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3770 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3771 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3772 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3773 convenience variables.
3774
3775 @table @code
3776 @item break @var{location}
3777 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3778 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3779 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3780 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3781 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3782
3783 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3784 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3785 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3786 that situation.
3787
3788 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3789 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3790 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3791
3792 @item break
3793 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3794 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3795 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3796 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3797 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3798 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3799 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3800 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3801 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3802 inside loops.
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3805 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3806 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3807 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3808 existed when your program stopped.
3809
3810 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3811 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3812 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3813 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3814 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3815 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3816 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3817
3818 @kindex tbreak
3819 @item tbreak @var{args}
3820 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3821 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3822 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3823 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3824
3825 @kindex hbreak
3826 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3827 @item hbreak @var{args}
3828 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3829 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3830 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3831 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3832 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3833 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3834 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3835 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3836 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3837 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3838 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3839 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3840 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3841 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3842 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3843 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3844 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3845 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3846
3847 @kindex thbreak
3848 @item thbreak @var{args}
3849 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3850 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3851 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3852 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3853 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3854 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3855 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3856 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3857
3858 @kindex rbreak
3859 @cindex regular expression
3860 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3861 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3862 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3863 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3864 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3865 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3866 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3867 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3868 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3869
3870 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3871 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3872 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3873 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3874 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3875 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3876
3877 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3878 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3879 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3880 classes.
3881
3882 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3883 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3884 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3891 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3892 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3893 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3894 every function in a given file:
3895
3896 @smallexample
3897 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3901 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3902
3903 @kindex info breakpoints
3904 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3905 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3906 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3907 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3908 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3909 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3910 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3911
3912 @table @emph
3913 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3914 @item Type
3915 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3916 @item Disposition
3917 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3918 @item Enabled or Disabled
3919 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3920 that are not enabled.
3921 @item Address
3922 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3923 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3924 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3925 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3926 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3927 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3928 @item What
3929 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3930 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3931 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3932 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3933 @end table
3934
3935 @noindent
3936 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3937 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3938 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3939 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3940 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3941 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3942
3943 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3944 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3945 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3946 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3950 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3951 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3952 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3953 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3954
3955 @noindent
3956 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3957 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3958 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3959 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3960 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3961 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3962
3963 @noindent
3964 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3965 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3970 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3971 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3972 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3973
3974 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3975 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3976 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3977 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3978
3979 @itemize @bullet
3980 @item
3981 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3982
3983 @item
3984 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3985 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3986
3987 @item
3988 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3989 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3990
3991 @item
3992 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3993 several places where that function is inlined.
3994 @end itemize
3995
3996 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3997 the relevant locations.
3998
3999 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4000 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4001 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4002 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4003 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4004 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4005 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4006
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4011 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4012 stop only if i==1
4013 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4014 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4015 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4019 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4020 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4021 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4022 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4023 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4024 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4025 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4026 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4027 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4028 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4029
4030 @cindex pending breakpoints
4031 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4032 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4033 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4034 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4035 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4036 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4037 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4038 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4039 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4040 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4041 is not yet resolved.
4042
4043 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4044 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4045 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4046 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4047 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4048 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4049
4050 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4051 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4052 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4053 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4054
4055 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4056 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4057 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4060 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4061 address specification to an address:
4062
4063 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4064 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4065 @table @code
4066 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4067 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4068 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4069
4070 @item set breakpoint pending on
4071 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4072 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint pending off
4075 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4076 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4077 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4078
4079 @item show breakpoint pending
4080 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4084 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4085 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4086
4087 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4088 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4089 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4090 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4091 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4092 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4093 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4094 breakpoints.
4095
4096 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4097
4098 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4099 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4100 @table @code
4101 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4102 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4103 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4104 breakpoint must be used.
4105
4106 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4107 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4108 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4109 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4110 @end table
4111
4112 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4113 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4114 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4115 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4116 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4117 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4118 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4119 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4120 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4121
4122 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4123 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4124 @table @code
4125 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4126 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4127 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4128 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4129
4130 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4131 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4132 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4133 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4134 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4138 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4139 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4140
4141 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4142 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4143
4144 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4145
4146 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4147 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4148 @table @code
4149 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4150 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4151 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4152 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4153 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4154
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4157 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4158 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4159 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4160 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4161 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4162 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4163 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4164 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4165 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4166 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4167 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4168
4169 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4170 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4171 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4172 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4173 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4174 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4179 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4180 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4181 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4182 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4183 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4184 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4185 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4186
4187
4188 @node Set Watchpoints
4189 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4190
4191 @cindex setting watchpoints
4192 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4193 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4194 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4195 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4196 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4197
4198 @itemize @bullet
4199 @item
4200 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4201
4202 @item
4203 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4204 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4205 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4206
4207 @item
4208 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4209 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4210 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4211 @end itemize
4212
4213 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4214 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4215 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4216 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4217 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4218 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4219 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4220 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4221 the expression changes.
4222
4223 @cindex software watchpoints
4224 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4225 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4226 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4227 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4228 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4229 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4230 culprit.)
4231
4232 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4233 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4234 slow down the running of your program.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex watch
4238 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4239 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4240 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4241 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4242 to watch the value of a single variable:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4249 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4250 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4251 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4252 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4253 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4254
4255 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4256 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4257 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4258 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4259 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4260 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4261 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4262 error.
4263
4264 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4265 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4266 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4267 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4268 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4269 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4270 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4271 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4272 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4273 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4274 Examples:
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4278 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 @kindex rwatch
4282 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4283 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4284 by the program.
4285
4286 @kindex awatch
4287 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4288 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4289 or written into by the program.
4290
4291 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4292 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4293 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4294 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4295 @end table
4296
4297 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4298 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4299 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4300 a never-changing value:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4304 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4306 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4310 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4311 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4312 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4313 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4314 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4315
4316 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4317 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4318 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4319 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4320 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4321 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4322 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4323 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4327 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4328 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4329
4330 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4331 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4332 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4333 @end table
4334
4335 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4336 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4337 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4338
4339 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 @noindent
4346 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4347
4348 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4349 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4350 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4351 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4352 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4353 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4354 will print a message like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4361 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4362 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4363 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4364 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4365 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4366 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4367 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4368
4369 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4370 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4371 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4372 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4373 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4374 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4378 @end smallexample
4379
4380 @noindent
4381 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4382
4383 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4384 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4385 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4386 expression with separately allocated resources.
4387
4388 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4389 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4390 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4391
4392 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4393 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4394 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4395 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4396 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4397 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4398 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4399 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4400 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4401
4402 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4403 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4404 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4405 watched expression from every thread.
4406
4407 @quotation
4408 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4409 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4410 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4411 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4412 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4413 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4414 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4415 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4416 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4417 @end quotation
4418
4419 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4420
4421 @node Set Catchpoints
4422 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4423 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4424 @cindex exception handlers
4425 @cindex event handling
4426
4427 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4428 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4429 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex catch
4433 @item catch @var{event}
4434 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4438 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4439 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4440 @kindex catch throw
4441 @kindex catch rethrow
4442 @kindex catch catch
4443 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4444 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4445
4446 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4447 regular expression will be caught.
4448
4449 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4450 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4451 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4452 exception being thrown.
4453
4454 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4455 @value{GDBN}:
4456
4457 @itemize @bullet
4458 @item
4459 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4460 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4461 supported.
4462
4463 @item
4464 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4465 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4466 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4467 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4468 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4469 built.
4470
4471 @item
4472 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4473 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4474
4475 @item
4476 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4477 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4478 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4479 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4480
4481 @item
4482 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4483 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4484 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4485 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4486 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4487 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4488 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4489 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4490 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4491
4492 @item
4493 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4494
4495 @item
4496 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @item exception
4500 @kindex catch exception
4501 @cindex Ada exception catching
4502 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4503 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4504 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4505 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4506 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4507
4508 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4509 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4510 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4511 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4512 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4513 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4514 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4515 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4516
4517 @item handlers
4518 @kindex catch handlers
4519 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4520 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4521 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4522 specified at the end of the command
4523 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4524 only when this specific exception is handled.
4525 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4526
4527 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4528 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4529 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4530 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4531 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4532 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4533 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4534 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4535 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4536
4537 @item exception unhandled
4538 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4539 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4540
4541 @item assert
4542 @kindex catch assert
4543 A failed Ada assertion.
4544
4545 @item exec
4546 @kindex catch exec
4547 @cindex break on fork/exec
4548 A call to @code{exec}.
4549
4550 @item syscall
4551 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4552 @kindex catch syscall
4553 @cindex break on a system call.
4554 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4555 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4556 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4557 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4558 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4559 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4560 will be caught.
4561
4562 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4563 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4564 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4565 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4566
4567 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4568 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4569 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4570 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4571
4572 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4573 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4574 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4575 available choices.
4576
4577 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4578 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4579 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4580 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4581 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4582 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4583 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4584 behind the OS upgrades).
4585
4586 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4587 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4588 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4589 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4590 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4591 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4592 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4593 syscall groups available on your environment.
4594
4595 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4596 arguments to it:
4597
4598 @smallexample
4599 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4600 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4601 (@value{GDBP}) r
4602 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4603
4604 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4605 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4606 (@value{GDBP}) c
4607 Continuing.
4608
4609 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4610 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4611 (@value{GDBP})
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4618 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4619 (@value{GDBP}) r
4620 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4621
4622 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4623 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4624 (@value{GDBP}) c
4625 Continuing.
4626
4627 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4628 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4629 (@value{GDBP})
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4633 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4634 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4635
4636 @smallexample
4637 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4638 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4639 (@value{GDBP}) r
4640 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4641
4642 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4643 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4644 (@value{GDBP}) c
4645 Continuing.
4646
4647 Program exited normally.
4648 (@value{GDBP})
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4655 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4656 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4657 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4658 (@value{GDBP}) r
4659 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4660
4661 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4662 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4663
4664 (@value{GDBP}) c
4665 Continuing.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4669 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4670 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4671 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4675 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4676 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4677 (@value{GDBP})
4678 @end smallexample
4679
4680 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4681 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4682 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4683 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4684 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4685 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4689 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4690 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4691 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4692 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4693 (@value{GDBP})
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4697
4698 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4699 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4703 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4707
4708 @item fork
4709 @kindex catch fork
4710 A call to @code{fork}.
4711
4712 @item vfork
4713 @kindex catch vfork
4714 A call to @code{vfork}.
4715
4716 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4717 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4718 @kindex catch load
4719 @kindex catch unload
4720 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4721 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4722 matches one of the affected libraries.
4723
4724 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4725 @kindex catch signal
4726 The delivery of a signal.
4727
4728 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4729 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4730 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4731
4732 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4733 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4734 signal names.
4735
4736 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4737 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4738 will be caught.
4739
4740 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4741 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4742 catchpoint.
4743
4744 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4745 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4746 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4747 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4748 commands.
4749
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @item tcatch @var{event}
4753 @kindex tcatch
4754 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4755 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4760
4761
4762 @node Delete Breaks
4763 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4766 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4767 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4768 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4769 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4770 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4771
4772 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4773 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4774 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4775 their breakpoint numbers.
4776
4777 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4778 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4779 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @kindex clear
4783 @item clear
4784 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4785 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4786 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4787 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4788
4789 @item clear @var{location}
4790 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4791 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4792 most useful ones are listed below:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item clear @var{function}
4796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4797 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4798
4799 @item clear @var{linenum}
4800 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4801 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4802 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 @cindex delete breakpoints
4806 @kindex delete
4807 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4808 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4809 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4810 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4811 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4812 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4813 @end table
4814
4815 @node Disabling
4816 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4817
4818 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4819 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4820 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4821 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4822 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4823
4824 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4825 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4826 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4827 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4828 do not know which numbers to use.
4829
4830 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4831 affects all of its locations.
4832
4833 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4834 different states of enablement:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4839 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4840 @item
4841 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4842 @item
4843 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4844 disabled.
4845 @item
4846 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4847 N times, then becomes disabled.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4850 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4851 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4852 @end itemize
4853
4854 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4855 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4856
4857 @table @code
4858 @kindex disable
4859 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4860 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4861 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4862 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4863 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4864 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4865 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4866
4867 @kindex enable
4868 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4869 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4870 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4871
4872 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4873 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4874 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4875
4876 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4877 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4878 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4879 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4880 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4881 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4882 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4883
4884 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4885 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4886 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4887 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4888 @end table
4889
4890 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4891 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4892 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4893 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4894 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4895 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4896 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4897 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4898 Stepping}.)
4899
4900 @node Conditions
4901 @subsection Break Conditions
4902 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4903 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4904
4905 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4906 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4907 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4908 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4909 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4910 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4911 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4912 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4913
4914 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4915 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4916 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4917 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4918 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4919
4920 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4921 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4922 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4923 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4924 one.
4925
4926 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4927 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4928 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4929 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4930 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4931 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4932 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4933 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4934 conditions for the
4935 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4936 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4937
4938 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4939 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4940 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4941 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4942 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4943 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4944
4945 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4946 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4947 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4948 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4949 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4950
4951 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4952 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4954 with the @code{condition} command.
4955
4956 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4957 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4958 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4959 catchpoint.
4960
4961 @table @code
4962 @kindex condition
4963 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4964 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4965 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4966 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4967 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4968 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4969 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4970 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4971 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4972 prints an error message:
4973
4974 @smallexample
4975 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4976 @end smallexample
4977
4978 @noindent
4979 @value{GDBN} does
4980 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4981 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4982 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4983
4984 @item condition @var{bnum}
4985 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4986 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4987 @end table
4988
4989 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4990 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4991 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4992 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4993 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4994 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4995 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4996 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4997 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4998 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4999 your program reaches it.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex ignore
5003 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5004 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5005 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5006 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5007 takes no action.
5008
5009 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5010 a count of zero.
5011
5012 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5013 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5014 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5015 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5016
5017 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5018 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5019 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5020
5021 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5022 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5023 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5024 Variables}.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5028
5029
5030 @node Break Commands
5031 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5032
5033 @cindex breakpoint commands
5034 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5035 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5036 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5037 enable other breakpoints.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex commands
5041 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5042 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5044 @itemx end
5045 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5046 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5047 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5048
5049 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5050 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5051
5052 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5053 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5054 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5055 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5056 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5057 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5058 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5059 Expressions}).
5060 @end table
5061
5062 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5063 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5064
5065 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5066 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5067 that resumes execution.
5068
5069 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5070 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5071 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5072 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5073 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5074
5075 @kindex silent
5076 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5077 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5078 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5079 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5080 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5081 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5082
5083 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5084 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5085 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5086
5087 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5088 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 break foo if x>0
5092 commands
5093 silent
5094 printf "x is %d\n",x
5095 cont
5096 end
5097 @end smallexample
5098
5099 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5100 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5101 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5102 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5103 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5104 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5105 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 break 403
5109 commands
5110 silent
5111 set x = y + 4
5112 cont
5113 end
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @node Dynamic Printf
5117 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5118
5119 @cindex dynamic printf
5120 @cindex dprintf
5121 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5122 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5123 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5124 having to recompile it.
5125
5126 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5127 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5128 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5129 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5130 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5131 redirects to files and so forth.
5132
5133 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5134 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5135 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5136 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5137 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5138 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5139 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex dprintf
5143 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5144 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5145 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5146 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5147
5148 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5149 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5150 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5151 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5152 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5153 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @item gdb
5157 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5158 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5159
5160 @item call
5161 @kindex dprintf-style call
5162 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5163 @code{printf}).
5164
5165 @item agent
5166 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5167 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5168 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5169 support running commands on the target.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5173 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5174 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5175 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5176 command.
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5179 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5180 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5181 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5182 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5183 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5184
5185 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5186 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5187 you could do the following:
5188
5189 @example
5190 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5191 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5192 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5193 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5194 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5195 (gdb) info break
5196 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5197 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5198 continue
5199 (gdb)
5200 @end example
5201
5202 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5203 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5204 the variable settings.
5205
5206 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5207 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5208 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5209 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5210 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5211 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5212
5213 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5215 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5216
5217 @end table
5218
5219 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5220 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5221 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5222 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5223 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5224 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5225
5226 @node Save Breakpoints
5227 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5228
5229 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5230 breakpoints}} command.
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @kindex save breakpoints
5234 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5235 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5236 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5237 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5238 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5239 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5240 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5241 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5242 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5243 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5244 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5245 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5246 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5247 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5248 that can no longer be recreated.
5249 @end table
5250
5251 @node Static Probe Points
5252 @subsection Static Probe Points
5253
5254 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5255 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5257 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5258 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5259
5260 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5261 ELF-compatible systems:
5262
5263 @itemize @bullet
5264
5265 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5266 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5267 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5268 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5269 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5270 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5271 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5272 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5273
5274 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5275 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5276 C@t{++} languages.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5280 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5281 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5282 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5283 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5284 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5285 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5286 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5287 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5288
5289 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5290 probes}, with optional arguments:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex info probes
5294 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5295 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5296 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5297 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5298
5299 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5300 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5301 probes from all providers are listed.
5302
5303 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5304 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5305 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5306
5307 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5308 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5309 given, all object files are considered.
5310
5311 @item info probes all
5312 List the available static probes, from all types.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5316 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5317 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5318 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5319 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5320
5321 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5322 commands, with optional arguments:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @kindex enable probes
5326 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5327 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5328 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5329 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5330
5331 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5332 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5333 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5334
5335 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5336 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5337 given, all object files are considered.
5338
5339 @kindex disable probes
5340 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5342 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5343 @end table
5344
5345 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5346 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5347 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5348 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5349 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5350 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5351 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5352 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5353 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5354 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5355 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5356 at the current probe point.
5357
5358 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5359 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5360 an error message.
5361
5362
5363 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5364 @node Error in Breakpoints
5365 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5366
5367 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5368 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5369
5370 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5371 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5372 @smallexample
5373 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5374 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5379 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5380 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5381
5382 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5383 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5384
5385 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5386 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5387 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5388
5389 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5390 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5391 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5392 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5393
5394 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5395 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5396 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5397 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5398 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5399 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5400 first in the bundle.
5401
5402 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5403 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5404 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5405 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5406 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5407 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5408 is hit.
5409
5410 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5411 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5418 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5419 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5420 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5421 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5422 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5423 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5424 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5425
5426 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5427 adjusted breakpoints:
5428
5429 @smallexample
5430 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5431 to 0x00010410.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5435 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5436 frequently than expected.
5437
5438 @node Continuing and Stepping
5439 @section Continuing and Stepping
5440
5441 @cindex stepping
5442 @cindex continuing
5443 @cindex resuming execution
5444 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5445 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5446 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5447 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5448 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5449 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5450 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5451 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5452 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5453 handlers}).)
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @kindex continue
5457 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5458 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5459 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5460 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5461 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5462 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5463 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5464 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5465 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5466 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5467
5468 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5469 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5470 @code{continue} is ignored.
5471
5472 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5473 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5474 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5475 @code{continue}.
5476 @end table
5477
5478 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5479 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5480 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5481 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5482
5483 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5484 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5485 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5486 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5487 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5488 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @kindex step
5492 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5493 @item step
5494 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5495 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5496 abbreviated @code{s}.
5497
5498 @quotation
5499 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5500 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5501 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5502 @c distinction here.
5503 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5504 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5505 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5506 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5507 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5508 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5509 below.
5510 @end quotation
5511
5512 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5513 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5514 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5515 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5516 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5517 called within the line.
5518
5519 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5520 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5521 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5522 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5523 was any debugging information about the routine.
5524
5525 @item step @var{count}
5526 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5527 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5528 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5529
5530 @kindex next
5531 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5532 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5533 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5534 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5535 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5536 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5537 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5538 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5539
5540 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5541
5542
5543 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5544 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5545 @c
5546 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5547 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5548 @c function are executed without stopping.
5549
5550 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5551 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5552 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5553
5554 @kindex set step-mode
5555 @item set step-mode
5556 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5557 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5558 @itemx set step-mode on
5559 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5560 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5561 information rather than stepping over it.
5562
5563 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5564 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5565 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5566
5567 @item set step-mode off
5568 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5569 debug information. This is the default.
5570
5571 @item show step-mode
5572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5573 source line debug information.
5574
5575 @kindex finish
5576 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5577 @item finish
5578 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5579 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5580 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5581
5582 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5583 ,Returning from a Function}).
5584
5585 @kindex until
5586 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5587 @cindex run until specified location
5588 @item until
5589 @itemx u
5590 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5591 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5592 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5593 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5594 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5595 than the address of the jump.
5596
5597 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5598 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5599 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5600 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5601 through the next iteration.
5602
5603 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5604 stack frame.
5605
5606 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5607 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5608 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5609 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5610 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 (@value{GDBP}) f
5614 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5615 206 expand_input();
5616 (@value{GDBP}) until
5617 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5621 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5622 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5623 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5624 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5625 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5626 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5627
5628 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5629 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5630 argument.
5631
5632 @item until @var{location}
5633 @itemx u @var{location}
5634 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5635 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5636 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5637 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5638 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5639 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5640 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5641 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5642 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5643 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5644 invocations have returned.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 94 int factorial (int value)
5648 95 @{
5649 96 if (value > 1) @{
5650 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5651 98 @}
5652 99 return (value);
5653 100 @}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656
5657 @kindex advance @var{location}
5658 @item advance @var{location}
5659 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5660 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5661 @ref{Specify Location}.
5662 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5663 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5664 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5665 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5666
5667
5668 @kindex stepi
5669 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5670 @item stepi
5671 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5672 @itemx si
5673 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5674
5675 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5676 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5677 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5678 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5679
5680 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5681
5682 @need 750
5683 @kindex nexti
5684 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5685 @item nexti
5686 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5687 @itemx ni
5688 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5689 proceed until the function returns.
5690
5691 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5692
5693 @end table
5694
5695 @anchor{range stepping}
5696 @cindex range stepping
5697 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5698 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5699 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5700 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5701 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5702 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5703 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5704 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5705 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5706 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5707 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5708 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5709 if necessary:
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set range-stepping
5713 @kindex show range-stepping
5714 @item set range-stepping
5715 @itemx show range-stepping
5716 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5717
5718 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5719 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5720 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5721 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5722 default is @code{on}.
5723
5724 @end table
5725
5726 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5727 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5728 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5729
5730 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5731 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5732 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5733 a particular file when stepping.
5734
5735 For example, consider the following C function:
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 101 int func()
5739 102 @{
5740 103 foo(boring());
5741 104 bar(boring());
5742 105 @}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5747 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5748 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5749 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5750
5751 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5752 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5753 is called from many places.
5754
5755 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5756 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5757 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5758 @code{foo}.
5759
5760 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5761 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5762 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5763
5764 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5765 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5766 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5767 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5768 the underlying system.
5769 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5770 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex skip
5774 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5775 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5776 that specify what to skip.
5777 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @item -file @var{file}
5781 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5782 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5783
5784 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5785 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5786 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5787 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5788 over when stepping.
5789
5790 @smallexample
5791 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 @item -function @var{linespec}
5795 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5796 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5797 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5798 @xref{Specify Location}.
5799
5800 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5802 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5803 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804
5805 This form is useful for complex function names.
5806 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5807 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5808 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5809 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5810 regular expression makes this easier.
5811
5812 @smallexample
5813 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5817 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5818
5819 @smallexample
5820 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5821 @end smallexample
5822 @end table
5823
5824 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5825 will be skipped.
5826
5827 @kindex skip function
5828 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5829 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5830 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5831 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5832
5833 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5834 will be skipped.
5835
5836 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5837 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5838
5839 @kindex skip file
5840 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5841 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5842 will be skipped over when stepping.
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5846 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5850 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5854 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info skip
5858 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5859 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5860 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5861 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5862
5863 @table @emph
5864 @item Identifier
5865 A number identifying this skip.
5866 @item Enabled or Disabled
5867 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5868 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5869 @item Glob
5870 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5871 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5872 @item File
5873 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5874 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5875 @item RE
5876 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item Function
5879 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5880 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @kindex skip delete
5884 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5885 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5886 skips.
5887
5888 @kindex skip enable
5889 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5890 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5891 skips.
5892
5893 @kindex skip disable
5894 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5895 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5896 skips.
5897
5898 @kindex set debug skip
5899 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5900 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
5901
5902 @kindex show debug skip
5903 @item show debug skip
5904 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
5905
5906 @end table
5907
5908 @node Signals
5909 @section Signals
5910 @cindex signals
5911
5912 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5913 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5914 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5915 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5916 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5917 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5918 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5919 requested an alarm).
5920
5921 @cindex fatal signals
5922 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5923 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5924 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5925 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5926 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5927 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5928
5929 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5930 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5931 signal.
5932
5933 @cindex handling signals
5934 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5935 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5936 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5937 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5938 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5939
5940 @table @code
5941 @kindex info signals
5942 @kindex info handle
5943 @item info signals
5944 @itemx info handle
5945 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5946 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5947 the defined types of signals.
5948
5949 @item info signals @var{sig}
5950 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5951
5952 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5953
5954 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5955 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5956 for details about this command.
5957
5958 @kindex handle
5959 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5960 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5961 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5962 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5963 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5964 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5965 say what change to make.
5966 @end table
5967
5968 @c @group
5969 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5970 Their full names are:
5971
5972 @table @code
5973 @item nostop
5974 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5975 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5976
5977 @item stop
5978 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5979 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5980
5981 @item print
5982 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5983
5984 @item noprint
5985 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5986 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5987
5988 @item pass
5989 @itemx noignore
5990 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5991 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5992 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5993
5994 @item nopass
5995 @itemx ignore
5996 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5997 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5998 @end table
5999 @c @end group
6000
6001 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6002 program until you
6003 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6004 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6005 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6006 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6007 program sees that signal when you continue.
6008
6009 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6010 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6011 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6012 erroneous signals.
6013
6014 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6015 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6016 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6017 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6018 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6019 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6020 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6021 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6022 Program a Signal}.
6023
6024 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6025 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6026
6027 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6028 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6029 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6030 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6031 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6032 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6033 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6034 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6035 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6036 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6037 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6038 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6039 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6040
6041 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6042
6043 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6044 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6045 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6046 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6047
6048 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6049 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6050 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6051 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6052
6053 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6054 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6055
6056 @smallexample
6057 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6058 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6059 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6060 (@value{GDBP}) c
6061 Continuing.
6062
6063 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6064 main () sigusr1.c:28
6065 28 p = 0;
6066 (@value{GDBP}) si
6067 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6068 9 @{
6069 @end smallexample
6070
6071 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6072 program to receive the signal first:
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (@value{GDBP}) n
6076 28 p = 0;
6077 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6078 (@value{GDBP}) si
6079 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6080 9 @{
6081 (@value{GDBP})
6082 @end smallexample
6083
6084 @cindex extra signal information
6085 @anchor{extra signal information}
6086
6087 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6088 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6089 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6090 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6091 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6092 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6093 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6094 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6095 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6096 system header.
6097
6098 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6099 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6100
6101 @smallexample
6102 @group
6103 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6104 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6105 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6106 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6107 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6108 type = struct @{
6109 int si_signo;
6110 int si_errno;
6111 int si_code;
6112 union @{
6113 int _pad[28];
6114 struct @{...@} _kill;
6115 struct @{...@} _timer;
6116 struct @{...@} _rt;
6117 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6118 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6119 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6120 @} _sifields;
6121 @}
6122 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6123 type = struct @{
6124 void *si_addr;
6125 @}
6126 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6127 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6128 @end group
6129 @end smallexample
6130
6131 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6132
6133 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6134 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6135 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6136 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6137 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6138 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6139 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6140 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6141 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6142 information is displayed.
6143
6144 The usual output of a segfault is:
6145 @smallexample
6146 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6147 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6148 68 value = *(p + len);
6149 @end smallexample
6150
6151 While a bound violation is presented as:
6152 @smallexample
6153 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6154 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6155 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6156 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6157 68 value = *(p + len);
6158 @end smallexample
6159
6160 @node Thread Stops
6161 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6162
6163 @cindex stopped threads
6164 @cindex threads, stopped
6165
6166 @cindex continuing threads
6167 @cindex threads, continuing
6168
6169 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6170 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6171 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6172 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6173 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6174 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6175 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6176 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6177 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6178
6179 @menu
6180 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6181 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6182 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6183 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6184 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6185 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6186 @end menu
6187
6188 @node All-Stop Mode
6189 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6190
6191 @cindex all-stop mode
6192
6193 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6194 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6195 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6196 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6197 underfoot.
6198
6199 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6200 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6201 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6202
6203 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6204 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6205 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6206 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6207 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6208 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6209 stops.
6210
6211 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6212 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6213 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6214 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6215
6216 @cindex automatic thread selection
6217 @cindex switching threads automatically
6218 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6219 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6220 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6221 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6222 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6223 thread.
6224
6225 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6226 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6227
6228 @table @code
6229 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6230 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6231 @cindex lock scheduler
6232 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6233 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6234 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6235 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6236 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6237 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6238 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6239 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6240 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6241 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6242 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6243 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6244 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6245 @code{on} in replay mode.
6246
6247 @item show scheduler-locking
6248 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6249 @end table
6250
6251 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6252 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6253 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6254 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6255 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6256 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6257 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6258 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6259 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6260 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6261 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6262 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6263 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6264 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6265
6266 @table @code
6267 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6268 @item set schedule-multiple
6269 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6270 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6271 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6272 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6273 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6274 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6275
6276 @item show schedule-multiple
6277 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6278 multiple processes.
6279 @end table
6280
6281 @node Non-Stop Mode
6282 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6283
6284 @cindex non-stop mode
6285
6286 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6287 @c with more details.
6288
6289 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6290 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6291 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6292 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6293 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6294 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6295
6296 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6297 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6298 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6299 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6300 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6301 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6302 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6303 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6304 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6305 independently and simultaneously.
6306
6307 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6308 or attach to your program:
6309
6310 @smallexample
6311 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6312 set pagination off
6313
6314 # Finally, turn it on!
6315 set non-stop on
6316 @end smallexample
6317
6318 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6319
6320 @table @code
6321 @kindex set non-stop
6322 @item set non-stop on
6323 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6324 @item set non-stop off
6325 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6326 @kindex show non-stop
6327 @item show non-stop
6328 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6329 @end table
6330
6331 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6332 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6333 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6334 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6335 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6336 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6337 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6338 default.
6339
6340 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6341 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6342 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6343
6344 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6345 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6346 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6347 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6348 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6349
6350 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6351 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6352 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6353 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6354 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6355
6356 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6357
6358 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6359 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6360 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6361 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6362 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6363 previously current thread.
6364
6365 @node Background Execution
6366 @subsection Background Execution
6367
6368 @cindex foreground execution
6369 @cindex background execution
6370 @cindex asynchronous execution
6371 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6372
6373 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6374 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6375 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6376 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6377 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6378 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6379
6380 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6381 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6382
6383 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6384 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6385 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6386 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6387 are:
6388
6389 @table @code
6390 @kindex run&
6391 @item run
6392 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6393
6394 @item attach
6395 @kindex attach&
6396 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6397
6398 @item step
6399 @kindex step&
6400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6401
6402 @item stepi
6403 @kindex stepi&
6404 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6405
6406 @item next
6407 @kindex next&
6408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6409
6410 @item nexti
6411 @kindex nexti&
6412 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6413
6414 @item continue
6415 @kindex continue&
6416 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6417
6418 @item finish
6419 @kindex finish&
6420 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6421
6422 @item until
6423 @kindex until&
6424 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6425
6426 @end table
6427
6428 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6429 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6430 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6431 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6432 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6433 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6434
6435 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6436 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6437
6438 @table @code
6439 @kindex interrupt
6440 @item interrupt
6441 @itemx interrupt -a
6442
6443 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6444 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6445 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6446 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6447 @end table
6448
6449 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6450 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6451
6452 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6453 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6454 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6455
6456 @table @code
6457 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6458 @cindex thread breakpoints
6459 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6460 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6461 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6462 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6463 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6464 specify some source line.
6465
6466 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6467 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6468 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6469 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6470 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6471
6472 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6473 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6474 program.
6475
6476 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6477 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6478 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6479
6480 @smallexample
6481 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6482 @end smallexample
6483
6484 @end table
6485
6486 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6487 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6488 thread list. For example:
6489
6490 @smallexample
6491 (@value{GDBP}) c
6492 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6493 @end smallexample
6494
6495 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6496 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6497 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6498 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6499 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6500 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6501 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6502 command.
6503
6504 @node Interrupted System Calls
6505 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6506
6507 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6508 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6509 @cindex premature return from system calls
6510 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6511 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6512 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6513 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6514 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6515 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6516 stop execution.
6517
6518 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6519 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6520 style anyways.
6521
6522 For example, do not write code like this:
6523
6524 @smallexample
6525 sleep (10);
6526 @end smallexample
6527
6528 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6529 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6530
6531 Instead, write this:
6532
6533 @smallexample
6534 int unslept = 10;
6535 while (unslept > 0)
6536 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6537 @end smallexample
6538
6539 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6540 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6541 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6542 @value{GDBN}.
6543
6544 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6545 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6546 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6547 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6548
6549 @node Observer Mode
6550 @subsection Observer Mode
6551
6552 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6553 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6554 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6555 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6556 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6557
6558 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6559 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6560 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6561 mode.
6562
6563 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6564 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6565 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6566 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6567 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6568
6569 @table @code
6570
6571 @kindex observer
6572 @item set observer on
6573 @itemx set observer off
6574 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6575 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6576 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6577 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6578
6579 @item show observer
6580 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6581
6582 @kindex may-write-registers
6583 @item set may-write-registers on
6584 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6585 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6586 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6587 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6588
6589 @item show may-write-registers
6590 Show the current permission to write registers.
6591
6592 @kindex may-write-memory
6593 @item set may-write-memory on
6594 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6595 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6596 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6597 defaults to @code{on}.
6598
6599 @item show may-write-memory
6600 Show the current permission to write memory.
6601
6602 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6603 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6604 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6605 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6606 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6607 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6608
6609 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6610 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6611
6612 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6613 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6614 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6615 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6616 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6617 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6618 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6619
6620 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6621 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6622
6623 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6624 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6625 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6626 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6627 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6628 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6629 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6630
6631 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6632 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6633
6634 @kindex may-interrupt
6635 @item set may-interrupt on
6636 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6637 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6638 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6639 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6640 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6641
6642 @item show may-interrupt
6643 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6644
6645 @end table
6646
6647 @node Reverse Execution
6648 @chapter Running programs backward
6649 @cindex reverse execution
6650 @cindex running programs backward
6651
6652 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6653 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6654 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6655 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6656
6657 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6658 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6659 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6660 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6661 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6662 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6663
6664 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6665 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6666 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6667 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6668 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6669 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6670 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6671 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6672 prior values@footnote{
6673 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6674 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6675 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6676
6677 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6678 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6679 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6680 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6681 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6682 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6683 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6684 }.
6685
6686 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6687 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex reverse-continue
6691 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6692 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6693 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6694 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6695 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6696 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6697 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6698
6699 @kindex reverse-step
6700 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6701 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6702 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6703 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6704
6705 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6706 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6707 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6708 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6709 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6710 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6711
6712 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6713 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6714
6715 @kindex reverse-stepi
6716 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6717 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6718 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6719 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6720 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6721 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6722 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6723
6724 @kindex reverse-next
6725 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6726 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6727 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6728 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6729 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6730 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6731 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6732 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6733 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6734 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6735
6736 @kindex reverse-nexti
6737 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6738 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6739 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6740 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6741 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6742 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6743 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6744 frame) is reached.
6745
6746 @kindex reverse-finish
6747 @item reverse-finish
6748 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6749 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6750 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6751 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6752
6753 @kindex set exec-direction
6754 @item set exec-direction
6755 Set the direction of target execution.
6756 @item set exec-direction reverse
6757 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6758 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6759 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6760 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6761 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6762 @item set exec-direction forward
6763 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6764 This is the default.
6765 @end table
6766
6767
6768 @node Process Record and Replay
6769 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6770 @cindex process record and replay
6771 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6772
6773 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6774 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6775 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6776
6777 @cindex replay mode
6778 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6779 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6780 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6781 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6782 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6783 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6784 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6785 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6786 execution log.
6787
6788 @cindex record mode
6789 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6790 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6791 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6792 for future replay.
6793
6794 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6795 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6796 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6797 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6798 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6799 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6800
6801 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6802 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6803 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6804 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6805
6806 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6807 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6808
6809 @table @code
6810 @kindex target record
6811 @kindex target record-full
6812 @kindex target record-btrace
6813 @kindex record
6814 @kindex record full
6815 @kindex record btrace
6816 @kindex record btrace bts
6817 @kindex record btrace pt
6818 @kindex record bts
6819 @kindex record pt
6820 @kindex rec
6821 @kindex rec full
6822 @kindex rec btrace
6823 @kindex rec btrace bts
6824 @kindex rec btrace pt
6825 @kindex rec bts
6826 @kindex rec pt
6827 @item record @var{method}
6828 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6829 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6830 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6831 recording methods are available:
6832
6833 @table @code
6834 @item full
6835 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6836 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6837 execution.
6838
6839 @item btrace @var{format}
6840 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6841 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6842 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6843 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6844 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6845 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6846 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6847
6848 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6849 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6850 formats are available:
6851
6852 @table @code
6853 @item bts
6854 @cindex branch trace store
6855 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6856 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6857 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6858
6859 @item pt
6860 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6861 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6862 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6863 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6864
6865 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6866 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6867 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6868
6869 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6870 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6871 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6872 buffer-size with care.
6873 @end table
6874
6875 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6876 @end table
6877
6878 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6879 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6880 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6881 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6882
6883 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6884 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6885 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6886 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6887 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6888
6889 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6890 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6891 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6892 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6893 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6894 does not support these two modes.
6895
6896 @kindex record stop
6897 @kindex rec s
6898 @item record stop
6899 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6900 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6901 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6902
6903 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6904 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6905 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6906 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6907 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6908
6909 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6910 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6911 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6912 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6913 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6914
6915 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6916 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6917
6918 @kindex record goto
6919 @item record goto
6920 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6921 ways to specify the location to go to:
6922
6923 @table @code
6924 @item record goto begin
6925 @itemx record goto start
6926 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6927
6928 @item record goto end
6929 Go to the end of the execution log.
6930
6931 @item record goto @var{n}
6932 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6933 @end table
6934
6935 @kindex record save
6936 @item record save @var{filename}
6937 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6938 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6939 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6940
6941 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6942
6943 @kindex record restore
6944 @item record restore @var{filename}
6945 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6946 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6947
6948 @kindex set record full
6949 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6950 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6951 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6952 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6953
6954 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6955 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6956 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6957 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6958 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6959 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6960 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6961 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6962
6963 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6964 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6965 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6966
6967 @kindex show record full
6968 @item show record full insn-number-max
6969 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6970 recording method.
6971
6972 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6973 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6974 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6975 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6976 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6977 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6978 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6979 oldest one to be deleted.
6980
6981 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6982 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6983
6984 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6985 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6986
6987 @item set record full memory-query
6988 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6989 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6990 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6991 case.
6992
6993 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6994 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6995 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6996 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6997 results.
6998
6999 @item show record full memory-query
7000 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7001
7002 @kindex set record btrace
7003 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7004 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7005 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7006 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7007 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7008 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7009 You can use the following command for that:
7010
7011 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7012 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7013 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7014 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7015 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7016 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7017 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7018 position.
7019
7020 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7021 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7022 errata when decoding the trace.
7023
7024 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7025 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7026 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7027 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7028 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7029 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7030 which the trace was recorded.
7031
7032 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7033 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7034 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7035 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7036 disable the workarounds.
7037
7038 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7039 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7040 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7041 (default).
7042
7043 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7044 identifiers are currently supported:
7045
7046 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7047
7048 @item @code{intel}
7049 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7050
7051 @end multitable
7052
7053 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7054 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7055
7056 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7057 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7058 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7059
7060 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7061 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7062 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7063 supports.
7064
7065 @smallexample
7066 (gdb) info record
7067 Active record target: record-btrace
7068 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7069 Buffer size: 16kB.
7070 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7071 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7072 (gdb) info record
7073 Active record target: record-btrace
7074 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7075 Buffer size: 16kB.
7076 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7077 @end smallexample
7078
7079 @kindex show record btrace
7080 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7081 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7082
7083 @item show record btrace cpu
7084 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7085 workarounds.
7086
7087 @kindex set record btrace bts
7088 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7089 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7090 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7091 format. Default is 64KB.
7092
7093 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7094 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7095 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7096 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7097 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7098 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7099 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7100
7101 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7102 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7103
7104 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7105 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7106
7107 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7108 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7109 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7110
7111 @kindex set record btrace pt
7112 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7113 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7114 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7115 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7116
7117 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7118 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7119 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7120 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7121 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7122 actual buffer size for each thread.
7123
7124 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7125 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7126
7127 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7128 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7129
7130 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7131 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7132 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7133
7134 @kindex info record
7135 @item info record
7136 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7137 method:
7138
7139 @table @code
7140 @item full
7141 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7142 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7143
7144 @itemize @bullet
7145 @item
7146 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7147 @item
7148 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7149 @item
7150 Highest recorded instruction number.
7151 @item
7152 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7153 @item
7154 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7155 @item
7156 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7157 @end itemize
7158
7159 @item btrace
7160 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7161
7162 @itemize @bullet
7163 @item
7164 Recording format.
7165 @item
7166 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7167 @item
7168 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7169 instructions.
7170 @item
7171 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7172 @end itemize
7173
7174 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7175 @itemize @bullet
7176 @item
7177 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7178 @end itemize
7179
7180 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7181 @itemize @bullet
7182 @item
7183 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7184 @end itemize
7185 @end table
7186
7187 @kindex record delete
7188 @kindex rec del
7189 @item record delete
7190 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7191 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7192 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7193 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7194
7195 @kindex record instruction-history
7196 @kindex rec instruction-history
7197 @item record instruction-history
7198 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7199 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7200 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7201 are printed in execution order.
7202
7203 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7204 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7205 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7206
7207 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7208 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7209 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7210 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7211 @code{/p} modifier.
7212
7213 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7214 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7215 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7216
7217 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7218 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7219
7220 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7221 disassemble:
7222
7223 @table @code
7224 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7225 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7226 @var{insn}.
7227
7228 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7229 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7230 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7231 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7232 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7233 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7234
7235 @item record instruction-history
7236 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7237
7238 @item record instruction-history -
7239 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7240
7241 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7242 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7243 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7244 number @var{end} is included.
7245 @end table
7246
7247 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7248
7249 @kindex set record
7250 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7251 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7252 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7253 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7254 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7255
7256 @kindex show record
7257 @item show record instruction-history-size
7258 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7259 instruction-history} command.
7260
7261 @kindex record function-call-history
7262 @kindex rec function-call-history
7263 @item record function-call-history
7264 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7265 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7266 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7267 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7268 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7269 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7270 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7271 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7272 given together.
7273
7274 @smallexample
7275 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7276 1 void foo (void)
7277 2 @{
7278 3 @}
7279 4
7280 5 void bar (void)
7281 6 @{
7282 7 ...
7283 8 foo ();
7284 9 ...
7285 10 @}
7286 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7287 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7288 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7289 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7290 @end smallexample
7291
7292 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7293 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7294 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7295 to print:
7296
7297 @table @code
7298 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7299 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7300
7301 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7302 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7303 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7304 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7305 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7306
7307 @item record function-call-history
7308 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7309
7310 @item record function-call-history -
7311 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7312
7313 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7314 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7315 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7316 @end table
7317
7318 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7319
7320 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7321 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7322 Define how many lines to print in the
7323 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7324 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7325
7326 @item show record function-call-history-size
7327 Show how many lines to print in the
7328 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7329 @end table
7330
7331
7332 @node Stack
7333 @chapter Examining the Stack
7334
7335 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7336 stopped and how it got there.
7337
7338 @cindex call stack
7339 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7340 is generated.
7341 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7342 the arguments of the call,
7343 and the local variables of the function being called.
7344 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7345 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7346 stack}.
7347
7348 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7349 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7350
7351 @cindex selected frame
7352 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7353 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7354 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7355 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7356 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7357 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7358
7359 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7360 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7361 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7362
7363 @menu
7364 * Frames:: Stack frames
7365 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7366 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7367 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7368 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7369 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7370
7371 @end menu
7372
7373 @node Frames
7374 @section Stack Frames
7375
7376 @cindex frame, definition
7377 @cindex stack frame
7378 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7379 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7380 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7381 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7382 which the function is executing.
7383
7384 @cindex initial frame
7385 @cindex outermost frame
7386 @cindex innermost frame
7387 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7388 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7389 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7390 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7391 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7392 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7393 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7394 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7395
7396 @cindex frame pointer
7397 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7398 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7399 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7400 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7401 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7402 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7403
7404 @cindex frame number
7405 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7406 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7407 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7408 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7409 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7410
7411 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7412 @c underflow problems.
7413 @cindex frameless execution
7414 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7415 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7416 @smallexample
7417 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7418 @end smallexample
7419 generates functions without a frame.)
7420 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7421 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7422 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7423 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7424 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7425 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7426 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7427
7428 @node Backtrace
7429 @section Backtraces
7430
7431 @cindex traceback
7432 @cindex call stack traces
7433 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7434 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7435 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7436 stack.
7437
7438 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7439 @kindex backtrace
7440 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7441 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7442 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7443 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7444 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7445 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7446
7447 @table @code
7448 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7449 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7450 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7451 be one of the following:
7452
7453 @table @code
7454 @item @var{n}
7455 @itemx @var{n}
7456 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7457 number.
7458
7459 @item -@var{n}
7460 @itemx -@var{n}
7461 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7462 number.
7463
7464 @item full
7465 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7466 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7467
7468 @item no-filters
7469 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7470 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7471 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7472 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7473 support.
7474
7475 @item hide
7476 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7477 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7478 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7479 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7480 @end table
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @kindex where
7484 @kindex info stack
7485 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7486 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7487
7488 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7489 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7490 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7491 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7492 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7493 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7494 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7495 multi-threaded program.
7496
7497 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7498 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7499 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7500 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7501 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7502 line number.
7503
7504 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7505 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7506
7507 @smallexample
7508 @group
7509 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7510 at builtin.c:993
7511 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7512 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7513 at macro.c:71
7514 (More stack frames follow...)
7515 @end group
7516 @end smallexample
7517
7518 @noindent
7519 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7520 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7521 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7522
7523 @noindent
7524 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7525 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7526 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7527 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7528 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7529
7530 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7531 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7532 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7533 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7534 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7535 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7536 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7537 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7538 such a backtrace might look like:
7539
7540 @smallexample
7541 @group
7542 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7543 at builtin.c:993
7544 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7545 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7546 at macro.c:71
7547 (More stack frames follow...)
7548 @end group
7549 @end smallexample
7550
7551 @noindent
7552 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7553 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7554
7555 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7556 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7557 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7558
7559 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7560 @cindex program entry point
7561 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7562 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7563 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7564 @code{main}@footnote{
7565 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7566 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7567 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7568 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7569 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7570 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7571
7572 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7573 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7574
7575 @table @code
7576 @item set backtrace past-main
7577 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7578 @kindex set backtrace
7579 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7580
7581 @item set backtrace past-main off
7582 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7583 default.
7584
7585 @item show backtrace past-main
7586 @kindex show backtrace
7587 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7588
7589 @item set backtrace past-entry
7590 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7591 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7592 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7593 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7594
7595 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7596 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7597 application. This is the default.
7598
7599 @item show backtrace past-entry
7600 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7601
7602 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7603 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7604 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7605 @cindex backtrace limit
7606 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7607 or zero means unlimited levels.
7608
7609 @item show backtrace limit
7610 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7611 @end table
7612
7613 You can control how file names are displayed.
7614
7615 @table @code
7616 @item set filename-display
7617 @itemx set filename-display relative
7618 @cindex filename-display
7619 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7620
7621 @item set filename-display basename
7622 Display only basename of a filename.
7623
7624 @item set filename-display absolute
7625 Display an absolute filename.
7626
7627 @item show filename-display
7628 Show the current way to display filenames.
7629 @end table
7630
7631 @node Selection
7632 @section Selecting a Frame
7633
7634 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7635 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7636 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7637 of the stack frame just selected.
7638
7639 @table @code
7640 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7641 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7642 @item frame @var{n}
7643 @itemx f @var{n}
7644 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7645 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7646 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7647 @code{main}.
7648
7649 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7650 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7651 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7652 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7653 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7654 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7655 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7656 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7657
7658 @kindex up
7659 @item up @var{n}
7660 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7661 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7662 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7663
7664 @kindex down
7665 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7666 @item down @var{n}
7667 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7668 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7669 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7670 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7671 @end table
7672
7673 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7674 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7675 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7676 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7677
7678 @need 1000
7679 For example:
7680
7681 @smallexample
7682 @group
7683 (@value{GDBP}) up
7684 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7685 at env.c:10
7686 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7687 @end group
7688 @end smallexample
7689
7690 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7691 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7692 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7693 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7694 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7695 for details.
7696
7697 @table @code
7698 @kindex select-frame
7699 @item select-frame
7700 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7701 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7702 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7703 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7704
7705 @kindex down-silently
7706 @kindex up-silently
7707 @item up-silently @var{n}
7708 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7709 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7710 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7711 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7712 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7713 distracting.
7714 @end table
7715
7716 @node Frame Info
7717 @section Information About a Frame
7718
7719 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7720 stack frame.
7721
7722 @table @code
7723 @item frame
7724 @itemx f
7725 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7726 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7727 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7728 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7729 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7730
7731 @kindex info frame
7732 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7733 @item info frame
7734 @itemx info f
7735 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7736 including:
7737
7738 @itemize @bullet
7739 @item
7740 the address of the frame
7741 @item
7742 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7743 @item
7744 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7745 @item
7746 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7747 @item
7748 the address of the frame's arguments
7749 @item
7750 the address of the frame's local variables
7751 @item
7752 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7753 @item
7754 which registers were saved in the frame
7755 @end itemize
7756
7757 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7758 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7759 the usual conventions.
7760
7761 @item info frame @var{addr}
7762 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7763 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7764 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7765 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7766 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7767 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7768
7769 @kindex info args
7770 @item info args
7771 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7772
7773 @item info locals
7774 @kindex info locals
7775 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7776 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7777 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7778
7779 @end table
7780
7781 @node Frame Apply
7782 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7783 @kindex frame apply
7784 @cindex apply command to several frames
7785 @table @code
7786 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7787 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7788 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7789
7790 @table @code
7791 @item @code{all}
7792 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7793
7794 @item @var{count}
7795 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7796 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7797
7798 @item @var{-count}
7799 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7800 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7801
7802 @item @code{level}
7803 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7804 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7805 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7806 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7807 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7808 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7809
7810 @end table
7811
7812 @end table
7813
7814 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7815 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7816 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7817 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7818
7819 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7820 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7821 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7822 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7823 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7824
7825 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7826 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7827 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7828 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7829
7830 @table @code
7831 @item -c
7832 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7833 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7834 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7835 @item -s
7836 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7837 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7838 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7839 are not printed.
7840 @item -q
7841 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7842 information.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7846 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7847 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7848 @code{#1 main} frame.
7849
7850 @smallexample
7851 @group
7852 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7853 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7854 No symbol "j" in current context.
7855 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7856 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7857 No symbol "j" in current context.
7858 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7859 $1 = 5
7860 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7861 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7862 $2 = 5
7863 (gdb)
7864 @end group
7865 @end smallexample
7866
7867 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7868 information before the command output:
7869
7870 @smallexample
7871 @group
7872 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7873 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7874 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7875 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7876 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7877 (gdb)
7878 @end group
7879 @end smallexample
7880
7881 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7882 @smallexample
7883 @group
7884 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7885 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7886 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7887 (gdb)
7888 @end group
7889 @end smallexample
7890
7891 @table @code
7892
7893 @kindex faas
7894 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7895 @item faas @var{command}
7896 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7897 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7898
7899 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7900 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7901 is, using:
7902 @smallexample
7903 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7904 @end smallexample
7905
7906 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7907 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7908 @end table
7909
7910
7911 @node Frame Filter Management
7912 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7913 @cindex managing frame filters
7914
7915 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7916 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7917
7918 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7919 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7920
7921 @table @code
7922 @kindex info frame-filter
7923 @item info frame-filter
7924 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7925 their name, priority and enabled status.
7926
7927 @kindex disable frame-filter
7928 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7929 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7930 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7931 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7932 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7933 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7934 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7935 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7936 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7937 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7938 may be enabled again later.
7939
7940 @kindex enable frame-filter
7941 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7942 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7943 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7944 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7945 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7946 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7947 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7948 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7949 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7950
7951 Example:
7952
7953 @smallexample
7954 (gdb) info frame-filter
7955
7956 global frame-filters:
7957 Priority Enabled Name
7958 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7959 100 Yes Reverse
7960
7961 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7962 Priority Enabled Name
7963 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7964
7965 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7966 Priority Enabled Name
7967 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7968
7969 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7970 (gdb) info frame-filter
7971
7972 global frame-filters:
7973 Priority Enabled Name
7974 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7975 100 Yes Reverse
7976
7977 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7978 Priority Enabled Name
7979 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7980
7981 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7982 Priority Enabled Name
7983 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7984
7985 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7986 (gdb) info frame-filter
7987
7988 global frame-filters:
7989 Priority Enabled Name
7990 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7991 100 Yes Reverse
7992
7993 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7994 Priority Enabled Name
7995 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7996
7997 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7998 Priority Enabled Name
7999 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8000 @end smallexample
8001
8002 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8003 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8004 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8005 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8006 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8007 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8008 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8009
8010 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8011 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8012 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8013 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8014 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8015 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8016 dictionary resides.
8017
8018 Example:
8019
8020 @smallexample
8021 (gdb) info frame-filter
8022
8023 global frame-filters:
8024 Priority Enabled Name
8025 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8026 100 Yes Reverse
8027
8028 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8029 Priority Enabled Name
8030 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8031
8032 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8033 Priority Enabled Name
8034 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8035
8036 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8037 (gdb) info frame-filter
8038
8039 global frame-filters:
8040 Priority Enabled Name
8041 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8042 50 Yes Reverse
8043
8044 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8045 Priority Enabled Name
8046 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8047
8048 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8049 Priority Enabled Name
8050 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8051 @end smallexample
8052 @end table
8053
8054 @node Source
8055 @chapter Examining Source Files
8056
8057 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8058 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8059 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8060 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8061 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8062 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8063 source files by explicit command.
8064
8065 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8066 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8067 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8068
8069 @menu
8070 * List:: Printing source lines
8071 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8072 * Edit:: Editing source files
8073 * Search:: Searching source files
8074 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8075 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8076 @end menu
8077
8078 @node List
8079 @section Printing Source Lines
8080
8081 @kindex list
8082 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8083 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8084 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8085 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8086 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8087
8088 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8089
8090 @table @code
8091 @item list @var{linenum}
8092 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8093 current source file.
8094
8095 @item list @var{function}
8096 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8097 @var{function}.
8098
8099 @item list
8100 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8101 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8102 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8103 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8104 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8105
8106 @item list -
8107 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8108 @end table
8109
8110 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8111 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8112 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8113
8114 @table @code
8115 @kindex set listsize
8116 @item set listsize @var{count}
8117 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8118 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8119 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8120 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8121
8122 @kindex show listsize
8123 @item show listsize
8124 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8125 @end table
8126
8127 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8128 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8129 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8130 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8131 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8132
8133 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8134 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8135 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8136 to specify some source line.
8137
8138 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8139
8140 @table @code
8141 @item list @var{location}
8142 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8143
8144 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8145 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8146 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8147 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8148 the same source file as the first location.
8149
8150 @item list ,@var{last}
8151 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8152
8153 @item list @var{first},
8154 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8155
8156 @item list +
8157 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8158
8159 @item list -
8160 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8161
8162 @item list
8163 As described in the preceding table.
8164 @end table
8165
8166 @node Specify Location
8167 @section Specifying a Location
8168 @cindex specifying location
8169 @cindex location
8170 @cindex source location
8171
8172 @menu
8173 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8174 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8175 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8176 @end menu
8177
8178 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8179 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8180 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8181 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8182 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8183
8184 @node Linespec Locations
8185 @subsection Linespec Locations
8186 @cindex linespec locations
8187
8188 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8189 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8190 specifying a linespec:
8191
8192 @table @code
8193 @item @var{linenum}
8194 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8195
8196 @item -@var{offset}
8197 @itemx +@var{offset}
8198 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8199 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8200 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8201 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8202 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8203 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8204 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8205 linespec.
8206
8207 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8208 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8209 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8210 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8211 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8212 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8213 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8214
8215 @item @var{function}
8216 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8217 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8218
8219 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8220 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8221 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8222 means in all packages.
8223
8224 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8225 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8226 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8227
8228 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8229 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8230 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8231 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8232
8233 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8234
8235 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8236 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8237
8238 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8239 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8240 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8241 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8242 functions in different source files.
8243
8244 @item @var{label}
8245 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8246 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8247 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8248 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8249
8250 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8251 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8252 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8253 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8254 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8255 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8256
8257 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8258 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8259 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8260 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8261 each one of those probes.
8262 @end table
8263
8264 @node Explicit Locations
8265 @subsection Explicit Locations
8266 @cindex explicit locations
8267
8268 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8269 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8270
8271 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8272 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8273 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8274 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8275 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8276
8277 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8278 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8279 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8280 the symbol table to know.
8281
8282 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8283 following table:
8284
8285 @table @code
8286 @item -source @var{filename}
8287 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8288 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8289 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8290 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8291 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8292
8293 @item -function @var{function}
8294 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8295 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8296 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8297 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8298
8299 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8300 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8301 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8302 means in all packages.
8303
8304 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8305 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8306 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8307 breakpoint on both symbols.
8308
8309 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8310
8311 @item -qualified
8312
8313 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8314 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8315
8316 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8317 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8318 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8319
8320 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8321 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8322 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8323
8324 @item -label @var{label}
8325 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8326 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8327 selected stack frame.
8328
8329 @item -line @var{number}
8330 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8331 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8332 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8333 relative to the current line.
8334 @end table
8335
8336 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8337 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8338
8339 @node Address Locations
8340 @subsection Address Locations
8341 @cindex address locations
8342
8343 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8344 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8345
8346 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8347 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8348 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8349 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8350 source files.
8351
8352 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8353 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8354 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8355 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8356 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8357 of @var{address}:
8358
8359 @table @code
8360 @item @var{expression}
8361 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8362
8363 @item @var{funcaddr}
8364 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8365 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8366 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8367 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8368 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8369 (although the Pascal form also works).
8370
8371 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8372 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8373
8374 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8375 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8376 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8377 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8378 functions with identical names in different source files.
8379 @end table
8380
8381 @node Edit
8382 @section Editing Source Files
8383 @cindex editing source files
8384
8385 @kindex edit
8386 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8387 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8388 The editing program of your choice
8389 is invoked with the current line set to
8390 the active line in the program.
8391 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8392 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8393
8394 @table @code
8395 @item edit @var{location}
8396 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8397 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8398 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8399 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8400 command most commonly used:
8401
8402 @table @code
8403 @item edit @var{number}
8404 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8405
8406 @item edit @var{function}
8407 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8408 @end table
8409
8410 @end table
8411
8412 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8413 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8414 @footnote{
8415 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8416 following command-line syntax:
8417 @smallexample
8418 ex +@var{number} file
8419 @end smallexample
8420 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8421 the file where to start editing.}.
8422 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8423 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8424 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8425 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8426 @smallexample
8427 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8428 export EDITOR
8429 gdb @dots{}
8430 @end smallexample
8431 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8432 @smallexample
8433 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8434 gdb @dots{}
8435 @end smallexample
8436
8437 @node Search
8438 @section Searching Source Files
8439 @cindex searching source files
8440
8441 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8442 regular expression.
8443
8444 @table @code
8445 @kindex search
8446 @kindex forward-search
8447 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8448 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8449 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8450 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8451 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8452 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8453 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8454 @code{fo}.
8455
8456 @kindex reverse-search
8457 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8458 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8459 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8460 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8461 this command as @code{rev}.
8462 @end table
8463
8464 @node Source Path
8465 @section Specifying Source Directories
8466
8467 @cindex source path
8468 @cindex directories for source files
8469 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8470 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8471 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8472 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8473 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8474 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8475 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8476
8477 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8478 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8479 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8480 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8481 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8482 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8483 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8484 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8485 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8486 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8487 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8488
8489 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8490 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8491 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8492 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8493 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8494 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8495
8496 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8497 source files.
8498
8499 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8500 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8501 each line is in the file.
8502
8503 @kindex directory
8504 @kindex dir
8505 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8506 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8507 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8508
8509 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8510 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8511
8512 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8513 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8514 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8515 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8516 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8517 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8518 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8519 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8520 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8521 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8522 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8523 name to look up the sources.
8524
8525 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8526 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8527 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8528 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8529 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8530 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8531 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8532 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8533
8534 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8535 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8536 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8537 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8538 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8539 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8540 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8541
8542 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8543 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8544 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8545 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8546 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8547 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8548 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8549 command.
8550
8551 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8552 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8553 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8554 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8555 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8556 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8557 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8558
8559 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8560 @cindex default source path substitution
8561 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8562 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8563 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8564 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8565 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8566 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8567 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8568 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8569 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8570 together.
8571
8572 @table @code
8573 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8574 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8575 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8576 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8577 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8578 part of absolute file names) or
8579 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8580 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8581
8582 @kindex cdir
8583 @kindex cwd
8584 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8585 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8586 @cindex compilation directory
8587 @cindex current directory
8588 @cindex working directory
8589 @cindex directory, current
8590 @cindex directory, compilation
8591 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8592 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8593 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8594 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8595 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8596 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8597
8598 @item directory
8599 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8600
8601 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8602 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8603
8604 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8605 @kindex set directories
8606 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8607 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8608
8609 @item show directories
8610 @kindex show directories
8611 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8612
8613 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8614 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8615 @kindex set substitute-path
8616 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8617 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8618 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8619
8620 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8621 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8622
8623 @smallexample
8624 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8625 @end smallexample
8626
8627 @noindent
8628 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8629 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8630 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8631
8632 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8633 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8634 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8635 the substitution.
8636
8637 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8638
8639 @smallexample
8640 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8641 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8642 @end smallexample
8643
8644 @noindent
8645 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8646 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8647 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8648 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8649
8650
8651 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8652 @kindex unset substitute-path
8653 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8654 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8655 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8656
8657 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8658
8659 @item show substitute-path [path]
8660 @kindex show substitute-path
8661 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8662 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8663
8664 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8665 rules.
8666
8667 @end table
8668
8669 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8670 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8671 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8672
8673 @enumerate
8674 @item
8675 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8676
8677 @item
8678 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8679 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8680 directories in one command.
8681 @end enumerate
8682
8683 @node Machine Code
8684 @section Source and Machine Code
8685 @cindex source line and its code address
8686
8687 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8688 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8689 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8690 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8691 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8692 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8693 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8694 well as hex.
8695
8696 @table @code
8697 @kindex info line
8698 @item info line
8699 @itemx info line @var{location}
8700 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8701 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8702 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8703 information about the current source line is printed.
8704 @end table
8705
8706 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8707 the object code for the first line of function
8708 @code{m4_changequote}:
8709
8710 @smallexample
8711 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8712 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8713 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8714 @end smallexample
8715
8716 @noindent
8717 @cindex code address and its source line
8718 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8719 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8720 @smallexample
8721 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8722 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8723 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8724 @end smallexample
8725
8726 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8727 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8728 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8729 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8730 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8731 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8732 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8733 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8734 Variables}).
8735
8736 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8737 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8738 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8739 line.
8740
8741 @table @code
8742 @kindex disassemble
8743 @cindex assembly instructions
8744 @cindex instructions, assembly
8745 @cindex machine instructions
8746 @cindex listing machine instructions
8747 @item disassemble
8748 @itemx disassemble /m
8749 @itemx disassemble /s
8750 @itemx disassemble /r
8751 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8752 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8753 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8754 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8755 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8756 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8757 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8758 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8759 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8760 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8761
8762 @table @code
8763 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8764 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8765 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8766 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8767 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8768 @end table
8769
8770 @noindent
8771 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8772 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8773
8774 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8775 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8776
8777 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8778 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8779 @end table
8780
8781 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8782 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8783
8784 @smallexample
8785 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8786 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8787 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8788 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8789 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8790 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8791 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8792 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8793 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8794 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8795 End of assembler dump.
8796 @end smallexample
8797
8798 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8799 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8800 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8801
8802 @smallexample
8803 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8804 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8805 5 @{
8806 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8807 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8808 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8809 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8810 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8811
8812 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8813 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8814 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8815
8816 7 return 0;
8817 8 @}
8818 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8819 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8820 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8821
8822 End of assembler dump.
8823 @end smallexample
8824
8825 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8826 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8827 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8828 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8829 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8830 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8831 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8832 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8833 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8834
8835 @file{foo.h}:
8836
8837 @smallexample
8838 int
8839 foo (int a)
8840 @{
8841 if (a < 0)
8842 return a * 2;
8843 if (a == 0)
8844 return 1;
8845 return a + 10;
8846 @}
8847 @end smallexample
8848
8849 @file{foo.c}:
8850
8851 @smallexample
8852 #include "foo.h"
8853 volatile int x, y;
8854 int
8855 main ()
8856 @{
8857 x = foo (y);
8858 return 0;
8859 @}
8860 @end smallexample
8861
8862 @smallexample
8863 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8864 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8865 5 @{
8866
8867 6 x = foo (y);
8868 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8869 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8870
8871 7 return 0;
8872 8 @}
8873 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8874 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8875 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8876 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8877
8878 End of assembler dump.
8879 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8880 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8881 foo.c:
8882 5 @{
8883 6 x = foo (y);
8884 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8885
8886 foo.h:
8887 4 if (a < 0)
8888 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8889 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8890
8891 6 if (a == 0)
8892 7 return 1;
8893 8 return a + 10;
8894 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8895 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8896 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8897 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8898
8899 foo.c:
8900 6 x = foo (y);
8901 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8902
8903 7 return 0;
8904 8 @}
8905 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8906 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8907
8908 foo.h:
8909 5 return a * 2;
8910 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8911 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8912 End of assembler dump.
8913 @end smallexample
8914
8915 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8916
8917 @smallexample
8918 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8919 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8920 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8921 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8922 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8923 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8924 End of assembler dump.
8925 @end smallexample
8926
8927 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8928 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8929 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8930 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8931
8932 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8933 mnemonics or other syntax.
8934
8935 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8936 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8937 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8938 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8939 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8940
8941 @table @code
8942 @kindex set disassembler-options
8943 @cindex disassembler options
8944 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8945 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8946 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8947 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8948 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8949 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8950 The default value is the empty string.
8951
8952 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8953 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8954 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
8955 and S/390.
8956
8957 @kindex show disassembler-options
8958 @item show disassembler-options
8959 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8960 @end table
8961
8962 @table @code
8963 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8964 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8965 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8966 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8967 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8968 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8969
8970 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8971 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8972 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8973 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8974
8975 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8976 @item show disassembly-flavor
8977 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8978 @end table
8979
8980 @table @code
8981 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8982 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8983 @item set disassemble-next-line
8984 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8985 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8986 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8987 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8988 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8989 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8990 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8991 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8992 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8993 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8994 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8995 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8996 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8997 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8998 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8999 instruction.
9000 @end table
9001
9002
9003 @node Data
9004 @chapter Examining Data
9005
9006 @cindex printing data
9007 @cindex examining data
9008 @kindex print
9009 @kindex inspect
9010 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9011 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9012 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9013 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9014 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9015 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9016
9017 @table @code
9018 @item print @var{expr}
9019 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9020 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9021 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9022 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9023 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9024 Formats}.
9025
9026 @item print
9027 @itemx print /@var{f}
9028 @cindex reprint the last value
9029 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9030 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9031 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9032 @end table
9033
9034 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9035 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9036 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9037
9038 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9039 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9040 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9041 Table}.
9042
9043 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9044 @kindex explore
9045 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9046 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9047 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9048 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9049 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9050 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9051 embedded in the higher level data types.
9052
9053 @table @code
9054 @item explore @var{arg}
9055 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9056 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9057 @end table
9058
9059 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9060 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9061 C program as
9062
9063 @smallexample
9064 struct SimpleStruct
9065 @{
9066 int i;
9067 double d;
9068 @};
9069
9070 struct ComplexStruct
9071 @{
9072 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9073 int arr[10];
9074 @};
9075 @end smallexample
9076
9077 @noindent
9078 followed by variable declarations as
9079
9080 @smallexample
9081 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9082 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9083 @end smallexample
9084
9085 @noindent
9086 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9087 @code{explore} command as follows.
9088
9089 @smallexample
9090 (gdb) explore cs
9091 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9092 the following fields:
9093
9094 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9095 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9096
9097 Enter the field number of choice:
9098 @end smallexample
9099
9100 @noindent
9101 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9102 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9103 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9104 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9105 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9106 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9107 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9108 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9112 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9113 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9114 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9115
9116 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9117 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9118
9119 Press enter to return to parent value:
9120 @end smallexample
9121
9122 @noindent
9123 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9124 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9125 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9126 to explore.
9127
9128 @smallexample
9129 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9130 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9131
9132 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9133
9134 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9135
9136 Press enter to return to parent value:
9137 @end smallexample
9138
9139 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9140 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9141 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9142 level data structure).
9143
9144 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9145 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9146 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9147 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9148 same example as above, your can explore the type
9149 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9150 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9151
9152 @smallexample
9153 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9154 @end smallexample
9155
9156 @noindent
9157 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9158 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9159 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9160 example.
9161
9162 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9163 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9164 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9165 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9166 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9167
9168 @table @code
9169 @item explore value @var{expr}
9170 @cindex explore value
9171 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9172 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9173 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9174 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9175 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9176
9177 @item explore type @var{arg}
9178 @cindex explore type
9179 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9180 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9181 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9182 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9183 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9184 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9185 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9186 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9187 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9188 @end table
9189
9190 @menu
9191 * Expressions:: Expressions
9192 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9193 * Variables:: Program variables
9194 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9195 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9196 * Memory:: Examining memory
9197 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9198 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9199 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9200 * Value History:: Value history
9201 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9202 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9203 * Registers:: Registers
9204 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9205 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9206 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9207 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9208 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9209 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9210 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9211 character set than GDB does
9212 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9213 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9214 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9215 @end menu
9216
9217 @node Expressions
9218 @section Expressions
9219
9220 @cindex expressions
9221 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9222 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9223 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9224 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9225 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9226 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9227 @ref{Compilation}.
9228
9229 @cindex arrays in expressions
9230 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9231 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9232 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9233 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9234 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9235 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9236
9237 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9238 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9239 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9240 languages.
9241
9242 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9243 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9244
9245 @cindex casts, in expressions
9246 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9247 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9248 at that address in memory.
9249 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9250
9251 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9252 to programming languages:
9253
9254 @table @code
9255 @item @@
9256 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9257 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9258
9259 @item ::
9260 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9261 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9262
9263 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9264 @cindex type casting memory
9265 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9266 @cindex casts, to view memory
9267 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9268 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9269 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9270 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9271 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9272 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9273 @end table
9274
9275 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9276 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9277 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9278
9279 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9280 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9281 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9282 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9283 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9284 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9285 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9286
9287 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9288 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9289 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9290 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9291 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9292 as well.
9293
9294 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9295 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9296 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9297 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9298 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9299 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9300 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9301 choices.
9302
9303 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9304 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9305 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9306
9307 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9308 @smallexample
9309 @group
9310 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9311 [0] cancel
9312 [1] all
9313 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9314 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9315 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9316 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9317 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9318 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9319 > 2 4 6
9320 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9321 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9322 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9323 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9324 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9325 breakpoints.
9326 (@value{GDBP})
9327 @end group
9328 @end smallexample
9329
9330 @table @code
9331 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9332 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9333 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9334
9335 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9336 is ambiguous.
9337
9338 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9339 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9340 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9341 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9342 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9343 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9344 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9345 in the use of the menu.
9346
9347 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9348 when an ambiguity is detected.
9349
9350 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9351 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9352
9353 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9354 @item show multiple-symbols
9355 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9356 @end table
9357
9358 @node Variables
9359 @section Program Variables
9360
9361 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9362 in your program.
9363
9364 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9365 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9366
9367 @itemize @bullet
9368 @item
9369 global (or file-static)
9370 @end itemize
9371
9372 @noindent or
9373
9374 @itemize @bullet
9375 @item
9376 visible according to the scope rules of the
9377 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9378 @end itemize
9379
9380 @noindent This means that in the function
9381
9382 @smallexample
9383 foo (a)
9384 int a;
9385 @{
9386 bar (a);
9387 @{
9388 int b = test ();
9389 bar (b);
9390 @}
9391 @}
9392 @end smallexample
9393
9394 @noindent
9395 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9396 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9397 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9398 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9399
9400 @cindex variable name conflict
9401 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9402 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9403 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9404 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9405 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9406 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9407 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9408
9409 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9410 @ifnotinfo
9411 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9412 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9413 @end ifnotinfo
9414 @smallexample
9415 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9416 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9417 @end smallexample
9418
9419 @noindent
9420 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9421 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9422 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9423 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9424
9425 @smallexample
9426 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9427 @end smallexample
9428
9429 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9430 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9431 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9432 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9433 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9434
9435 @smallexample
9436 void
9437 foo (int a)
9438 @{
9439 if (a < 10)
9440 bar (a);
9441 else
9442 process (a); /* Stop here */
9443 @}
9444
9445 int
9446 bar (int a)
9447 @{
9448 foo (a + 5);
9449 @}
9450 @end smallexample
9451
9452 @noindent
9453 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9454 here is what you might see
9455 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9456
9457 @smallexample
9458 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9459 $1 = 10
9460 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9461 $2 = 5
9462 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9463 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9464 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9465 $3 = 5
9466 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9467 $4 = 0
9468 @end smallexample
9469
9470 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9471 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9472 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9473 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9474 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9475
9476 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9477 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9478 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9479 @code{some_global}.
9480
9481 @smallexample
9482 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9483 $1 = 23
9484 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9485 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9486 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9487 $2 = 27
9488 @end smallexample
9489
9490 @cindex wrong values
9491 @cindex variable values, wrong
9492 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9493 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9494 @quotation
9495 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9496 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9497 scope, and just before exit.
9498 @end quotation
9499 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9500 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9501 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9502 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9503 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9504 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9505 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9506 variable definitions may be gone.
9507
9508 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9509 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9510 when compiling.
9511
9512 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9513 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9514 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9515 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9516 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9517 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9518 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9519
9520 @smallexample
9521 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9522 @end smallexample
9523
9524 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9525 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9526 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9527 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9528 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9529
9530 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9531 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9532 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9533 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9534
9535 @cindex no debug info variables
9536 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9537 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9538 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9539 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9540 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9541 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9542 example, in a C program:
9543
9544 @smallexample
9545 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9546 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9547 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9548 $1 = 3.14
9549 @end smallexample
9550
9551 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9552 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9553 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9554 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9555 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9556
9557 @smallexample
9558 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9559 29 i++;
9560 (gdb) next
9561 30 e (i);
9562 (gdb) print i
9563 $1 = 31
9564 (gdb) print i@@entry
9565 $2 = 30
9566 @end smallexample
9567
9568 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9569 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9570 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9571 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9572 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9573 For program code
9574
9575 @smallexample
9576 char var0[] = "A";
9577 signed char var1[] = "A";
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 You get during debugging
9581 @smallexample
9582 (gdb) print var0
9583 $1 = "A"
9584 (gdb) print var1
9585 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9586 @end smallexample
9587
9588 @node Arrays
9589 @section Artificial Arrays
9590
9591 @cindex artificial array
9592 @cindex arrays
9593 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9594 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9595 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9596 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9597 program.
9598
9599 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9600 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9601 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9602 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9603 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9604 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9605 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9606 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9607 example. If a program says
9608
9609 @smallexample
9610 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9611 @end smallexample
9612
9613 @noindent
9614 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9615
9616 @smallexample
9617 p *array@@len
9618 @end smallexample
9619
9620 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9621 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9622 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9623 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9624 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9625
9626 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9627 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9628 The value need not be in memory:
9629 @smallexample
9630 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9631 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9635 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9636 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9637 @smallexample
9638 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9639 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9640 @end smallexample
9641
9642 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9643 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9644 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9645 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9646 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9647 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9648 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9649 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9650 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9651 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9652
9653 @smallexample
9654 set $i = 0
9655 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9656 @key{RET}
9657 @key{RET}
9658 @dots{}
9659 @end smallexample
9660
9661 @node Output Formats
9662 @section Output Formats
9663
9664 @cindex formatted output
9665 @cindex output formats
9666 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9667 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9668 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9669 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9670 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9671
9672 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9673 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9674 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9675 letters supported are:
9676
9677 @table @code
9678 @item x
9679 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9680 hexadecimal.
9681
9682 @item d
9683 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9684
9685 @item u
9686 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9687
9688 @item o
9689 Print as integer in octal.
9690
9691 @item t
9692 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9693 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9694 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9695 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9696
9697 @item a
9698 @cindex unknown address, locating
9699 @cindex locate address
9700 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9701 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9702 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9703
9704 @smallexample
9705 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9706 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9707 @end smallexample
9708
9709 @noindent
9710 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9711 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9712
9713 @item c
9714 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9715 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9716 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9717 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9718
9719 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9720 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9721 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9722 data.
9723
9724 @item f
9725 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9726 using typical floating point syntax.
9727
9728 @item s
9729 @cindex printing strings
9730 @cindex printing byte arrays
9731 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9732 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9733 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9734 natural types.
9735
9736 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9737 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9738 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9739 array.
9740
9741 @item z
9742 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9743 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9744 to the size of the integer type.
9745
9746 @item r
9747 @cindex raw printing
9748 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9749 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9750 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9751 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9752 pretty-printer which might exist.
9753 @end table
9754
9755 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9756
9757 @smallexample
9758 p/x $pc
9759 @end smallexample
9760
9761 @noindent
9762 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9763 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9764
9765 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9766 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9767 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9768
9769 @node Memory
9770 @section Examining Memory
9771
9772 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9773 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9774
9775 @cindex examining memory
9776 @table @code
9777 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9778 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9779 @itemx x @var{addr}
9780 @itemx x
9781 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9782 @end table
9783
9784 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9785 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9786 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9787 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9788 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9789
9790 @table @r
9791 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9792 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9793 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9794 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9795 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9796 @c 4.1.2.
9797
9798 @item @var{f}, the display format
9799 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9800 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9801 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9802 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9803 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9804
9805 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9806 The unit size is any of
9807
9808 @table @code
9809 @item b
9810 Bytes.
9811 @item h
9812 Halfwords (two bytes).
9813 @item w
9814 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9815 @item g
9816 Giant words (eight bytes).
9817 @end table
9818
9819 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9820 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9821 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9822 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9823 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9824 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9825 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9826 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9827 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9828 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9829 be altered.
9830
9831 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9832 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9833 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9834 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9835 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9836 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9837 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9838 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9839 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9840 a value from memory).
9841 @end table
9842
9843 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9844 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9845 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9846 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9847 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9848
9849 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9850 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9851 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9852
9853 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9854 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9855 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9856 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9857 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9858
9859 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9860 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9861 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9862 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9863 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9864 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9865 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9866 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9867 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9868
9869 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9870 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9871 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9872 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9873 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9874 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9875
9876 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9877 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9878 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9879 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9880 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9881 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9882 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9883
9884 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9885 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9886
9887 @smallexample
9888 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9889 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9890 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9891 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9892 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9893 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9894 @end smallexample
9895
9896 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9897 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9898 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9899 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9900 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9901 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9902 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9903 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9904 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9905
9906 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9907 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9908 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9909
9910 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9911 @cindex addressable memory unit
9912 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9913 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9914 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9915 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9916 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9917 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9918 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9919 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9920 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9921
9922 @cindex remote memory comparison
9923 @cindex target memory comparison
9924 @cindex verify remote memory image
9925 @cindex verify target memory image
9926 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9927 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9928 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9929 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9930 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9931 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9932
9933 @table @code
9934 @kindex compare-sections
9935 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9936 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9937 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9938 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9939 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9940 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9941
9942 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9943 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9944 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9945 @end table
9946
9947 @node Auto Display
9948 @section Automatic Display
9949 @cindex automatic display
9950 @cindex display of expressions
9951
9952 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9953 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9954 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9955 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9956 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9957 The automatic display looks like this:
9958
9959 @smallexample
9960 2: foo = 38
9961 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9962 @end smallexample
9963
9964 @noindent
9965 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9966 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9967 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9968 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9969 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9970 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9971
9972 @table @code
9973 @kindex display
9974 @item display @var{expr}
9975 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9976 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9977
9978 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9979
9980 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9981 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9982 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9983 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9984 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9985
9986 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9987 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9988 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9989 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9990 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9991 @end table
9992
9993 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9994 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9995 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9996
9997 @table @code
9998 @kindex delete display
9999 @kindex undisplay
10000 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10001 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10002 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10003 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10004 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10005 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10006 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10007
10008 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10009 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10010
10011 @kindex disable display
10012 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10013 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10014 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10015 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10016 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10017 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10018 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10019 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10020
10021 @kindex enable display
10022 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10023 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10024 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10025 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10026 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10027 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10028 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10029
10030 @item display
10031 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10032 done when your program stops.
10033
10034 @kindex info display
10035 @item info display
10036 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10037 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10038 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10039 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10040 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10041 @end table
10042
10043 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10044 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10045 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10046 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10047 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10048 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10049 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10050 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10051 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10052 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10053 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10054
10055 @node Print Settings
10056 @section Print Settings
10057
10058 @cindex format options
10059 @cindex print settings
10060 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10061 and symbols are printed.
10062
10063 @noindent
10064 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10065
10066 @table @code
10067 @kindex set print
10068 @item set print address
10069 @itemx set print address on
10070 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10071 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10072 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10073 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10074 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10075 @code{set print address on}:
10076
10077 @smallexample
10078 @group
10079 (@value{GDBP}) f
10080 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10081 at input.c:530
10082 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10083 @end group
10084 @end smallexample
10085
10086 @item set print address off
10087 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10088 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 @group
10092 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10093 (@value{GDBP}) f
10094 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10095 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10096 @end group
10097 @end smallexample
10098
10099 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10100 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10101 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10102 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10103
10104 @kindex show print
10105 @item show print address
10106 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10107 @end table
10108
10109 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10110 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10111 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10112 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10113 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10114 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10115 it prints a symbolic address:
10116
10117 @table @code
10118 @item set print symbol-filename on
10119 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10120 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10121 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10122 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10123
10124 @item set print symbol-filename off
10125 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10126 default.
10127
10128 @item show print symbol-filename
10129 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10130 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10131 @end table
10132
10133 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10134 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10135 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10136
10137 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10138 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10139
10140 @table @code
10141 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10142 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10143 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10144 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10145 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10146 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10147 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10148 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10149
10150 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10151 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10152 symbolic address.
10153 @end table
10154
10155 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10156 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10157 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10158 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10159 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10160 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10161 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10162 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10163
10164 @smallexample
10165 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10166 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10167 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10168 @end smallexample
10169
10170 @quotation
10171 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10172 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10173 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10174 @end quotation
10175
10176 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10177 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10178
10179 @table @code
10180 @item set print symbol on
10181 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10182 one exists.
10183
10184 @item set print symbol off
10185 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10186 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10187 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10188
10189 @item show print symbol
10190 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10191 address.
10192 @end table
10193
10194 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10195
10196 @table @code
10197 @item set print array
10198 @itemx set print array on
10199 @cindex pretty print arrays
10200 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10201 but uses more space. The default is off.
10202
10203 @item set print array off
10204 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10205
10206 @item show print array
10207 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10208 arrays.
10209
10210 @cindex print array indexes
10211 @item set print array-indexes
10212 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10213 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10214 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10215 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10216
10217 @item set print array-indexes off
10218 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10219
10220 @item show print array-indexes
10221 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10222 arrays.
10223
10224 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10225 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10226 @cindex number of array elements to print
10227 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10228 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10229 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10230 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10231 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10232 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10233 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10234 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10235
10236 @item show print elements
10237 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10238 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10239
10240 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10241 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10242 @cindex printing frame argument values
10243 @cindex print all frame argument values
10244 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10245 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10246 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10247 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10248 values are:
10249
10250 @table @code
10251 @item all
10252 The values of all arguments are printed.
10253
10254 @item scalars
10255 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10256 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10257 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10258 only scalar arguments are shown:
10259
10260 @smallexample
10261 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10262 at frame-args.c:23
10263 @end smallexample
10264
10265 @item none
10266 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10267 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10268
10269 @smallexample
10270 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10271 at frame-args.c:23
10272 @end smallexample
10273 @end table
10274
10275 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10276 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10277 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10278 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10279 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10280 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10281 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10282 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10283 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10284 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10285
10286 @item show print frame-arguments
10287 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10288
10289 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10290 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10291
10292 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10293 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10294 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10295 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10296 This is the default.
10297
10298 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10299 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10300
10301 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10302 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10303 @kindex set print entry-values
10304 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10305 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10306 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10307 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10308 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10309
10310 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10311 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10312 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10313 @code{no} setting.
10314
10315 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10316 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10317 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10318 this information.
10319
10320 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10321
10322 @table @code
10323 @item no
10324 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10325 point.
10326 @smallexample
10327 #0 equal (val=5)
10328 #0 different (val=6)
10329 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10330 #0 born (val=10)
10331 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 @item only
10335 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10336 values are never printed.
10337 @smallexample
10338 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10339 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10340 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10341 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10342 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10343 @end smallexample
10344
10345 @item preferred
10346 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10347 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10348 value for such parameter.
10349 @smallexample
10350 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10351 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10352 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10353 #0 born (val=10)
10354 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10355 @end smallexample
10356
10357 @item if-needed
10358 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10359 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10360 parameter.
10361 @smallexample
10362 #0 equal (val=5)
10363 #0 different (val=6)
10364 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10365 #0 born (val=10)
10366 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10367 @end smallexample
10368
10369 @item both
10370 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10371 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10372 optimizations.
10373 @smallexample
10374 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10375 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10376 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10377 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10378 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10379 @end smallexample
10380
10381 @item compact
10382 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10383 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10384 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10385 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10386 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10387 @smallexample
10388 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10389 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10390 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10391 #0 born (val=10)
10392 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10393 @end smallexample
10394
10395 @item default
10396 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10397 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10398 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10399 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10400 @smallexample
10401 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10402 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10403 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10404 #0 born (val=10)
10405 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10406 @end smallexample
10407 @end table
10408
10409 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10410 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10411
10412 @item show print entry-values
10413 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10414 entry.
10415
10416 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10417 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10418 @cindex repeated array elements
10419 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10420 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10421 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10422 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10423 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10424 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10425 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10426 is 10.
10427
10428 @item show print repeats
10429 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10430 elements.
10431
10432 @item set print null-stop
10433 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10434 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10435 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10436 contain only short strings.
10437 The default is off.
10438
10439 @item show print null-stop
10440 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10441 @sc{null} character.
10442
10443 @item set print pretty on
10444 @cindex print structures in indented form
10445 @cindex indentation in structure display
10446 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10447 per line, like this:
10448
10449 @smallexample
10450 @group
10451 $1 = @{
10452 next = 0x0,
10453 flags = @{
10454 sweet = 1,
10455 sour = 1
10456 @},
10457 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10458 @}
10459 @end group
10460 @end smallexample
10461
10462 @item set print pretty off
10463 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10464
10465 @smallexample
10466 @group
10467 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10468 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10469 @end group
10470 @end smallexample
10471
10472 @noindent
10473 This is the default format.
10474
10475 @item show print pretty
10476 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10477
10478 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10479 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10480 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10481 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10482 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10483 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10484 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10485 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10486
10487 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10488 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10489 international character sets, and is the default.
10490
10491 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10492 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10493
10494 @item set print union on
10495 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10496 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10497 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10498
10499 @item set print union off
10500 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10501 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10502 instead.
10503
10504 @item show print union
10505 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10506 structures and other unions.
10507
10508 For example, given the declarations
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10512 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10513 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10514 Bug_forms;
10515
10516 struct thing @{
10517 Species it;
10518 union @{
10519 Tree_forms tree;
10520 Bug_forms bug;
10521 @} form;
10522 @};
10523
10524 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10525 @end smallexample
10526
10527 @noindent
10528 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10529
10530 @smallexample
10531 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10532 @end smallexample
10533
10534 @noindent
10535 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10536
10537 @smallexample
10538 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10539 @end smallexample
10540
10541 @noindent
10542 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10543 and in Pascal.
10544 @end table
10545
10546 @need 1000
10547 @noindent
10548 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10549
10550 @table @code
10551 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10552 @item set print demangle
10553 @itemx set print demangle on
10554 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10555 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10556 linkage. The default is on.
10557
10558 @item show print demangle
10559 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10560
10561 @item set print asm-demangle
10562 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10563 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10564 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10565 The default is off.
10566
10567 @item show print asm-demangle
10568 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10569 or demangled form.
10570
10571 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10572 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10573 @kindex set demangle-style
10574 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10575 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10576 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10577
10578 @table @code
10579 @item auto
10580 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10581 This is the default.
10582
10583 @item gnu
10584 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10585
10586 @item hp
10587 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10588
10589 @item lucid
10590 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10591
10592 @item arm
10593 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10594 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10595 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10596 require further enhancement to permit that.
10597
10598 @end table
10599 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10600
10601 @item show demangle-style
10602 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10603
10604 @item set print object
10605 @itemx set print object on
10606 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10607 @cindex display derived types
10608 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10609 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10610 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10611 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10612 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10613 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10614 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10615
10616 @item set print object off
10617 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10618 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10619
10620 @item show print object
10621 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10622
10623 @item set print static-members
10624 @itemx set print static-members on
10625 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10626 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10627
10628 @item set print static-members off
10629 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10630
10631 @item show print static-members
10632 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10633
10634 @item set print pascal_static-members
10635 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10636 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10637 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10638 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10639
10640 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10641 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10642
10643 @item show print pascal_static-members
10644 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10645
10646 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10647 @item set print vtbl
10648 @itemx set print vtbl on
10649 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10650 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10651 @cindex VTBL display
10652 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10653 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10654 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10655
10656 @item set print vtbl off
10657 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10658
10659 @item show print vtbl
10660 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10661 @end table
10662
10663 @node Pretty Printing
10664 @section Pretty Printing
10665
10666 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10667 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10668 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10669
10670 @menu
10671 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10672 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10673 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10674 @end menu
10675
10676 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10677 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10678
10679 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10680 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10681 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10682
10683 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10684 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10685 pretty-printers with their names.
10686 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10687 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10688 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10689 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10690
10691 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10692 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10693 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10694 do anything special.
10695
10696 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10697
10698 @itemize @bullet
10699 @item
10700 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10701 all inferiors.
10702
10703 @item
10704 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10705 when debugging that program.
10706 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10707
10708 @item
10709 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10710 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10711 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10712 @end itemize
10713
10714 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10715 pretty-printers are selected,
10716
10717 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10718 for new types.
10719
10720 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10721 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10722
10723 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10724
10725 @smallexample
10726 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10727 $1 = @{
10728 static npos = 4294967295,
10729 _M_dataplus = @{
10730 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10731 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10732 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10733 @},
10734 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10735 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10736 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10737 @}
10738 @}
10739 @end smallexample
10740
10741 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10742
10743 @smallexample
10744 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10745 $2 = "abcd"
10746 @end smallexample
10747
10748 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10749 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10750 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10751
10752 @table @code
10753 @kindex info pretty-printer
10754 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10755 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10756 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10757
10758 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10759 whose pretty-printers to list.
10760 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10761 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10762 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10763 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10764 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10765
10766 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10767 to list.
10768
10769 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10770 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10771 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10772 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10773
10774 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10775 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10776 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10777 @end table
10778
10779 Example:
10780
10781 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10782 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10783 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10784 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10785
10786 @smallexample
10787 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10788 library1.so:
10789 foo
10790 library2.so:
10791 bar
10792 bar1
10793 bar2
10794 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10795 library2.so:
10796 bar
10797 bar1
10798 bar2
10799 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10800 1 printer disabled
10801 2 of 3 printers enabled
10802 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10803 library1.so:
10804 foo [disabled]
10805 library2.so:
10806 bar
10807 bar1
10808 bar2
10809 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
10810 1 printer disabled
10811 1 of 3 printers enabled
10812 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10813 library1.so:
10814 foo [disabled]
10815 library2.so:
10816 bar
10817 bar1 [disabled]
10818 bar2
10819 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10820 1 printer disabled
10821 0 of 3 printers enabled
10822 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10823 library1.so:
10824 foo [disabled]
10825 library2.so:
10826 bar [disabled]
10827 bar1 [disabled]
10828 bar2
10829 @end smallexample
10830
10831 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10832 as can each individual subprinter.
10833
10834 @node Value History
10835 @section Value History
10836
10837 @cindex value history
10838 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10839 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10840 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10841 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10842 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10843 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10844 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10845 symbol table.
10846
10847 @cindex @code{$}
10848 @cindex @code{$$}
10849 @cindex history number
10850 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10851 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10852 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10853 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10854 history number.
10855
10856 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10857 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10858 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10859 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10860 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10861 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10862 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10863
10864 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10865 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10866
10867 @smallexample
10868 p *$
10869 @end smallexample
10870
10871 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10872 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10873
10874 @smallexample
10875 p *$.next
10876 @end smallexample
10877
10878 @noindent
10879 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10880 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10881
10882 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10883 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10884
10885 @smallexample
10886 print x
10887 set x=5
10888 @end smallexample
10889
10890 @noindent
10891 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10892 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10893
10894 @table @code
10895 @kindex show values
10896 @item show values
10897 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10898 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10899 values} does not change the history.
10900
10901 @item show values @var{n}
10902 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10903
10904 @item show values +
10905 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10906 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10907 @end table
10908
10909 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10910 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10911
10912 @node Convenience Vars
10913 @section Convenience Variables
10914
10915 @cindex convenience variables
10916 @cindex user-defined variables
10917 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10918 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10919 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10920 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10921 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10922
10923 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10924 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10925 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10926 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10927 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10928
10929 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10930 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10931 For example:
10932
10933 @smallexample
10934 set $foo = *object_ptr
10935 @end smallexample
10936
10937 @noindent
10938 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10939 @code{object_ptr}.
10940
10941 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10942 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10943 value with another assignment at any time.
10944
10945 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10946 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10947 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10948 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10949
10950 @table @code
10951 @kindex show convenience
10952 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10953 @item show convenience
10954 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10955 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10956 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10957
10958 @kindex init-if-undefined
10959 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10960 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10961 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10962 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10963 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10964 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10965 override default values used in a command script.
10966
10967 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10968 any side-effects do not occur.
10969 @end table
10970
10971 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10972 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10973 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10974
10975 @smallexample
10976 set $i = 0
10977 print bar[$i++]->contents
10978 @end smallexample
10979
10980 @noindent
10981 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10982
10983 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10984 values likely to be useful.
10985
10986 @table @code
10987 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10988 @item $_
10989 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10990 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10991 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10992 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10993 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10994 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10995 to the type of @code{$__}.
10996
10997 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10998 @item $__
10999 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11000 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11001 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11002
11003 @item $_exitcode
11004 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11005 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11006 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11007 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11008
11009 @item $_exitsignal
11010 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11011 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11012 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11013 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11014
11015 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11016 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11017 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11018 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11019 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11020
11021 @smallexample
11022 #include <signal.h>
11023
11024 int
11025 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11026 @{
11027 raise (SIGALRM);
11028 return 0;
11029 @}
11030 @end smallexample
11031
11032 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11033 or signalled would be:
11034
11035 @smallexample
11036 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11037 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11038 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11039 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11040 >echo The program has exited\n
11041 >else
11042 >echo The program has signalled\n
11043 >end
11044 >end
11045 (@value{GDBP}) run
11046 Starting program:
11047
11048 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11049 The program no longer exists.
11050 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11051 The program has signalled
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11055 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11056 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11057 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11058
11059 @smallexample
11060 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11061 The program has exited
11062 @end smallexample
11063
11064 @item $_exception
11065 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11066 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11067
11068 @item $_probe_argc
11069 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11070 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11071
11072 @item $_sdata
11073 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11074 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11075 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11076 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11077 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11078
11079 @item $_siginfo
11080 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11081 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11082 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11083 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11084 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11085
11086 @item $_tlb
11087 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11088 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11089 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11090 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11091 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11092 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11093
11094 @item $_inferior
11095 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11096 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11097
11098 @item $_thread
11099 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11100
11101 @item $_gthread
11102 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11103
11104 @end table
11105
11106 @node Convenience Funs
11107 @section Convenience Functions
11108
11109 @cindex convenience functions
11110 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11111 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11112 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11113 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11114 @value{GDBN}.
11115
11116 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11117 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11118
11119 @table @code
11120
11121 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11122 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11123 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11124 returns zero.
11125
11126 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11127 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11128 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11129 it is @code{void}:
11130
11131 @smallexample
11132 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11133 $1 = void
11134 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11135 $2 = 1
11136 (@value{GDBP}) run
11137 Starting program: ./a.out
11138 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11139 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11140 $3 = 0
11141 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11142 $4 = 0
11143 @end smallexample
11144
11145 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11146 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11147 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11148 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11149 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11150 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11151 anymore.
11152
11153 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11154 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11155
11156 @smallexample
11157 void
11158 foo (void)
11159 @{
11160 @}
11161 @end smallexample
11162
11163 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11164
11165 @smallexample
11166 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11167 $1 = void
11168 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11169 $2 = 1
11170 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11171 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11172 $3 = void
11173 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11174 $4 = 1
11175 @end smallexample
11176
11177 @end table
11178
11179 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11180 @code{Python} support.
11181
11182 @table @code
11183
11184 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11185 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11186 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11187 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11188 Otherwise it returns zero.
11189
11190 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11191 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11192 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11193 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11194 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11195 regular expression support.
11196
11197 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11198 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11199 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11200 Otherwise it returns zero.
11201
11202 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11203 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11204 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11205
11206 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11207 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11208 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11209 Otherwise it returns zero.
11210
11211 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11212 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11213 The default is 1.
11214
11215 Example:
11216
11217 @smallexample
11218 (gdb) backtrace
11219 #0 bottom_func ()
11220 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11221 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11222 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11223 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11224 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11225 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11226 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11227 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11228 $1 = 1
11229 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11230 $1 = 1
11231 @end smallexample
11232
11233 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11234 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11235 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11236 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11237
11238 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11239 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11240 The default is 1.
11241
11242 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11243 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11244 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11245 Otherwise it returns zero.
11246
11247 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11248 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11249 The default is 1.
11250
11251 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11252 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11253 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11254 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11255
11256 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11257 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11258 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11259 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11260
11261 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11262 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11263 The default is 1.
11264
11265 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11266 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11267 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11268 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11269
11270 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11271 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11272 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11273
11274 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11275 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11276 an enumerated type:
11277
11278 @smallexample
11279 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11280 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11281 @end smallexample
11282
11283 @end table
11284
11285 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11286 convenience functions.
11287
11288 @table @code
11289 @item help function
11290 @kindex help function
11291 @cindex show all convenience functions
11292 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11293 @end table
11294
11295 @node Registers
11296 @section Registers
11297
11298 @cindex registers
11299 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11300 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11301 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11302 your machine.
11303
11304 @table @code
11305 @kindex info registers
11306 @item info registers
11307 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11308 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11309
11310 @kindex info all-registers
11311 @cindex floating point registers
11312 @item info all-registers
11313 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11314 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11315
11316 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11317 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11318 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11319 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11320
11321 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11322 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11323 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11324 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11325 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11326 @end table
11327
11328 @anchor{standard registers}
11329 @cindex stack pointer register
11330 @cindex program counter register
11331 @cindex process status register
11332 @cindex frame pointer register
11333 @cindex standard registers
11334 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11335 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11336 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11337 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11338 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11339 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11340 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11341 you could print the program counter in hex with
11342
11343 @smallexample
11344 p/x $pc
11345 @end smallexample
11346
11347 @noindent
11348 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11349
11350 @smallexample
11351 x/i $pc
11352 @end smallexample
11353
11354 @noindent
11355 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11356 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11357 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11358 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11359 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11360 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11361 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11362
11363 @smallexample
11364 set $sp += 4
11365 @end smallexample
11366
11367 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11368 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11369 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11370 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11371 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11372 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11373 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11374
11375 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11376 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11377 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11378 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11379 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11380 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11381 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11382
11383 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11384 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11385 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11386 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11387 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11388 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11389 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11390 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11391 prints the data in both formats.
11392
11393 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11394 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11395 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11396 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11397 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11398 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11399 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11400
11401 @smallexample
11402 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11403 $1 = @{
11404 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11405 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11406 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11407 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11408 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11409 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11410 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11411 @}
11412 @end smallexample
11413
11414 @noindent
11415 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11416 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11417 value to a @code{struct} member:
11418
11419 @smallexample
11420 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11421 @end smallexample
11422
11423 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11424 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11425 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11426 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11427 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11428 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11429
11430 @cindex caller-saved registers
11431 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11432 @cindex volatile registers
11433 @cindex <not saved> values
11434 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11435 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11436 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11437 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11438 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11439 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11440 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11441 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11442 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11443 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11444 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11445 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11446 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11447 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11448 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11449 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11450 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11451 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11452 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11453 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11454 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11455 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11456 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11457
11458 @node Floating Point Hardware
11459 @section Floating Point Hardware
11460 @cindex floating point
11461
11462 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11463 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11464
11465 @table @code
11466 @kindex info float
11467 @item info float
11468 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11469 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11470 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11471 the ARM and x86 machines.
11472 @end table
11473
11474 @node Vector Unit
11475 @section Vector Unit
11476 @cindex vector unit
11477
11478 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11479 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11480
11481 @table @code
11482 @kindex info vector
11483 @item info vector
11484 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11485 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11486 @end table
11487
11488 @node OS Information
11489 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11490 @cindex OS information
11491
11492 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11493 you debug your program.
11494
11495 @cindex auxiliary vector
11496 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11497 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11498 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11499 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11500 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11501 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11502 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11503 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11504 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11505 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11506 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11507 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11508
11509 @table @code
11510 @kindex info auxv
11511 @item info auxv
11512 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11513 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11514 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11515 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11516 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11517 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11518 an unrecognized tag.
11519 @end table
11520
11521 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11522 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11523 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11524 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11525 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11526 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11527 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11528
11529 @table @code
11530 @kindex info os
11531 @item info os @var{infotype}
11532
11533 Display OS information of the requested type.
11534
11535 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11536
11537 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11538 @table @code
11539 @kindex info os cpus
11540 @item cpus
11541 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11542 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11543 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11544 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11545 kernel initialization.
11546
11547 @kindex info os files
11548 @item files
11549 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11550 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11551 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11552 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11553
11554 @kindex info os modules
11555 @item modules
11556 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11557 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11558 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11559 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11560 in memory.
11561
11562 @kindex info os msg
11563 @item msg
11564 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11565 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11566 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11567 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11568 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11569 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11570 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11571 the message queue was last changed.
11572
11573 @kindex info os processes
11574 @item processes
11575 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11576 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11577 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11578 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11579 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11580 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11581
11582 @kindex info os procgroups
11583 @item procgroups
11584 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11585 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11586 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11587 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11588 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11589 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11590 and the process group leader is listed first.
11591
11592 @kindex info os semaphores
11593 @item semaphores
11594 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11595 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11596 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11597 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11598 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11599
11600 @kindex info os shm
11601 @item shm
11602 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11603 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11604 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11605 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11606 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11607 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11608 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11609
11610 @kindex info os sockets
11611 @item sockets
11612 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11613 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11614 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11615 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11616 connection.
11617
11618 @kindex info os threads
11619 @item threads
11620 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11621 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11622 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11623 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11624 process is not listed.
11625 @end table
11626
11627 @item info os
11628 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11629 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11630 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11631 types, this command will report an error.
11632 @end table
11633
11634 @node Memory Region Attributes
11635 @section Memory Region Attributes
11636 @cindex memory region attributes
11637
11638 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11639 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11640 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11641 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11642 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11643 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11644 user can override the fetched regions.
11645
11646 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11647 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11648 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11649 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11650 all memory.
11651
11652 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11653 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11654
11655 @table @code
11656 @kindex mem
11657 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11658 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11659 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11660 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11661 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11662 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11663
11664 @item mem auto
11665 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11666 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11667
11668 @kindex delete mem
11669 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11670 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11671 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11672
11673 @kindex disable mem
11674 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11675 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11676 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11677 It may be enabled again later.
11678
11679 @kindex enable mem
11680 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11681 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11682
11683 @kindex info mem
11684 @item info mem
11685 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11686 for each region:
11687
11688 @table @emph
11689 @item Memory Region Number
11690 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11691 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11692 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11693
11694 @item Lo Address
11695 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11696
11697 @item Hi Address
11698 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11699
11700 @item Attributes
11701 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11702 @end table
11703 @end table
11704
11705
11706 @subsection Attributes
11707
11708 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11709 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11710 write accesses to a memory region.
11711
11712 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11713 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11714 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11715
11716 @table @code
11717 @item ro
11718 Memory is read only.
11719 @item wo
11720 Memory is write only.
11721 @item rw
11722 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11723 @end table
11724
11725 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11726 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11727 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11728 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11729 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11730
11731 @table @code
11732 @item 8
11733 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11734 @item 16
11735 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11736 @item 32
11737 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11738 @item 64
11739 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11740 @end table
11741
11742 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11743 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11744 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11745 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11746 @c
11747 @c @table @code
11748 @c @item hwbreak
11749 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11750 @c @item swbreak (default)
11751 @c @end table
11752
11753 @subsubsection Data Cache
11754 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11755 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11756 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11757 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11758 registers.
11759
11760 @table @code
11761 @item cache
11762 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11763 @item nocache
11764 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11765 @end table
11766
11767 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11768 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11769 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11770 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11771 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11772
11773 @table @code
11774 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11775 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11776 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11777 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11778 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11779 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11780 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11781 The default value is @code{on}.
11782 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11783 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11784 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11785 @end table
11786
11787
11788 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11789 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11790 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11791 @c
11792 @c @table @code
11793 @c @item verify
11794 @c @item noverify (default)
11795 @c @end table
11796
11797 @node Dump/Restore Files
11798 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11799 @cindex dump/restore files
11800 @cindex append data to a file
11801 @cindex dump data to a file
11802 @cindex restore data from a file
11803
11804 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11805 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11806 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11807 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11808 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11809 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11810 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11811
11812 @table @code
11813
11814 @kindex dump
11815 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11816 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11817 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11818 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11819
11820 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11821 @table @code
11822 @item binary
11823 Raw binary form.
11824 @item ihex
11825 Intel hex format.
11826 @item srec
11827 Motorola S-record format.
11828 @item tekhex
11829 Tektronix Hex format.
11830 @item verilog
11831 Verilog Hex format.
11832 @end table
11833
11834 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11835 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11836 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11837 form.
11838
11839 @kindex append
11840 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11841 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11842 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11843 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11844 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11845
11846 @kindex restore
11847 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11848 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11849 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11850 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11851 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11852
11853 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11854 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11855 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11856 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11857 from that location.
11858
11859 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11860 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11861 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11862 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11863
11864 @end table
11865
11866 @node Core File Generation
11867 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11868 @cindex dump core from inferior
11869
11870 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11871 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11872 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11873 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11874 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11875 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11876 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11877
11878 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11879 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11880 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11881
11882 @table @code
11883 @kindex gcore
11884 @kindex generate-core-file
11885 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11886 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11887 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11888 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11889 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11890 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11891
11892 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11893 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11894
11895 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11896 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11897 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11898 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11899 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11900
11901 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11902 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11903 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11904 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11905 Enable or disable the use of the file
11906 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11907 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11908 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11909 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11910
11911 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11912 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11913 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11914 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11915 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11916 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11917 about the bits that can be set in the
11918 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11919 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11920
11921 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11922 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11923 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11924 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11925 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11926 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11927 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11928 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11929
11930 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11931 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11932 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11933 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11934 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11935 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11936 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11937
11938 The default value is @code{off}.
11939 @end table
11940
11941 @node Character Sets
11942 @section Character Sets
11943 @cindex character sets
11944 @cindex charset
11945 @cindex translating between character sets
11946 @cindex host character set
11947 @cindex target character set
11948
11949 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11950 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11951 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11952 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11953 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11954 @dfn{target character set}.
11955
11956 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11957 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11958 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11959 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11960 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11961 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11962 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11963 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11964 character and string literals in expressions.
11965
11966 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11967 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11968 target-charset} command, described below.
11969
11970 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11971 support:
11972
11973 @table @code
11974 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11975 @kindex set target-charset
11976 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11977 list of supported target character sets, type
11978 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11979
11980 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11981 @kindex set host-charset
11982 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11983
11984 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11985 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11986 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11987 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11988 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11989
11990 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11991 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11992 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11993
11994 @item set charset @var{charset}
11995 @kindex set charset
11996 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11997 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11998 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11999 for both host and target.
12000
12001 @item show charset
12002 @kindex show charset
12003 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12004
12005 @item show host-charset
12006 @kindex show host-charset
12007 Show the name of the current host character set.
12008
12009 @item show target-charset
12010 @kindex show target-charset
12011 Show the name of the current target character set.
12012
12013 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12014 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12015 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12016 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12017 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12018 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12019
12020 @item show target-wide-charset
12021 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12022 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12023 @end table
12024
12025 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12026 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12027 @file{charset-test.c}:
12028
12029 @smallexample
12030 #include <stdio.h>
12031
12032 char ascii_hello[]
12033 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12034 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12035 char ibm1047_hello[]
12036 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12037 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12038
12039 main ()
12040 @{
12041 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12042 @}
12043 @end smallexample
12044
12045 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12046 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12047 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12048
12049 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12050
12051 @smallexample
12052 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12053 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12054 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12055 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12056 @dots{}
12057 (@value{GDBP})
12058 @end smallexample
12059
12060 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12061 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12062 strings:
12063
12064 @smallexample
12065 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12066 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12067 (@value{GDBP})
12068 @end smallexample
12069
12070 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12071 initial character set:
12072 @smallexample
12073 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12074 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12075 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12076 (@value{GDBP})
12077 @end smallexample
12078
12079 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12080 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12081 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12082 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12083 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12084
12085 @smallexample
12086 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12087 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12088 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12089 $2 = 72 'H'
12090 (@value{GDBP})
12091 @end smallexample
12092
12093 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12094 literals you use in expressions:
12095
12096 @smallexample
12097 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12098 $3 = 43 '+'
12099 (@value{GDBP})
12100 @end smallexample
12101
12102 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12103 character.
12104
12105 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12106 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12107 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12108
12109 @smallexample
12110 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12111 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12112 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12113 $5 = 200 '\310'
12114 (@value{GDBP})
12115 @end smallexample
12116
12117 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12118 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12119
12120 @smallexample
12121 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12122 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12123 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12124 @end smallexample
12125
12126 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12127 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12128 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12129 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12130 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12131
12132 @smallexample
12133 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12134 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12135 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12136 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12137 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12138 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12139 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12140 $7 = 72 '\110'
12141 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12142 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12143 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12144 $9 = 200 'H'
12145 (@value{GDBP})
12146 @end smallexample
12147
12148 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12149 string literals you use in expressions:
12150
12151 @smallexample
12152 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12153 $10 = 78 '+'
12154 (@value{GDBP})
12155 @end smallexample
12156
12157 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12158 character.
12159
12160 @node Caching Target Data
12161 @section Caching Data of Targets
12162 @cindex caching data of targets
12163
12164 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12165 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12166 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12167 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12168 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12169 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12170 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12171 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12172 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12173 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12174 is executing.
12175 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12176 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12177 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12178 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12179 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12180 in the code segment.
12181 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12182 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12183
12184 @table @code
12185 @kindex set remotecache
12186 @item set remotecache on
12187 @itemx set remotecache off
12188 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12189 with old scripts.
12190
12191 @kindex show remotecache
12192 @item show remotecache
12193 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12194
12195 @kindex set stack-cache
12196 @item set stack-cache on
12197 @itemx set stack-cache off
12198 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12199 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12200
12201 @kindex show stack-cache
12202 @item show stack-cache
12203 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12204
12205 @kindex set code-cache
12206 @item set code-cache on
12207 @itemx set code-cache off
12208 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12209 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12210 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12211
12212 @kindex show code-cache
12213 @item show code-cache
12214 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12215 accesses.
12216
12217 @kindex info dcache
12218 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12219 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12220 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12221 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12222 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12223 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12224
12225 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12226 printed in hex.
12227
12228 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12229 @cindex dcache size
12230 @kindex set dcache size
12231 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12232
12233 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12234 @cindex dcache line-size
12235 @kindex set dcache line-size
12236 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12237 Must be a power of 2.
12238
12239 @item show dcache size
12240 @kindex show dcache size
12241 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12242
12243 @item show dcache line-size
12244 @kindex show dcache line-size
12245 Show default size of dcache lines.
12246
12247 @end table
12248
12249 @node Searching Memory
12250 @section Search Memory
12251 @cindex searching memory
12252
12253 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12254 @code{find} command.
12255
12256 @table @code
12257 @kindex find
12258 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12259 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12260 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12261 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12262 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12263 @end table
12264
12265 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12266 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12267
12268 @table @r
12269 @item @var{s}, search query size
12270 The size of each search query value.
12271
12272 @table @code
12273 @item b
12274 bytes
12275 @item h
12276 halfwords (two bytes)
12277 @item w
12278 words (four bytes)
12279 @item g
12280 giant words (eight bytes)
12281 @end table
12282
12283 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12284 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12285 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12286 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12287 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12288
12289 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12290 value's type in the current language.
12291 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12292 pattern as a mixture of types.
12293 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12294 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12295 which is typically four bytes.
12296
12297 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12298 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12299 @end table
12300
12301 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12302 (@code{"}).
12303 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12304 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12305
12306 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12307 number of matches found.
12308
12309 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12310 @samp{$_}.
12311 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12312
12313 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12314
12315 @smallexample
12316 void
12317 hello ()
12318 @{
12319 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12320 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12321 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12322 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12323 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12324 @}
12325 @end smallexample
12326
12327 @noindent
12328 you get during debugging:
12329
12330 @smallexample
12331 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12332 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12333 1 pattern found
12334 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12335 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12336 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12337 2 patterns found.
12338 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12339 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12340 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12341 2 patterns found.
12342 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12343 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12344 1 pattern found
12345 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12346 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12347 1 pattern found
12348 (gdb) print $numfound
12349 $1 = 1
12350 (gdb) print $_
12351 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12352 @end smallexample
12353
12354 @node Value Sizes
12355 @section Value Sizes
12356
12357 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12358 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12359 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12360 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12361 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12362
12363 @table @code
12364 @kindex set max-value-size
12365 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12366 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12367 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12368 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12369 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12370
12371 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12372 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12373
12374 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12375 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12376 currently 16 bytes.
12377
12378 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12379 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12380 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12381 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12382 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12383 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12384 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12385 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12386
12387 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12388
12389 @kindex show max-value-size
12390 @item show max-value-size
12391 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12392 allocate for the contents of a value.
12393 @end table
12394
12395 @node Optimized Code
12396 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12397 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12398 @cindex debugging optimized code
12399
12400 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12401 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12402 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12403 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12404 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12405 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12406 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12407
12408 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12409 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12410 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12411 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12412
12413 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12414 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12415 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12416 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12417 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12418 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12419
12420 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12421 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12422 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12423 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12424 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12425
12426 @menu
12427 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12428 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12429 @end menu
12430
12431 @node Inline Functions
12432 @section Inline Functions
12433 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12434
12435 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12436 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12437 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12438 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12439 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12440 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12441 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12442 @code{info frame} command.
12443
12444 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12445 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12446 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12447 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12448 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12449 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12450 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12451 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12452 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12453 local variables in the caller.
12454
12455 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12456 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12457 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12458 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12459 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12460 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12461 instructions are executed.
12462
12463 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12464 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12465 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12466 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12467
12468 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12469 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12470
12471 @itemize @bullet
12472 @item
12473 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12474 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12475 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12476 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12477 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12478 or inside the inlined function instead.
12479
12480 @item
12481 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12482 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12483 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12484 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12485
12486 @end itemize
12487
12488 @node Tail Call Frames
12489 @section Tail Call Frames
12490 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12491
12492 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12493 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12494 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12495 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12496 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12497
12498 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12499 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12500 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12501 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12502 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12503 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12504 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12505
12506 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12507 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12508 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12509 this information.
12510
12511 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12512 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12513
12514 @smallexample
12515 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12516 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12517 (gdb) info frame
12518 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12519 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12520 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12521 source language c++.
12522 Arglist at unknown address.
12523 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12524 @end smallexample
12525
12526 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12527 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12528 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12529 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12530 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12531 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12532
12533 @table @code
12534 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12535 @item set debug entry-values
12536 @kindex set debug entry-values
12537 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12538 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12539 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12540 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12541 result.
12542
12543 @item show debug entry-values
12544 @kindex show debug entry-values
12545 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12546 values at function entry and tail calls.
12547 @end table
12548
12549 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12550 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12551 reference by variable @code{x}):
12552
12553 @smallexample
12554 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12555 void (*x) (void) = c;
12556 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12557 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12558 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12559
12560 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12561 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12562 a () at t.c:3
12563 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12564 (gdb) bt
12565 #0 a () at t.c:3
12566 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12567 @end smallexample
12568
12569 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12570
12571 @smallexample
12572 int i;
12573 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12574 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12575 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12576 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12577 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12578 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12579 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12580 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12581
12582 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12583 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12584 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12585 (gdb) bt
12586 #0 f () at t.c:2
12587 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12588 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12589 @end smallexample
12590
12591 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12592 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12593
12594 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12595 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12596 @set ARROW @click{}
12597 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12598 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12599 @end ifset
12600 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12601 @set ARROW ->
12602 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12603 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12604 @end ifclear
12605
12606 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12607 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12608 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12609
12610 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12611 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12612 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12613 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12614 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12615 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12616
12617 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12618 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12619 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12620 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12621 omitted.
12622
12623 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12624 entry may fail:
12625
12626 @smallexample
12627 int v;
12628 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12629 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12630 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12631 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12632 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12633 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12634
12635 (gdb) bt
12636 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12637 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12638 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12639 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12640 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12641 @end smallexample
12642
12643 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12644 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12645 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12646 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12647 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12648
12649 @node Macros
12650 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12651
12652 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12653 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12654 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12655 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12656 where it was defined.
12657
12658 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12659 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12660 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12661 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12662
12663 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12664 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12665 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12666 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12667 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12668 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12669 see @ref{List}.
12670
12671 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12672 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12673 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12674
12675 @table @code
12676
12677 @kindex macro expand
12678 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12679 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12680 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12681 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12682 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12683 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12684 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12685 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12686 it can be any string of tokens.
12687
12688 @kindex macro exp1
12689 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12690 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12691 @cindex expand macro once
12692 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12693 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12694 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12695 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12696 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12697 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12698 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12699 can be any string of tokens.
12700
12701 @kindex info macro
12702 @cindex macro definition, showing
12703 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12704 @cindex macros, from debug info
12705 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12706 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12707 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12708 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12709 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12710 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12711
12712 @kindex info macros
12713 @item info macros @var{location}
12714 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12715 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12716 command-line where those definitions were established.
12717
12718 @kindex macro define
12719 @cindex user-defined macros
12720 @cindex defining macros interactively
12721 @cindex macros, user-defined
12722 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12723 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12724 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12725 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12726 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12727 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12728 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12729 @var{arglist}.
12730
12731 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12732 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12733 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12734 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12735 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12736
12737 @kindex macro undef
12738 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12739 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12740 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12741 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12742 in the program being debugged.
12743
12744 @kindex macro list
12745 @item macro list
12746 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12747 @end table
12748
12749 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12750 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12751 show our source files:
12752
12753 @smallexample
12754 $ cat sample.c
12755 #include <stdio.h>
12756 #include "sample.h"
12757
12758 #define M 42
12759 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12760
12761 main ()
12762 @{
12763 #define N 28
12764 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12765 #undef N
12766 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12767 #define N 1729
12768 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12769 @}
12770 $ cat sample.h
12771 #define Q <
12772 $
12773 @end smallexample
12774
12775 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12776 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12777 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12778 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12779 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12780 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12781 information.
12782
12783 @smallexample
12784 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12785 $
12786 @end smallexample
12787
12788 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12789
12790 @smallexample
12791 $ gdb -nw sample
12792 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12793 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12794 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12795 (@value{GDBP})
12796 @end smallexample
12797
12798 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12799 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12800 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12801
12802 @smallexample
12803 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12804 3
12805 4 #define M 42
12806 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12807 6
12808 7 main ()
12809 8 @{
12810 9 #define N 28
12811 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12812 11 #undef N
12813 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12814 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12815 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12816 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12817 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12818 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12819 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12820 #define Q <
12821 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12822 expands to: (42 + 1)
12823 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12824 expands to: once (M + 1)
12825 (@value{GDBP})
12826 @end smallexample
12827
12828 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12829 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12830 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12831 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12832
12833 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12834 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12835
12836 @smallexample
12837 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12838 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12839 (@value{GDBP}) run
12840 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12841
12842 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12843 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12844 (@value{GDBP})
12845 @end smallexample
12846
12847 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12848
12849 @smallexample
12850 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12851 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12852 #define N 28
12853 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12854 expands to: 28 < 42
12855 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12856 $1 = 1
12857 (@value{GDBP})
12858 @end smallexample
12859
12860 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12861 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12862 thereof) in force at each point:
12863
12864 @smallexample
12865 (@value{GDBP}) next
12866 Hello, world!
12867 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12868 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12869 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12870 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12871 (@value{GDBP}) next
12872 We're so creative.
12873 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12874 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12875 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12876 #define N 1729
12877 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12878 expands to: 1729 < 42
12879 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12880 $2 = 0
12881 (@value{GDBP})
12882 @end smallexample
12883
12884 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12885 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12886 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12887 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12888
12889 @smallexample
12890 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12891 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12892 -D__STDC__=1
12893 (@value{GDBP})
12894 @end smallexample
12895
12896
12897 @node Tracepoints
12898 @chapter Tracepoints
12899 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12900 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12901
12902 @cindex tracepoints
12903 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12904 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12905 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12906 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12907 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12908 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12909 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12910
12911 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12912 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12913 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12914 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12915 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12916 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12917 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12918 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12919 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12920 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12921 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12922
12923 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12924 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12925 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12926 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12927 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12928 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12929 Packets}.
12930
12931 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12932 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12933 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12934
12935 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12936
12937 @menu
12938 * Set Tracepoints::
12939 * Analyze Collected Data::
12940 * Tracepoint Variables::
12941 * Trace Files::
12942 @end menu
12943
12944 @node Set Tracepoints
12945 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12946
12947 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12948 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12949 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12950 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12951 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12952 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12953 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12954
12955 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12956 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12957 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12958 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12959 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12960 tracepoint was hit.
12961
12962 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12963 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12964 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12965 either.
12966
12967 @cindex fast tracepoints
12968 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12969 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12970 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12971
12972 @cindex static tracepoints
12973 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12974 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12975 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12976 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12977 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12978 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12979 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12980 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12981 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12982 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12983 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12984 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12985 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12986 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12987 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12988 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12989 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12990 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12991 static tracepoint marker.
12992
12993 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12994 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12995
12996 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12997 conditions and actions.
12998
12999 @menu
13000 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13001 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13002 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13003 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13004 * Trace State Variables::
13005 * Tracepoint Actions::
13006 * Listing Tracepoints::
13007 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13008 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13009 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13010 @end menu
13011
13012 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13013 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13014
13015 @table @code
13016 @cindex set tracepoint
13017 @kindex trace
13018 @item trace @var{location}
13019 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13020 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13021 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13022 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13023 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13024 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13025 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13026 in tracing}).
13027 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13028 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13029 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13030 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13031 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13032 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13033 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13034 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13035 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13036 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13037 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13038 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13039
13040 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13041
13042 @smallexample
13043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13044
13045 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13046
13047 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13048
13049 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13050
13051 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13052 @end smallexample
13053
13054 @noindent
13055 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13056
13057 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13058 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13059 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13060 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13061 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13062 information on tracepoint conditions.
13063
13064 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13065 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13066 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13067 @kindex ftrace
13068 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13069 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13070 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13071 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13072 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13073 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13074 message.
13075
13076 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13077 @code{trace}.
13078
13079 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13080 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13081 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13082 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13083 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13084 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13085 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13086 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13087
13088 @example
13089 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13090 @end example
13091
13092 @noindent
13093 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13094 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13095
13096 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13097 @cindex set static tracepoint
13098 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13099 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13100 @kindex strace
13101 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13102 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13103 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13104 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13105 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13106
13107 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13108 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13109 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13110 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13111 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13112 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13113 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13114 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13115 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13116 tracing engine:
13117
13118 @smallexample
13119 main ()
13120 @{
13121 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13122 @}
13123 @end smallexample
13124
13125 @noindent
13126 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13127 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13128
13129 @smallexample
13130 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13131 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13132 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13133 Data: "str %s"
13134 [etc...]
13135 @end smallexample
13136
13137 @noindent
13138 so you may probe the marker above with:
13139
13140 @smallexample
13141 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13142 @end smallexample
13143
13144 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13145 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13146 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13147 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13148 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13149 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13150 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13151 the @samp{Data:} field.
13152
13153 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13154 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13155 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13156
13157 @vindex $tpnum
13158 @cindex last tracepoint number
13159 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13160 @cindex tracepoint number
13161 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13162 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13163
13164 @kindex delete tracepoint
13165 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13166 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13167 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13168 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13169 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13170
13171 Examples:
13172
13173 @smallexample
13174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13175
13176 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13177 @end smallexample
13178
13179 @noindent
13180 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13181 @end table
13182
13183 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13184 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13185
13186 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13187
13188 @table @code
13189 @kindex disable tracepoint
13190 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13191 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13192 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13193 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13194 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13195 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13196 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13197 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13198 next trace experiment.
13199
13200 @kindex enable tracepoint
13201 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13202 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13203 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13204 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13205 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13206 next time a trace experiment is run.
13207 @end table
13208
13209 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13210 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13211
13212 @table @code
13213 @kindex passcount
13214 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13215 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13216 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13217 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13218 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13219 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13220 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13221 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13222 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13223 user.
13224
13225 Examples:
13226
13227 @smallexample
13228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13229 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13230
13231 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13233 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13234 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13235 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13236 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13237 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13238 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13239 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13240 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13241 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13242 @end smallexample
13243 @end table
13244
13245 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13246 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13247 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13248 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13249
13250 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13251 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13252 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13253 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13254 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13255 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13256 is true.
13257
13258 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13259 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13260 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13261 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13262 just as with breakpoints.
13263
13264 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13265 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13266 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13267 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13268 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13269 accesses, and so forth.
13270
13271 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13272 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13273 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13274 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13275 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13276 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13277 search through.
13278
13279 @smallexample
13280 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13281 @end smallexample
13282
13283 @node Trace State Variables
13284 @subsection Trace State Variables
13285 @cindex trace state variables
13286
13287 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13288 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13289 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13290 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13291 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13292 integers.
13293
13294 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13295 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13296 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13297 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13298
13299 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13300 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13301 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13302 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13303 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13304 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13305 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13306 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13307 variable with the same name.
13308
13309 @table @code
13310
13311 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13312 @kindex tvariable
13313 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13314 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13315 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13316 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13317 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13318 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13319 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13320 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13321 value. The default initial value is 0.
13322
13323 @item info tvariables
13324 @kindex info tvariables
13325 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13326 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13327 currently running.
13328
13329 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13330 @kindex delete tvariable
13331 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13332 are specified.
13333
13334 @end table
13335
13336 @node Tracepoint Actions
13337 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13338
13339 @table @code
13340 @kindex actions
13341 @cindex tracepoint actions
13342 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13343 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13344 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13345 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13346 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13347 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13348 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13349 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13350 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13351 @code{while-stepping}.
13352
13353 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13354 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13355 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13356
13357 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13358 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13359 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13360
13361 @smallexample
13362 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13363
13364 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13365
13366 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13367 @end smallexample
13368
13369 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13370 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13371 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13372 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13373 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13374 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13375 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13376 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13377
13378 @smallexample
13379 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13380 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13381 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13382 > collect bar,baz
13383 > collect $regs
13384 > while-stepping 12
13385 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13386 > end
13387 end
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13391 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13392 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13393 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13394 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13395 special arguments are supported:
13396
13397 @table @code
13398 @item $regs
13399 Collect all registers.
13400
13401 @item $args
13402 Collect all function arguments.
13403
13404 @item $locals
13405 Collect all local variables.
13406
13407 @item $_ret
13408 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13409 of a backtrace.
13410
13411 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13412 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13413 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13414 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13415 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13416 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13417
13418 @item $_probe_argc
13419 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13420 tracepoint is located.
13421 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13422
13423 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13424 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13425 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13426 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13427
13428 @item $_sdata
13429 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13430 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13431 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13432 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13433 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13434 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13435 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13436 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13437 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13438
13439 @smallexample
13440 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13441 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13442 @end smallexample
13443
13444 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13445 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13446 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13447 @value{GDBN}.
13448 @end table
13449
13450 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13451 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13452 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13453
13454 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13455 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13456 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13457 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13458 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13459 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13460 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13461 @samp{mystr}.
13462
13463 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13464 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13465
13466 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13467 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13468 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13469 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13470 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13471 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13472 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13473 action were used.
13474
13475 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13476 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13477 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13478 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13479 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13480 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13481
13482 @smallexample
13483 > while-stepping 12
13484 > collect $regs, myglobal
13485 > end
13486 >
13487 @end smallexample
13488
13489 @noindent
13490 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13491 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13492 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13493 @code{stepping}.
13494
13495 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13496 @kindex set default-collect
13497 @cindex default collection action
13498 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13499 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13500 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13501 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13502 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13503 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13504
13505 @item show default-collect
13506 @kindex show default-collect
13507 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13508 tracepoint hit.
13509
13510 @end table
13511
13512 @node Listing Tracepoints
13513 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13514
13515 @table @code
13516 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13517 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13518 @cindex information about tracepoints
13519 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13520 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13521 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13522 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13523 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13524 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13525
13526 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13527 tracing:
13528
13529 @itemize @bullet
13530 @item
13531 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13532
13533 @item
13534 the state about installed on target of each location
13535 @end itemize
13536
13537 @smallexample
13538 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13539 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13540 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13541 while-stepping 20
13542 collect globfoo, $regs
13543 end
13544 collect globfoo2
13545 end
13546 pass count 1200
13547 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13548 collect $eip
13549 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13550 installed on target
13551 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13552 installed on target
13553 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13554 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13555 not installed on target
13556 (@value{GDBP})
13557 @end smallexample
13558
13559 @noindent
13560 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13561 @end table
13562
13563 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13564 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13565
13566 @table @code
13567 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13568 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13569 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13570 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13571 program.
13572
13573 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13574
13575 @table @emph
13576 @item Count
13577 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13578 stable identifier.
13579 @item ID
13580 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13581 @item Enabled or Disabled
13582 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13583 that are not enabled.
13584 @item Address
13585 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13586 @item What
13587 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13588 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13589 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13590 will be left blank.
13591 @end table
13592
13593 @noindent
13594 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13595
13596 @table @emph
13597 @item Data
13598 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13599 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13600 marker call.
13601 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13602 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13603 @end table
13604
13605 @smallexample
13606 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13607 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13608 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13609 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13610 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13611 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13612 Data: str %s
13613 (@value{GDBP})
13614 @end smallexample
13615 @end table
13616
13617 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13618 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13619
13620 @table @code
13621 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13622 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13623 @cindex collected data discarded
13624 @item tstart
13625 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13626 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13627 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13628 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13629 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13630 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13631 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13632 information, and so forth.
13633
13634 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13635 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13636 @item tstop
13637 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13638 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13639 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13640 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13641 needs to be stopped quickly.
13642
13643 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13644 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13645 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13646
13647 @kindex tstatus
13648 @cindex status of trace data collection
13649 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13650 @item tstatus
13651 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13652 collection.
13653 @end table
13654
13655 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13656
13657 @smallexample
13658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13659 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13660 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13661 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13662 > while-stepping 11
13663 > collect $regs
13664 > end
13665 > end
13666 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13667 [time passes @dots{}]
13668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13669 @end smallexample
13670
13671 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13672 @cindex disconnected tracing
13673 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13674 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13675 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13676 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13677 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13678 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13679 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13680 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13681
13682 @table @code
13683 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13684 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13685 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13686 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13687 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13688 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13689 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13690 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13691
13692 @item show disconnected-tracing
13693 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13694 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13695
13696 @end table
13697
13698 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13699 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13700 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13701 it will continue after reconnection.
13702
13703 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13704 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13705 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13706 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13707 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13708 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13709 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13710 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13711 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13712 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13713
13714 @cindex circular trace buffer
13715 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13716 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13717 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13718 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13719 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13720 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13721 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13722 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13723 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13724 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13725 the next run.
13726
13727 @table @code
13728 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13729 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13730 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13731 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13732 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13733 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13734 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13735
13736 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13737 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13738 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13739 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13740 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13741 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13742
13743 @end table
13744
13745 @table @code
13746 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13747 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13748 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13749 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13750 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13751 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13752 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13753 likes. This is also the default.
13754
13755 @item show trace-buffer-size
13756 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13757 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13758 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13759 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13760 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13761 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13762 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13763 @end table
13764
13765 @table @code
13766 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13767 @kindex set trace-user
13768
13769 @item show trace-user
13770 @kindex show trace-user
13771
13772 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13773 @kindex set trace-notes
13774 Set the trace run's notes.
13775
13776 @item show trace-notes
13777 @kindex show trace-notes
13778 Show the trace run's notes.
13779
13780 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13781 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13782 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13783 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13784 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13785
13786 @item show trace-stop-notes
13787 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13788 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13789
13790 @end table
13791
13792 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13793 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13794
13795 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13796 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13797 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13798 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13799 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13800 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13801 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13802 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13803 mentioned here.
13804
13805 @itemize @bullet
13806
13807 @item
13808 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13809 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13810 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13811 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13812 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13813 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13814 cannot be collected either.
13815
13816 @item
13817 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13818 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13819 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13820 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13821 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13822 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13823 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13824 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13825 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13826 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13827
13828 @item
13829 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13830 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13831 in a misleading way.
13832
13833 @item
13834 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13835 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13836 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13837 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13838 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13839 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13840 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13841 by @code{ptr}.
13842
13843 @item
13844 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13845 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13846 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13847 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13848 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13849 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13850 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13851 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13852 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13853 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13854 invalid address.
13855
13856 @item
13857 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13858 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13859 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13860 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13861 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13862 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13863 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13864 it to zero.
13865
13866 @end itemize
13867
13868 @node Analyze Collected Data
13869 @section Using the Collected Data
13870
13871 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13872 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13873 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13874 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13875 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13876 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13877 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13878 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13879 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13880 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13881 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13882 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13883 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13884 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13885 the buffer will fail.
13886
13887 @menu
13888 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13889 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13890 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13891 @end menu
13892
13893 @node tfind
13894 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13895
13896 @kindex tfind
13897 @cindex select trace snapshot
13898 @cindex find trace snapshot
13899 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13900 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13901 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13902 snapshot is selected.
13903
13904 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13905
13906 @table @code
13907 @item tfind start
13908 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13909 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13910
13911 @item tfind none
13912 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13913
13914 @item tfind end
13915 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13916
13917 @item tfind
13918 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13919 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13920
13921 @item tfind -
13922 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13923 retracing earlier steps.
13924
13925 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13926 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13927 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13928 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13929 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13930
13931 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13932 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13933 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13934 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13935 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13936
13937 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13938 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13939 addresses (exclusive).
13940
13941 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13942 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13943 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13944
13945 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13946 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13947 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13948 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13949 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13950 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13951 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13952 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13953 @end table
13954
13955 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13956 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13957 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13958 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13959 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13960 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13961 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13962 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13963 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13964 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13965 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13966 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13967 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13968 tracepoint as the current one.
13969
13970 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13971 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13972 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13973 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13974 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13975
13976 @smallexample
13977 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13978 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13979 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13980 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13981 > tfind
13982 > end
13983
13984 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13985 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13986 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13987 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13988 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13989 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13990 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13991 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13992 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13993 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13994 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13995 @end smallexample
13996
13997 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13998 the buffer:
13999
14000 @smallexample
14001 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14002 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14003 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14004 > tfind line
14005 > end
14006
14007 Frame 0, X = 1
14008 Frame 7, X = 2
14009 Frame 13, X = 255
14010 @end smallexample
14011
14012 @node tdump
14013 @subsection @code{tdump}
14014 @kindex tdump
14015 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14016 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14017
14018 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14019 the current trace snapshot.
14020
14021 @smallexample
14022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14024 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14025 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14026 > end
14027
14028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14029
14030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14031 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14032 at gdb_test.c:444
14033 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14034
14035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14036 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14037 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14038 d1 0x18 24
14039 d2 0x80 128
14040 d3 0x33 51
14041 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14042 d5 0x22 34
14043 d6 0xe0 224
14044 d7 0x380035 3670069
14045 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14046 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14047 a2 0x100 256
14048 a3 0x322000 3284992
14049 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14050 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14051 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14052 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14053 ps 0x0 0
14054 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14055 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14056 fpstatus 0x0 0
14057 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14058 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14059 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14060 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14061 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14062 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14063 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14064 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14065 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14066
14067 (@value{GDBP})
14068 @end smallexample
14069
14070 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14071 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14072 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14073 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14074
14075 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14076 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14077 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14078 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14079 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14080 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14081 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14082 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14083 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14084 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14085
14086 @node save tracepoints
14087 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14088 @kindex save tracepoints
14089 @kindex save-tracepoints
14090 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14091
14092 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14093 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14094 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14095 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14096 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14097 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14098
14099 @node Tracepoint Variables
14100 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14101 @cindex tracepoint variables
14102 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14103
14104 @table @code
14105 @vindex $trace_frame
14106 @item (int) $trace_frame
14107 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14108 snapshot is selected.
14109
14110 @vindex $tracepoint
14111 @item (int) $tracepoint
14112 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14113
14114 @vindex $trace_line
14115 @item (int) $trace_line
14116 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14117
14118 @vindex $trace_file
14119 @item (char []) $trace_file
14120 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14121
14122 @vindex $trace_func
14123 @item (char []) $trace_func
14124 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14125 @end table
14126
14127 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14128 use @code{output} instead.
14129
14130 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14131 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14132 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14133 which are managed by the target.
14134
14135 @smallexample
14136 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14137
14138 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14139 > output $trace_file
14140 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14141 > tfind
14142 > end
14143 @end smallexample
14144
14145 @node Trace Files
14146 @section Using Trace Files
14147 @cindex trace files
14148
14149 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14150 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14151 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14152 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14153 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14154
14155 @table @code
14156
14157 @kindex tsave
14158 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14159 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14160 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14161 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14162 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14163 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14164 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14165 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14166 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14167 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14168 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14169 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14170 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14171 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14172 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14173
14174 @kindex target tfile
14175 @kindex tfile
14176 @kindex target ctf
14177 @kindex ctf
14178 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14179 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14180 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14181 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14182 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14183 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14184 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14185 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14186 the host.
14187
14188 @smallexample
14189 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14190 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14191 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14192 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14193 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14194 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14195 i = 0
14196 a = 0
14197 b = 1 '\001'
14198 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14199 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14200 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14201 $1 = 1
14202 @end smallexample
14203
14204 @end table
14205
14206 @node Overlays
14207 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14208 @cindex overlays
14209
14210 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14211 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14212 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14213 use overlays.
14214
14215 @menu
14216 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14217 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14218 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14219 mapped by asking the inferior.
14220 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14221 @end menu
14222
14223 @node How Overlays Work
14224 @section How Overlays Work
14225 @cindex mapped overlays
14226 @cindex unmapped overlays
14227 @cindex load address, overlay's
14228 @cindex mapped address
14229 @cindex overlay area
14230
14231 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14232 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14233 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14234 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14235 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14236
14237 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14238 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14239 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14240 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14241 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14242 largest overlay as well.
14243
14244 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14245 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14246 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14247 there.
14248
14249 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14250 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14251 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14252
14253 @smallexample
14254 @group
14255 Data Instruction Larger
14256 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14257 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14258 | | | | | |
14259 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14260 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14261 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14262 | and heap | | | | | |
14263 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14264 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14265 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14266 | | | | | |
14267 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14268 address | | | | | |
14269 | overlay | <-' | | |
14270 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14271 | | <---. | | load address
14272 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14273 | | | |
14274 +-----------+ | |
14275 +-----------+
14276 | |
14277 +-----------+
14278
14279 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14280 @end group
14281 @end smallexample
14282
14283 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14284 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14285 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14286 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14287 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14288 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14289 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14290 program and the overlay area.
14291
14292 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14293 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14294 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14295 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14296 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14297 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14298 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14299
14300 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14301 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14302 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14303
14304 @itemize @bullet
14305
14306 @item
14307 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14308 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14309 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14310 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14311
14312 @item
14313 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14314 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14315 your program's performance.
14316
14317 @item
14318 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14319 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14320 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14321 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14322 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14323 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14324 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14325
14326 @item
14327 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14328 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14329 instruction and data spaces.
14330
14331 @end itemize
14332
14333 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14334 improved in many ways:
14335
14336 @itemize @bullet
14337
14338 @item
14339 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14340 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14341 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14342 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14343 area in the usual way.
14344
14345 @item
14346 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14347 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14348
14349 @item
14350 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14351 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14352 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14353 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14354 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14355 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14356 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14357
14358 @end itemize
14359
14360
14361 @node Overlay Commands
14362 @section Overlay Commands
14363
14364 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14365 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14366 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14367 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14368 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14369 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14370
14371 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14372 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14373
14374 @table @code
14375 @item overlay off
14376 @kindex overlay
14377 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14378 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14379 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14380 overlay support is disabled.
14381
14382 @item overlay manual
14383 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14384 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14385 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14386 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14387 commands described below.
14388
14389 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14390 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14391 @cindex map an overlay
14392 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14393 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14394 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14395 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14396 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14397 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14398
14399 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14400 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14401 @cindex unmap an overlay
14402 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14403 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14404 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14405 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14406
14407 @item overlay auto
14408 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14409 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14410 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14411 Overlay Debugging}.
14412
14413 @item overlay load-target
14414 @itemx overlay load
14415 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14416 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14417 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14418 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14419 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14420 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14421
14422 @item overlay list-overlays
14423 @itemx overlay list
14424 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14425 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14426 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14427
14428 @end table
14429
14430 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14431 of the function the address falls in:
14432
14433 @smallexample
14434 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14435 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14436 @end smallexample
14437 @noindent
14438 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14439 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14440 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14441 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14442
14443 @smallexample
14444 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14445 No sections are mapped.
14446 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14447 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14448 @end smallexample
14449 @noindent
14450 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14451 name normally:
14452
14453 @smallexample
14454 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14455 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14456 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14457 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14458 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14459 @end smallexample
14460
14461 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14462 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14463 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14464 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14465 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14466
14467 @itemize @bullet
14468 @item
14469 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14470 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14471 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14472 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14473 @item
14474 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14475 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14476 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14477 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14478 breakpoints properly.
14479 @end itemize
14480
14481
14482 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14483 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14484 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14485
14486 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14487 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14488 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14489 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14490 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14491 current state of the overlays.
14492
14493 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14494 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14495
14496 @table @asis
14497
14498 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14499 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14500
14501 @smallexample
14502 struct
14503 @{
14504 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14505 unsigned long vma;
14506
14507 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14508 unsigned long size;
14509
14510 /* The overlay's load address. */
14511 unsigned long lma;
14512
14513 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14514 zero otherwise. */
14515 unsigned long mapped;
14516 @}
14517 @end smallexample
14518
14519 @item @code{_novlys}:
14520 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14521 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14522
14523 @end table
14524
14525 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14526 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14527 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14528 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14529 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14530 currently mapped.
14531
14532 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14533 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14534 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14535 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14536 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14537 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14538 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14539 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14540 are not being executed.
14541
14542 @node Overlay Sample Program
14543 @section Overlay Sample Program
14544 @cindex overlay example program
14545
14546 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14547 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14548 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14549 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14550 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14551 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14552 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14553
14554 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14555 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14556 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14557 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14558
14559 @table @file
14560 @item overlays.c
14561 The main program file.
14562 @item ovlymgr.c
14563 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14564 @item foo.c
14565 @itemx bar.c
14566 @itemx baz.c
14567 @itemx grbx.c
14568 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14569 @item d10v.ld
14570 @itemx m32r.ld
14571 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14572 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14573 @end table
14574
14575 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14576 cross-compiler like this:
14577
14578 @smallexample
14579 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14580 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14581 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14582 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14583 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14584 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14585 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14586 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14587 @end smallexample
14588
14589 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14590 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14591 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14592
14593
14594 @node Languages
14595 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14596 @cindex languages
14597
14598 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14599 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14600 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14601 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14602 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14603 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14604
14605 @cindex working language
14606 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14607 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14608 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14609 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14610 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14611 language}.
14612
14613 @menu
14614 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14615 * Show:: Displaying the language
14616 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14617 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14618 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14619 @end menu
14620
14621 @node Setting
14622 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14623
14624 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14625 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14626 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14627 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14628 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14629 are printed, etc.
14630
14631 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14632 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14633 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14634 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14635 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14636 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14637 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14638 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14639 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14640 Displaying the Language}.
14641
14642 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14643 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14644 another language. In that case, make the
14645 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14646 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14647 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14648
14649 @menu
14650 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14651 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14652 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14653 @end menu
14654
14655 @node Filenames
14656 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14657
14658 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14659 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14660
14661 @table @file
14662 @item .ada
14663 @itemx .ads
14664 @itemx .adb
14665 @itemx .a
14666 Ada source file.
14667
14668 @item .c
14669 C source file
14670
14671 @item .C
14672 @itemx .cc
14673 @itemx .cp
14674 @itemx .cpp
14675 @itemx .cxx
14676 @itemx .c++
14677 C@t{++} source file
14678
14679 @item .d
14680 D source file
14681
14682 @item .m
14683 Objective-C source file
14684
14685 @item .f
14686 @itemx .F
14687 Fortran source file
14688
14689 @item .mod
14690 Modula-2 source file
14691
14692 @item .s
14693 @itemx .S
14694 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14695 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14696 @end table
14697
14698 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14699 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14700
14701 @node Manually
14702 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14703
14704 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14705 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14706 your program.
14707
14708 @kindex set language
14709 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14710 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14711 a language, such as
14712 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14713 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14714
14715 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14716 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14717 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14718 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14719 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14720 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14721 command such as:
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 print a = b + c
14725 @end smallexample
14726
14727 @noindent
14728 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14729 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14730 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14731 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14732
14733 @node Automatically
14734 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14735
14736 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14737 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14738 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14739 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14740 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14741 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14742 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14743 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14744 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14745
14746 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14747 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14748 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14749 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14750 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14751
14752 @node Show
14753 @section Displaying the Language
14754
14755 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14756 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14757
14758 @table @code
14759 @item show language
14760 @anchor{show language}
14761 @kindex show language
14762 Display the current working language. This is the
14763 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14764 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14765
14766 @item info frame
14767 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14768 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14769 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14770 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14771 information listed here.
14772
14773 @item info source
14774 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14775 Display the source language of this source file.
14776 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14777 information listed here.
14778 @end table
14779
14780 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14781 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14782 with a language explicitly:
14783
14784 @table @code
14785 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14786 @kindex set extension-language
14787 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14788 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14789
14790 @item info extensions
14791 @kindex info extensions
14792 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14793 @end table
14794
14795 @node Checks
14796 @section Type and Range Checking
14797
14798 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14799 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14800 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14801 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14802 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14803 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14804 errors when your program is running.
14805
14806 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14807 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14808 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14809 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14810
14811 @menu
14812 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14813 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14814 @end menu
14815
14816 @cindex type checking
14817 @cindex checks, type
14818 @node Type Checking
14819 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14820
14821 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14822 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14823 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14824 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14825
14826 @smallexample
14827 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14828
14829 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14830 $1 = 2
14831 @exdent but
14832 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14833 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14834 @end smallexample
14835
14836 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14837 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14838
14839 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14840 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14841 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14842 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14843 expressions like the second example above.
14844
14845 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14846 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14847 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14848 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14849 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14850 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14851
14852 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14853
14854 @kindex set check type
14855 @kindex show check type
14856 @table @code
14857 @item set check type on
14858 @itemx set check type off
14859 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14860 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14861 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14862
14863 @item show check type
14864 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14865 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14866 @end table
14867
14868 @cindex range checking
14869 @cindex checks, range
14870 @node Range Checking
14871 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14872
14873 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14874 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14875 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14876 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14877 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14878
14879 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14880 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14881 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14882 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14883
14884 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14885 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14886 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14887 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14888 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14889 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14890
14891 @smallexample
14892 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14893 @end smallexample
14894
14895 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14896 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14897 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14898
14899 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14900
14901 @kindex set check range
14902 @kindex show check range
14903 @table @code
14904 @item set check range auto
14905 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14906 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14907 each language.
14908
14909 @item set check range on
14910 @itemx set check range off
14911 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14912 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14913 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14914 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14915
14916 @item set check range warn
14917 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14918 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14919 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14920 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14921 systems).
14922
14923 @item show range
14924 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14925 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14926 @end table
14927
14928 @node Supported Languages
14929 @section Supported Languages
14930
14931 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14932 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14933 @c This is false ...
14934 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14935 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14936 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14937 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14938 language.
14939
14940 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14941 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14942 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14943 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14944 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14945 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14946 language reference or tutorial.
14947
14948 @menu
14949 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14950 * D:: D
14951 * Go:: Go
14952 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14953 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14954 * Fortran:: Fortran
14955 * Pascal:: Pascal
14956 * Rust:: Rust
14957 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14958 * Ada:: Ada
14959 @end menu
14960
14961 @node C
14962 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14963
14964 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14965 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14966
14967 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14968 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14969 together.
14970
14971 @cindex C@t{++}
14972 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14973 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14974 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14975 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14976 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14977 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14978 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14979
14980 @menu
14981 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14982 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14983 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14984 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14985 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14986 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14987 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14988 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14989 @end menu
14990
14991 @node C Operators
14992 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14993
14994 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14995
14996 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14997 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14998 often defined on groups of types.
14999
15000 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15001
15002 @itemize @bullet
15003
15004 @item
15005 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15006 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15007
15008 @item
15009 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15010 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15011
15012 @item
15013 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15014
15015 @item
15016 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15017
15018 @end itemize
15019
15020 @noindent
15021 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15022 in order of increasing precedence:
15023
15024 @table @code
15025 @item ,
15026 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15027 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15028 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15029
15030 @item =
15031 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15032 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15033
15034 @item @var{op}=
15035 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15036 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15037 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15038 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15039 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15040
15041 @item ?:
15042 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15043 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15044 should be of an integral type.
15045
15046 @item ||
15047 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15048
15049 @item &&
15050 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15051
15052 @item |
15053 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15054
15055 @item ^
15056 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15057
15058 @item &
15059 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15060
15061 @item ==@r{, }!=
15062 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15063 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15064
15065 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15066 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15067 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15068 and non-zero for true.
15069
15070 @item <<@r{, }>>
15071 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15072
15073 @item @@
15074 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15075
15076 @item +@r{, }-
15077 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15078 pointer types.
15079
15080 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15081 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15082 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15083 integral types.
15084
15085 @item ++@r{, }--
15086 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15087 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15088 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15089 operation takes place.
15090
15091 @item *
15092 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15093 @code{++}.
15094
15095 @item &
15096 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15097
15098 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15099 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15100 to examine the address
15101 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15102 stored.
15103
15104 @item -
15105 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15106 precedence as @code{++}.
15107
15108 @item !
15109 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15110 @code{++}.
15111
15112 @item ~
15113 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15114 @code{++}.
15115
15116
15117 @item .@r{, }->
15118 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15119 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15120 pointer based on the stored type information.
15121 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15122
15123 @item .*@r{, }->*
15124 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15125
15126 @item []
15127 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15128 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15129
15130 @item ()
15131 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15132
15133 @item ::
15134 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15135 and @code{class} types.
15136
15137 @item ::
15138 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15139 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15140 above.
15141 @end table
15142
15143 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15144 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15145 predefined meaning.
15146
15147 @node C Constants
15148 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15149
15150 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15151
15152 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15153 following ways:
15154
15155 @itemize @bullet
15156 @item
15157 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15158 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15159 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15160 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15161 @code{long} value.
15162
15163 @item
15164 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15165 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15166 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15167 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15168 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15169 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15170 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15171 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15172 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15173 constant.
15174
15175 @item
15176 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15177 integral equivalents.
15178
15179 @item
15180 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15181 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15182 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15183 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15184 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15185 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15186 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15187 @samp{\n} for newline.
15188
15189 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15190 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15191 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15192 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15193
15194 @item
15195 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15196 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15197 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15198 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15199 characters.
15200
15201 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15202 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15203 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15204
15205 @item
15206 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15207 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15208
15209 @item
15210 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15211 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15212 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15213 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15214 @end itemize
15215
15216 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15217 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15218
15219 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15220 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15221
15222 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15223 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15224 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15225 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15226 @quotation
15227 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15228 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15229 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15230 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15231 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15232 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15233 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15234 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15235 @end quotation
15236
15237 @enumerate
15238
15239 @cindex member functions
15240 @item
15241 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15242
15243 @smallexample
15244 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15245 @end smallexample
15246
15247 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15248 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15249 @item
15250 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15251 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15252 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15253 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15254 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15255
15256 @cindex call overloaded functions
15257 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15258 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15259 @item
15260 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15261 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15262 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15263 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15264 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15265 default arguments.
15266
15267 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15268 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15269 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15270 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15271 number of function arguments.
15272
15273 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15274 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15275 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15276
15277 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15278 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15279 @smallexample
15280 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15281 @end smallexample
15282
15283 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15284 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15285
15286 @cindex reference declarations
15287 @item
15288 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15289 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15290 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15291
15292 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15293 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15294 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15295 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15296 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15297
15298 @item
15299 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15300 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15301 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15302 necessary, for example in an expression like
15303 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15304 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15305 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15306
15307 @item
15308 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15309 specification.
15310 @end enumerate
15311
15312 @node C Defaults
15313 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15314
15315 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15316
15317 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15318 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15319 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15320 selects the working language.
15321
15322 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15323 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15324 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15325 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15326 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15327 for further details.
15328
15329 @node C Checks
15330 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15331
15332 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15333
15334 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15335 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15336 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15337 constants to pointers.
15338
15339 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15340 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15341 that is not itself an array.
15342
15343 @node Debugging C
15344 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15345
15346 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15347 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15348 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15349 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15350
15351 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15352 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15353 ,Expressions}.
15354
15355 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15356 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15357
15358 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15359
15360 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15361 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15362
15363 @table @code
15364 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15365 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15366 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15367 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15368 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15369 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15370
15371 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15372 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15373 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15374 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15375 classes.
15376 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15377
15378 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15379 @item catch throw
15380 @itemx catch rethrow
15381 @itemx catch catch
15382 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15383 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15384
15385 @cindex inheritance
15386 @item ptype @var{typename}
15387 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15388 @var{typename}.
15389 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15390
15391 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15392 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15393 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15394 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15395 multiple inheritance is in use.
15396
15397 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15398 @item demangle @var{name}
15399 Demangle @var{name}.
15400 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15401
15402 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15403 @item set print demangle
15404 @itemx show print demangle
15405 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15406 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15407 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15408 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15409 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15410
15411 @item set print object
15412 @itemx show print object
15413 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15414 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15415
15416 @item set print vtbl
15417 @itemx show print vtbl
15418 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15419 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15420 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15421 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15422
15423 @kindex set overload-resolution
15424 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15425 @item set overload-resolution on
15426 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15427 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15428 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15429 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15430 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15431 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15432
15433 @item set overload-resolution off
15434 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15435 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15436 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15437 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15438 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15439 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15440 argument types.
15441
15442 @kindex show overload-resolution
15443 @item show overload-resolution
15444 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15445
15446 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15447 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15448 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15449 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15450 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15451 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15452 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15453
15454 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15455
15456 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15457 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15458 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15459 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15460 for more detail.
15461
15462 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15463 function that returns a std::string:
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 std::string function(int);
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 @noindent
15470 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15471 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15472
15473 @smallexample
15474 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15475 @end smallexample
15476
15477 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15478 tag. For example:
15479
15480 @smallexample
15481 (gdb) b function(int)
15482 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15483 (gdb) info breakpoints
15484 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15485 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15486 at main.cc:10
15487 @end smallexample
15488
15489 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15490 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15491 name, like:
15492
15493 @smallexample
15494 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15495 @end smallexample
15496 @end table
15497
15498 @node Decimal Floating Point
15499 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15500 @cindex decimal floating point format
15501
15502 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15503 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15504 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15505 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15506
15507 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15508 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15509 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15510 configured target.
15511
15512 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15513 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15514 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15515
15516 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15517 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15518 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15519
15520 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15521 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15522 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15523
15524 @node D
15525 @subsection D
15526
15527 @cindex D
15528 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15529 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15530 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15531
15532 @node Go
15533 @subsection Go
15534
15535 @cindex Go (programming language)
15536 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15537 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15538
15539 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15540
15541 @table @code
15542 @cindex current Go package
15543 @item The current Go package
15544 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15545 specifying global variables and functions.
15546
15547 For example, given the program:
15548
15549 @example
15550 package main
15551 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15552 func main () @{
15553 // ...
15554 @}
15555 @end example
15556
15557 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15558
15559 @example
15560 (gdb) p myglob
15561 (gdb) p main.myglob
15562 @end example
15563
15564 @cindex builtin Go types
15565 @item Builtin Go types
15566 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15567 as a string.
15568
15569 @cindex builtin Go functions
15570 @item Builtin Go functions
15571 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15572 function and handles it internally.
15573
15574 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15575 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15576 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15577 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15578 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15579 @end table
15580
15581 @node Objective-C
15582 @subsection Objective-C
15583
15584 @cindex Objective-C
15585 This section provides information about some commands and command
15586 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15587 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15588 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15589
15590 @menu
15591 * Method Names in Commands::
15592 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15593 @end menu
15594
15595 @node Method Names in Commands
15596 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15597
15598 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15599 names as line specifications:
15600
15601 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15602 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15603 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15604 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15605 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15606 @itemize
15607 @item @code{clear}
15608 @item @code{break}
15609 @item @code{info line}
15610 @item @code{jump}
15611 @item @code{list}
15612 @end itemize
15613
15614 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15615
15616 @smallexample
15617 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15618 @end smallexample
15619
15620 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15621 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15622 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15623 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15624 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15625 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15626 debugged, enter:
15627
15628 @smallexample
15629 break -[Fruit create]
15630 @end smallexample
15631
15632 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15633 enter:
15634
15635 @smallexample
15636 list +[NSText initialize]
15637 @end smallexample
15638
15639 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15640 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15641 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15642 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15643
15644 @smallexample
15645 break create
15646 @end smallexample
15647
15648 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15649 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15650 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15651 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15652 none apply.
15653
15654 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15655 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15656
15657 @smallexample
15658 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15659 @end smallexample
15660
15661 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15662 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15663 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15664 @kindex print-object
15665 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15666
15667 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15668
15669 @smallexample
15670 print -[@var{object} hash]
15671 @end smallexample
15672
15673 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15674 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15675 @noindent
15676 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15677 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15678 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15679 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15680 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15681 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15682
15683 @node OpenCL C
15684 @subsection OpenCL C
15685
15686 @cindex OpenCL C
15687 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15688
15689 @menu
15690 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15691 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15692 * OpenCL C Operators::
15693 @end menu
15694
15695 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15696 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15697
15698 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15699 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15700 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15701 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15702 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15703
15704 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15705 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15706
15707 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15708 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15709 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15710 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15711
15712 @node OpenCL C Operators
15713 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15714
15715 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15716 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15717 vector data types.
15718
15719 @node Fortran
15720 @subsection Fortran
15721 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15722
15723 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15724 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15725
15726 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15727 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15728 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15729 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15730 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15731 underscore.
15732
15733 @menu
15734 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15735 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15736 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15737 @end menu
15738
15739 @node Fortran Operators
15740 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15741
15742 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15743
15744 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15745 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15746 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15747
15748 @table @code
15749 @item **
15750 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15751 of the second one.
15752
15753 @item :
15754 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15755 represent a section of array.
15756
15757 @item %
15758 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15759 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15760 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15761 union type.
15762 @end table
15763
15764 @node Fortran Defaults
15765 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15766
15767 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15768
15769 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15770 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15771 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15772 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15773
15774 @node Special Fortran Commands
15775 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15776
15777 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15778
15779 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15780 such as displaying common blocks.
15781
15782 @table @code
15783 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15784 @kindex info common
15785 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15786 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15787 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15788 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15789 printed.
15790 @end table
15791
15792 @node Pascal
15793 @subsection Pascal
15794
15795 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15796 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15797 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15798 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15799 syntax.
15800
15801 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15802 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15803 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15804
15805 @node Rust
15806 @subsection Rust
15807
15808 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15809 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15810 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15811 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15812
15813 @itemize @bullet
15814 @item
15815 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15816 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15817 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15818
15819 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15820 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15821 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15822 @samp{B}.
15823
15824 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15825 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15826
15827 @item
15828 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15829 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15830 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15831 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15832 @samp{K::x::y}.
15833
15834 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15835 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15836 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15837 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15838 scope.
15839
15840 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15841 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15842
15843 @item
15844 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15845 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15846
15847 @item
15848 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15849
15850 @item
15851 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15852 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15853 never be destroyed.
15854
15855 @item
15856 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15857 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15858 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15859
15860 @item
15861 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15862 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15863 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15864 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15865 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15866 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15867 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15868 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15869
15870 @item
15871 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15872 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15873 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15874 @itemize @bullet
15875
15876 @item
15877 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15878
15879 @item
15880 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15881
15882 @item
15883 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15884 type names.
15885
15886 @item
15887 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15888
15889 @item
15890 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15891 available in the crate.
15892 @end itemize
15893 @end itemize
15894
15895 @node Modula-2
15896 @subsection Modula-2
15897
15898 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15899
15900 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15901 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15902 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15903 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15904 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15905 table.
15906
15907 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15908 @menu
15909 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15910 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15911 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15912 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15913 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15914 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15915 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15916 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15917 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15918 @end menu
15919
15920 @node M2 Operators
15921 @subsubsection Operators
15922 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15923
15924 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15925 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15926 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15927 following definitions hold:
15928
15929 @itemize @bullet
15930
15931 @item
15932 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15933 their subranges.
15934
15935 @item
15936 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15937
15938 @item
15939 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15940
15941 @item
15942 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15943 @var{type}}.
15944
15945 @item
15946 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15947
15948 @item
15949 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15950
15951 @item
15952 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15953 @end itemize
15954
15955 @noindent
15956 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15957 increasing precedence:
15958
15959 @table @code
15960 @item ,
15961 Function argument or array index separator.
15962
15963 @item :=
15964 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15965 @var{value}.
15966
15967 @item <@r{, }>
15968 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15969 types.
15970
15971 @item <=@r{, }>=
15972 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15973 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15974 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15975
15976 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15977 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15978 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15979 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15980 comment character.
15981
15982 @item IN
15983 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15984 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15985
15986 @item OR
15987 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15988
15989 @item AND@r{, }&
15990 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15991
15992 @item @@
15993 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15994
15995 @item +@r{, }-
15996 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15997 and difference on set types.
15998
15999 @item *
16000 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16001 on set types.
16002
16003 @item /
16004 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16005 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16006
16007 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16008 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16009 precedence as @code{*}.
16010
16011 @item -
16012 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16013
16014 @item ^
16015 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16016
16017 @item NOT
16018 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16019 @code{^}.
16020
16021 @item .
16022 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16023 precedence as @code{^}.
16024
16025 @item []
16026 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16027
16028 @item ()
16029 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16030 as @code{^}.
16031
16032 @item ::@r{, }.
16033 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16034 @end table
16035
16036 @quotation
16037 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16038 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16039 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16040 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16041 @end quotation
16042
16043
16044 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16045 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16046 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16047
16048 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16049 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16050
16051 @table @var
16052
16053 @item a
16054 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16055
16056 @item c
16057 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16058
16059 @item i
16060 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16061
16062 @item m
16063 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16064 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16065 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16066
16067 @item n
16068 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16069
16070 @item r
16071 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16072
16073 @item t
16074 represents a type.
16075
16076 @item v
16077 represents a variable.
16078
16079 @item x
16080 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16081 explanation of the function for details.
16082 @end table
16083
16084 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16085
16086 @table @code
16087 @item ABS(@var{n})
16088 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16089
16090 @item CAP(@var{c})
16091 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16092 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16093
16094 @item CHR(@var{i})
16095 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16096
16097 @item DEC(@var{v})
16098 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16099
16100 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16101 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16102 new value.
16103
16104 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16105 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16106 set.
16107
16108 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16109 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16110
16111 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16112 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16113
16114 @item INC(@var{v})
16115 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16116
16117 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16118 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16119 new value.
16120
16121 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16122 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16123 there. Returns the new set.
16124
16125 @item MAX(@var{t})
16126 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16127
16128 @item MIN(@var{t})
16129 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16130
16131 @item ODD(@var{i})
16132 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16133
16134 @item ORD(@var{x})
16135 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16136 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16137 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16138 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16139
16140 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16141 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16142 variable or a type.
16143
16144 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16145 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16146
16147 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16148 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16149 variable or a type.
16150
16151 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16152 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16153 @end table
16154
16155 @quotation
16156 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16157 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16158 an error.
16159 @end quotation
16160
16161 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16162 @node M2 Constants
16163 @subsubsection Constants
16164
16165 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16166 ways:
16167
16168 @itemize @bullet
16169
16170 @item
16171 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16172 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16173 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16174 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16175
16176 @item
16177 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16178 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16179 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16180 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16181 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16182 digits.
16183
16184 @item
16185 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16186 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16187 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16188 followed by a @samp{C}.
16189
16190 @item
16191 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16192 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16193 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16194 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16195 sequences.
16196
16197 @item
16198 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16199
16200 @item
16201 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16202 @code{FALSE}.
16203
16204 @item
16205 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16206
16207 @item
16208 Set constants are not yet supported.
16209 @end itemize
16210
16211 @node M2 Types
16212 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16213 @cindex Modula-2 types
16214
16215 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16216 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16217 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16218 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16219 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16220 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16221
16222 The first example contains the following section of code:
16223
16224 @smallexample
16225 VAR
16226 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16227 r: [20..40] ;
16228 @end smallexample
16229
16230 @noindent
16231 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16232 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16233
16234 @smallexample
16235 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16236 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16237 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16238 SET OF CHAR
16239 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16240 21
16241 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16242 [20..40]
16243 @end smallexample
16244
16245 @noindent
16246 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16247
16248 @smallexample
16249 VAR
16250 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 @noindent
16254 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16255
16256 @smallexample
16257 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16258 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16259 @end smallexample
16260
16261 @noindent
16262 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16263 expressions using the debugger.
16264
16265 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16266 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 VAR
16270 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16271 @end smallexample
16272
16273 @smallexample
16274 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16275 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16276 @end smallexample
16277
16278 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16279 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16280 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16281 above.
16282
16283 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16284
16285 @smallexample
16286 TYPE
16287 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16288 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16289 VAR
16290 s: t ;
16291 BEGIN
16292 s := blue ;
16293 @end smallexample
16294
16295 @noindent
16296 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16297 and value of a variable.
16298
16299 @smallexample
16300 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16301 $1 = blue
16302 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16303 type = [blue..yellow]
16304 @end smallexample
16305
16306 @noindent
16307 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16308 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16309 their @code{C} counterparts.
16310
16311 @smallexample
16312 VAR
16313 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16314 BEGIN
16315 s[1] := 1 ;
16316 @end smallexample
16317
16318 @smallexample
16319 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16320 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16321 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16322 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16323 @end smallexample
16324
16325 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16326 pointer types as shown in this example:
16327
16328 @smallexample
16329 VAR
16330 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16331 BEGIN
16332 NEW(s) ;
16333 s^[1] := 1 ;
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @noindent
16337 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16338
16339 @smallexample
16340 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16341 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16342 @end smallexample
16343
16344 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16345 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16346 types:
16347
16348 @smallexample
16349 TYPE
16350 foo = RECORD
16351 f1: CARDINAL ;
16352 f2: CHAR ;
16353 f3: myarray ;
16354 END ;
16355
16356 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16357 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16358 VAR
16359 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16360 @end smallexample
16361
16362 @noindent
16363 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16364 below.
16365
16366 @smallexample
16367 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16368 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16369 f1 : CARDINAL;
16370 f2 : CHAR;
16371 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16372 END
16373 @end smallexample
16374
16375 @node M2 Defaults
16376 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16377 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16378
16379 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16380 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16381 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16382 selected the working language.
16383
16384 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16385 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16386 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16387 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16388
16389 @node Deviations
16390 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16391 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16392
16393 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16394 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16395
16396 @itemize @bullet
16397 @item
16398 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16399 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16400 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16401 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16402 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16403 returned a pointer.)
16404
16405 @item
16406 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16407 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16408 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16409 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16410
16411 @item
16412 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16413 argument.
16414
16415 @item
16416 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16417 @end itemize
16418
16419 @node M2 Checks
16420 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16421 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16422
16423 @quotation
16424 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16425 range checking.
16426 @end quotation
16427 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16428
16429 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16430
16431 @itemize @bullet
16432 @item
16433 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16434 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16435
16436 @item
16437 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16438 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16439 @end itemize
16440
16441 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16442 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16443
16444 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16445 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16446
16447 @node M2 Scope
16448 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16449 @cindex scope
16450 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16451 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16452 @ifinfo
16453 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16454 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16455 @end ifinfo
16456 @ifnotinfo
16457 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16458 @end ifnotinfo
16459
16460 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16461 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16462 similar syntax:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465
16466 @var{module} . @var{id}
16467 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16468 @end smallexample
16469
16470 @noindent
16471 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16472 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16473 identifier within your program, except another module.
16474
16475 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16476 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16477 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16478 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16479
16480 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16481 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16482 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16483 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16484 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16485 @var{module}.
16486
16487 @node GDB/M2
16488 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16489
16490 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16491 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16492 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16493 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16494 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16495 analogue in Modula-2.
16496
16497 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16498 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16499 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16500 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16501 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16502 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16503
16504 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16505 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16506 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16507
16508 @node Ada
16509 @subsection Ada
16510 @cindex Ada
16511
16512 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16513 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16514 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16515 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16516 to be difficult.
16517
16518
16519 @cindex expressions in Ada
16520 @menu
16521 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16522 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16523 in @value{GDBN}.
16524 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16525 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16526 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16527 subprograms.
16528 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16529 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16530 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16531 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16532 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16533 Profile
16534 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16535 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16536 @end menu
16537
16538 @node Ada Mode Intro
16539 @subsubsection Introduction
16540 @cindex Ada mode, general
16541
16542 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16543 syntax, with some extensions.
16544 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16545
16546 @itemize @bullet
16547 @item
16548 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16549 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16550 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16551 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16552
16553 @item
16554 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16555 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16556
16557 @item
16558 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16559 @end itemize
16560
16561 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16562 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16563 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16564 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16565 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16566
16567 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16568 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16569 was translated from an Ada source file.
16570
16571 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16572 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16573 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16574 middle (to allow based literals).
16575
16576 @node Omissions from Ada
16577 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16578 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16579
16580 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16581
16582 @itemize @bullet
16583 @item
16584 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16585
16586 @itemize @minus
16587 @item
16588 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16589 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16590
16591 @item
16592 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16593
16594 @item
16595 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16596
16597 @item
16598 @t{'Tag}.
16599
16600 @item
16601 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16602 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16603
16604 @item
16605 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16606 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16607
16608 @item
16609 @t{'Address}.
16610 @end itemize
16611
16612 @item
16613 The names in
16614 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16615 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16616 not currently available.
16617
16618 @item
16619 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16620 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16621 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16622 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16623 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16624 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16625 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16626 indeterminate values.
16627
16628 @item
16629 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16630 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16631 are not implemented.
16632
16633 @item
16634 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16635 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16636 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16637 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16638 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16639
16640 @smallexample
16641 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16642 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16643 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16644 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16645 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16646 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16647 @end smallexample
16648
16649 Changing a
16650 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16651 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16652 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16653 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16654 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16655 declared to have a type such as:
16656
16657 @smallexample
16658 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16659 Id : Integer;
16660 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16661 end record;
16662 @end smallexample
16663
16664 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16665 assignments:
16666
16667 @smallexample
16668 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16669 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16670 @end smallexample
16671
16672 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16673 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16674 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16675 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16676 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16677 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16678 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16679 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16680
16681 @item
16682 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16683
16684 @item
16685 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16686 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16687 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16688 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16689 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16690 the proper resolution.
16691
16692 @item
16693 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16694
16695 @item
16696 Entry calls are not implemented.
16697
16698 @item
16699 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16700 formats are not supported.
16701
16702 @item
16703 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16704
16705 @item
16706 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16707 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16708 context.
16709 Should your program
16710 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16711 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16712 @end itemize
16713
16714 @node Additions to Ada
16715 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16716 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16717
16718 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16719 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16720
16721 @itemize @bullet
16722 @item
16723 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16724 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16725 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16726 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16727 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16728 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16729 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16730 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16731
16732 @item
16733 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16734 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16735 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16736
16737 @item
16738 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16739 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16740
16741 @item
16742 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16743 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16744 @end itemize
16745
16746 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16747 additions specific to Ada:
16748
16749 @itemize @bullet
16750 @item
16751 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16752 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16753
16754 @smallexample
16755 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16756 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16757 @end smallexample
16758
16759 @item
16760 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16761 the value of its right-hand operand.
16762 This allows, for example,
16763 complex conditional breaks:
16764
16765 @smallexample
16766 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16767 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16768 @end smallexample
16769
16770 @item
16771 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16772 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16773 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16774 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16775 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16776 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16777 in strings. For example,
16778 @smallexample
16779 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16780 @end smallexample
16781 @noindent
16782 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16783 after each period.
16784
16785 @item
16786 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16787 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16788 to write
16789
16790 @smallexample
16791 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16792 @end smallexample
16793
16794 @item
16795 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16796 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16797 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16798 of 3 might print as
16799
16800 @smallexample
16801 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16802 @end smallexample
16803
16804 @noindent
16805 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16806 clause.
16807
16808 @item
16809 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16810 multi-character subsequence of
16811 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16812 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16813 in place of @t{a'length}.
16814
16815 @item
16816 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16817 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16818 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16819 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16820 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16821 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16822 For example,
16823 @smallexample
16824 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16825 @end smallexample
16826
16827 @item
16828 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16829 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16830 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16831 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16832 object.
16833
16834 @end itemize
16835
16836 @node Overloading support for Ada
16837 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16838 @cindex overloading, Ada
16839
16840 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16841 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16842 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16843 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16844 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16845 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16846
16847 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16848 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16849 use, for instance:
16850
16851 @smallexample
16852 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16853 Multiple matches for f
16854 [0] cancel
16855 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16856 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16857 >
16858 @end smallexample
16859
16860 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16861 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16862 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16863
16864 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16865 case:
16866
16867 @table @code
16868
16869 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16870 @item set ada print-signatures
16871 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16872 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16873 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16874
16875 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16876 @item show ada print-signatures
16877 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16878 overloads selection menu.
16879 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16880
16881 @end table
16882
16883 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16884 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16885
16886 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16887 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16888 before reaching the main procedure.
16889 As defined in the Ada Reference
16890 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16891 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16892 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16893 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16894
16895 @node Ada Exceptions
16896 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16897
16898 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16899
16900 @table @code
16901 @kindex info exceptions
16902 @item info exceptions
16903 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16904 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16905 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16906 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16907 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16908 @end table
16909
16910 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16911 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16912 argument.
16913
16914 @smallexample
16915 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16916 All defined Ada exceptions:
16917 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16918 program_error: 0x613d20
16919 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16920 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16921 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16922 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16923 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16924 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16925 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16926 @end smallexample
16927
16928 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16929 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16930
16931 @node Ada Tasks
16932 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16933 @cindex Ada, tasking
16934
16935 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16936 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16937
16938 @table @code
16939 @kindex info tasks
16940 @item info tasks
16941 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16942
16943
16944 @smallexample
16945 @iftex
16946 @leftskip=0.5cm
16947 @end iftex
16948 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16949 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16950 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16951 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16952 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16953 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16954
16955 @end smallexample
16956
16957 @noindent
16958 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16959 task currently being inspected.
16960
16961 @table @asis
16962 @item ID
16963 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16964
16965 @item TID
16966 The Ada task ID.
16967
16968 @item P-ID
16969 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16970
16971 @item Pri
16972 The base priority of the task.
16973
16974 @item State
16975 Current state of the task.
16976
16977 @table @code
16978 @item Unactivated
16979 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16980 executing.
16981
16982 @item Runnable
16983 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16984 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16985
16986 @item Terminated
16987 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16988 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16989 terminated themselves.
16990
16991 @item Child Activation Wait
16992 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16993
16994 @item Accept Statement
16995 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16996
16997 @item Waiting on entry call
16998 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16999
17000 @item Async Select Wait
17001 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17002 select statement.
17003
17004 @item Delay Sleep
17005 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17006 alternative open.
17007
17008 @item Child Termination Wait
17009 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17010 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17011 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17012
17013 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17014 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17015 finish terminating.
17016
17017 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17018 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17019 @end table
17020
17021 @item Name
17022 Name of the task in the program.
17023
17024 @end table
17025
17026 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17027 @item info task @var{taskno}
17028 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17029 the following example:
17030 @smallexample
17031 @iftex
17032 @leftskip=0.5cm
17033 @end iftex
17034 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17035 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17036 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17037 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17038 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17039 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17040 Name: task_1
17041 Thread: 0x807f378
17042 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17043 Base Priority: 15
17044 State: Runnable
17045 @end smallexample
17046
17047 @item task
17048 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17049 @cindex current Ada task ID
17050 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17051
17052 @smallexample
17053 @iftex
17054 @leftskip=0.5cm
17055 @end iftex
17056 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17057 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17058 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17059 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17060 (@value{GDBP}) task
17061 [Current task is 2]
17062 @end smallexample
17063
17064 @item task @var{taskno}
17065 @cindex Ada task switching
17066 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17067 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17068 from the current task to the given task.
17069
17070 @smallexample
17071 @iftex
17072 @leftskip=0.5cm
17073 @end iftex
17074 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17075 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17076 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17077 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17078 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17079 [Switching to task 1]
17080 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17081 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17082 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17083 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17084 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17085 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17086 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17087 @end smallexample
17088
17089 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17090 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17091 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17092 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17093 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17094 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17095 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17096 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17097 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17098
17099 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17100 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17101 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17102 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17103 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17104
17105 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17106 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17107 program.
17108
17109 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17110 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17111 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17112
17113 For example,
17114
17115 @smallexample
17116 @iftex
17117 @leftskip=0.5cm
17118 @end iftex
17119 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17120 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17121 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17122 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17123 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17124 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17125 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17126 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17127 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17128 Continuing.
17129 task # 1 running
17130 task # 2 running
17131
17132 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17133 15 flush;
17134 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17135 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17136 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17137 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17138 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17139 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17140 @end smallexample
17141 @end table
17142
17143 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17144 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17145 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17146
17147 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17148 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17149 the platform being used.
17150 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17151 switching is not supported.
17152
17153 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17154 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17155 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17156 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17157 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17158 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17159
17160 @node Ravenscar Profile
17161 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17162 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17163
17164 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17165 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17166 requirements.
17167
17168 @table @code
17169 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17170 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17171 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17172 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17173 Profile. This is the default.
17174
17175 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17176 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17177 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17178 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17179 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17180 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17181 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17182
17183 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17184 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17185 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17186 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17187
17188 @end table
17189
17190 @node Ada Settings
17191 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17192 @cindex Ada settings
17193
17194 @table @code
17195 @kindex set varsize-limit
17196 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17197 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17198 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17199 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17200 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17201 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17202 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17203
17204 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17205 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17206 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17207 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17208 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17209 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17210 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17211 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17212 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17213 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17214 size is less than @var{size}.
17215
17216 @kindex show varsize-limit
17217 @item show varsize-limit
17218 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17219 @end table
17220
17221 @node Ada Glitches
17222 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17223 @cindex Ada, problems
17224
17225 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17226 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17227 @value{GDBN},
17228 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17229 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17230
17231 @itemize @bullet
17232 @item
17233 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17234 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17235
17236 @item
17237 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17238 argument lists are treated as positional).
17239
17240 @item
17241 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17242
17243 @item
17244 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17245 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17246 the host machine.
17247
17248 @item
17249 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17250 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17251 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17252 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17253 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17254 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17255 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17256 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17257 you can usually resolve the confusion
17258 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17259 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17260 @end itemize
17261
17262 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17263 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17264 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17265 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17266 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17267 enabled.
17268
17269 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17270 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17271 @table @code
17272
17273 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17274 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17275 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17276 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17277 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17278 This is the default.
17279
17280 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17281 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17282 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17283 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17284 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17285 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17286 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17287
17288 @end table
17289
17290 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17291 @cindex GNAT encoding
17292 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17293 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17294 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17295 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17296 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17297 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17298
17299 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17300 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17301 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17302 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17303 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17304 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17305 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17306 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17307
17308 @table @code
17309
17310 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17311 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17312 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17313 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17314
17315 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17316 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17317 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17318
17319 @end table
17320
17321 @node Unsupported Languages
17322 @section Unsupported Languages
17323
17324 @cindex unsupported languages
17325 @cindex minimal language
17326 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17327 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17328 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17329 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17330 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17331 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17332
17333 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17334 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17335 language.
17336
17337 @node Symbols
17338 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17339
17340 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17341 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17342 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17343 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17344 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17345 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17346 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17347
17348 @cindex symbol names
17349 @cindex names of symbols
17350 @cindex quoting names
17351 @anchor{quoting names}
17352 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17353 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17354 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17355 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17356 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17357 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17358 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17359 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17360
17361 @smallexample
17362 p 'foo.c'::x
17363 @end smallexample
17364
17365 @noindent
17366 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17367
17368 @table @code
17369 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17370 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17371 @kindex set case-sensitive
17372 @item set case-sensitive on
17373 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17374 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17375 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17376 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17377 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17378 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17379 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17380 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17381 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17382 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17383 case-insensitive matches.
17384
17385 @kindex show case-sensitive
17386 @item show case-sensitive
17387 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17388 lookups.
17389
17390 @kindex set print type methods
17391 @item set print type methods
17392 @itemx set print type methods on
17393 @itemx set print type methods off
17394 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17395 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17396 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17397 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17398 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17399 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17400
17401 @kindex show print type methods
17402 @item show print type methods
17403 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17404 classes.
17405
17406 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17407 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17408 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17409 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17410 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17411 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17412 types defined in classes.
17413
17414 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17415 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17416 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17417 printing classes.
17418
17419 @kindex set print type typedefs
17420 @item set print type typedefs
17421 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17422 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17423
17424 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17425 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17426 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17427 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17428 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17429 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17430 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17431 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17432 types.
17433
17434 @kindex show print type typedefs
17435 @item show print type typedefs
17436 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17437 printing classes.
17438
17439 @kindex info address
17440 @cindex address of a symbol
17441 @item info address @var{symbol}
17442 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17443 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17444 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17445 is always stored.
17446
17447 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17448 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17449 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17450
17451 @kindex info symbol
17452 @cindex symbol from address
17453 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17454 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17455 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17456 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17457 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17458
17459 @smallexample
17460 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17461 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17462 @end smallexample
17463
17464 @noindent
17465 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17466 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17467
17468 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17469 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17470
17471 @smallexample
17472 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17473 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17474 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17475 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17476 @end smallexample
17477
17478 @kindex demangle
17479 @cindex demangle
17480 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17481 Demangle @var{name}.
17482 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17483 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17484
17485 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17486 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17487
17488 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17489 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17490
17491 @kindex whatis
17492 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17493 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17494 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17495 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17496
17497 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17498 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17499 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17500
17501 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17502 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17503 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17504 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17505 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17506 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17507 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17508 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17509 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17510
17511 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17512 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17513 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17514 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17515 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17516 unroll it.
17517
17518 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17519 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17520 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17521
17522 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17523 Available flags are:
17524
17525 @table @code
17526 @item r
17527 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17528 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17529 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17530
17531 @item m
17532 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17533
17534 @item M
17535 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17536 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17537
17538 @item t
17539 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17540 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17541 names are substituted when printing other types.
17542
17543 @item T
17544 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17545 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17546
17547 @item o
17548 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17549 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17550
17551 For example, given the following declarations:
17552
17553 @smallexample
17554 struct tuv
17555 @{
17556 int a1;
17557 char *a2;
17558 int a3;
17559 @};
17560
17561 struct xyz
17562 @{
17563 int f1;
17564 char f2;
17565 void *f3;
17566 struct tuv f4;
17567 @};
17568
17569 union qwe
17570 @{
17571 struct tuv fff1;
17572 struct xyz fff2;
17573 @};
17574
17575 struct tyu
17576 @{
17577 int a1 : 1;
17578 int a2 : 3;
17579 int a3 : 23;
17580 char a4 : 2;
17581 int64_t a5;
17582 int a6 : 5;
17583 int64_t a7 : 3;
17584 @};
17585 @end smallexample
17586
17587 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17588
17589 @smallexample
17590 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17591 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17592 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17593 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17594 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17595 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17596
17597 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17598 @}
17599 @end smallexample
17600
17601 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17602 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17603 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17604 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17605 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17606 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17607 its fields.
17608
17609 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17610
17611 @smallexample
17612 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17613 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17614 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17615 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17616 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17617 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17618 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17619
17620 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17621 @} fff1;
17622 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17623 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17624 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17625 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17626 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17627 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17628 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17629 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17630 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17631 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17632
17633 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17634 @} f4;
17635
17636 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17637 @} fff2;
17638
17639 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17640 @}
17641 @end smallexample
17642
17643 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17644 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17645 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17646 of these structures' fields.
17647
17648 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17649 bitfields:
17650
17651 @smallexample
17652 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17653 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17654 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17655 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17656 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17657 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17658 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17659 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17660 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17661 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17662 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17663
17664 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17665 @}
17666 @end smallexample
17667
17668 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17669 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17670 @end table
17671
17672 @kindex ptype
17673 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17674 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17675 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17676 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17677
17678 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17679 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17680 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17681 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17682 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17683 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17684 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17685 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17686
17687 For example, for this variable declaration:
17688
17689 @smallexample
17690 typedef double real_t;
17691 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17692 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17693 complex_t var;
17694 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17695 @end smallexample
17696
17697 @noindent
17698 the two commands give this output:
17699
17700 @smallexample
17701 @group
17702 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17703 type = complex_t
17704 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17705 type = struct complex @{
17706 real_t real;
17707 double imag;
17708 @}
17709 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17710 type = struct complex
17711 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17712 type = struct complex
17713 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17714 type = struct complex @{
17715 real_t real;
17716 double imag;
17717 @}
17718 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17719 type = real_t *
17720 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17721 type = double *
17722 @end group
17723 @end smallexample
17724
17725 @noindent
17726 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17727 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17728
17729 @cindex incomplete type
17730 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17731 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17732 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17733 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17734 given these declarations:
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 struct foo;
17738 struct foo *fooptr;
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 @noindent
17742 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17743
17744 @smallexample
17745 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17746 $1 = <incomplete type>
17747 @end smallexample
17748
17749 @noindent
17750 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17751 completely specified.
17752
17753 @cindex unknown type
17754 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17755 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17756 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17757 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17758 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17759 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17760 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17761 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17762
17763 @smallexample
17764 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17765 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17766 @end smallexample
17767
17768 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17769 of such variables.
17770
17771 @kindex info types
17772 @item info types @var{regexp}
17773 @itemx info types
17774 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17775 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17776 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17777 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17778 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17779 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17780 name is @code{value}.
17781
17782 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17783 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17784 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17785
17786 @kindex info type-printers
17787 @item info type-printers
17788 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17789 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17790 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17791 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17792 type printers.
17793
17794 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17795
17796 @kindex enable type-printer
17797 @kindex disable type-printer
17798 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17799 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17800 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17801
17802 @kindex info scope
17803 @cindex local variables
17804 @item info scope @var{location}
17805 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17806 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17807 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17808 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17809 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17810
17811 @smallexample
17812 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17813 Scope for command_line_handler:
17814 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17815 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17816 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17817 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17818 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17819 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17820 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17821 @end smallexample
17822
17823 @noindent
17824 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17825 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17826 collect}.
17827
17828 @kindex info source
17829 @item info source
17830 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17831 the function containing the current point of execution:
17832 @itemize @bullet
17833 @item
17834 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17835 @item
17836 the directory it was compiled in,
17837 @item
17838 its length, in lines,
17839 @item
17840 which programming language it is written in,
17841 @item
17842 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17843 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17844 @item
17845 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17846 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17847 @item
17848 whether the debugging information includes information about
17849 preprocessor macros.
17850 @end itemize
17851
17852
17853 @kindex info sources
17854 @item info sources
17855 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17856 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17857 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17858
17859 @kindex info functions
17860 @item info functions
17861 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17862 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17863 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17864 number.
17865
17866 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17867 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17868 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17869 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17870 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17871 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17872 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17873 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17874
17875 @kindex info variables
17876 @item info variables
17877 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17878 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17879 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17880 their respective source line numbers.
17881
17882 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17883 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17884 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17885 @var{regexp}.
17886
17887 @kindex info classes
17888 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17889 @item info classes
17890 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17891 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17892 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17893 expression.
17894
17895 @kindex info selectors
17896 @item info selectors
17897 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17898 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17899 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17900 expression.
17901
17902 @ignore
17903 This was never implemented.
17904 @kindex info methods
17905 @item info methods
17906 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17907 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17908 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17909 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17910 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17911 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17912 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17913 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17914 @end ignore
17915
17916 @cindex opaque data types
17917 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17918 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17919 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17920 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17921 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17922 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17923 another source file. The default is on.
17924
17925 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17926 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17927
17928 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17929 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17930 is printed as follows:
17931 @smallexample
17932 @{<no data fields>@}
17933 @end smallexample
17934
17935 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17936 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17937 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17938
17939 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17940 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17941 @item set print symbol-loading
17942 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17943 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17944 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17945 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17946 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17947 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17948 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17949 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17950 can be annoying.
17951 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17952 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17953 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17954 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17955
17956 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17957 @item show print symbol-loading
17958 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17959 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17960
17961 @kindex maint print symbols
17962 @cindex symbol dump
17963 @kindex maint print psymbols
17964 @cindex partial symbol dump
17965 @kindex maint print msymbols
17966 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17967 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17968 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17969 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17970 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17971 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17972 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17973 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17974 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17975 that objfile.
17976 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17977 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17978 @code{main}.
17979 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17980 source file.
17981
17982 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17983 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17984 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17985 tables.
17986 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17987 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17988 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17989 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17990 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17991 ``ELF symbols''.
17992
17993 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17994 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17995
17996 @kindex maint info symtabs
17997 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17998 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17999 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18000 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18001 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18002 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18003 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18004
18005 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18006 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18007 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18008 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18009 structure in more detail. For example:
18010
18011 @smallexample
18012 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18013 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18014 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18015 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18016 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18017 readin no
18018 fullname (null)
18019 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18020 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18021 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18022 dependencies (none)
18023 @}
18024 @}
18025 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18026 (@value{GDBP})
18027 @end smallexample
18028 @noindent
18029 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18030 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18031 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18032 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18033 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18034
18035 @smallexample
18036 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18037 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18038 line 1574.
18039 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18040 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18041 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18042 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18043 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18044 dirname (null)
18045 fullname (null)
18046 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18047 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18048 debugformat DWARF 2
18049 @}
18050 @}
18051 (@value{GDBP})
18052 @end smallexample
18053
18054 @kindex maint info line-table
18055 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18056 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18057 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18058
18059 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18060 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18061 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18062
18063 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18064 @cindex symbol cache size
18065 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18066 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18067 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18068 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18069 with different sizes.
18070
18071 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18072 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18073 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18074
18075 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18076 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18077 @item maint print symbol-cache
18078 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18079 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18080
18081 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18082 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18083 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18084 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18085 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18086
18087 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18088 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18089 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18090 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18091 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18092 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18093
18094 @end table
18095
18096 @node Altering
18097 @chapter Altering Execution
18098
18099 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18100 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18101 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18102 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18103 program.
18104
18105 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18106 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18107 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18108
18109 @menu
18110 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18111 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18112 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18113 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18114 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18115 * Patching:: Patching your program
18116 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18117 @end menu
18118
18119 @node Assignment
18120 @section Assignment to Variables
18121
18122 @cindex assignment
18123 @cindex setting variables
18124 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18125 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18126
18127 @smallexample
18128 print x=4
18129 @end smallexample
18130
18131 @noindent
18132 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18133 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18134 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18135 information on operators in supported languages.
18136
18137 @kindex set variable
18138 @cindex variables, setting
18139 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18140 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18141 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18142 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18143 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18144
18145 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18146 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18147 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18148 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18149 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18150 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18151 command @code{set width}:
18152
18153 @smallexample
18154 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18155 type = double
18156 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18157 $4 = 13
18158 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18159 Invalid syntax in expression.
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 @noindent
18163 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18164 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18165
18166 @smallexample
18167 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18168 @end smallexample
18169
18170 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18171 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18172 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18173 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18174 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18175 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18176
18177 @smallexample
18178 @group
18179 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18180 type = double
18181 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18182 $1 = 1
18183 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18184 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18185 $2 = 1
18186 (@value{GDBP}) r
18187 The program being debugged has been started already.
18188 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18189 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18190 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18191 Invalid bfd target.
18192 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18193 The current BFD target is "=4".
18194 @end group
18195 @end smallexample
18196
18197 @noindent
18198 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18199 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18200 @code{g}, use
18201
18202 @smallexample
18203 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18204 @end smallexample
18205
18206 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18207 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18208 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18209 same length or shorter.
18210 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18211 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18212
18213 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18214 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18215 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18216 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18217 and representation in memory), and
18218
18219 @smallexample
18220 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18221 @end smallexample
18222
18223 @noindent
18224 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18225
18226 @node Jumping
18227 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18228
18229 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18230 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18231 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18232
18233 @table @code
18234 @kindex jump
18235 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18236 @item jump @var{location}
18237 @itemx j @var{location}
18238 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18239 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18240 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18241 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18242 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18243
18244 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18245 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18246 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18247 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18248 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18249 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18250 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18251 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18252 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18253 @end table
18254
18255 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18256 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18257 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18258 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18259 example,
18260
18261 @smallexample
18262 set $pc = 0x485
18263 @end smallexample
18264
18265 @noindent
18266 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18267 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18268 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18269
18270 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18271 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18272 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18273 detail.
18274
18275 @c @group
18276 @node Signaling
18277 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18278 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18279
18280 @table @code
18281 @kindex signal
18282 @item signal @var{signal}
18283 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18284 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18285 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18286 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18287
18288 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18289 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18290 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18291 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18292 signal.
18293
18294 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18295 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18296 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18297 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18298 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18299 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18300 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18301 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18302
18303 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18304 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18305 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18306 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18307 passes the signal directly to your program.
18308
18309 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18310 after executing the command.
18311
18312 @kindex queue-signal
18313 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18314 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18315 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18316 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18317 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18318 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18319 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18320 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18321 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18322
18323 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18324 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18325 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18326 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18327 @code{continue} command.
18328
18329 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18330 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18331 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18332 (@pxref{Signals}).
18333 @end table
18334 @c @end group
18335
18336 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18337 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18338
18339 @node Returning
18340 @section Returning from a Function
18341
18342 @table @code
18343 @cindex returning from a function
18344 @kindex return
18345 @item return
18346 @itemx return @var{expression}
18347 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18348 command. If you give an
18349 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18350 value.
18351 @end table
18352
18353 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18354 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18355 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18356 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18357
18358 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18359 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18360 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18361 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18362 of functions.
18363
18364 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18365 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18366 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18367 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18368 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18369
18370 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18371 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18372 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18373 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18374 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18375 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18376 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18377 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18378 assignment into the right register(s).
18379
18380 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18381 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18382 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18383 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18384 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18385 into a @code{long long int}:
18386
18387 @smallexample
18388 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18389 29 return 31;
18390 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18391 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18392 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18393 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18394 (@value{GDBP})
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18398 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18399 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18400 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18401 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18402 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18403 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18404 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18405
18406 @smallexample
18407 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18408 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18409 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18410 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18411 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18412 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18413 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18414 (@value{GDBP})
18415 @end smallexample
18416
18417 @node Calling
18418 @section Calling Program Functions
18419
18420 @table @code
18421 @cindex calling functions
18422 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18423 @item print @var{expr}
18424 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18425 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18426 debugged.
18427
18428 @kindex call
18429 @item call @var{expr}
18430 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18431 returned values.
18432
18433 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18434 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18435 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18436 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18437 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18438 value history.
18439 @end table
18440
18441 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18442 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18443 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18444 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18445
18446 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18447 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18448 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18449 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18450 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18451 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18452 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18453 in that case is controlled by the
18454 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18455
18456 @table @code
18457 @item set unwindonsignal
18458 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18459 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18460 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18461 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18462 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18463 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18464 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18465 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18466 received.
18467
18468 @item show unwindonsignal
18469 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18470 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18471 @value{GDBN}.
18472
18473 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18474 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18475 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18476 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18477 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18478 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18479 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18480 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18481 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18482 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18483
18484 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18485 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18486 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18487 @value{GDBN}.
18488
18489 @end table
18490
18491 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18492
18493 @cindex no debug info functions
18494 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18495 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18496 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18497 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18498 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18499 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18500
18501 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18502 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18503 declared return type. For example:
18504
18505 @smallexample
18506 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18507 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18508 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18509 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18510 @end smallexample
18511
18512 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18513 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18514 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18515 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18516
18517 @smallexample
18518 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18519 @end smallexample
18520
18521 @noindent
18522 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18523
18524 @smallexample
18525 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 @noindent
18529 these calls are equivalent:
18530
18531 @smallexample
18532 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18533 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18534 @end smallexample
18535
18536 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18537 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18538 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18539 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18540 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18541 float parameters, and no debug info:
18542
18543 @smallexample
18544 float
18545 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18546 float v1, v2;
18547 @{
18548 return v1 * v2;
18549 @}
18550 @end smallexample
18551
18552 @noindent
18553 you call it like this:
18554
18555 @smallexample
18556 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18557 @end smallexample
18558
18559 @node Patching
18560 @section Patching Programs
18561
18562 @cindex patching binaries
18563 @cindex writing into executables
18564 @cindex writing into corefiles
18565
18566 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18567 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18568 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18569 patching your program's binary.
18570
18571 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18572 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18573 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18574 repairs.
18575
18576 @table @code
18577 @kindex set write
18578 @item set write on
18579 @itemx set write off
18580 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18581 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18582 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18583
18584 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18585 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18586 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18587
18588 @item show write
18589 @kindex show write
18590 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18591 as well as reading.
18592 @end table
18593
18594 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18595 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18596 @cindex injecting code
18597 @cindex writing into executables
18598 @cindex compiling code
18599
18600 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18601 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18602 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18603 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18604
18605 @table @code
18606 @kindex compile code
18607 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18608 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18609 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18610 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18611 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18612 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18613 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18614 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18615 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18616 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18617 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18618 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18619
18620 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18621 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18622 E.g.:
18623
18624 @smallexample
18625 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18626 @end smallexample
18627
18628 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18629 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18630 from actual source code. E.g.:
18631
18632 @smallexample
18633 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18634 @end smallexample
18635
18636 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18637 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18638 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18639 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18640 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18641 editor.
18642
18643 @smallexample
18644 compile code
18645 >printf ("hello\n");
18646 >printf ("world\n");
18647 >end
18648 @end smallexample
18649
18650 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18651 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18652 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18653 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18654 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18655 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18656 inferior symbols otherwise.
18657
18658 @kindex compile file
18659 @item compile file @var{filename}
18660 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18661 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18662
18663 @smallexample
18664 compile file /home/user/example.c
18665 @end smallexample
18666 @end table
18667
18668 @table @code
18669 @item compile print @var{expr}
18670 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18671 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18672 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18673 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18674 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18675 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18676 Formats}.
18677
18678 @item compile print
18679 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18680 @cindex reprint the last value
18681 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18682 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18683 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18684 multiple-line editor.
18685 @end table
18686
18687 @noindent
18688 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18689
18690 @table @code
18691 @anchor{set debug compile}
18692 @item set debug compile
18693 @cindex compile command debugging info
18694 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18695 injecting the code. The default is off.
18696
18697 @item show debug compile
18698 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18699 compiling and injecting the code.
18700
18701 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
18702 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
18703 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
18704 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
18705 The default is off.
18706
18707 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
18708 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
18709 C@t{++} type conversion.
18710 @end table
18711
18712 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18713
18714 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18715 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18716 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18717 injecting process.
18718
18719 @noindent
18720 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18721
18722 @table @asis
18723 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18724 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18725 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18726 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18727
18728 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18729 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18730 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18731 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18732 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18733 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18734 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18735 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18736
18737 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18738 @end table
18739
18740 @noindent
18741 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18742
18743 @table @code
18744 @item set compile-args
18745 @cindex compile command options override
18746 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18747 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18748 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18749 compilation.
18750
18751 @item show compile-args
18752 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18753 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18754 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18755 @end table
18756
18757 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18758
18759 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18760 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18761 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18762
18763 @table @asis
18764 @item C code examples and caveats
18765 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18766 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18767 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18768 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18769 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18770
18771 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18772 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18773 much like any other normal debugging session.
18774
18775 @smallexample
18776 void function1 (void)
18777 @{
18778 int i = 42;
18779 printf ("function 1\n");
18780 @}
18781
18782 void function2 (void)
18783 @{
18784 int j = 12;
18785 function1 ();
18786 @}
18787
18788 int main(void)
18789 @{
18790 int k = 6;
18791 int *p;
18792 function2 ();
18793 return 0;
18794 @}
18795 @end smallexample
18796
18797 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18798 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18799 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18800
18801 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18802 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18803 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18804 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18805 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18806
18807 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18808 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18809 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18810 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18811 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18812 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18813 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18814 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18815 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18816 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18817
18818 @smallexample
18819 compile code k = 3;
18820 @end smallexample
18821
18822 @noindent
18823 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18824 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18825 @code{compile} command changes it.
18826
18827 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18828 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18829 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18830 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18831 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18832
18833 @smallexample
18834 compile code j = 3;
18835 @end smallexample
18836
18837 @noindent
18838 will result in a compilation error message.
18839
18840 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18841 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18842 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18843
18844 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18845 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18846 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18847 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18854 command has completed:
18855
18856 @smallexample
18857 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18858 @end smallexample
18859
18860 @noindent
18861 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18862 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18863 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18864 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18865 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18866
18867 @smallexample
18868 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18869 @end smallexample
18870
18871 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18872 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18873 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18874 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18875 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18876 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18877 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18878 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18879
18880 @smallexample
18881 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18882 @end smallexample
18883
18884 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18885 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18886 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18887 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18888 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18889 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18890 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18891
18892 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18893 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18894 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18895 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18896 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18897 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18898
18899 @smallexample
18900 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18901 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18902 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18903 Compilation failed.
18904 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18905 42
18906 @end smallexample
18907
18908 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18909 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18910 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18911 will print to the console.
18912 @end table
18913
18914 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18915
18916 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18917 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18918 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18919 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18920 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18921 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18922 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18923 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18924
18925
18926 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18927 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18928 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18929 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18930 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18931 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18932 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18933
18934 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18935 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18936 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18937 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18938 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18939 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18940 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18941
18942 @table @code
18943 @item set compile-gcc
18944 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18945 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18946 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18947 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18948 default.
18949
18950 @item show compile-gcc
18951 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18952 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18953 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18954 @end table
18955
18956 @node GDB Files
18957 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18958
18959 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18960 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18961 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18962 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18963
18964 @menu
18965 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18966 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18967 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18968 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18969 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18970 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18971 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18972 @end menu
18973
18974 @node Files
18975 @section Commands to Specify Files
18976
18977 @cindex symbol table
18978 @cindex core dump file
18979
18980 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18981 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18982 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18983 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18984
18985 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18986 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18987 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18988 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18989 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18990 new files are useful.
18991
18992 @table @code
18993 @cindex executable file
18994 @kindex file
18995 @item file @var{filename}
18996 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18997 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18998 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18999 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19000 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19001 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19002 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19003 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19004
19005 @cindex unlinked object files
19006 @cindex patching object files
19007 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19008 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19009 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19010 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19011 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19012 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19013 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19014 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19015
19016 @item file
19017 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19018 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19019
19020 @kindex exec-file
19021 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19022 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19023 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19024 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19025 discard information on the executable file.
19026
19027 @kindex symbol-file
19028 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19029 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19030 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19031 table and program to run from the same file.
19032
19033 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19034 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19035 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19036 enabled.
19037
19038 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19039 program's symbol table.
19040
19041 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19042 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19043 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19044 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19045 @value{GDBN}.
19046
19047 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19048 executing it once.
19049
19050 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19051 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19052 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19053 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19054 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19055 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19056 optimized code.
19057
19058 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19059 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19060 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19061 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19062 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19063
19064 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19065 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19066 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19067 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19068 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19069 Warnings and Messages}.)
19070
19071 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19072 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19073 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19074 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19075 in stabs format.
19076
19077 @kindex readnow
19078 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19079 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19080 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19081 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19082 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19083 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19084 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19085 entire symbol table available.
19086
19087 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19088 @cindex never read symbols
19089 @cindex symbols, never read
19090 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19091 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19092 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19093 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19094 @xref{--readnever}.
19095
19096 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19097 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19098 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19099 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19100 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19101 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19102 @c files.
19103
19104 @kindex core-file
19105 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19106 @itemx core
19107 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19108 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19109 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19110 executable file itself for other parts.
19111
19112 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19113 to be used.
19114
19115 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19116 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19117 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19118 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19119 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19120
19121 @kindex add-symbol-file
19122 @cindex dynamic linking
19123 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19124 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19125 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19126 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19127 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19128 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19129 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19130 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19131 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19132 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19133 can be given as an expression.
19134
19135 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19136 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19137 specified explicitly.
19138
19139 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19140 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19141 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19142 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19143
19144 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19145
19146 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19147 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19148 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19149 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19150 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19151 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19152 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19153 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19154 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19155
19156 @itemize @bullet
19157 @item
19158 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19159 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19160 @item
19161 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19162 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19163 @item
19164 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19165 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19166 @end itemize
19167
19168 @noindent
19169 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19170 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19171 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19172 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19173 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19174 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19175 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19176 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19177 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19178 way.
19179
19180 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19181
19182 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19183 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19184 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19185 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19186 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19187 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19188
19189 @smallexample
19190 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19191 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19192 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19193 (y or n) y
19194 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19195 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19196 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19197 (gdb)
19198 @end smallexample
19199
19200
19201 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19202
19203 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19204 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19205 @cindex load symbols from memory
19206 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19207 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19208 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19209 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19210 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19211 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19212 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19213 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19214 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19215
19216 @kindex section
19217 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19218 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19219 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19220 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19221 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19222 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19223 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19224 their addresses.
19225
19226 @kindex info files
19227 @kindex info target
19228 @item info files
19229 @itemx info target
19230 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19231 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19232 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19233 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19234 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19235 current ones.
19236
19237 @kindex maint info sections
19238 @item maint info sections
19239 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19240 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19241 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19242 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19243 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19244 may be arbitrarily combined):
19245
19246 @table @code
19247 @item ALLOBJ
19248 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19249 @item @var{sections}
19250 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19251 @item @var{section-flags}
19252 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19253 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19254 @table @code
19255 @item ALLOC
19256 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19257 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19258 @item LOAD
19259 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19260 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19261 @item RELOC
19262 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19263 @item READONLY
19264 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19265 @item CODE
19266 Section contains executable code only.
19267 @item DATA
19268 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19269 @item ROM
19270 Section will reside in ROM.
19271 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19272 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19273 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19274 Section is not empty.
19275 @item NEVER_LOAD
19276 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19277 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19278 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19279 COFF shared library information.
19280 @item IS_COMMON
19281 Section contains common symbols.
19282 @end table
19283 @end table
19284 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19285 @cindex read-only sections
19286 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19287 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19288 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19289 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19290 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19291 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19292 enhancement to debugging performance.
19293
19294 The default is off.
19295
19296 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19297 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19298 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19299 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19300
19301 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19302 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19303 @end table
19304
19305 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19306 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19307 name and remembers it that way.
19308
19309 @cindex shared libraries
19310 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19311 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19312 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19313 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19314
19315 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19316 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19317
19318 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19319 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19320 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19321 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19322 debugging a core file).
19323
19324 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19325 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19326 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19327
19328 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19329 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19330 particularly large or there are many of them.
19331
19332 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19333 commands:
19334
19335 @table @code
19336 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19337 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19338 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19339 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19340 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19341 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19342 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19343 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19344
19345 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19346 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19347 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19348 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19349 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19350 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19351 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19352 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19353 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19354
19355 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19356 @item show auto-solib-add
19357 Display the current autoloading mode.
19358 @end table
19359
19360 @cindex load shared library
19361 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19362 command:
19363
19364 @table @code
19365 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19366 @kindex info share
19367 @item info share @var{regex}
19368 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19369 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19370 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19371 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19372
19373 @kindex info dll
19374 @item info dll @var{regex}
19375 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19376
19377 @kindex sharedlibrary
19378 @kindex share
19379 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19380 @itemx share @var{regex}
19381 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19382 Unix regular expression.
19383 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19384 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19385 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19386 loaded.
19387
19388 @item nosharedlibrary
19389 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19390 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19391 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19392 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19393 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19394 discarded.
19395 @end table
19396
19397 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19398 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19399 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19400 Catchpoints}).
19401
19402 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19403 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19404 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19405 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19406
19407 @table @code
19408 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19409 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19410 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19411 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19412 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19413 shared library.
19414
19415 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19416 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19417 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19418 library events happen.
19419 @end table
19420
19421 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19422 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19423 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19424 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19425 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19426 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19427 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19428 not.
19429
19430 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19431 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19432 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19433 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19434 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19435
19436 @table @code
19437 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19438 @cindex system root, alternate
19439 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19440 @kindex set sysroot
19441 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19442 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19443 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19444 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19445 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19446 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19447 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19448 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19449 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19450 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19451 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19452 @var{path}.
19453
19454 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19455 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19456 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19457 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19458 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19459 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19460 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19461 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19462 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19463 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19464 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19465 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19466 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19467 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19468
19469 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19470 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19471 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19472 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19473 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19474
19475 @smallexample
19476 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19477 @end smallexample
19478
19479 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19480 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19481 system:
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19485 @end smallexample
19486
19487 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19488 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19489 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19490 colons:
19491
19492 @smallexample
19493 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19494 @end smallexample
19495
19496 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19497 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19498 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19499 @samp{z}):
19500
19501 @smallexample
19502 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19503 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19504 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19505 @end smallexample
19506
19507 @noindent
19508 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19509 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19510 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19511
19512 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19513 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19514
19515 @smallexample
19516 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19517 @end smallexample
19518
19519 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19520 if you don't want or need to.
19521
19522 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19523 sysroot}.
19524
19525 @cindex default system root
19526 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19527 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19528 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19529 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19530 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19531 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19532 location.
19533
19534 @kindex show sysroot
19535 @item show sysroot
19536 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19537
19538 @kindex set solib-search-path
19539 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19540 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19541 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19542 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19543 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19544 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19545 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19546 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19547 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19548 of shared library symbols.
19549
19550 @kindex show solib-search-path
19551 @item show solib-search-path
19552 Display the current shared library search path.
19553
19554 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19555 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19556 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19557 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19558 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19559
19560 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19561 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19562 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19563 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19564 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19565 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19566 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19567 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19568 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19569 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19570 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19571 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19572 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19573 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19574 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19575 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19576 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19577 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19578 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19579 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19580 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19581 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19582
19583 @table @code
19584 @item unix
19585 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19586 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19587 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19588 the forward slash.
19589
19590 @item dos-based
19591 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19592 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19593 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19594 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19595 considered directory separators.
19596
19597 @item auto
19598 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19599 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19600 This is the default.
19601 @end table
19602 @end table
19603
19604 @cindex file name canonicalization
19605 @cindex base name differences
19606 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19607 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19608 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19609 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19610 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19611 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19612 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19613 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19614 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19615 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19616 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19617 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19618 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19619 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19620 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19621
19622 @table @code
19623 @item set basenames-may-differ
19624 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19625 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19626
19627 @item show basenames-may-differ
19628 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19629 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19630 @end table
19631
19632 @node File Caching
19633 @section File Caching
19634 @cindex caching of opened files
19635 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19636
19637 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19638 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19639 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19640 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19641
19642 @table @code
19643 @kindex maint info bfds
19644 @item maint info bfds
19645 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19646 @value{GDBN}.
19647
19648 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19649 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19650 @kindex bfd caching
19651 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19652 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19653 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19654 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19655 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19656 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19657 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19658 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19659 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19660
19661 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19662 @kindex bfd caching
19663 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19664 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19665
19666 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19667 @kindex bfd caching
19668 @item show debug bfd-cache
19669 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19670 @end table
19671
19672 @node Separate Debug Files
19673 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19674 @cindex separate debugging information files
19675 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19676 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19677 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19678 @cindex global debugging information directories
19679 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19680 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19681
19682 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19683 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19684 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19685 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19686 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19687 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19688 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19689
19690 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19691 file:
19692
19693 @itemize @bullet
19694 @item
19695 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19696 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19697 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19698 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19699 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19700 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19701 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19702 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19703
19704 @item
19705 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19706 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19707 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19708 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19709 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19710 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
19711 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19712 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19713 below.
19714 @end itemize
19715
19716 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19717 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19718
19719 @itemize @bullet
19720 @item
19721 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19722 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19723 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19724 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19725 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19726
19727 @item
19728 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19729 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19730 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19731 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19732 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19733 hex characters, not 10.)
19734 @end itemize
19735
19736 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19737 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19738 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19739 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19740 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19741 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19742
19743 @itemize @minus
19744 @item
19745 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19746 @item
19747 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19748 @item
19749 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19750 @item
19751 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19752 @end itemize
19753
19754 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19755 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19756 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19757 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19758 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19759
19760 @table @code
19761
19762 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19763 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19764 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19765 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19766 concatenating them by a path separator.
19767
19768 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19769 @item show debug-file-directory
19770 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19771 information files.
19772
19773 @end table
19774
19775 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19776 @cindex debug link sections
19777 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19778 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19779
19780 @itemize
19781 @item
19782 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19783 a zero byte,
19784 @item
19785 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19786 boundary within the section, and
19787 @item
19788 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19789 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19790 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19791 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19792 @end itemize
19793
19794 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19795 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19796 described above.
19797
19798 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19799 @cindex build ID sections
19800 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19801 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19802 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19803 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19804 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19805 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19806 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19807 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19808 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19809
19810 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19811 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19812 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19813 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19814 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19815 in an ordinary executable.
19816
19817 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19818 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19819 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19820 following commands:
19821
19822 @smallexample
19823 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19824 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19825 @end smallexample
19826
19827 @noindent
19828 These commands remove the debugging
19829 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19830 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19831 two files:
19832
19833 @itemize @bullet
19834 @item
19835 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19836 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19837
19838 @smallexample
19839 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19840 @end smallexample
19841
19842 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19843 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19844 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19845 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19846
19847 @item
19848 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19849 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19850 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19851 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19852 @end itemize
19853
19854 @noindent
19855
19856 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19857 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19858 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19859
19860 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19861 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19862 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19863 @c different ways!
19864 @ifhtml
19865 @display
19866 @html
19867 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19868 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19869 @end html
19870 @end display
19871 @end ifhtml
19872 @ifnothtml
19873 @display
19874 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19875 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19876 @end display
19877 @end ifnothtml
19878
19879 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19880 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19881 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19882 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19883 CRC.
19884
19885 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19886 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19887 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19888 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19889 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19890
19891 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19892 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19893 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19894 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19895 @code{0xffffffff}.
19896
19897 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19898 @smallexample
19899 unsigned long
19900 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19901 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19902 @{
19903 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19904 @{
19905 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19906 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19907 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19908 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19909 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19910 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19911 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19912 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19913 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19914 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19915 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19916 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19917 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19918 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19919 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19920 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19921 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19922 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19923 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19924 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19925 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19926 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19927 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19928 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19929 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19930 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19931 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19932 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19933 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19934 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19935 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19936 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19937 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19938 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19939 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19940 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19941 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19942 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19943 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19944 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19945 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19946 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19947 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19948 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19949 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19950 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19951 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19952 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19953 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19954 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19955 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19956 0x2d02ef8d
19957 @};
19958 unsigned char *end;
19959
19960 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19961 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19962 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19963 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19964 @}
19965 @end smallexample
19966
19967 @noindent
19968 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19969
19970 @node MiniDebugInfo
19971 @section Debugging information in a special section
19972 @cindex separate debug sections
19973 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19974
19975 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19976 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19977 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19978 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19979
19980 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19981 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19982 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19983 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19984 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19985 debugging information might be included in the section.
19986
19987 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19988 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19989 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19990
19991 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19992 standard utilities:
19993
19994 @smallexample
19995 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19996 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19997 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19998 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19999
20000 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20001 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20002 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20003 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20004 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20005 | sort > funcsyms
20006
20007 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20008 # table.
20009 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20010
20011 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20012 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20013
20014 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20015 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20016 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20017 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20018
20019 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20020 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20021
20022 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20023 # original binary.
20024 xz mini_debuginfo
20025 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20026 @end smallexample
20027
20028 @node Index Files
20029 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20030 @cindex index files
20031 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20032
20033 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20034 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20035 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20036 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20037 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20038 startup.
20039
20040 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20041 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20042 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20043
20044 @smallexample
20045 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20046 @end smallexample
20047
20048 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20049
20050 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20051 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20052
20053 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20054 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20055 using @command{objcopy}.
20056
20057 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20058
20059 @table @code
20060 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20061 @kindex save gdb-index
20062 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20063 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20064 default creates it produces a single file
20065 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20066 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20067 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20068 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20069 given @var{directory}.
20070 @end table
20071
20072 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20073 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20074
20075 @smallexample
20076 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20077 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20078 @end smallexample
20079
20080 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20081
20082 @smallexample
20083 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20084 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20085 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20086 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20087 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20088 @end smallexample
20089
20090 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20091 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20092 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20093 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20094 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20095 The default is @code{off}.
20096 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20097 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20098
20099 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20100 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20101
20102 @smallexample
20103 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20104 @end smallexample
20105
20106 Instead you must do, for example,
20107
20108 @smallexample
20109 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20110 @end smallexample
20111
20112 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20113 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20114 currently work for programs using Ada.
20115
20116 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
20117
20118 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
20119 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
20120 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
20121 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
20122
20123 @table @code
20124
20125 @item set index-cache on
20126 @itemx set index-cache off
20127 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
20128
20129 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
20130 @itemx show index-cache directory
20131 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
20132
20133 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
20134 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
20135 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
20136 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
20137 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
20138 differ according to local convention.
20139
20140 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
20141 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
20142
20143 @item show index-cache stats
20144 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
20145
20146 @end table
20147
20148 @node Symbol Errors
20149 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20150
20151 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20152 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20153 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20154 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20155 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20156 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20157 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20158 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20159 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20160 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20161 Messages}).
20162
20163 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20164
20165 @table @code
20166 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20167
20168 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20169 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20170 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20171 in its outer scope blocks.
20172
20173 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20174 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20175 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20176 function.
20177
20178 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20179
20180 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20181 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20182 do so.
20183
20184 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20185 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20186 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20187 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20188 Messages}.)
20189
20190 @item bad block start address patched
20191
20192 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20193 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20194 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20195
20196 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20197 starting on the previous source line.
20198
20199 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20200
20201 @cindex foo
20202 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20203 larger than the size of the string table.
20204
20205 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20206 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20207 with this name.
20208
20209 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20210
20211 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20212 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20213 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20214
20215 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20216 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20217 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20218 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20219 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20220 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20221
20222 @item stub type has NULL name
20223
20224 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20225
20226 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20227 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20228 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20229 it.
20230
20231 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20232
20233 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20234
20235 @end table
20236
20237 @node Data Files
20238 @section GDB Data Files
20239
20240 @cindex prefix for data files
20241 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20242 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20243
20244 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20245 is currently using.
20246
20247 @table @code
20248 @kindex set data-directory
20249 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20250 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20251 to @var{directory}.
20252
20253 @kindex show data-directory
20254 @item show data-directory
20255 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20256 @end table
20257
20258 @cindex default data directory
20259 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20260 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20261 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20262 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20263 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20264 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20265 location.
20266
20267 The data directory may also be specified with the
20268 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20269 @xref{Mode Options}.
20270
20271 @node Targets
20272 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20273
20274 @cindex debugging target
20275 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20276
20277 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20278 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20279 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20280 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20281 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20282 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20283 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20284 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20285
20286 @cindex target architecture
20287 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20288 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20289 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20290 command.
20291
20292 @table @code
20293 @kindex set architecture
20294 @kindex show architecture
20295 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20296 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20297 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20298 supported architectures.
20299
20300 @item show architecture
20301 Show the current target architecture.
20302
20303 @item set processor
20304 @itemx processor
20305 @kindex set processor
20306 @kindex show processor
20307 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20308 and @code{show architecture}.
20309 @end table
20310
20311 @menu
20312 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20313 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20314 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20315 @end menu
20316
20317 @node Active Targets
20318 @section Active Targets
20319
20320 @cindex stacking targets
20321 @cindex active targets
20322 @cindex multiple targets
20323
20324 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20325 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20326 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20327 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20328 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20329 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20330 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20331 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20332 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20333
20334 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20335 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20336 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20337 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20338
20339 @node Target Commands
20340 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20341
20342 @table @code
20343 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20344 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20345 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20346 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20347 protocol of the target machine.
20348
20349 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20350 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20351 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20352
20353 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20354 after executing the command.
20355
20356 @kindex help target
20357 @item help target
20358 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20359 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20360 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20361
20362 @item help target @var{name}
20363 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20364 select it.
20365
20366 @kindex set gnutarget
20367 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20368 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20369 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20370 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20371 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20372 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20373
20374 @quotation
20375 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20376 you must know the actual BFD name.
20377 @end quotation
20378
20379 @noindent
20380 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20381
20382 @kindex show gnutarget
20383 @item show gnutarget
20384 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20385 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20386 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20387 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20388 @end table
20389
20390 @cindex common targets
20391 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20392 configuration):
20393
20394 @table @code
20395 @kindex target
20396 @item target exec @var{program}
20397 @cindex executable file target
20398 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20399 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20400
20401 @item target core @var{filename}
20402 @cindex core dump file target
20403 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20404 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20405
20406 @item target remote @var{medium}
20407 @cindex remote target
20408 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20409 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20410 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20411
20412 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20413 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20414
20415 @smallexample
20416 target remote /dev/ttya
20417 @end smallexample
20418
20419 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20420 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20421 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20422 clobbered by the download.
20423
20424 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20425 @cindex built-in simulator target
20426 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20427 In general,
20428 @smallexample
20429 target sim
20430 load
20431 run
20432 @end smallexample
20433 @noindent
20434 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20435 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20436 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20437 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20438 Processors}.
20439
20440 @item target native
20441 @cindex native target
20442 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20443 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20444 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20445 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20446
20447 @end table
20448
20449 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20450 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20451
20452 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20453 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20454 various aspects of this process.
20455
20456 @table @code
20457
20458 @item set hash
20459 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20460 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20461 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20462 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20463 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20464 monitor.
20465
20466 @item show hash
20467 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20468 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20469
20470 @item set debug monitor
20471 @kindex set debug monitor
20472 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20473 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20474 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20475
20476 @item show debug monitor
20477 @kindex show debug monitor
20478 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20479 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20480 @end table
20481
20482 @table @code
20483
20484 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20485 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20486 @anchor{load}
20487 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20488 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20489 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20490 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20491 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20492 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20493
20494 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20495 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20496 target is @dots{}}''
20497
20498 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20499 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20500 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20501 specifies a fixed address.
20502 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20503
20504 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20505 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20506 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20507
20508 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20509 load programs into flash memory.
20510
20511 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20512 @end table
20513
20514 @table @code
20515
20516 @kindex flash-erase
20517 @item flash-erase
20518 @anchor{flash-erase}
20519
20520 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20521
20522 @end table
20523
20524 @node Byte Order
20525 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20526
20527 @cindex choosing target byte order
20528 @cindex target byte order
20529
20530 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20531 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20532 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20533 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20534 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20535 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20536
20537 @table @code
20538 @kindex set endian
20539 @item set endian big
20540 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20541
20542 @item set endian little
20543 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20544
20545 @item set endian auto
20546 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20547 executable.
20548
20549 @item show endian
20550 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20551
20552 @end table
20553
20554 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20555 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20556 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20557 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20558 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20559 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20560 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20561 and @code{big} otherwise.
20562
20563 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20564 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20565 target system.
20566
20567
20568 @node Remote Debugging
20569 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20570 @cindex remote debugging
20571
20572 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20573 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20574 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20575 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20576 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20577
20578 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20579 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20580 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20581 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20582 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20583 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20584
20585 Other remote targets may be available in your
20586 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20587
20588 @menu
20589 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20590 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20591 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20592 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20593 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20594 @end menu
20595
20596 @node Connecting
20597 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20598 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20599 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20600 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20601 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20602 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20603 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20604
20605 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20606 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20607 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20608 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20609
20610 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20611
20612 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20613 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20614 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20615 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20616
20617 @table @asis
20618
20619 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20620 @item Result of detach or program exit
20621 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20622 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20623 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20624
20625 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20626 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20627 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20628 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20629
20630 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20631 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20632 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20633 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20634
20635 @item Specifying the program to debug
20636 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20637 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20638 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20639 target.
20640
20641 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20642 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20643 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20644
20645 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20646 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20647 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20648 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20649
20650 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20651 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20652 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20653 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20654 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20655 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20656 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20657 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20658 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20659
20660 @item The @code{run} command
20661 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20662 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20663 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20664 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20665 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20666
20667 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20668 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20669 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20670 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20671 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20672
20673 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20674 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20675 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20676 @code{target remote} mode.
20677
20678 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20679 @item Attaching
20680 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20681 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20682 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20683
20684 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20685 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20686 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20687 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20688 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20689
20690 @end table
20691
20692 @anchor{Host and target files}
20693 @subsection Host and Target Files
20694 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20695 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20696
20697 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20698 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20699 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20700 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20701 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20702
20703 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20704 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20705 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20706 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20707 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20708
20709 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20710 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20711 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20712 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20713 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20714 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20715 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20716 target libraries.
20717
20718 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20719 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20720 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20721 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20722 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20723 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20724 programs.
20725
20726 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20727 @cindex remote connection commands
20728 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20729 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20730 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20731 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20732 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20733 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20734 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20735
20736 @table @code
20737
20738 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20739 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20740 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20741 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20742 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20743
20744 @smallexample
20745 target remote /dev/ttyb
20746 @end smallexample
20747
20748 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20749 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20750 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20751 @code{target} command.
20752
20753 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20754 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20755 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20756 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20757 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20758 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20759 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20760 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20761 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20762 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20763 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20764 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20765 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20766 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20767 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20768 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20769 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20770 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20771 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20772 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20773 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20774 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20775
20776 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20777 @code{manyfarms}:
20778
20779 @smallexample
20780 target remote manyfarms:2828
20781 @end smallexample
20782
20783 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20784 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20785 square bracket syntax:
20786
20787 @smallexample
20788 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20789 @end smallexample
20790
20791 @noindent
20792 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20793
20794 @smallexample
20795 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20796 @end smallexample
20797
20798 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20799 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20800 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20801 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20802 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20803 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20804
20805 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20806 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20807 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20808 port 1234 on your local machine:
20809
20810 @smallexample
20811 target remote :1234
20812 @end smallexample
20813 @noindent
20814
20815 Note that the colon is still required here.
20816
20817 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20818 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20819 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20820 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20821 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20822 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20823 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20824 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20825 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20826 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20827 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20828 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20829 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20830
20831 @smallexample
20832 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20833 @end smallexample
20834
20835 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20836 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20837 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20838 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20839
20840 @item target remote | @var{command}
20841 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20842 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20843 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20844 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20845 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20846 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20847 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20848 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20849 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20850
20851 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20852 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20853 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20854
20855 @end table
20856
20857 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20858 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20859 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20860 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20861 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20862 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20863 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20864
20865 @smallexample
20866 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20867 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20868 @end smallexample
20869
20870 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20871 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20872 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20873 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20874
20875 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20876 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20877
20878 @table @code
20879 @kindex detach (remote)
20880 @item detach
20881 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20882 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20883 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20884 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20885 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20886 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20887 still connected to the target.
20888
20889 @kindex disconnect
20890 @item disconnect
20891 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20892 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20893 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20894 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20895 another target.
20896
20897 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20898 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20899 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20900 @kindex monitor
20901 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20902 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20903 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20904 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20905 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20906 and implement.
20907 @end table
20908
20909 @node File Transfer
20910 @section Sending files to a remote system
20911 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20912 @cindex file transfer
20913 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20914
20915 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20916 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20917 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20918 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20919 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20920 the only way to upload or download files.
20921
20922 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20923
20924 @table @code
20925 @kindex remote put
20926 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20927 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20928 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20929
20930 @kindex remote get
20931 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20932 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20933 on the host system.
20934
20935 @kindex remote delete
20936 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20937 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20938
20939 @end table
20940
20941 @node Server
20942 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20943
20944 @kindex gdbserver
20945 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20946 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20947 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20948 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20949 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20950
20951 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20952 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20953 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20954 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20955 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20956 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20957 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20958 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20959 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20960 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20961 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20962 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20963 choice for debugging.
20964
20965 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20966 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20967 protocol.
20968
20969 @quotation
20970 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20971 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20972 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20973 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20974 @code{gdbserver}.
20975 @end quotation
20976
20977 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20978 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20979 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20980 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20981
20982 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20983 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20984 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20985 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20986 system does all the symbol handling.
20987
20988 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20989 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20990 syntax is:
20991
20992 @smallexample
20993 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20994 @end smallexample
20995
20996 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20997 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20998 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20999 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21000 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21001 @file{/dev/com1}:
21002
21003 @smallexample
21004 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21005 @end smallexample
21006
21007 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21008 with it.
21009
21010 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21011
21012 @smallexample
21013 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21014 @end smallexample
21015
21016 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21017 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21018 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21019 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21020 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21021 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21022 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21023 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21024 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21025 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21026 @code{target remote} command.
21027
21028 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21029 with ssh:
21030
21031 @smallexample
21032 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21033 @end smallexample
21034
21035 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21036 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21037 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21038 You could elide it if you want to.
21039
21040 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21041 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21042 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21043 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21044
21045 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21046 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21047 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21048 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21049
21050 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21051 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21052
21053 @smallexample
21054 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21055 @end smallexample
21056
21057 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21058 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21059
21060 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21061 @value{GDBN} attach command
21062 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21063
21064 @pindex pidof
21065 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21066 @code{pidof} utility:
21067
21068 @smallexample
21069 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21070 @end smallexample
21071
21072 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21073 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21074 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21075
21076 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21077
21078 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21079 port.
21080
21081 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21082 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21083 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21084 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21085 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21086 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21087 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21088 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21089
21090 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21091 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21092 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21093
21094 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21095 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21096 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21097 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21098 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21099 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21100 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21101 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21102 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21103 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21104 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21105 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21106
21107 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21108 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21109
21110 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21111 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21112 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21113 program. For more information,
21114 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21115
21116 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21117 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21118 status information about the debugging process.
21119 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21120 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21121 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21122 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21123
21124 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21125 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21126 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21127 Possible options are:
21128
21129 @table @code
21130 @item none
21131 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21132 @item all
21133 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21134 @item timestamps
21135 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21136 @end table
21137
21138 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21139 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21140
21141 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21142 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21143 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21144 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21145 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21146
21147 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21148 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21149 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21150 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21151
21152 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21153 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21154 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21155 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21156
21157 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21158 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21159 environment:
21160
21161 @smallexample
21162 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21163 @end smallexample
21164
21165 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21166 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21167
21168 @smallexample
21169 $ gdbserver --selftest
21170 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21171 @end smallexample
21172
21173 These tests are disabled in release.
21174 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21175
21176 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21177 @itemize
21178
21179 @item
21180 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21181
21182 @item
21183 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21184 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21185 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21186 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21187 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21188 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21189
21190 @item
21191 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21192 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21193 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21194 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21195 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21196 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21197 program is already on the target.
21198
21199 @end itemize
21200
21201 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21202 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21203 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21204
21205 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21206 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21207 Here are the available commands.
21208
21209 @table @code
21210 @item monitor help
21211 List the available monitor commands.
21212
21213 @item monitor set debug 0
21214 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21215 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21216
21217 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21218 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21219 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21220 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21221
21222 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21223 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21224 Possible options are:
21225
21226 @table @code
21227 @item none
21228 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21229 @item all
21230 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21231 @item timestamps
21232 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21233 @end table
21234
21235 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21236 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21237
21238 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21239 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21240 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21241 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21242 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21243 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21244
21245 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21246 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21247
21248 @item monitor exit
21249 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21250 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21251 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21252 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21253 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21254
21255 @end table
21256
21257 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21258 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21259
21260 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21261 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21262
21263 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21264 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21265 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21266 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21267 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21268 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21269 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21270 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21271 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21272 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21273 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21274 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21275
21276 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21277
21278 @table @code
21279 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21280
21281 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21282 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21283 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21284
21285 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21286
21287 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21288 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21289 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21290 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21291 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21292 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21293
21294 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21295
21296 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21297 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21298 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21299 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21300 command for that. For example:
21301
21302 @smallexample
21303 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21304 @end smallexample
21305
21306 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21307 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21308 @end table
21309
21310 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21311 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21312 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21313 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21314 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21315 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21316 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21317 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21318 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21319 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21320
21321 @smallexample
21322 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21323 @end smallexample
21324
21325 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21326
21327 @smallexample
21328 $ gdb myprogram
21329 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21330 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21331 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21332 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21333 @end smallexample
21334
21335 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21336 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21337 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21338 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21339 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21340 tracing.
21341
21342 @node Remote Configuration
21343 @section Remote Configuration
21344
21345 @kindex set remote
21346 @kindex show remote
21347 This section documents the configuration options available when
21348 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21349 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21350 system-call-allowed}.
21351
21352 @table @code
21353 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21354 @cindex address size for remote targets
21355 @cindex bits in remote address
21356 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21357 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21358 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21359 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21360
21361 @item show remoteaddresssize
21362 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21363
21364 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21365 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21366 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21367 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21368 remote targets.
21369
21370 @item show serial baud
21371 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21372
21373 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21374 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21375 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21376
21377 @item show serial parity
21378 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21379
21380 @item set remotebreak
21381 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21382 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21383 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21384 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21385 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21386 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21387 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21388 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21389
21390 @item show remotebreak
21391 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21392 interrupt the remote program.
21393
21394 @item set remoteflow on
21395 @itemx set remoteflow off
21396 @kindex set remoteflow
21397 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21398 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21399
21400 @item show remoteflow
21401 @kindex show remoteflow
21402 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21403
21404 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21405 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21406 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21407 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21408 @code{ascii}.
21409
21410 @item show remotelogbase
21411 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21412 protocol.
21413
21414 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21415 @cindex record serial communications on file
21416 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21417 default is not to record at all.
21418
21419 @item show remotelogfile.
21420 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21421 serial communications.
21422
21423 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21424 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21425 @cindex remote timeout
21426 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21427 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21428
21429 @item show remotetimeout
21430 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21431 responses.
21432
21433 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21434 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21435 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21436 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21437 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21438 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21439 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21440 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21441 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21442 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21443
21444 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21445 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21446 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21447 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21448
21449 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21450 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21451 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21452 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21453 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21454 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21455 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21456 length.
21457
21458 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21459 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21460 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21461
21462 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21463 @itemx show remote exec-file
21464 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21465 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21466 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21467 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21468 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21469 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21470
21471 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21472 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21473 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21474 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21475 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21476 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21477 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21478 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21479 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21480 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21481
21482 @item show interrupt-sequence
21483 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21484 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21485 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21486 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21487
21488 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21489 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21490 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21491 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21492 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21493 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21494
21495 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21496 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21497 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21498
21499 @kindex set tcp
21500 @kindex show tcp
21501 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21502 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21503 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21504 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21505 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21506 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21507 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21508 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21509 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21510
21511 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21512 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21513
21514 @item show tcp auto-retry
21515 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21516
21517 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21518 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21519 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21520 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21521 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21522 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21523 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21524 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21525 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21526 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21527 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21528
21529 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21530 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21531 @end table
21532
21533 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21534 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21535 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21536 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21537 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21538 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21539 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21540 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21541 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21542
21543 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21544 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21545 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21546 @value{GDBN} developers.
21547
21548 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21549 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21550 are:
21551
21552 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21553 @item Command Name
21554 @tab Remote Packet
21555 @tab Related Features
21556
21557 @item @code{fetch-register}
21558 @tab @code{p}
21559 @tab @code{info registers}
21560
21561 @item @code{set-register}
21562 @tab @code{P}
21563 @tab @code{set}
21564
21565 @item @code{binary-download}
21566 @tab @code{X}
21567 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21568
21569 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21570 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21571 @tab @code{info auxv}
21572
21573 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21574 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21575 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21576
21577 @item @code{attach}
21578 @tab @code{vAttach}
21579 @tab @code{attach}
21580
21581 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21582 @tab @code{vCont}
21583 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21584
21585 @item @code{run}
21586 @tab @code{vRun}
21587 @tab @code{run}
21588
21589 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21590 @tab @code{Z0}
21591 @tab @code{break}
21592
21593 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21594 @tab @code{Z1}
21595 @tab @code{hbreak}
21596
21597 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21598 @tab @code{Z2}
21599 @tab @code{watch}
21600
21601 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21602 @tab @code{Z3}
21603 @tab @code{rwatch}
21604
21605 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21606 @tab @code{Z4}
21607 @tab @code{awatch}
21608
21609 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21610 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21611 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21612
21613 @item @code{target-features}
21614 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21615 @tab @code{set architecture}
21616
21617 @item @code{library-info}
21618 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21619 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21620
21621 @item @code{memory-map}
21622 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21623 @tab @code{info mem}
21624
21625 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21626 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21627 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21628
21629 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21630 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21631 @tab @code{info spu}
21632
21633 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21634 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21635 @tab @code{info spu}
21636
21637 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21638 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21639 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21640
21641 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21642 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21643 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21644
21645 @item @code{threads}
21646 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21647 @tab @code{info threads}
21648
21649 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21650 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21651 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21652
21653 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21654 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21655 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21656
21657 @item @code{search-memory}
21658 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21659 @tab @code{find}
21660
21661 @item @code{supported-packets}
21662 @tab @code{qSupported}
21663 @tab Remote communications parameters
21664
21665 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21666 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21667 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21668
21669 @item @code{pass-signals}
21670 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21671 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21672
21673 @item @code{program-signals}
21674 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21675 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21676
21677 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21678 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21679 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21680
21681 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21682 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21683 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21684
21685 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21686 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21687 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21688
21689 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21690 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21691 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21692
21693 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21694 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21695 @tab @code{remote delete}
21696
21697 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21698 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21699 @tab Host I/O
21700
21701 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21702 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21703 @tab Host I/O
21704
21705 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21706 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21707 @tab Host I/O
21708
21709 @item @code{noack-packet}
21710 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21711 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21712
21713 @item @code{osdata}
21714 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21715 @tab @code{info os}
21716
21717 @item @code{query-attached}
21718 @tab @code{qAttached}
21719 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21720
21721 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21722 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21723 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21724
21725 @item @code{trace-status}
21726 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21727 @tab @code{tstatus}
21728
21729 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21730 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21731 @tab Traceframe info
21732
21733 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21734 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21735 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21736
21737 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21738 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21739 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21740
21741 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21742 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21743 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21744
21745 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21746 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21747 @tab @code{set environment}
21748
21749 @item @code{environment-unset}
21750 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21751 @tab @code{unset environment}
21752
21753 @item @code{environment-reset}
21754 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21755 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21756
21757 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21758 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21759 @tab @code{set cwd}
21760
21761 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21762 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21763 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21764
21765 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21766 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21767 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21768
21769 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21770 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21771 @tab @code{break}
21772
21773 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21774 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21775 @tab @code{hbreak}
21776
21777 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21778 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21779 @tab @code{fork}
21780
21781 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21782 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21783 @tab @code{vfork}
21784
21785 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21786 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21787 @tab @code{exec}
21788
21789 @item @code{thread-events}
21790 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21791 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21792
21793 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21794 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21795 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21796
21797 @end multitable
21798
21799 @node Remote Stub
21800 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21801
21802 @cindex debugging stub, example
21803 @cindex remote stub, example
21804 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21805 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21806 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21807 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21808 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21809 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21810 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21811 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21812
21813 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21814 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21815 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21816 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21817 program, you need:
21818
21819 @enumerate
21820 @item
21821 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21822 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21823 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21824
21825 @item
21826 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21827 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21828
21829 @item
21830 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21831 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21832 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21833 documentation.
21834 @end enumerate
21835
21836 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21837 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21838 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21839
21840 @table @emph
21841 @item On the host,
21842 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21843 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21844 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21845
21846 @item On the target,
21847 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21848 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21849 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21850
21851 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21852 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21853 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21854 @end table
21855
21856 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21857 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21858 @sc{sparc} boards.
21859
21860 @cindex remote serial stub list
21861 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21862
21863 @table @code
21864
21865 @item i386-stub.c
21866 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21867 @cindex Intel
21868 @cindex i386
21869 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21870
21871 @item m68k-stub.c
21872 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21873 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21874 @cindex m680x0
21875 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21876
21877 @item sh-stub.c
21878 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21879 @cindex Renesas
21880 @cindex SH
21881 For Renesas SH architectures.
21882
21883 @item sparc-stub.c
21884 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21885 @cindex Sparc
21886 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21887
21888 @item sparcl-stub.c
21889 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21890 @cindex Fujitsu
21891 @cindex SparcLite
21892 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21893
21894 @end table
21895
21896 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21897 recently added stubs.
21898
21899 @menu
21900 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21901 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21902 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21903 @end menu
21904
21905 @node Stub Contents
21906 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21907
21908 @cindex remote serial stub
21909 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21910 subroutines:
21911
21912 @table @code
21913 @item set_debug_traps
21914 @findex set_debug_traps
21915 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21916 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21917 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21918 program's startup code.
21919
21920 @item handle_exception
21921 @findex handle_exception
21922 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21923 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21924 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21925 run when a trap is triggered.
21926
21927 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21928 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21929 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21930 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21931 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21932 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21933 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21934 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21935 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21936 machine.
21937
21938 @item breakpoint
21939 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21940 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21941 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21942 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21943 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21944 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21945 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21946 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21947 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21948 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21949 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21950
21951 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21952 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21953 start of your debugging session.
21954 @end table
21955
21956 @node Bootstrapping
21957 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21958
21959 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21960 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21961 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21962 debugging target machine.
21963
21964 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21965 serial port.
21966
21967 @table @code
21968 @item int getDebugChar()
21969 @findex getDebugChar
21970 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21971 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21972 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21973
21974 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21975 @findex putDebugChar
21976 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21977 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21978 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21979 @end table
21980
21981 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21982 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21983 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21984 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21985 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21986 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21987 remote system to stop.
21988
21989 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21990 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21991 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21992 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21993
21994 Other routines you need to supply are:
21995
21996 @table @code
21997 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21998 @findex exceptionHandler
21999 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22000 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22001 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22002 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22003 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22004 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22005 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22006 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22007 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22008 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22009 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22010 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22011 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22012
22013 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22014 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22015 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22016 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22017 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22018
22019 @item void flush_i_cache()
22020 @findex flush_i_cache
22021 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22022 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22023 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22024
22025 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22026 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22027 @end table
22028
22029 @noindent
22030 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22031
22032 @table @code
22033 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22034 @findex memset
22035 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22036 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22037 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22038 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22039 @end table
22040
22041 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22042 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22043 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22044 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22045
22046
22047 @node Debug Session
22048 @subsection Putting it All Together
22049
22050 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22051 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22052 steps.
22053
22054 @enumerate
22055 @item
22056 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22057 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22058 @display
22059 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22060 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22061 @end display
22062
22063 @item
22064 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22065 procedure is called:
22066
22067 @smallexample
22068 set_debug_traps();
22069 breakpoint();
22070 @end smallexample
22071
22072 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22073 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22074 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22075 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22076 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22077 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22078 progress.
22079
22080 @item
22081 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22082 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22083
22084 @smallexample
22085 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22086 @end smallexample
22087
22088 @noindent
22089 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22090 function in your program, that function is called when
22091 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22092 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22093 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22094
22095 @item
22096 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22097 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22098
22099 @item
22100 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22101 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22102
22103 @item
22104 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22105 @c document that. FIXME.
22106 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22107 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22108
22109 @item
22110 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22111 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22112
22113 @end enumerate
22114
22115 @node Configurations
22116 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22117
22118 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22119 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22120 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22121
22122 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22123 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22124 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22125 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22126 are quite different from each other.
22127
22128 @menu
22129 * Native::
22130 * Embedded OS::
22131 * Embedded Processors::
22132 * Architectures::
22133 @end menu
22134
22135 @node Native
22136 @section Native
22137
22138 This section describes details specific to particular native
22139 configurations.
22140
22141 @menu
22142 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22143 * Process Information:: Process information
22144 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22145 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22146 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22147 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22148 @end menu
22149
22150 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22151 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22152
22153 @cindex libkvm
22154 @cindex kernel memory image
22155 @cindex kernel crash dump
22156
22157 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22158 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22159 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22160 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22161 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22162 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22163 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22164 @code{kvm} target:
22165
22166 @smallexample
22167 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22168 @end smallexample
22169
22170 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22171 argument:
22172
22173 @smallexample
22174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22175 @end smallexample
22176
22177 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22178 available:
22179
22180 @table @code
22181 @kindex kvm
22182 @item kvm pcb
22183 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22184
22185 @item kvm proc
22186 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22187 modern FreeBSD systems.
22188 @end table
22189
22190 @node Process Information
22191 @subsection Process Information
22192 @cindex /proc
22193 @cindex examine process image
22194 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22195
22196 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22197 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22198 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22199 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22200 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22201 any process running on your system.
22202
22203 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22204 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22205 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22206 systems.
22207
22208 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22209 information.
22210
22211 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22212 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22213 information available from a live process. Process information is
22214 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22215 systems.
22216
22217 @table @code
22218 @kindex info proc
22219 @cindex process ID
22220 @item info proc
22221 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22222 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
22223 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22224 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22225 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22226 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22227 executable file's absolute file name.
22228
22229 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22230 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22231 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22232 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22233 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22234 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22235
22236 @item info proc cmdline
22237 @cindex info proc cmdline
22238 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22239 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22240
22241 @item info proc cwd
22242 @cindex info proc cwd
22243 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22244 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22245
22246 @item info proc exe
22247 @cindex info proc exe
22248 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22249 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22250
22251 @item info proc mappings
22252 @cindex memory address space mappings
22253 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
22254 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22255 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22256 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22257 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22258
22259 @item info proc stat
22260 @itemx info proc status
22261 @cindex process detailed status information
22262 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22263 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22264 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22265 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22266 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22267
22268 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22269 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22270
22271 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22272 proc status}.
22273
22274 @item info proc all
22275 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22276 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22277
22278 @ignore
22279 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22280 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22281 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22282 @kindex info proc times
22283 @item info proc times
22284 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22285 its children.
22286
22287 @kindex info proc id
22288 @item info proc id
22289 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22290 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22291 @end ignore
22292
22293 @item set procfs-trace
22294 @kindex set procfs-trace
22295 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22296 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22297
22298 @item show procfs-trace
22299 @kindex show procfs-trace
22300 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22301
22302 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22303 @kindex set procfs-file
22304 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22305 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22306 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22307 standard output.
22308
22309 @item show procfs-file
22310 @kindex show procfs-file
22311 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22312
22313 @item proc-trace-entry
22314 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22315 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22316 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22317 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22318 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22319 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22320 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22321 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22322 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22323
22324 @item info pidlist
22325 @kindex info pidlist
22326 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22327 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22328 processes and all the threads within each process.
22329
22330 @item info meminfo
22331 @kindex info meminfo
22332 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22333 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22334 @end table
22335
22336 @node DJGPP Native
22337 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22338 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22339 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22340 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22341
22342 @cindex DPMI
22343 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22344 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22345 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22346 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22347
22348 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22349 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22350 subsection describes those commands.
22351
22352 @table @code
22353 @kindex info dos
22354 @item info dos
22355 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22356 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22357
22358 @kindex sysinfo
22359 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22360 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22361 @item info dos sysinfo
22362 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22363 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22364 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22365
22366 @cindex GDT
22367 @cindex LDT
22368 @cindex IDT
22369 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22370 @cindex descriptor tables display
22371 @item info dos gdt
22372 @itemx info dos ldt
22373 @itemx info dos idt
22374 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22375 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22376 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22377 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22378 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22379 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22380 rights.
22381
22382 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22383 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22384 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22385 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22386 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22387
22388 @cindex garbled pointers
22389 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22390 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22391 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22392 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22393 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22394 debugged program's data segment:
22395
22396 @smallexample
22397 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22398 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22399 @end smallexample
22400
22401 @noindent
22402 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22403 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22404
22405 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22406 @item info dos pde
22407 @itemx info dos pte
22408 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22409 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22410 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22411 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22412 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22413 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22414 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22415 that is currently in use.
22416
22417 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22418 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22419 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22420 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22421 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22422 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22423 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22424
22425 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22426 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22427 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22428 controller.
22429
22430 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22431
22432 @cindex physical address from linear address
22433 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22434 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22435 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22436 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22437 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22438 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22439 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22440
22441 @smallexample
22442 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22443 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22444 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22445 @end smallexample
22446
22447 @noindent
22448 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22449 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22450 attributes of that page.
22451
22452 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22453 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22454 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22455 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22456 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22457 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22458
22459 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22460 transfer buffer:
22461
22462 @smallexample
22463 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22464 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22465 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22466 @end smallexample
22467
22468 @noindent
22469 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22470 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22471 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22472 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22473 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22474
22475 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22476 @end table
22477
22478 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22479 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22480 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22481 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22482
22483 @table @code
22484 @kindex set com1base
22485 @kindex set com1irq
22486 @kindex set com2base
22487 @kindex set com2irq
22488 @kindex set com3base
22489 @kindex set com3irq
22490 @kindex set com4base
22491 @kindex set com4irq
22492 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22493 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22494 port.
22495
22496 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22497 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22498 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22499
22500 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22501 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22502 other 3 COM ports.
22503
22504 @kindex show com1base
22505 @kindex show com1irq
22506 @kindex show com2base
22507 @kindex show com2irq
22508 @kindex show com3base
22509 @kindex show com3irq
22510 @kindex show com4base
22511 @kindex show com4irq
22512 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22513 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22514 lines used by the COM ports.
22515
22516 @item info serial
22517 @kindex info serial
22518 @cindex DOS serial port status
22519 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22520 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22521 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22522 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22523 @end table
22524
22525
22526 @node Cygwin Native
22527 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22528 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22529 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22530 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22531
22532 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22533 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22534
22535 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22536 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22537 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22538 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22539 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22540 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22541 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22542 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22543
22544 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22545 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22546 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22547
22548 @table @code
22549 @kindex info w32
22550 @item info w32
22551 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22552 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22553
22554 @item info w32 selector
22555 This command displays information returned by
22556 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22557 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22558 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22559 Without argument, this command displays information
22560 about the six segment registers.
22561
22562 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22563 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22564 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22565 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22566
22567 @kindex signal-event
22568 @item signal-event @var{id}
22569 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22570 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22571
22572 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22573 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22574 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22575 (for x86_64 versions):
22576
22577 @itemize @minus
22578 @item
22579 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22580 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22581 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22582
22583 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22584 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22585 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22586 to attach.
22587
22588 @item
22589 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22590 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22591 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22592 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22593 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22594 @end itemize
22595
22596 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22597 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22598 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22599 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22600 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22601 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22602 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22603 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22604 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22605 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22606 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22607
22608 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22609 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22610 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22611 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22612
22613 @kindex set new-console
22614 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22615 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22616 be started in a new console on next start.
22617 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22618 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22619
22620 @kindex show new-console
22621 @item show new-console
22622 Displays whether a new console is used
22623 when the debuggee is started.
22624
22625 @kindex set new-group
22626 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22627 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22628 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22629 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22630 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22631
22632 @kindex show new-group
22633 @item show new-group
22634 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22635
22636 @kindex set debugevents
22637 @item set debugevents
22638 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22639 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22640 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22641 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22642 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22643
22644 @kindex set debugexec
22645 @item set debugexec
22646 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22647 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22648
22649 @kindex set debugexceptions
22650 @item set debugexceptions
22651 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22652 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22653
22654 @kindex set debugmemory
22655 @item set debugmemory
22656 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22657 and writes by the debugger.
22658
22659 @kindex set shell
22660 @item set shell
22661 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22662 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22663
22664 @kindex show shell
22665 @item show shell
22666 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22667
22668 @end table
22669
22670 @menu
22671 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22672 @end menu
22673
22674 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22675 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22676 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22677 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22678
22679 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22680 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22681 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22682 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22683 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22684 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22685 ``minimal symbols''.
22686
22687 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22688 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22689 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22690 program run once to completion.
22691
22692 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22693
22694 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22695 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22696 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22697 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22698 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22699 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22700 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22701 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22702 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22703
22704 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22705 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22706 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22707 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22708 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22709 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22710
22711 @smallexample
22712 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22713 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22714
22715 Non-debugging symbols:
22716 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22717 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22718 @end smallexample
22719
22720 @smallexample
22721 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22722 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22723
22724 Non-debugging symbols:
22725 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22726 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22727 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22728 [etc...]
22729 @end smallexample
22730
22731 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22732
22733 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22734 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22735 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22736 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22737 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22738 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22739 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22740
22741 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22742 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22743 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22744 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22745 problem:
22746
22747 @smallexample
22748 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22749 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22750 @end smallexample
22751
22752 @smallexample
22753 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22754 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22755 @end smallexample
22756
22757 And two possible solutions:
22758
22759 @smallexample
22760 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22761 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22762 @end smallexample
22763
22764 @smallexample
22765 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22766 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22767 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22768 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22769 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22770 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22771 @end smallexample
22772
22773 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22774 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22775 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22776 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22777 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22778
22779 @smallexample
22780 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22781 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22782 @end smallexample
22783
22784 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22785 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22786 safe.
22787
22788 @node Hurd Native
22789 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22790 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22791
22792 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22793 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22794
22795 @table @code
22796 @item set signals
22797 @itemx set sigs
22798 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22799 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22800 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22801 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22802 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22803 @code{signals}.
22804
22805 @item show signals
22806 @itemx show sigs
22807 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22808 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22809 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22810
22811 @item set signal-thread
22812 @itemx set sigthread
22813 @kindex set signal-thread
22814 @kindex set sigthread
22815 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22816 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22817 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22818 signal-thread}.
22819
22820 @item show signal-thread
22821 @itemx show sigthread
22822 @kindex show signal-thread
22823 @kindex show sigthread
22824 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22825 delivered a signal.
22826
22827 @item set stopped
22828 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22829 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22830 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22831 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22832
22833 @item show stopped
22834 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22835 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22836 stopped.
22837
22838 @item set exceptions
22839 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22840 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22841 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22842 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22843 trapping on.
22844
22845 @item show exceptions
22846 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22847 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22848
22849 @item set task pause
22850 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22851 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22852 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22853 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22854 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22855 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22856 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22857 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22858 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22859
22860 @item show task pause
22861 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22862 Show the current state of task suspension.
22863
22864 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22865 @cindex task suspend count
22866 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22867 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22868 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22869
22870 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22871 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22872
22873 @item set task exception-port
22874 @itemx set task excp
22875 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22876 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22877 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22878 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22879
22880 @item set noninvasive
22881 @cindex noninvasive task options
22882 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22883 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22884 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22885 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22886
22887 @item info send-rights
22888 @itemx info receive-rights
22889 @itemx info port-rights
22890 @itemx info port-sets
22891 @itemx info dead-names
22892 @itemx info ports
22893 @itemx info psets
22894 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22895 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22896 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22897 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22898 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22899 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22900 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22901 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22902 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22903
22904 @item set thread pause
22905 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22906 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22907 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22908 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22909 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22910 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22911 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22912 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22913 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22914 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22915 only the current thread.
22916
22917 @item show thread pause
22918 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22919 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22920
22921 @item set thread run
22922 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22923
22924 @item show thread run
22925 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22926
22927 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22928 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22929 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22930 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22931 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22932 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22933 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22934
22935 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22936 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22937 detaching.
22938
22939 @item set thread exception-port
22940 @itemx set thread excp
22941 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22942 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22943 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22944
22945 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22946 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22947 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22948 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22949
22950 @item set thread default
22951 @itemx show thread default
22952 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22953 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22954 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22955 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22956 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22957 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22958 the non-default commands.
22959 @end table
22960
22961 @node Darwin
22962 @subsection Darwin
22963 @cindex Darwin
22964
22965 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22966
22967 @table @code
22968 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22969 @kindex set debug darwin
22970 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22971 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22972
22973 @item show debug darwin
22974 @kindex show debug darwin
22975 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22976
22977 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22978 @kindex set debug mach-o
22979 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22980 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22981 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22982 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22983 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22984 usage.
22985
22986 @item show debug mach-o
22987 @kindex show debug mach-o
22988 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22989
22990 @item set mach-exceptions on
22991 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22992 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22993 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22994 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22995 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22996 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22997
22998 @item show mach-exceptions
22999 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23000 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23001 @end table
23002
23003
23004 @node Embedded OS
23005 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23006
23007 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23008 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23009 architectures.
23010
23011 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
23012 various real-time operating systems.
23013
23014 @node Embedded Processors
23015 @section Embedded Processors
23016
23017 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
23018 configurations.
23019
23020 @cindex send command to simulator
23021 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
23022 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
23023
23024 @table @code
23025 @item sim @var{command}
23026 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
23027 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
23028 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
23029 acceptable commands.
23030 @end table
23031
23032
23033 @menu
23034 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
23035 * ARM:: ARM
23036 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
23037 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
23038 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
23039 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
23040 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
23041 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
23042 * CRIS:: CRIS
23043 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
23044 @end menu
23045
23046 @node ARC
23047 @subsection Synopsys ARC
23048 @cindex Synopsys ARC
23049 @cindex ARC specific commands
23050 @cindex ARC600
23051 @cindex ARC700
23052 @cindex ARC EM
23053 @cindex ARC HS
23054
23055 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23056
23057 @table @code
23058 @item set debug arc
23059 @kindex set debug arc
23060 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23061 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23062
23063 @item show debug arc
23064 @kindex show debug arc
23065 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23066
23067 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23068 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23069 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23070
23071 @end table
23072
23073 @node ARM
23074 @subsection ARM
23075
23076 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23077
23078 @table @code
23079 @item set arm disassembler
23080 @kindex set arm
23081 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23082 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23083
23084 @item show arm disassembler
23085 @kindex show arm
23086 Show the current disassembly style.
23087
23088 @item set arm apcs32
23089 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23090 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23091
23092 @item show arm apcs32
23093 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23094
23095 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23096 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23097 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23098
23099 @table @code
23100 @item auto
23101 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23102 @item softfpa
23103 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23104 processors.
23105 @item fpa
23106 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23107 @item softvfp
23108 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23109 @item vfp
23110 VFP co-processor.
23111 @end table
23112
23113 @item show arm fpu
23114 Show the current type of the FPU.
23115
23116 @item set arm abi
23117 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23118
23119 @item show arm abi
23120 Show the currently used ABI.
23121
23122 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23123 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23124 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23125 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23126 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23127 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23128 register).
23129
23130 @item show arm fallback-mode
23131 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23132
23133 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23134 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23135 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23136 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23137 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23138
23139 @item show arm force-mode
23140 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23141
23142 @item set debug arm
23143 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23144 target support subsystem.
23145
23146 @item show debug arm
23147 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23148 @end table
23149
23150 @table @code
23151 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23152 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23153
23154 @table @code
23155 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23156 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23157 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23158 The default value is @code{all}.
23159
23160 @table @code
23161 @item none
23162 @item demon
23163 @item angel
23164 @item redboot
23165 @item all
23166 @end table
23167 @end table
23168 @end table
23169
23170 @node M68K
23171 @subsection M68k
23172
23173 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23174
23175 @node MicroBlaze
23176 @subsection MicroBlaze
23177 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23178 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23179
23180 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23181 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23182 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23183 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23184 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23185 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23186 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23187 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23188 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23189 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23190 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23191
23192 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23193
23194 @table @code
23195 @item target remote :1234
23196 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23197 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23198
23199 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23200 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23201 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23202
23203 @item load
23204 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23205
23206 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23207 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23208
23209 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23210 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23211 @end table
23212
23213 @node MIPS Embedded
23214 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23215
23216 @noindent
23217 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23218
23219 @table @code
23220 @item set mipsfpu double
23221 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23222 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23223 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23224 @itemx show mipsfpu
23225 @kindex set mipsfpu
23226 @kindex show mipsfpu
23227 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23228 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23229 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23230 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23231 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23232 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23233 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23234 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23235 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23236 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23237 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23238 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23239 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23240
23241 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23242 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23243 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23244
23245 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23246 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23247 @end table
23248
23249 @node OpenRISC 1000
23250 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23251 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23252
23253 @noindent
23254 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23255 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23256 FPGA's.
23257
23258 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23259 a target:
23260
23261 @table @code
23262
23263 @kindex target sim
23264 @item target sim
23265
23266 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23267 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23268 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23269 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23270
23271 Example: @code{target sim}
23272
23273 @item set debug or1k
23274 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23275 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23276
23277 @item show debug or1k
23278 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23279 @end table
23280
23281 @node PowerPC Embedded
23282 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23283
23284 @cindex DVC register
23285 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23286 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23287
23288 @smallexample
23289 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23290 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23291 @end smallexample
23292
23293 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23294 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23295 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23296 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23297 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23298 or newer.
23299
23300 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23301 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23302 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23303 watching variables of scalar types.
23304
23305 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23306 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23307
23308 @smallexample
23309 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23310 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23311 @end smallexample
23312
23313 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23314 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23315
23316 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23317 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23318 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23319 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23320 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23321 use the @code{break-range} command.
23322
23323 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23324
23325 @table @code
23326 @kindex break-range
23327 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23328 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23329 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23330 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23331 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23332 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23333 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23334 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23335 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23336
23337 @kindex set powerpc
23338 @item set powerpc soft-float
23339 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23340 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23341 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23342 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23343
23344 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23345 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23346 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23347 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23348 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23349 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23350 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23351 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23352
23353 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23354 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23355 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23356 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23357 address of its first byte.
23358
23359 @end table
23360
23361 @node AVR
23362 @subsection Atmel AVR
23363 @cindex AVR
23364
23365 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23366 following AVR-specific commands:
23367
23368 @table @code
23369 @item info io_registers
23370 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23371 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23372 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23373 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23374 @end table
23375
23376 @node CRIS
23377 @subsection CRIS
23378 @cindex CRIS
23379
23380 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23381 following CRIS-specific commands:
23382
23383 @table @code
23384 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23385 @cindex CRIS version
23386 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23387 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23388 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23389
23390 @item show cris-version
23391 Show the current CRIS version.
23392
23393 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23394 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23395 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23396 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23397 @code{R59}.
23398
23399 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23400 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23401
23402 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23403 @cindex CRIS mode
23404 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23405 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23406 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23407
23408 @item show cris-mode
23409 Show the current CRIS mode.
23410 @end table
23411
23412 @node Super-H
23413 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23414 @cindex Super-H
23415
23416 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23417 commands:
23418
23419 @table @code
23420 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23421 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23422 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23423 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23424 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23425 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23426 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23427 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23428 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23429 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23430 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23431 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23432
23433 @item show sh calling-convention
23434 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23435 Show the current calling convention setting.
23436
23437 @end table
23438
23439
23440 @node Architectures
23441 @section Architectures
23442
23443 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23444 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23445
23446 @menu
23447 * AArch64::
23448 * i386::
23449 * Alpha::
23450 * MIPS::
23451 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23452 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23453 * PowerPC::
23454 * Nios II::
23455 * Sparc64::
23456 @end menu
23457
23458 @node AArch64
23459 @subsection AArch64
23460 @cindex AArch64 support
23461
23462 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23463 following special commands:
23464
23465 @table @code
23466 @item set debug aarch64
23467 @kindex set debug aarch64
23468 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23469 messages are to be displayed.
23470
23471 @item show debug aarch64
23472 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23473
23474 @end table
23475
23476 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
23477 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
23478
23479 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
23480 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
23481 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
23482 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
23483 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
23484 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
23485
23486 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
23487 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
23488 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
23489 target process.
23490
23491
23492 @node i386
23493 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23494
23495 @table @code
23496 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23497 @kindex set struct-convention
23498 @cindex struct return convention
23499 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23500 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23501 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23502 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23503 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23504 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23505 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23506 be returned in a register.
23507
23508 @item show struct-convention
23509 @kindex show struct-convention
23510 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23511 from functions.
23512 @end table
23513
23514
23515 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23516 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23517
23518 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23519 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23520 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23521 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23522 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23523 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23524 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23525
23526 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23527 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23528 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23529 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23530 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23531 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23532
23533 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23534 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23535 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23536
23537 @smallexample
23538 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23539 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23540 @end smallexample
23541
23542 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23543 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23544 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23545 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23546 the pointer.
23547
23548 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23549 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23550 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23551 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23552 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23553
23554 @table @code
23555 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23556 @kindex show mpx bound
23557 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23558
23559 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23560 @kindex set mpx bound
23561 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23562 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23563 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23564 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23565 @end table
23566
23567 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23568 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23569 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23570 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23571
23572 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23573 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23574 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23575 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23576 function.
23577
23578 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23579 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23580 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23581 continuing the execution. For example:
23582
23583 @smallexample
23584 $ break *upper
23585 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23586 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23587 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23588 $ print $bnd0
23589 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23590 @end smallexample
23591
23592 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23593 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23594 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23595
23596 @node Alpha
23597 @subsection Alpha
23598
23599 See the following section.
23600
23601 @node MIPS
23602 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23603
23604 @cindex stack on Alpha
23605 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23606 @cindex Alpha stack
23607 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23608 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23609 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23610 find the beginning of a function.
23611
23612 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23613 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23614 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23615 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23616 commands:
23617
23618 @table @code
23619 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23620 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23621 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23622 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23623 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23624 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23625 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23626 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23627
23628 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23629 Display the current limit.
23630 @end table
23631
23632 @noindent
23633 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23634 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23635
23636 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23637 programs:
23638
23639 @table @code
23640 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23641 @kindex set mips abi
23642 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23643 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23644 values of @var{arg} are:
23645
23646 @table @samp
23647 @item auto
23648 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23649 default).
23650 @item o32
23651 @item o64
23652 @item n32
23653 @item n64
23654 @item eabi32
23655 @item eabi64
23656 @end table
23657
23658 @item show mips abi
23659 @kindex show mips abi
23660 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23661
23662 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23663 @kindex set mips compression
23664 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23665 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23666 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23667 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23668 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23669 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23670 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23671 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23672 provided by the executable.
23673
23674 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23675 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23676 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23677 identified as such.
23678
23679 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23680 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23681 implicitly from an executable.
23682
23683 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23684 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23685 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23686 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23687 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23688
23689 @item show mips compression
23690 @kindex show mips compression
23691 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23692 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23693
23694 @item set mipsfpu
23695 @itemx show mipsfpu
23696 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23697
23698 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23699 @kindex set mips mask-address
23700 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23701 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23702 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23703 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23704 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23705
23706 @item show mips mask-address
23707 @kindex show mips mask-address
23708 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23709 not.
23710
23711 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23712 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23713 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23714 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23715 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23716 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23717
23718 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23719 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23720 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23721
23722 @item set debug mips
23723 @kindex set debug mips
23724 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23725 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23726
23727 @item show debug mips
23728 @kindex show debug mips
23729 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23730 @end table
23731
23732
23733 @node HPPA
23734 @subsection HPPA
23735 @cindex HPPA support
23736
23737 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23738 following special commands:
23739
23740 @table @code
23741 @item set debug hppa
23742 @kindex set debug hppa
23743 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23744 messages are to be displayed.
23745
23746 @item show debug hppa
23747 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23748
23749 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23750 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23751 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23752 given @var{address}.
23753
23754 @end table
23755
23756
23757 @node SPU
23758 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23759 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23760 @cindex SPU
23761
23762 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23763 it provides the following special commands:
23764
23765 @table @code
23766 @item info spu event
23767 @kindex info spu
23768 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23769 and pending event status.
23770
23771 @item info spu signal
23772 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23773 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23774 notification channels.
23775
23776 @item info spu mailbox
23777 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23778 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23779 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23780
23781 @item info spu dma
23782 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23783 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23784 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23785
23786 @item info spu proxydma
23787 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23788 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23789 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23790
23791 @end table
23792
23793 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23794 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23795 special commands:
23796
23797 @table @code
23798 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23799 @kindex set spu
23800 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23801 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23802 function. The default is @code{off}.
23803
23804 @item show spu stop-on-load
23805 @kindex show spu
23806 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23807
23808 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23809 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23810 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23811 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23812 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23813 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23814
23815 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23816 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23817
23818 @end table
23819
23820 @node PowerPC
23821 @subsection PowerPC
23822 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23823
23824 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23825 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23826 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23827 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23828 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23829
23830 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23831 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23832 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23833
23834 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23835 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23836
23837 @node Nios II
23838 @subsection Nios II
23839 @cindex Nios II architecture
23840
23841 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23842 it provides the following special commands:
23843
23844 @table @code
23845
23846 @item set debug nios2
23847 @kindex set debug nios2
23848 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23849 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23850
23851 @item show debug nios2
23852 @kindex show debug nios2
23853 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23854 @end table
23855
23856 @node Sparc64
23857 @subsection Sparc64
23858 @cindex Sparc64 support
23859 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23860 @subsubsection ADI Support
23861
23862 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23863 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23864 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23865 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23866 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23867 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23868 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23869 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23870 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23871 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23872 signal.
23873
23874 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23875 ADI-enabled.
23876
23877 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23878 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23879
23880
23881 @table @code
23882 @kindex adi examine
23883 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23884
23885 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23886 cacheline.
23887
23888 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23889 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23890 block size, to display.
23891
23892 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23893 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23894
23895 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23896
23897 @smallexample
23898 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23899 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23900 @end smallexample
23901
23902 @kindex adi assign
23903 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23904
23905 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23906 to an address.
23907
23908 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23909 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23910 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23911
23912 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23913 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23914
23915 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23916
23917 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23918 variable "shmaddr":
23919
23920 @smallexample
23921 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23922 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23923 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23924 @end smallexample
23925
23926 @end table
23927
23928 @node Controlling GDB
23929 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23930
23931 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23932 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23933 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23934 described here.
23935
23936 @menu
23937 * Prompt:: Prompt
23938 * Editing:: Command editing
23939 * Command History:: Command history
23940 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23941 * Numbers:: Numbers
23942 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23943 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23944 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23945 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23946 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23947 @end menu
23948
23949 @node Prompt
23950 @section Prompt
23951
23952 @cindex prompt
23953
23954 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23955 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23956 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23957 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23958 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23959 which one you are talking to.
23960
23961 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23962 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23963 or a prompt that does not.
23964
23965 @table @code
23966 @kindex set prompt
23967 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23968 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23969
23970 @kindex show prompt
23971 @item show prompt
23972 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23973 @end table
23974
23975 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23976 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23977 are:
23978
23979 @table @code
23980 @kindex set extended-prompt
23981 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23982 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23983 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23984 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23985 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23986 is displayed.
23987
23988 For example:
23989
23990 @smallexample
23991 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23992 @end smallexample
23993
23994 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23995 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23996
23997 @kindex show extended-prompt
23998 @item show extended-prompt
23999 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
24000 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
24001 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
24002 @end table
24003
24004 @node Editing
24005 @section Command Editing
24006 @cindex readline
24007 @cindex command line editing
24008
24009 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
24010 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
24011 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
24012 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
24013 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
24014 debugging sessions.
24015
24016 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
24017 command @code{set}.
24018
24019 @table @code
24020 @kindex set editing
24021 @cindex editing
24022 @item set editing
24023 @itemx set editing on
24024 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
24025
24026 @item set editing off
24027 Disable command line editing.
24028
24029 @kindex show editing
24030 @item show editing
24031 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
24032 @end table
24033
24034 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24035 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
24036 @end ifset
24037 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24038 @xref{Command Line Editing},
24039 @end ifclear
24040 for more details about the Readline
24041 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
24042 encouraged to read that chapter.
24043
24044 @node Command History
24045 @section Command History
24046 @cindex command history
24047
24048 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
24049 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
24050 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
24051 history facility.
24052
24053 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
24054 package, to provide the history facility.
24055 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24056 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
24057 @end ifset
24058 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24059 @xref{Using History Interactively},
24060 @end ifclear
24061 for the detailed description of the History library.
24062
24063 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
24064 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
24065 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24066 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24067 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24068 pressed on a line by itself.
24069
24070 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24071 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24072 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24073 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24074
24075 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24076 history.
24077
24078 @table @code
24079 @cindex history substitution
24080 @cindex history file
24081 @kindex set history filename
24082 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24083 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24084 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24085 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24086 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24087 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24088 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24089 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24090 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24091 is not set.
24092
24093 @cindex save command history
24094 @kindex set history save
24095 @item set history save
24096 @itemx set history save on
24097 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24098 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24099
24100 @item set history save off
24101 Stop recording command history in a file.
24102
24103 @cindex history size
24104 @kindex set history size
24105 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24106 @item set history size @var{size}
24107 @itemx set history size unlimited
24108 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24109 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24110 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24111 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24112 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24113 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24114
24115 @cindex remove duplicate history
24116 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24117 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24118 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24119 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24120 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24121 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24122 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24123 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24124 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24125
24126 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24127 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24128
24129 @end table
24130
24131 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24132 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24133 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24134 @end ifset
24135 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24136 @xref{Event Designators},
24137 @end ifclear
24138 for more details.
24139
24140 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24141 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24142 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24143 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24144 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24145 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24146 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24147 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24148
24149 The commands to control history expansion are:
24150
24151 @table @code
24152 @item set history expansion on
24153 @itemx set history expansion
24154 @kindex set history expansion
24155 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24156
24157 @item set history expansion off
24158 Disable history expansion.
24159
24160 @c @group
24161 @kindex show history
24162 @item show history
24163 @itemx show history filename
24164 @itemx show history save
24165 @itemx show history size
24166 @itemx show history expansion
24167 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24168 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24169 @c @end group
24170 @end table
24171
24172 @table @code
24173 @kindex show commands
24174 @cindex show last commands
24175 @cindex display command history
24176 @item show commands
24177 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24178
24179 @item show commands @var{n}
24180 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24181
24182 @item show commands +
24183 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24184 @end table
24185
24186 @node Screen Size
24187 @section Screen Size
24188 @cindex size of screen
24189 @cindex screen size
24190 @cindex pagination
24191 @cindex page size
24192 @cindex pauses in output
24193
24194 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24195 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24196 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24197 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24198 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24199 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24200 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24201 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24202 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24203 following line.
24204
24205 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24206 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24207 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24208 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24209 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24210 width} commands:
24211
24212 @table @code
24213 @kindex set height
24214 @kindex set width
24215 @kindex show width
24216 @kindex show height
24217 @item set height @var{lpp}
24218 @itemx set height unlimited
24219 @itemx show height
24220 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24221 @itemx set width unlimited
24222 @itemx show width
24223 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24224 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24225 commands display the current settings.
24226
24227 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24228 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24229 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24230 buffer.
24231
24232 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24233 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24234
24235 @item set pagination on
24236 @itemx set pagination off
24237 @kindex set pagination
24238 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24239 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24240 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24241 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24242
24243 @item show pagination
24244 @kindex show pagination
24245 Show the current pagination mode.
24246 @end table
24247
24248 @node Numbers
24249 @section Numbers
24250 @cindex number representation
24251 @cindex entering numbers
24252
24253 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24254 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24255 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24256 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24257 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24258 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24259 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24260 both input and output with the commands described below.
24261
24262 @table @code
24263 @kindex set input-radix
24264 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24265 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24266 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24267 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24268 example, any of
24269
24270 @smallexample
24271 set input-radix 012
24272 set input-radix 10.
24273 set input-radix 0xa
24274 @end smallexample
24275
24276 @noindent
24277 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24278 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24279 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24280 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24281 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24282 change the radix.
24283
24284 @kindex set output-radix
24285 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24286 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24287 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24288 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24289
24290 @kindex show input-radix
24291 @item show input-radix
24292 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24293
24294 @kindex show output-radix
24295 @item show output-radix
24296 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24297
24298 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24299 @itemx show radix
24300 @kindex set radix
24301 @kindex show radix
24302 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24303 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24304 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24305 default value of 10.
24306
24307 @end table
24308
24309 @node ABI
24310 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24311
24312 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24313 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24314 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24315 current ABI.
24316
24317 @cindex OS ABI
24318 @kindex set osabi
24319 @kindex show osabi
24320 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24321
24322 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24323 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24324 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24325 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24326 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24327 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24328 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24329 platform provides.
24330
24331 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24332 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24333 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24334 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24335
24336 @table @code
24337 @item show osabi
24338 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24339
24340 @item set osabi
24341 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24342
24343 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24344 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24345 @end table
24346
24347 @cindex float promotion
24348
24349 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24350 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24351 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24352 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24353 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24354 @code{double} and then passed.
24355
24356 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24357 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24358 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24359
24360 @table @code
24361 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24362 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24363 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24364 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24365 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24366
24367 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24368 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24369 functions.
24370
24371 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24372 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24373 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24374 @end table
24375
24376 @kindex set cp-abi
24377 @kindex show cp-abi
24378 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24379 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24380 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24381 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24382 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24383 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24384 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24385 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24386 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24387 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24388 ``auto''.
24389
24390 @table @code
24391 @item show cp-abi
24392 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24393
24394 @item set cp-abi
24395 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24396
24397 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24398 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24399 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24400 @end table
24401
24402 @node Auto-loading
24403 @section Automatically loading associated files
24404 @cindex auto-loading
24405
24406 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24407 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24408 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24409 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24410 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24411 sources).
24412
24413 @menu
24414 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24415 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24416
24417 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24418 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24419 @end menu
24420
24421 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24422 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24423 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24424
24425 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24426 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24427 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24428
24429 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24430 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24431
24432 @table @code
24433 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24434 @kindex set auto-load off
24435 @item set auto-load off
24436 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24437 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24438 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24439 @smallexample
24440 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24441 @end smallexample
24442
24443 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24444 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24445 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24446 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24447 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24448 @code{set auto-load no}.
24449
24450 @anchor{show auto-load}
24451 @kindex show auto-load
24452 @item show auto-load
24453 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24454 or disabled.
24455
24456 @smallexample
24457 (gdb) show auto-load
24458 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24459 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24460 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24461 is on.
24462 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24463 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24464 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24465 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24466 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24467 @end smallexample
24468
24469 @anchor{info auto-load}
24470 @kindex info auto-load
24471 @item info auto-load
24472 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24473 not.
24474
24475 @smallexample
24476 (gdb) info auto-load
24477 gdb-scripts:
24478 Loaded Script
24479 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24480 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24481 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24482 loaded.
24483 python-scripts:
24484 Loaded Script
24485 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24486 @end smallexample
24487 @end table
24488
24489 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24490
24491 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24492 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24493 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24494 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24495 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24496 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24497 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24498 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24499 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24500 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24501 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24502 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24503 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24504 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24505 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24506 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24507 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24508 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24509 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24510 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24511 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24512 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24513 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24514 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24515 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24516 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24517 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24518 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24519 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24520 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24521 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24522 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24523 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24524 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24525 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24526 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24527 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24528 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24529 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24530 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24531 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24532 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24533 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24534 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24535 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24536 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24537 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24538 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24539 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24540 @end multitable
24541
24542 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24543 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24544 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24545
24546 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24547 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24548 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24549
24550 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24551 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24552
24553 @table @code
24554 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24555 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24556 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24557 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24558 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24559
24560 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24561 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24562 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24563 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24564 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24565
24566 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24567 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24568 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24569 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24570 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24571 @end table
24572
24573 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24574 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24575 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24576
24577 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24578
24579 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24580 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24581
24582 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24583 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24584 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24585 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24586 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24587 library.
24588
24589 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24590 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24591
24592 @table @code
24593 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24594 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24595 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24596 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24597
24598 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24599 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24600 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24601 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24602 enabled or disabled.
24603
24604 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24605 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24606 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24607 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24608 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24609 @end table
24610
24611 @node Auto-loading safe path
24612 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24613 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24614
24615 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24616 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24617 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24618 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24619 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24620
24621 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24622 get loaded:
24623
24624 @smallexample
24625 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24626 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24627 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24628 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24629 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24630 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24631 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24632 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24633 @end smallexample
24634
24635 @noindent
24636 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24637 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24638
24639 @smallexample
24640 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24641 @end smallexample
24642
24643 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24644
24645 @table @code
24646 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24647 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24648 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24649 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24650 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24651 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24652 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24653 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24654 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24655 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24656
24657 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24658 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24659 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24660
24661 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24662 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24663 @item show auto-load safe-path
24664 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24665 scripts.
24666
24667 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24668 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24669 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24670 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24671 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24672 by the host platform path separator in use.
24673 @end table
24674
24675 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24676 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24677 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24678 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24679 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24680
24681 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24682 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24683 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24684 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24685 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24686 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24687 init file in the current directory
24688 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24689
24690 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24691 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24692
24693 @table @asis
24694 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24695 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24696 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24697 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24698
24699 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24700 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24701 @value{GDBN} session.
24702
24703 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24704 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24705 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24706 from trusted sources.
24707
24708 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24709 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24710 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24711 trusted sources.
24712 @end table
24713
24714 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24715 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24716
24717 @table @asis
24718 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24719 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24720
24721 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24722 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24723 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24724 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24725 @end table
24726
24727 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24728 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24729 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24730 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24731 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24732 recommended to be entered.
24733
24734 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24735 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24736 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24737
24738 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24739 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24740 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24741 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24742 be printed.
24743
24744 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24745 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24746 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24747
24748 @smallexample
24749 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24750 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24751 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24752 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24753 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24754 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24755 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24756 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24757 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24758 @end smallexample
24759
24760 @table @code
24761 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24762 @kindex set debug auto-load
24763 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24764 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24765
24766 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24767 @kindex show debug auto-load
24768 @item show debug auto-load
24769 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24770 on or off.
24771 @end table
24772
24773 @node Messages/Warnings
24774 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24775
24776 @cindex verbose operation
24777 @cindex optional warnings
24778 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24779 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24780 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24781 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24782
24783 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24784 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24785 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24786
24787 @table @code
24788 @kindex set verbose
24789 @item set verbose on
24790 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24791
24792 @item set verbose off
24793 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24794
24795 @kindex show verbose
24796 @item show verbose
24797 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24798 @end table
24799
24800 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24801 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24802 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24803 Symbol Files}).
24804
24805 @table @code
24806
24807 @kindex set complaints
24808 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24809 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24810 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24811 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24812 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24813
24814 @kindex show complaints
24815 @item show complaints
24816 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24817
24818 @end table
24819
24820 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24821 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24822 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24823 you try to run a program which is already running:
24824
24825 @smallexample
24826 (@value{GDBP}) run
24827 The program being debugged has been started already.
24828 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24829 @end smallexample
24830
24831 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24832 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24833
24834 @table @code
24835
24836 @kindex set confirm
24837 @cindex flinching
24838 @cindex confirmation
24839 @cindex stupid questions
24840 @item set confirm off
24841 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24842 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24843 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24844
24845 @item set confirm on
24846 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24847
24848 @kindex show confirm
24849 @item show confirm
24850 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24851
24852 @end table
24853
24854 @cindex command tracing
24855 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24856 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24857 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24858 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24859
24860 @table @code
24861 @kindex set trace-commands
24862 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24863 @item set trace-commands on
24864 Enable command tracing.
24865 @item set trace-commands off
24866 Disable command tracing.
24867 @item show trace-commands
24868 Display the current state of command tracing.
24869 @end table
24870
24871 @node Debugging Output
24872 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24873 @cindex optional debugging messages
24874
24875 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24876 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24877 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24878 section documents those commands.
24879
24880 @table @code
24881 @kindex set exec-done-display
24882 @item set exec-done-display
24883 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24884 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24885 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24886 @kindex show exec-done-display
24887 @item show exec-done-display
24888 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24889 notification.
24890 @kindex set debug
24891 @cindex ARM AArch64
24892 @item set debug aarch64
24893 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24894 The default is off.
24895 @kindex show debug
24896 @item show debug aarch64
24897 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24898 ARM AArch64.
24899 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24900 @cindex architecture debugging info
24901 @item set debug arch
24902 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24903 @item show debug arch
24904 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24905 @item set debug aix-solib
24906 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24907 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24908 support module. The default is off.
24909 @item show debug aix-thread
24910 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24911 @item set debug aix-thread
24912 @cindex AIX threads
24913 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24914 module.
24915 @item show debug aix-thread
24916 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24917 @item set debug check-physname
24918 @cindex physname
24919 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24920 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24921 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24922 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24923 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24924 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24925 @item show debug check-physname
24926 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24927 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24928 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24929 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24930 exported symbols. The default is off.
24931 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24932 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24933 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24934 @item set debug dwarf-die
24935 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24936 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24937 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24938 A value of zero turns off the display.
24939 @item show debug dwarf-die
24940 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24941 @item set debug dwarf-line
24942 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24943 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24944 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24945 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24946 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24947 @item show debug dwarf-line
24948 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24949 @item set debug dwarf-read
24950 @cindex DWARF Reading
24951 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24952 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24953 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24954 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24955 @item show debug dwarf-read
24956 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24957 @item set debug displaced
24958 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24959 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24960 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24961 @item show debug displaced
24962 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24963 related to displaced stepping.
24964 @item set debug event
24965 @cindex event debugging info
24966 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24967 default is off.
24968 @item show debug event
24969 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24970 info.
24971 @item set debug expression
24972 @cindex expression debugging info
24973 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24974 expression parsing. The default is off.
24975 @item show debug expression
24976 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24977 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24978 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24979 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24980 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24981 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24982 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24983 @item set debug fbsd-nat
24984 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
24985 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
24986 @item show debug fbsd-nat
24987 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
24988 @item set debug frame
24989 @cindex frame debugging info
24990 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24991 default is off.
24992 @item show debug frame
24993 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24994 info.
24995 @item set debug gnu-nat
24996 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24997 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24998 @item show debug gnu-nat
24999 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
25000 @item set debug infrun
25001 @cindex inferior debugging info
25002 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
25003 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
25004 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
25005 @item show debug infrun
25006 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
25007 @item set debug jit
25008 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
25009 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
25010 @item show debug jit
25011 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
25012 @item set debug lin-lwp
25013 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
25014 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
25015 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
25016 @item show debug lin-lwp
25017 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
25018 @item set debug linux-namespaces
25019 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
25020 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
25021 @item show debug linux-namespaces
25022 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
25023 @item set debug mach-o
25024 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
25025 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
25026 processing. The default is off.
25027 @item show debug mach-o
25028 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
25029 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
25030 @item set debug notification
25031 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
25032 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
25033 The default is off.
25034 @item show debug notification
25035 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
25036 @item set debug observer
25037 @cindex observer debugging info
25038 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
25039 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
25040 @item show debug observer
25041 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
25042 @item set debug overload
25043 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
25044 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
25045 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
25046 is off.
25047 @item show debug overload
25048 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
25049 debugging info.
25050 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
25051 @cindex debug expression parser
25052 @item set debug parser
25053 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
25054 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
25055 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
25056 details. The default is off.
25057 @item show debug parser
25058 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
25059 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
25060 @cindex serial connections, debugging
25061 @cindex debug remote protocol
25062 @cindex remote protocol debugging
25063 @cindex display remote packets
25064 @item set debug remote
25065 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25066 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25067 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25068 @item show debug remote
25069 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25070
25071 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25072 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25073 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25074 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25075
25076 @item set debug serial
25077 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25078 default is off.
25079 @item show debug serial
25080 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25081 info.
25082 @item set debug solib-frv
25083 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25084 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25085 @item show debug solib-frv
25086 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25087 messages.
25088 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25089 @cindex symbol lookup
25090 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25091 The default is 0 (off).
25092 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25093 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25094 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25095 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25096 @item set debug symfile
25097 @cindex symbol file functions
25098 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25099 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25100 @item show debug symfile
25101 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25102 @item set debug symtab-create
25103 @cindex symbol table creation
25104 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25105 The default is 0 (off).
25106 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25107 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25108 @item show debug symtab-create
25109 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25110 @item set debug target
25111 @cindex target debugging info
25112 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25113 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25114 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25115 value of large memory transfers.
25116 @item show debug target
25117 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25118 info.
25119 @item set debug timestamp
25120 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25121 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25122 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25123 message.
25124 @item show debug timestamp
25125 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25126 debugging info.
25127 @item set debug varobj
25128 @cindex variable object debugging info
25129 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25130 info. The default is off.
25131 @item show debug varobj
25132 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25133 debugging info.
25134 @item set debug xml
25135 @cindex XML parser debugging
25136 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25137 @item show debug xml
25138 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25139 @end table
25140
25141 @node Other Misc Settings
25142 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25143 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25144
25145 @table @code
25146 @kindex set interactive-mode
25147 @item set interactive-mode
25148 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25149 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25150 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25151 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25152 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25153 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25154 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25155 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25156
25157 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25158 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25159 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25160 inside a cygwin window.
25161
25162 @kindex show interactive-mode
25163 @item show interactive-mode
25164 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25165 @end table
25166
25167 @node Extending GDB
25168 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25169 @cindex extending GDB
25170
25171 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25172 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25173 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25174 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25175 being debugged.
25176
25177 @menu
25178 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25179 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25180 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25181 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25182 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25183 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25184 @end menu
25185
25186 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25187 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25188 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25189 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25190 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25191 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25192
25193 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25194 setting:
25195
25196 @table @code
25197 @kindex set script-extension
25198 @kindex show script-extension
25199 @item set script-extension off
25200 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25201
25202 @item set script-extension soft
25203 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25204 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25205 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25206 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25207
25208 @item set script-extension strict
25209 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25210 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25211 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25212
25213 @item show script-extension
25214 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25215
25216 @end table
25217
25218 @node Sequences
25219 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25220
25221 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25222 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25223 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25224 files.
25225
25226 @menu
25227 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25228 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25229 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25230 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25231 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25232 @end menu
25233
25234 @node Define
25235 @subsection User-defined Commands
25236
25237 @cindex user-defined command
25238 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25239 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25240 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25241 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25242 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25243 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25244
25245 @smallexample
25246 define adder
25247 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25248 end
25249 @end smallexample
25250
25251 @noindent
25252 To execute the command use:
25253
25254 @smallexample
25255 adder 1 2 3
25256 @end smallexample
25257
25258 @noindent
25259 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25260 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25261 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25262 functions calls.
25263
25264 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25265 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25266 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25267 been passed.
25268
25269 @smallexample
25270 define adder
25271 if $argc == 2
25272 print $arg0 + $arg1
25273 end
25274 if $argc == 3
25275 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25276 end
25277 end
25278 @end smallexample
25279
25280 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25281 to process a variable number of arguments:
25282
25283 @smallexample
25284 define adder
25285 set $i = 0
25286 set $sum = 0
25287 while $i < $argc
25288 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25289 set $i = $i + 1
25290 end
25291 print $sum
25292 end
25293 @end smallexample
25294
25295 @table @code
25296
25297 @kindex define
25298 @item define @var{commandname}
25299 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25300 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25301 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25302 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25303 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25304 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25305
25306 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25307 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25308 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25309
25310 @kindex document
25311 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25312 @item document @var{commandname}
25313 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25314 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25315 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25316 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25317 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25318 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25319
25320 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25321 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25322 does not change the documentation.
25323
25324 @kindex dont-repeat
25325 @cindex don't repeat command
25326 @item dont-repeat
25327 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25328 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25329 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25330
25331 @kindex help user-defined
25332 @item help user-defined
25333 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25334 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25335 included (if any).
25336
25337 @kindex show user
25338 @item show user
25339 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25340 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25341 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25342 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25343 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25344
25345 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25346 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25347 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25348 @item show max-user-call-depth
25349 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25350 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25351 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25352 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25353 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25354 @end table
25355
25356 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25357 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25358
25359 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25360 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25361 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25362
25363 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25364 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25365 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25366 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25367
25368 @node Hooks
25369 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25370 @cindex command hooks
25371 @cindex hooks, for commands
25372 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25373
25374 @kindex hook
25375 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25376 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25377 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25378 before that command.
25379
25380 @cindex hooks, post-command
25381 @kindex hookpost
25382 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25383 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25384 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25385 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25386 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25387
25388 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25389 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25390
25391 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25392 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25393
25394 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25395 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25396 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25397 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25398 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25399
25400 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25401 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25402 you could define:
25403
25404 @smallexample
25405 define hook-stop
25406 handle SIGALRM nopass
25407 end
25408
25409 define hook-run
25410 handle SIGALRM pass
25411 end
25412
25413 define hook-continue
25414 handle SIGALRM pass
25415 end
25416 @end smallexample
25417
25418 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25419 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25420 you could define:
25421
25422 @smallexample
25423 define hook-echo
25424 echo <<<---
25425 end
25426
25427 define hookpost-echo
25428 echo --->>>\n
25429 end
25430
25431 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25432 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25433 (@value{GDBP})
25434
25435 @end smallexample
25436
25437 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25438 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25439 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25440 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25441 @c or not?
25442 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25443 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25444 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25445
25446 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25447 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25448 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25449
25450 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25451 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25452
25453 @node Command Files
25454 @subsection Command Files
25455
25456 @cindex command files
25457 @cindex scripting commands
25458 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25459 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25460 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25461 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25462 terminal.
25463
25464 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25465 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25466 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25467 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25468 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25469
25470 @table @code
25471 @kindex source
25472 @cindex execute commands from a file
25473 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25474 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25475 @end table
25476
25477 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25478 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25479 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25480 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25481 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25482
25483 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25484 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25485 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25486 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25487 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25488 is not relevant to scripts.
25489
25490 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25491 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25492 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25493 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25494 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25495 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25496 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25497 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25498 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25499 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25500 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25501 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25502 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25503 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25504
25505 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25506 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25507 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25508
25509 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25510 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25511 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25512 when called from command files.
25513
25514 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25515 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25516 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25517 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25518 the next command.
25519
25520 @smallexample
25521 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25522 @end smallexample
25523
25524 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25525 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25526 would be directed to @file{log}.
25527
25528 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25529 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25530 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25531 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25532 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25533 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25534 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25535 conditionally, etc.
25536
25537 @table @code
25538 @kindex if
25539 @kindex else
25540 @item if
25541 @itemx else
25542 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25543 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25544 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25545 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25546 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25547 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25548 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25549
25550 @kindex while
25551 @item while
25552 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25553 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25554 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25555 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25556 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25557 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25558
25559 @kindex loop_break
25560 @item loop_break
25561 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25562 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25563 line.
25564
25565 @kindex loop_continue
25566 @item loop_continue
25567 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25568 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25569 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25570 the controlling expression.
25571
25572 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25573 @item end
25574 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25575 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25576 @end table
25577
25578
25579 @node Output
25580 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25581
25582 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25583 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25584 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25585 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25586 want.
25587
25588 @table @code
25589 @kindex echo
25590 @item echo @var{text}
25591 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25592 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25593 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25594 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25595 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25596 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25597 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25598 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25599 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25600 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25601 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25602
25603 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25604 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25605
25606 @smallexample
25607 echo This is some text\n\
25608 which is continued\n\
25609 onto several lines.\n
25610 @end smallexample
25611
25612 produces the same output as
25613
25614 @smallexample
25615 echo This is some text\n
25616 echo which is continued\n
25617 echo onto several lines.\n
25618 @end smallexample
25619
25620 @kindex output
25621 @item output @var{expression}
25622 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25623 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25624 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25625 on expressions.
25626
25627 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25628 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25629 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25630 Formats}, for more information.
25631
25632 @kindex printf
25633 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25634 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25635 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25636 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25637 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25638 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25639 executing the code below:
25640
25641 @smallexample
25642 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25643 @end smallexample
25644
25645 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25646 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25647 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25648 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25649 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25650 printed.
25651
25652 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25653
25654 @smallexample
25655 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25656 @end smallexample
25657
25658 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25659 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25660 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25661
25662 @itemize @bullet
25663 @item
25664 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25665
25666 @item
25667 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25668 width.
25669
25670 @item
25671 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25672 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25673
25674 @item
25675 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25676 supported.
25677
25678 @item
25679 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25680
25681 @item
25682 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25683 @end itemize
25684
25685 @noindent
25686 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25687 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25688 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25689 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25690
25691 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25692 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25693 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25694 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25695 supported.
25696
25697 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25698 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25699 together with a floating point specifier.
25700 letters:
25701
25702 @itemize @bullet
25703 @item
25704 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25705
25706 @item
25707 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25708
25709 @item
25710 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25711 @end itemize
25712
25713 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25714 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25715 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25716
25717 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25718 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25719
25720 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25721 @smallexample
25722 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25723 @end smallexample
25724
25725 @anchor{eval}
25726 @kindex eval
25727 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25728 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25729 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25730
25731 @end table
25732
25733 @node Auto-loading sequences
25734 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25735 @cindex native script auto-loading
25736
25737 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25738 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25739 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25740 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25741
25742 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25743 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25744
25745 @table @code
25746 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25747 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25748 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25749 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25750
25751 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25752 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25753 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25754 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25755 disabled.
25756
25757 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25758 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25759 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25760 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25761 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25762 auto-loaded.
25763 @end table
25764
25765 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25766 matching names are printed.
25767
25768 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25769 @include python.texi
25770
25771 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25772 @include guile.texi
25773
25774 @node Auto-loading extensions
25775 @section Auto-loading extensions
25776 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25777
25778 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25779 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25780 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25781 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25782 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25783
25784 @menu
25785 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25786 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25787 * Which flavor to choose?::
25788 @end menu
25789
25790 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25791 debugging commands and features.
25792
25793 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25794 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25795 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25796 for more information.
25797 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25798 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25799
25800 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25801 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25802
25803 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25804 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25805 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25806 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25807 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25808
25809 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25810 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25811 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25812 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25813
25814 @table @code
25815 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25816 GDB's own command language
25817 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25818 Python
25819 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25820 Guile
25821 @end table
25822
25823 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25824 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25825 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25826 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25827 script in the specified extension language.
25828
25829 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25830 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25831
25832 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25833 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25834
25835 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25836 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25837 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25838 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25839 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25840 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25841
25842 @table @code
25843 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25844 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25845 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25846 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25847 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25848 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25849
25850 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25851 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25852
25853 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25854 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25855 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25856 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25857
25858 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25859 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25860 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25861 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25862 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25863 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25864 platform.
25865
25866 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25867 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25868 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25869
25870 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25871 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25872 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25873 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25874
25875 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25876 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25877 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25878 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25879 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25880 @end table
25881
25882 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25883 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25884 @var{objfile} is opened.
25885 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25886 is evaluated more than once.
25887
25888 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25889 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25890 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25891
25892 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25893 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25894 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25895 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25896 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25897 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25898 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25899
25900 The following entries are supported:
25901
25902 @table @code
25903 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25904 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25905 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25906 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25907 @end table
25908
25909 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25910
25911 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25912 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25913 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25914 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25915 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25916
25917 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25918 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25919
25920 @example
25921 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25922 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25923 asm("\
25924 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25925 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25926 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25927 .popsection \n\
25928 ");
25929 @end example
25930
25931 @noindent
25932 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25933 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25934
25935 @example
25936 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25937 @end example
25938
25939 The script name may include directories if desired.
25940
25941 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25942 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25943
25944 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25945 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25946 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25947 will remove duplicates.
25948
25949 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25950
25951 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25952 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25953 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25954 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25955 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25956 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25957 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25958 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25959 on its name.
25960
25961 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25962 testsuite.
25963
25964 @example
25965 #include "symcat.h"
25966 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25967 asm(
25968 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25969 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25970 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25971 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25972 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25973 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25974 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25975 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25976 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25977 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25978 ".byte 0\n"
25979 ".popsection\n"
25980 );
25981 @end example
25982
25983 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25984 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25985 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25986 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25987
25988 @node Which flavor to choose?
25989 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25990
25991 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25992 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25993
25994 @noindent
25995 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25996
25997 @itemize @bullet
25998 @item
25999 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
26000
26001 @item
26002 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
26003
26004 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
26005 in the source search path.
26006 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
26007 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
26008
26009 @item
26010 Doesn't require source code additions.
26011 @end itemize
26012
26013 @noindent
26014 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
26015
26016 @itemize @bullet
26017 @item
26018 Works with static linking.
26019
26020 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
26021 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
26022 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
26023 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
26024 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
26025
26026 @item
26027 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
26028
26029 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
26030 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
26031
26032 @item
26033 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
26034
26035 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
26036 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
26037 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
26038 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
26039 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
26040 top of the source tree to the source search path.
26041 @end itemize
26042
26043 @node Multiple Extension Languages
26044 @section Multiple Extension Languages
26045
26046 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
26047 and generally do not interfere with each other.
26048 There are some things to be aware of, however.
26049
26050 @subsection Python comes first
26051
26052 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
26053 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
26054 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
26055 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
26056 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
26057 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
26058 pretty-printed form of a value).
26059 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
26060 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
26061 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
26062
26063 @node Aliases
26064 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
26065 @cindex aliases for commands
26066
26067 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26068 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26069 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26070 that involves less typing.
26071
26072 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26073 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26074 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26075
26076 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26077 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26078 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26079
26080 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26081
26082 @table @code
26083
26084 @kindex alias
26085 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26086
26087 @end table
26088
26089 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26090 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26091 underscores.
26092
26093 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26094 that is being aliased.
26095
26096 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26097 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26098 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26099
26100 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26101 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26102
26103 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26104 of a command so that there is less to type.
26105 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26106 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26107 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26108 The following will accomplish this.
26109
26110 @smallexample
26111 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26112 @end smallexample
26113
26114 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26115 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26116 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26117 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26118
26119 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26120 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26121 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26122 of a command.
26123
26124 @smallexample
26125 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26126 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26127 (gdb) set p elms 20
26128 (gdb) show p elms
26129 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26130 @end smallexample
26131
26132 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26133 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26134 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26135
26136 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26137 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26138
26139 @smallexample
26140 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26141 @end smallexample
26142
26143 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26144 alias for a more complex command.
26145 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26146
26147 @smallexample
26148 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26149 (gdb) spe 20
26150 @end smallexample
26151
26152 @node Interpreters
26153 @chapter Command Interpreters
26154 @cindex command interpreters
26155
26156 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26157 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26158 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26159
26160 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26161 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26162 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26163 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26164
26165 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26166 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26167 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26168 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26169
26170 @table @code
26171 @item console
26172 @cindex console interpreter
26173 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26174 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26175 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26176
26177 @item mi
26178 @cindex mi interpreter
26179 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26180 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26181 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26182 Interface}.
26183
26184 @item mi2
26185 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26186 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26187
26188 @item mi1
26189 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26190 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26191
26192 @end table
26193
26194 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26195
26196 @kindex interpreter-exec
26197 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26198 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26199 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26200
26201 @smallexample
26202 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26203 @end smallexample
26204
26205 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26206 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26207
26208 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26209 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26210 permanently.
26211
26212 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26213
26214 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26215 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26216 device (usually a tty).
26217
26218 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26219 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26220 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26221 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26222 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26223 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26224 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26225 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26226 the separate MI interpreter.
26227
26228 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26229 @code{new-ui} command:
26230
26231 @kindex new-ui
26232 @cindex new user interface
26233 @smallexample
26234 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26235 @end smallexample
26236
26237 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26238 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26239 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26240 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26241 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26242 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26243
26244 @smallexample
26245 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26246 @end smallexample
26247
26248 @noindent
26249 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26250
26251 @node TUI
26252 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26253 @cindex TUI
26254 @cindex Text User Interface
26255
26256 @menu
26257 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26258 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26259 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26260 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26261 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26262 @end menu
26263
26264 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26265 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26266 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26267 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26268 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26269 is available.
26270
26271 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26272 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26273 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26274 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26275 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26276 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26277
26278 @node TUI Overview
26279 @section TUI Overview
26280
26281 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26282
26283 @table @emph
26284 @item command
26285 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26286 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26287 managed using readline.
26288
26289 @item source
26290 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26291 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26292
26293 @item assembly
26294 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26295
26296 @item register
26297 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26298 when their values change.
26299 @end table
26300
26301 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26302 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26303 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26304 indicates the breakpoint type:
26305
26306 @table @code
26307 @item B
26308 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26309
26310 @item b
26311 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26312
26313 @item H
26314 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26315
26316 @item h
26317 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26318 @end table
26319
26320 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26321
26322 @table @code
26323 @item +
26324 Breakpoint is enabled.
26325
26326 @item -
26327 Breakpoint is disabled.
26328 @end table
26329
26330 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26331 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26332 changes.
26333
26334 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26335 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26336 layouts:
26337
26338 @itemize @bullet
26339 @item
26340 source only,
26341
26342 @item
26343 assembly only,
26344
26345 @item
26346 source and assembly,
26347
26348 @item
26349 source and registers, or
26350
26351 @item
26352 assembly and registers.
26353 @end itemize
26354
26355 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26356
26357 @table @emph
26358 @item target
26359 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26360 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26361
26362 @item process
26363 Gives the current process or thread number.
26364 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26365
26366 @item function
26367 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26368 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26369 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26370 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26371
26372 @item line
26373 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26374 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26375
26376 @item pc
26377 Indicates the current program counter address.
26378 @end table
26379
26380 @node TUI Keys
26381 @section TUI Key Bindings
26382 @cindex TUI key bindings
26383
26384 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26385 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26386 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26387 @end ifset
26388 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26389 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26390 @end ifclear
26391 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26392 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26393
26394 @table @kbd
26395 @kindex C-x C-a
26396 @item C-x C-a
26397 @kindex C-x a
26398 @itemx C-x a
26399 @kindex C-x A
26400 @itemx C-x A
26401 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26402 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26403 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26404 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26405 The screen is then refreshed.
26406
26407 @kindex C-x 1
26408 @item C-x 1
26409 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26410 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26411 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26412
26413 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26414
26415 @kindex C-x 2
26416 @item C-x 2
26417 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26418 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26419 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26420 previous layout and the new one.
26421
26422 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26423
26424 @kindex C-x o
26425 @item C-x o
26426 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26427 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26428 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26429
26430 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26431
26432 @kindex C-x s
26433 @item C-x s
26434 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26435 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26436 @end table
26437
26438 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26439
26440 @table @asis
26441 @kindex PgUp
26442 @item @key{PgUp}
26443 Scroll the active window one page up.
26444
26445 @kindex PgDn
26446 @item @key{PgDn}
26447 Scroll the active window one page down.
26448
26449 @kindex Up
26450 @item @key{Up}
26451 Scroll the active window one line up.
26452
26453 @kindex Down
26454 @item @key{Down}
26455 Scroll the active window one line down.
26456
26457 @kindex Left
26458 @item @key{Left}
26459 Scroll the active window one column left.
26460
26461 @kindex Right
26462 @item @key{Right}
26463 Scroll the active window one column right.
26464
26465 @kindex C-L
26466 @item @kbd{C-L}
26467 Refresh the screen.
26468 @end table
26469
26470 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26471 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26472 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26473 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26474 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26475
26476 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26477 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26478 @cindex TUI single key mode
26479
26480 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26481 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26482 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26483
26484 @table @kbd
26485 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26486 @item c
26487 continue
26488
26489 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26490 @item d
26491 down
26492
26493 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26494 @item f
26495 finish
26496
26497 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26498 @item n
26499 next
26500
26501 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26502 @item o
26503 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26504
26505 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26506 @item q
26507 exit the SingleKey mode.
26508
26509 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26510 @item r
26511 run
26512
26513 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26514 @item s
26515 step
26516
26517 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26518 @item i
26519 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26520
26521 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26522 @item u
26523 up
26524
26525 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26526 @item v
26527 info locals
26528
26529 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26530 @item w
26531 where
26532 @end table
26533
26534 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26535 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26536 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26537 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26538 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26539 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26540
26541
26542 @node TUI Commands
26543 @section TUI-specific Commands
26544 @cindex TUI commands
26545
26546 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26547 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26548 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26549 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26550
26551 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26552 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26553 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26554 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26555 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26556
26557 @table @code
26558 @item tui enable
26559 @kindex tui enable
26560 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26561 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26562 otherwise a default layout is used.
26563
26564 @item tui disable
26565 @kindex tui disable
26566 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26567
26568 @item info win
26569 @kindex info win
26570 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26571
26572 @item layout @var{name}
26573 @kindex layout
26574 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26575 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26576 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26577
26578 @table @code
26579 @item next
26580 Display the next layout.
26581
26582 @item prev
26583 Display the previous layout.
26584
26585 @item src
26586 Display the source and command windows.
26587
26588 @item asm
26589 Display the assembly and command windows.
26590
26591 @item split
26592 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26593
26594 @item regs
26595 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26596 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26597 register, assembler, and command windows.
26598 @end table
26599
26600 @item focus @var{name}
26601 @kindex focus
26602 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26603 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26604
26605 @table @code
26606 @item next
26607 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26608
26609 @item prev
26610 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26611
26612 @item src
26613 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26614
26615 @item asm
26616 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26617
26618 @item regs
26619 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26620
26621 @item cmd
26622 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26623 @end table
26624
26625 @item refresh
26626 @kindex refresh
26627 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26628
26629 @item tui reg @var{group}
26630 @kindex tui reg
26631 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26632 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26633 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26634 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26635 following groups are available on most targets:
26636 @table @code
26637 @item next
26638 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26639 through all of the available register groups.
26640
26641 @item prev
26642 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26643 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26644 @var{next}.
26645
26646 @item general
26647 Display the general registers.
26648 @item float
26649 Display the floating point registers.
26650 @item system
26651 Display the system registers.
26652 @item vector
26653 Display the vector registers.
26654 @item all
26655 Display all registers.
26656 @end table
26657
26658 @item update
26659 @kindex update
26660 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26661
26662 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26663 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26664 @kindex winheight
26665 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26666 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26667 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26668 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26669 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26670
26671 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26672 @kindex tabset
26673 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26674 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26675 assembly windows.
26676 @end table
26677
26678 @node TUI Configuration
26679 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26680 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26681
26682 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26683
26684 @table @code
26685 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26686 @kindex set tui border-kind
26687 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26688 The possible values are the following:
26689 @table @code
26690 @item space
26691 Use a space character to draw the border.
26692
26693 @item ascii
26694 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26695
26696 @item acs
26697 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26698 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26699 @end table
26700
26701 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26702 @kindex set tui border-mode
26703 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26704 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26705 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26706 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26707 @table @code
26708 @item normal
26709 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26710
26711 @item standout
26712 Use standout mode.
26713
26714 @item reverse
26715 Use reverse video mode.
26716
26717 @item half
26718 Use half bright mode.
26719
26720 @item half-standout
26721 Use half bright and standout mode.
26722
26723 @item bold
26724 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26725
26726 @item bold-standout
26727 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26728 @end table
26729 @end table
26730
26731 @node Emacs
26732 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26733
26734 @cindex Emacs
26735 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26736 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26737 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26738 @value{GDBN}.
26739
26740 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26741 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26742 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26743 created Emacs buffer.
26744 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26745
26746 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26747 things:
26748
26749 @itemize @bullet
26750 @item
26751 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26752 the GUD buffer.
26753
26754 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26755 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26756
26757 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26758 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26759 in this way.
26760
26761 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26762 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26763 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26764 stop.
26765
26766 @item
26767 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26768
26769 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26770 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26771 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26772 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26773 and the source.
26774
26775 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26776 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26777 @end itemize
26778
26779 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26780 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26781 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26782 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26783
26784 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26785 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26786 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26787 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26788 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26789 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26790 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26791 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26792 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26793
26794 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26795 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26796 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26797 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26798
26799 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26800 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26801 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26802 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26803 one you want.
26804
26805 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26806 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26807
26808 @table @kbd
26809 @item C-h m
26810 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26811
26812 @item C-c C-s
26813 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26814 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26815
26816 @item C-c C-n
26817 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26818 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26819 to show the current file and location.
26820
26821 @item C-c C-i
26822 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26823 display window accordingly.
26824
26825 @item C-c C-f
26826 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26827 @code{finish} command.
26828
26829 @item C-c C-r
26830 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26831 command.
26832
26833 @item C-c <
26834 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26835 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26836 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26837
26838 @item C-c >
26839 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26840 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26841 @end table
26842
26843 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26844 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26845
26846 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26847 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26848 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26849 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26850 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26851 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26852 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26853
26854 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26855 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26856 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26857 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26858 frame.
26859
26860 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26861 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26862 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26863 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26864 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26865 to correspond properly with the code.
26866
26867 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26868 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26869 Emacs Manual}).
26870
26871 @node GDB/MI
26872 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26873
26874 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26875
26876 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26877 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26878 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26879 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26880 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26881 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26882
26883 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26884 in the form of a reference manual.
26885
26886 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26887 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26888 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26889
26890 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26891
26892 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26893 This chapter uses the following notation:
26894
26895 @itemize @bullet
26896 @item
26897 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26898
26899 @item
26900 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26901 it may or may not be given.
26902
26903 @item
26904 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26905 may repeat zero or more times.
26906
26907 @item
26908 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26909 may repeat one or more times.
26910
26911 @item
26912 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26913 @end itemize
26914
26915 @ignore
26916 @heading Dependencies
26917 @end ignore
26918
26919 @menu
26920 * GDB/MI General Design::
26921 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26922 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26923 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26924 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26925 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26926 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26927 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26928 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26929 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26930 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26931 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26932 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26933 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26934 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26935 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26936 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26937 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26938 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26939 @ignore
26940 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26941 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26942 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26943 @end ignore
26944 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26945 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26946 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26947 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26948 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26949 @end menu
26950
26951 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26952 @node GDB/MI General Design
26953 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26954 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26955
26956 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26957 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26958 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26959 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26960 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26961 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26962 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26963 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26964 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26965 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26966
26967 The important examples of notifications are:
26968 @itemize @bullet
26969
26970 @item
26971 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26972 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26973 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26974 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26975 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26976 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26977 command itself was successfully executed.
26978
26979 @item
26980 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26981 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26982 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26983 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26984 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26985 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26986
26987 @item
26988 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26989 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26990 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26991 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26992 orthogonal frontend design.
26993
26994 @end itemize
26995
26996 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26997 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26998 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26999 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
27000 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
27001 the user interface.
27002
27003
27004 @menu
27005 * Context management::
27006 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
27007 * Thread groups::
27008 @end menu
27009
27010 @node Context management
27011 @subsection Context management
27012
27013 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
27014
27015 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
27016 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
27017 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
27018 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
27019 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
27020 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
27021 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
27022 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
27023 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
27024
27025 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
27026 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
27027 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
27028 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
27029 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
27030 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
27031 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
27032 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
27033 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
27034 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
27035 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
27036
27037 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
27038 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
27039 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
27040 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
27041 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
27042 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
27043 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
27044 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
27045 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
27046 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
27047
27048 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
27049 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
27050 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
27051 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
27052 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
27053 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
27054 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
27055 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
27056 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
27057 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
27058 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
27059 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
27060 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
27061 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
27062 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
27063 @samp{--frame} options.
27064
27065 @subsubsection Language
27066
27067 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27068 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27069 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27070 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27071 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27072 For instance:
27073
27074 @smallexample
27075 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27076 ^done,value="4"
27077 (gdb)
27078 @end smallexample
27079
27080 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27081 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27082 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27083
27084 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27085 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27086
27087 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27088 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27089 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27090 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27091 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27092 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27093 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27094 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27095 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27096
27097 @table @code
27098 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27099 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27100 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27101
27102 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27103 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27104 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27105
27106 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27107 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27108 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27109 MI commands even while the target is running.
27110
27111 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27112 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27113 @end table
27114
27115 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27116 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27117 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27118 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27119 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27120 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27121
27122 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27123 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27124 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27125 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27126 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27127 are running.
27128
27129 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27130 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27131 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27132 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27133 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27134 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27135 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27136 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27137 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27138 @samp{--thread} option).
27139
27140 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27141 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27142 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27143 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27144
27145 @node Thread groups
27146 @subsection Thread groups
27147 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27148 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27149 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27150 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27151 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27152
27153 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27154 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27155 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27156 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27157 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27158 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27159 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27160 into processes.
27161
27162 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27163 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27164 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27165 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27166 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27167 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27168 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27169 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27170 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27171 the members of specific thread group.
27172
27173 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27174 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27175 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27176 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27177 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27178 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27179 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27180 after attaching to that thread group.
27181
27182 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27183 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27184 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27185 such thread groups.
27186
27187 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27188 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27189 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27190
27191 @menu
27192 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27193 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27194 @end menu
27195
27196 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27197 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27198
27199 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27200 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27201 @table @code
27202 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27203 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27204
27205 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27206 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27207 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27208
27209 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27210 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27211 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27212
27213 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27214 "any sequence of digits"
27215
27216 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27217 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27218
27219 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27220 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27221
27222 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27223 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27224
27225 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27226 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27227 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27228
27229 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27230 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27231
27232 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27233 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27234 @end table
27235
27236 @noindent
27237 Notes:
27238
27239 @itemize @bullet
27240 @item
27241 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27242 output is described below.
27243
27244 @item
27245 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27246 finishes.
27247
27248 @item
27249 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27250 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27251 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27252 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27253 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27254 @end itemize
27255
27256 Pragmatics:
27257
27258 @itemize @bullet
27259 @item
27260 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27261
27262 @item
27263 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27264 @end itemize
27265
27266 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27267 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27268
27269 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27270 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27271 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27272 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27273 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27274 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27275
27276 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27277 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27278 @var{token}.
27279
27280 @table @code
27281 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27282 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27283
27284 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27285 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27286
27287 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27288 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27289
27290 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27291 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27292
27293 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27294 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27295
27296 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27297 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27298
27299 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27300 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27301
27302 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27303 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27304
27305 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27306 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27307
27308 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27309 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27310 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27311
27312 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27313 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27314
27315 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27316 @code{ @var{string} }
27317
27318 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27319 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27320
27321 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27322 @code{@var{c-string}}
27323
27324 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27325 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27326
27327 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27328 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27329 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27330
27331 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27332 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27333
27334 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27335 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27336
27337 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27338 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27339
27340 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27341 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27342
27343 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27344 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27345
27346 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27347 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27348 @end table
27349
27350 @noindent
27351 Notes:
27352
27353 @itemize @bullet
27354 @item
27355 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27356
27357 @item
27358 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27359 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27360 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27361 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27362 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27363 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27364 prior command.
27365
27366 @item
27367 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27368 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27369 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27370 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27371
27372 @item
27373 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27374 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27375 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27376 @samp{*}.
27377
27378 @item
27379 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27380 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27381 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27382 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27383
27384 @item
27385 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27386 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27387 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27388 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27389
27390 @item
27391 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27392 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27393 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27394
27395 @item
27396 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27397 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27398 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27399 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27400
27401 @item
27402 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27403 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27404 @var{values}.
27405
27406
27407 @end itemize
27408
27409 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27410 details about the various output records.
27411
27412 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27413 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27414 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27415
27416 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27417 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27418
27419 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27420 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27421 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27422 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27423 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27424 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27425
27426 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27427 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27428 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27429
27430 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27431 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27432 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27433 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27434
27435 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27436 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27437
27438 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27439 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27440 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27441 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27442 might change.
27443
27444 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27445 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27446 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27447 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27448
27449 @itemize @bullet
27450 @item
27451 New MI commands may be added.
27452
27453 @item
27454 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27455
27456 @item
27457 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27458 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27459
27460 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27461 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27462
27463 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27464 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27465 @end itemize
27466
27467 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27468 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27469 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27470 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27471 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27472
27473 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27474 @c version?
27475
27476 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27477 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27478 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27479 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27480 @cindex mailing lists
27481
27482 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27483 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27484 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27485
27486 @menu
27487 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27488 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27489 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27490 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27491 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27492 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27493 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27494 @end menu
27495
27496 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27497 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27498
27499 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27500 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27501 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27502 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27503
27504 @table @code
27505 @findex ^done
27506 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27507 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27508 values.
27509
27510 @item "^running"
27511 @findex ^running
27512 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27513 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27514 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27515 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27516 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27517 which threads are resumed.
27518
27519 @item "^connected"
27520 @findex ^connected
27521 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27522
27523 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27524 @findex ^error
27525 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27526 the corresponding error message.
27527
27528 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27529 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27530 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27531
27532 @table @samp
27533 @item "undefined-command"
27534 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27535 @end table
27536
27537 @item "^exit"
27538 @findex ^exit
27539 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27540
27541 @end table
27542
27543 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27544 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27545
27546 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27547 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27548 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27549 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27550 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27551
27552 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27553 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27554 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27555 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27556 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27557
27558 @table @code
27559 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27560 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27561 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27562
27563 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27564 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27565 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27566 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27567
27568 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27569 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27570 internals.
27571 @end table
27572
27573 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27574 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27575
27576 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27577 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27578 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27579 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27580 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27581 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27582
27583 The following is the list of possible async records:
27584
27585 @table @code
27586
27587 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27588 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27589 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27590 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27591 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27592 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27593 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27594 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27595 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27596 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27597 it run freely.
27598
27599 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27600 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27601 following values:
27602
27603 @table @code
27604 @item breakpoint-hit
27605 A breakpoint was reached.
27606 @item watchpoint-trigger
27607 A watchpoint was triggered.
27608 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27609 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27610 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27611 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27612 @item function-finished
27613 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27614 @item location-reached
27615 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27616 @item watchpoint-scope
27617 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27618 @item end-stepping-range
27619 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27620 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27621 @item exited-signalled
27622 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27623 @item exited
27624 The inferior exited.
27625 @item exited-normally
27626 The inferior exited normally.
27627 @item signal-received
27628 A signal was received by the inferior.
27629 @item solib-event
27630 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27631 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27632 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27633 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27634 @item fork
27635 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27636 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27637 @item vfork
27638 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27639 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27640 @item syscall-entry
27641 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27642 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27643 @item syscall-return
27644 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27645 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27646 @item exec
27647 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27648 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27649 @end table
27650
27651 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27652 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27653 Depending on whether all-stop
27654 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27655 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27656 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27657 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27658 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27659 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27660 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27661 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27662 if such information is not available.
27663
27664 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27665 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27666 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27667 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27668 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27669 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27670 cannot be used in any way.
27671
27672 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27673 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27674 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27675 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27676 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27677 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27678
27679 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27680 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27681 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27682 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27683 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27684 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27685
27686 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27687 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27688 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27689 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27690 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27691
27692 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27693 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27694 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27695 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27696 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27697 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27698 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27699 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27700 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27701
27702 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27703 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27704
27705 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27706 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27707 that thread.
27708
27709 @item =library-loaded,...
27710 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27711 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27712 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27713 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27714 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27715 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27716 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27717 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27718 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27719 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27720 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27721 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27722 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27723 to this library.
27724
27725 @item =library-unloaded,...
27726 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27727 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27728 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27729 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27730 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27731 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27732 thread groups.
27733
27734 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27735 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27736 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27737 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27738 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27739
27740 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27741 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27742 initial value @var{initial}.
27743
27744 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27745 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27746 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27747 trace state variables are deleted.
27748
27749 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27750 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27751 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27752 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27753 value of trace state variable is known.
27754
27755 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27756 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27757 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27758 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27759 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27760 user.
27761
27762 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27763 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27764 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27765
27766 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27767 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27768
27769 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27770 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27771 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27772 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27773 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27774
27775 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27776 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27777 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27778 for existing method and format values.
27779
27780 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27781 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27782 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27783 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27784 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27785 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27786
27787 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27788 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27789 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27790 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27791 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27792 executable code.
27793 @end table
27794
27795 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27796 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27797
27798 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27799 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27800 following fields:
27801
27802 @table @code
27803 @item number
27804 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27805 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27806 @samp{1.2}.
27807
27808 @item type
27809 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27810 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27811
27812 @item catch-type
27813 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27814 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27815
27816 @item disp
27817 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27818 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27819 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27820
27821 @item enabled
27822 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27823 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27824 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27825
27826 @item addr
27827 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27828 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27829 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27830 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27831 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27832
27833 @item func
27834 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27835 If not known, this field is not present.
27836
27837 @item filename
27838 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27839 If not known, this field is not present.
27840
27841 @item fullname
27842 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27843 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27844
27845 @item line
27846 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27847 If not known, this field is not present.
27848
27849 @item at
27850 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27851 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27852 by a symbol name.
27853
27854 @item pending
27855 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27856 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27857
27858 @item evaluated-by
27859 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27860 @samp{target}.
27861
27862 @item thread
27863 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27864 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27865
27866 @item task
27867 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27868 field will hold the task identifier.
27869
27870 @item cond
27871 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27872
27873 @item ignore
27874 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27875
27876 @item enable
27877 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27878
27879 @item traceframe-usage
27880 FIXME.
27881
27882 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27883 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27884
27885 @item mask
27886 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27887
27888 @item pass
27889 A tracepoint's pass count.
27890
27891 @item original-location
27892 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27893 This field is optional.
27894
27895 @item times
27896 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27897
27898 @item installed
27899 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27900 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27901 is not.
27902
27903 @item what
27904 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27905
27906 @end table
27907
27908 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27909 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27910
27911 @smallexample
27912 -> -break-insert main
27913 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27914 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27915 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27916 times="0"@}
27917 <- (gdb)
27918 @end smallexample
27919
27920 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27921 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27922
27923 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27924 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27925 fields:
27926
27927 @table @code
27928 @item level
27929 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27930 zero. This field is always present.
27931
27932 @item func
27933 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27934 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27935
27936 @item addr
27937 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27938
27939 @item file
27940 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27941 address. This field may be absent.
27942
27943 @item line
27944 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27945 may be absent.
27946
27947 @item from
27948 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27949 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27950
27951 @end table
27952
27953 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27954 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27955
27956 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27957 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27958 stated otherwise.
27959
27960 @table @code
27961 @item id
27962 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27963
27964 @item target-id
27965 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27966
27967 @item details
27968 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27969 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27970 frontend. This field is optional.
27971
27972 @item name
27973 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27974 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27975 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27976 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27977 field is omitted.
27978
27979 @item state
27980 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27981 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27982
27983 @item frame
27984 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27985 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27986 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27987
27988 @item core
27989 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27990 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27991 @end table
27992
27993 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27994 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27995
27996 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27997 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27998 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27999 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
28000 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
28001 the @code{exception-message} field.
28002
28003 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28004 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
28005 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
28006 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
28007
28008 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
28009 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
28010 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
28011 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
28012
28013 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
28014 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
28015
28016 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
28017
28018 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
28019 information of the breakpoint.
28020
28021 @smallexample
28022 -> -break-insert main
28023 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28024 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
28025 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
28026 times="0"@}
28027 <- (gdb)
28028 @end smallexample
28029
28030 @subheading Program Execution
28031
28032 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
28033 reason that execution stopped.
28034
28035 @smallexample
28036 -> -exec-run
28037 <- ^running
28038 <- (gdb)
28039 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
28040 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
28041 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
28042 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
28043 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28044 <- (gdb)
28045 -> -exec-continue
28046 <- ^running
28047 <- (gdb)
28048 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
28049 <- (gdb)
28050 @end smallexample
28051
28052 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
28053
28054 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
28055
28056 @smallexample
28057 -> (gdb)
28058 <- -gdb-exit
28059 <- ^exit
28060 @end smallexample
28061
28062 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
28063 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
28064 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
28065 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
28066 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28067 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28068
28069 @subheading A Bad Command
28070
28071 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28072
28073 @smallexample
28074 -> -rubbish
28075 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28076 <- (gdb)
28077 @end smallexample
28078
28079
28080 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28081 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28082 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28083
28084 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28085 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28086
28087 @subheading Motivation
28088
28089 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28090
28091 @subheading Introduction
28092
28093 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28094
28095 @subheading Commands
28096
28097 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28098
28099 @subsubheading Synopsis
28100
28101 @smallexample
28102 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28103 @end smallexample
28104
28105 @subsubheading Result
28106
28107 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28108
28109 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28110
28111 @subsubheading Example
28112
28113 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28114 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28115
28116
28117 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28118 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28119 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28120
28121 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28122 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28123 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28124 breakpoints.
28125
28126 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28127 @findex -break-after
28128
28129 @subsubheading Synopsis
28130
28131 @smallexample
28132 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28133 @end smallexample
28134
28135 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28136 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28137 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28138 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28139
28140 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28141
28142 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28143
28144 @subsubheading Example
28145
28146 @smallexample
28147 (gdb)
28148 -break-insert main
28149 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28150 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28151 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28152 times="0"@}
28153 (gdb)
28154 -break-after 1 3
28155 ~
28156 ^done
28157 (gdb)
28158 -break-list
28159 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28160 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28161 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28162 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28163 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28164 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28165 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28166 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28167 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28168 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28169 (gdb)
28170 @end smallexample
28171
28172 @ignore
28173 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28174 @findex -break-catch
28175 @end ignore
28176
28177 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28178 @findex -break-commands
28179
28180 @subsubheading Synopsis
28181
28182 @smallexample
28183 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28184 @end smallexample
28185
28186 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28187 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28188 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28189 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28190 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28191 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28192
28193 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28194
28195 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28196
28197 @subsubheading Example
28198
28199 @smallexample
28200 (gdb)
28201 -break-insert main
28202 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28203 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28204 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28205 times="0"@}
28206 (gdb)
28207 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28208 ^done
28209 (gdb)
28210 @end smallexample
28211
28212 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28213 @findex -break-condition
28214
28215 @subsubheading Synopsis
28216
28217 @smallexample
28218 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28219 @end smallexample
28220
28221 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28222 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28223 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28224 command below).
28225
28226 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28227
28228 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28229
28230 @subsubheading Example
28231
28232 @smallexample
28233 (gdb)
28234 -break-condition 1 1
28235 ^done
28236 (gdb)
28237 -break-list
28238 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28239 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28240 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28241 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28242 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28243 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28244 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28245 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28246 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28247 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28248 (gdb)
28249 @end smallexample
28250
28251 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28252 @findex -break-delete
28253
28254 @subsubheading Synopsis
28255
28256 @smallexample
28257 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28258 @end smallexample
28259
28260 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28261 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28262
28263 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28264
28265 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28266
28267 @subsubheading Example
28268
28269 @smallexample
28270 (gdb)
28271 -break-delete 1
28272 ^done
28273 (gdb)
28274 -break-list
28275 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28276 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28277 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28278 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28279 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28280 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28281 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28282 body=[]@}
28283 (gdb)
28284 @end smallexample
28285
28286 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28287 @findex -break-disable
28288
28289 @subsubheading Synopsis
28290
28291 @smallexample
28292 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28293 @end smallexample
28294
28295 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28296 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28297
28298 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28299
28300 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28301
28302 @subsubheading Example
28303
28304 @smallexample
28305 (gdb)
28306 -break-disable 2
28307 ^done
28308 (gdb)
28309 -break-list
28310 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28311 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28312 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28313 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28314 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28315 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28316 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28317 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28318 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28319 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28320 (gdb)
28321 @end smallexample
28322
28323 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28324 @findex -break-enable
28325
28326 @subsubheading Synopsis
28327
28328 @smallexample
28329 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28330 @end smallexample
28331
28332 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28333
28334 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28335
28336 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28337
28338 @subsubheading Example
28339
28340 @smallexample
28341 (gdb)
28342 -break-enable 2
28343 ^done
28344 (gdb)
28345 -break-list
28346 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28347 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28348 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28349 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28350 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28351 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28352 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28353 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28354 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28355 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28356 (gdb)
28357 @end smallexample
28358
28359 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28360 @findex -break-info
28361
28362 @subsubheading Synopsis
28363
28364 @smallexample
28365 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28366 @end smallexample
28367
28368 @c REDUNDANT???
28369 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28370
28371 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28372 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28373 table.
28374
28375 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28376
28377 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28378
28379 @subsubheading Example
28380 N.A.
28381
28382 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28383 @findex -break-insert
28384 @anchor{-break-insert}
28385
28386 @subsubheading Synopsis
28387
28388 @smallexample
28389 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28390 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28391 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28392 @end smallexample
28393
28394 @noindent
28395 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28396
28397 @table @var
28398 @item linespec location
28399 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28400
28401 @item explicit location
28402 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28403 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28404 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28405
28406 @table @samp
28407 @item --source @var{filename}
28408 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28409 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28410
28411 @item --function @var{function}
28412 The name of a function or method.
28413
28414 @item --label @var{label}
28415 The name of a label.
28416
28417 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28418 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28419 @end table
28420
28421 @item address location
28422 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28423 @end table
28424
28425 @noindent
28426 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28427
28428 @table @samp
28429 @item -t
28430 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28431 @item -h
28432 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28433 @item -f
28434 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28435 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28436 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28437 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28438 cannot be parsed.
28439 @item -d
28440 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28441 @item -a
28442 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28443 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28444 @item -c @var{condition}
28445 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28446 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28447 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28448 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28449 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28450 @var{thread-id}.
28451 @end table
28452
28453 @subsubheading Result
28454
28455 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28456 resulting breakpoint.
28457
28458 Note: this format is open to change.
28459 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28460
28461 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28462
28463 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28464 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28465
28466 @subsubheading Example
28467
28468 @smallexample
28469 (gdb)
28470 -break-insert main
28471 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28472 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28473 times="0"@}
28474 (gdb)
28475 -break-insert -t foo
28476 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28477 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28478 times="0"@}
28479 (gdb)
28480 -break-list
28481 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28482 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28483 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28484 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28485 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28486 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28487 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28488 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28489 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28490 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28491 times="0"@},
28492 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28493 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28494 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28495 times="0"@}]@}
28496 (gdb)
28497 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28498 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28499 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28500 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28501 @c times="0"@}
28502 @c (gdb)
28503 @end smallexample
28504
28505 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28506 @findex -dprintf-insert
28507
28508 @subsubheading Synopsis
28509
28510 @smallexample
28511 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28512 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28513 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28514 [ @var{argument} ]
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 @noindent
28518 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28519 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28520
28521 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28522
28523 @table @samp
28524 @item -t
28525 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28526 @item -f
28527 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28528 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28529 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28530 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28531 cannot be parsed.
28532 @item -d
28533 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28534 @item -c @var{condition}
28535 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28536 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28537 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28538 to @var{ignore-count}.
28539 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28540 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28541 @var{thread-id}.
28542 @end table
28543
28544 @subsubheading Result
28545
28546 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28547 resulting breakpoint.
28548
28549 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28550
28551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28552
28553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28554
28555 @subsubheading Example
28556
28557 @smallexample
28558 (gdb)
28559 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28560 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28561 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28562 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28563 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28564 original-location="foo"@}
28565 (gdb)
28566 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28567 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28568 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28569 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28570 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28571 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28572 (gdb)
28573 @end smallexample
28574
28575 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28576 @findex -break-list
28577
28578 @subsubheading Synopsis
28579
28580 @smallexample
28581 -break-list
28582 @end smallexample
28583
28584 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28585
28586 @table @samp
28587 @item Number
28588 number of the breakpoint
28589 @item Type
28590 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28591 @item Disposition
28592 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28593 or @samp{nokeep}
28594 @item Enabled
28595 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28596 @item Address
28597 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28598 @item What
28599 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28600 name, line number
28601 @item Thread-groups
28602 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28603 @item Times
28604 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28605 @end table
28606
28607 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28608 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28609
28610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28611
28612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28613
28614 @subsubheading Example
28615
28616 @smallexample
28617 (gdb)
28618 -break-list
28619 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28620 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28621 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28622 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28623 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28624 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28625 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28626 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28627 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28628 times="0"@},
28629 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28630 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28631 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28632 (gdb)
28633 @end smallexample
28634
28635 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28636
28637 @smallexample
28638 (gdb)
28639 -break-list
28640 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28641 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28642 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28643 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28644 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28645 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28646 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28647 body=[]@}
28648 (gdb)
28649 @end smallexample
28650
28651 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28652 @findex -break-passcount
28653
28654 @subsubheading Synopsis
28655
28656 @smallexample
28657 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28658 @end smallexample
28659
28660 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28661 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28662 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28663 command @samp{passcount}.
28664
28665 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28666 @findex -break-watch
28667
28668 @subsubheading Synopsis
28669
28670 @smallexample
28671 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28672 @end smallexample
28673
28674 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28675 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28676 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28677 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28678 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28679 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28680 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28681 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28682
28683 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28684 breakpoints inserted.
28685
28686 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28687
28688 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28689 @samp{rwatch}.
28690
28691 @subsubheading Example
28692
28693 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28694
28695 @smallexample
28696 (gdb)
28697 -break-watch x
28698 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28699 (gdb)
28700 -exec-continue
28701 ^running
28702 (gdb)
28703 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28704 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28705 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28706 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28707 (gdb)
28708 @end smallexample
28709
28710 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28711 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28712 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28713
28714 @smallexample
28715 (gdb)
28716 -break-watch C
28717 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28718 (gdb)
28719 -exec-continue
28720 ^running
28721 (gdb)
28722 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28723 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28724 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28725 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28726 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28727 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28728 (gdb)
28729 -exec-continue
28730 ^running
28731 (gdb)
28732 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28733 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28734 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28735 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28736 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28737 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28738 (gdb)
28739 @end smallexample
28740
28741 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28742 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28743 deleted.
28744
28745 @smallexample
28746 (gdb)
28747 -break-watch C
28748 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28749 (gdb)
28750 -break-list
28751 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28752 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28753 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28754 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28755 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28756 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28757 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28758 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28759 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28760 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28761 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28762 times="1"@},
28763 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28764 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28765 (gdb)
28766 -exec-continue
28767 ^running
28768 (gdb)
28769 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28770 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28771 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28772 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28773 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
28774 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28775 (gdb)
28776 -break-list
28777 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28778 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28779 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28780 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28781 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28782 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28783 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28784 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28785 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28786 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28787 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28788 times="1"@},
28789 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28790 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28791 (gdb)
28792 -exec-continue
28793 ^running
28794 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28795 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28796 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28797 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28798 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
28799 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
28800 (gdb)
28801 -break-list
28802 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28803 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28804 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28805 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28806 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28807 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28808 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28809 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28810 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28811 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28812 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28813 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28814 (gdb)
28815 @end smallexample
28816
28817
28818 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28819 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28820 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28821
28822 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28823 catchpoints.
28824
28825 @menu
28826 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28827 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28828 @end menu
28829
28830 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28831 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28832
28833 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28834 @findex -catch-load
28835
28836 @subsubheading Synopsis
28837
28838 @smallexample
28839 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28840 @end smallexample
28841
28842 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28843 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28844 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28845 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28846 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28847
28848
28849 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28850
28851 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28852
28853 @subsubheading Example
28854
28855 @smallexample
28856 -catch-load -t foo.so
28857 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28858 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28859 (gdb)
28860 @end smallexample
28861
28862
28863 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28864 @findex -catch-unload
28865
28866 @subsubheading Synopsis
28867
28868 @smallexample
28869 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28870 @end smallexample
28871
28872 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28873 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28874 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28875 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28876 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28877
28878 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28879
28880 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28881
28882 @subsubheading Example
28883
28884 @smallexample
28885 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28886 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28887 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28888 (gdb)
28889 @end smallexample
28890
28891 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28892 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28893
28894 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28895 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28896
28897 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28898 @findex -catch-assert
28899
28900 @subsubheading Synopsis
28901
28902 @smallexample
28903 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28904 @end smallexample
28905
28906 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28907
28908 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28909
28910 @table @samp
28911 @item -c @var{condition}
28912 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28913 @item -d
28914 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28915 @item -t
28916 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28917 @end table
28918
28919 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28920
28921 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28922
28923 @subsubheading Example
28924
28925 @smallexample
28926 -catch-assert
28927 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28928 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28929 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28930 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28931 (gdb)
28932 @end smallexample
28933
28934 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28935 @findex -catch-exception
28936
28937 @subsubheading Synopsis
28938
28939 @smallexample
28940 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28941 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28942 @end smallexample
28943
28944 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28945 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28946 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28947 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28948 catchpoints.
28949
28950 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28951
28952 @table @samp
28953 @item -c @var{condition}
28954 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28955 @item -d
28956 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28957 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28958 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28959 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28960 @item -t
28961 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28962 @item -u
28963 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28964 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28965 @end table
28966
28967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28968
28969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28970 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28971
28972 @subsubheading Example
28973
28974 @smallexample
28975 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28976 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28977 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28978 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28979 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28980 (gdb)
28981 @end smallexample
28982
28983 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
28984 @findex -catch-handlers
28985
28986 @subsubheading Synopsis
28987
28988 @smallexample
28989 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28990 [ -t ]
28991 @end smallexample
28992
28993 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
28994 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28995 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28996 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28997 catchpoints.
28998
28999 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
29000
29001 @table @samp
29002 @item -c @var{condition}
29003 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29004 @item -d
29005 Create a disabled catchpoint.
29006 @item -e @var{exception-name}
29007 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
29008 @item -t
29009 Create a temporary catchpoint.
29010 @end table
29011
29012 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29013
29014 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
29015
29016 @subsubheading Example
29017
29018 @smallexample
29019 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
29020 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29021 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
29022 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
29023 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
29024 (gdb)
29025 @end smallexample
29026
29027 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29028 @node GDB/MI Program Context
29029 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
29030
29031 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
29032 @findex -exec-arguments
29033
29034
29035 @subsubheading Synopsis
29036
29037 @smallexample
29038 -exec-arguments @var{args}
29039 @end smallexample
29040
29041 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
29042 @samp{-exec-run}.
29043
29044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29045
29046 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
29047
29048 @subsubheading Example
29049
29050 @smallexample
29051 (gdb)
29052 -exec-arguments -v word
29053 ^done
29054 (gdb)
29055 @end smallexample
29056
29057
29058 @ignore
29059 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
29060 @findex -exec-show-arguments
29061
29062 @subsubheading Synopsis
29063
29064 @smallexample
29065 -exec-show-arguments
29066 @end smallexample
29067
29068 Print the arguments of the program.
29069
29070 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29071
29072 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29073
29074 @subsubheading Example
29075 N.A.
29076 @end ignore
29077
29078
29079 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29080 @findex -environment-cd
29081
29082 @subsubheading Synopsis
29083
29084 @smallexample
29085 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29086 @end smallexample
29087
29088 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29089
29090 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29091
29092 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29093
29094 @subsubheading Example
29095
29096 @smallexample
29097 (gdb)
29098 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29099 ^done
29100 (gdb)
29101 @end smallexample
29102
29103
29104 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29105 @findex -environment-directory
29106
29107 @subsubheading Synopsis
29108
29109 @smallexample
29110 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29111 @end smallexample
29112
29113 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29114 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29115 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29116 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29117 occurs as normal.
29118 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29119 multiple directories in a single command
29120 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29121 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29122 If blanks are needed as
29123 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29124 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29125 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29126 character must not be used
29127 in any directory name.
29128 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29129
29130 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29131
29132 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29133
29134 @subsubheading Example
29135
29136 @smallexample
29137 (gdb)
29138 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29139 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29140 (gdb)
29141 -environment-directory ""
29142 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29143 (gdb)
29144 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29145 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29146 (gdb)
29147 -environment-directory -r
29148 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29149 (gdb)
29150 @end smallexample
29151
29152
29153 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29154 @findex -environment-path
29155
29156 @subsubheading Synopsis
29157
29158 @smallexample
29159 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29160 @end smallexample
29161
29162 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29163 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29164 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29165 supplied in addition to the
29166 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29167 occurs as normal.
29168 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29169 multiple directories in a single command
29170 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29171 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29172 If blanks are needed as
29173 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29174 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29175 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29176 character must not be used
29177 in any directory name.
29178 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29179
29180
29181 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29182
29183 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29184
29185 @subsubheading Example
29186
29187 @smallexample
29188 (gdb)
29189 -environment-path
29190 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29191 (gdb)
29192 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29193 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29194 (gdb)
29195 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29196 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29197 (gdb)
29198 @end smallexample
29199
29200
29201 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29202 @findex -environment-pwd
29203
29204 @subsubheading Synopsis
29205
29206 @smallexample
29207 -environment-pwd
29208 @end smallexample
29209
29210 Show the current working directory.
29211
29212 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29213
29214 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29215
29216 @subsubheading Example
29217
29218 @smallexample
29219 (gdb)
29220 -environment-pwd
29221 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29222 (gdb)
29223 @end smallexample
29224
29225 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29226 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29227 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29228
29229
29230 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29231 @findex -thread-info
29232
29233 @subsubheading Synopsis
29234
29235 @smallexample
29236 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29237 @end smallexample
29238
29239 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29240 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29241 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29242 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29243 current thread.
29244
29245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29246
29247 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29248 about all threads.
29249
29250 @subsubheading Result
29251
29252 The result contains the following attributes:
29253
29254 @table @samp
29255 @item threads
29256 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29257 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29258
29259 @item current-thread-id
29260 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29261 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29262 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29263 the command.
29264
29265 @end table
29266
29267 @subsubheading Example
29268
29269 @smallexample
29270 -thread-info
29271 ^done,threads=[
29272 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29273 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29274 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29275 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29276 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29277 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29278 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29279 state="running"@}],
29280 current-thread-id="1"
29281 (gdb)
29282 @end smallexample
29283
29284 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29285 @findex -thread-list-ids
29286
29287 @subsubheading Synopsis
29288
29289 @smallexample
29290 -thread-list-ids
29291 @end smallexample
29292
29293 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29294 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29295 threads.
29296
29297 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29298 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29299
29300 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29301
29302 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29303
29304 @subsubheading Example
29305
29306 @smallexample
29307 (gdb)
29308 -thread-list-ids
29309 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29310 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29311 (gdb)
29312 @end smallexample
29313
29314
29315 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29316 @findex -thread-select
29317
29318 @subsubheading Synopsis
29319
29320 @smallexample
29321 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29322 @end smallexample
29323
29324 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29325 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29326 topmost frame for that thread.
29327
29328 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29329 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29330
29331 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29332
29333 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29334
29335 @subsubheading Example
29336
29337 @smallexample
29338 (gdb)
29339 -exec-next
29340 ^running
29341 (gdb)
29342 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29343 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29344 (gdb)
29345 -thread-list-ids
29346 ^done,
29347 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29348 number-of-threads="3"
29349 (gdb)
29350 -thread-select 3
29351 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29352 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29353 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29354 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29355 (gdb)
29356 @end smallexample
29357
29358 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29359 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29360 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29361
29362 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29363 @findex -ada-task-info
29364
29365 @subsubheading Synopsis
29366
29367 @smallexample
29368 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29369 @end smallexample
29370
29371 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29372 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29373
29374 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29375
29376 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29377 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29378
29379 @subsubheading Result
29380
29381 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29382 defined for each Ada task:
29383
29384 @table @samp
29385 @item current
29386 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29387
29388 @item id
29389 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29390
29391 @item task-id
29392 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29393
29394 @item thread-id
29395 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29396 task.
29397
29398 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29399 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29400 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29401
29402 @item parent-id
29403 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29404 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29405
29406 @item priority
29407 The base priority of the task.
29408
29409 @item state
29410 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29411 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29412
29413 @item name
29414 The name of the task.
29415
29416 @end table
29417
29418 @subsubheading Example
29419
29420 @smallexample
29421 -ada-task-info
29422 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29423 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29424 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29425 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29426 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29427 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29428 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29429 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29430 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29431 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29432 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29433 (gdb)
29434 @end smallexample
29435
29436 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29437 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29438 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29439
29440 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29441 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29442 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29443 other cases.
29444
29445 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29446 @findex -exec-continue
29447
29448 @subsubheading Synopsis
29449
29450 @smallexample
29451 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29452 @end smallexample
29453
29454 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29455 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29456 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29457 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29458 @itemize @bullet
29459 @item
29460 breakpoints or watchpoints
29461 @item
29462 signals or exceptions
29463 @item
29464 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29465 @item
29466 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29467 @end itemize
29468 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29469 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29470 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29471 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29472 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29473 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29474
29475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29476
29477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29478
29479 @subsubheading Example
29480
29481 @smallexample
29482 -exec-continue
29483 ^running
29484 (gdb)
29485 @@Hello world
29486 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29487 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29488 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29489 (gdb)
29490 @end smallexample
29491
29492
29493 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29494 @findex -exec-finish
29495
29496 @subsubheading Synopsis
29497
29498 @smallexample
29499 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29500 @end smallexample
29501
29502 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29503 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29504 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29505 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29506 function was called.
29507
29508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29509
29510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29511
29512 @subsubheading Example
29513
29514 Function returning @code{void}.
29515
29516 @smallexample
29517 -exec-finish
29518 ^running
29519 (gdb)
29520 @@hello from foo
29521 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29522 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29523 (gdb)
29524 @end smallexample
29525
29526 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29527 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29528 value itself.
29529
29530 @smallexample
29531 -exec-finish
29532 ^running
29533 (gdb)
29534 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29535 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29536 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
29537 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
29538 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29539 (gdb)
29540 @end smallexample
29541
29542
29543 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29544 @findex -exec-interrupt
29545
29546 @subsubheading Synopsis
29547
29548 @smallexample
29549 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29550 @end smallexample
29551
29552 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29553 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29554 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29555 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29556 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29557
29558 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29559 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29560 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29561 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29562
29563 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29564 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29565 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29566 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29567
29568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29569
29570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29571
29572 @subsubheading Example
29573
29574 @smallexample
29575 (gdb)
29576 111-exec-continue
29577 111^running
29578
29579 (gdb)
29580 222-exec-interrupt
29581 222^done
29582 (gdb)
29583 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29584 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29585 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29586 (gdb)
29587
29588 (gdb)
29589 -exec-interrupt
29590 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29591 (gdb)
29592 @end smallexample
29593
29594 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29595 @findex -exec-jump
29596
29597 @subsubheading Synopsis
29598
29599 @smallexample
29600 -exec-jump @var{location}
29601 @end smallexample
29602
29603 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29604 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29605 different forms of @var{location}.
29606
29607 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29608
29609 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29610
29611 @subsubheading Example
29612
29613 @smallexample
29614 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29615 *running,thread-id="all"
29616 ^running
29617 @end smallexample
29618
29619
29620 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29621 @findex -exec-next
29622
29623 @subsubheading Synopsis
29624
29625 @smallexample
29626 -exec-next [--reverse]
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29630 of the next source line is reached.
29631
29632 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29633 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29634 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29635 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29636 source line where the function was called.
29637
29638
29639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29640
29641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29642
29643 @subsubheading Example
29644
29645 @smallexample
29646 -exec-next
29647 ^running
29648 (gdb)
29649 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29650 (gdb)
29651 @end smallexample
29652
29653
29654 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29655 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29656
29657 @subsubheading Synopsis
29658
29659 @smallexample
29660 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29661 @end smallexample
29662
29663 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29664 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29665 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29666 printed as well.
29667
29668 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29669 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29670 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29671 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29672 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29673
29674 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29675
29676 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29677
29678 @subsubheading Example
29679
29680 @smallexample
29681 (gdb)
29682 -exec-next-instruction
29683 ^running
29684
29685 (gdb)
29686 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29687 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29688 (gdb)
29689 @end smallexample
29690
29691
29692 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29693 @findex -exec-return
29694
29695 @subsubheading Synopsis
29696
29697 @smallexample
29698 -exec-return
29699 @end smallexample
29700
29701 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29702 Displays the new current frame.
29703
29704 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29705
29706 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29707
29708 @subsubheading Example
29709
29710 @smallexample
29711 (gdb)
29712 200-break-insert callee4
29713 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29714 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29715 (gdb)
29716 000-exec-run
29717 000^running
29718 (gdb)
29719 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29720 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29721 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29722 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
29723 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29724 (gdb)
29725 205-break-delete
29726 205^done
29727 (gdb)
29728 111-exec-return
29729 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29730 args=[@{name="strarg",
29731 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29732 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29733 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29734 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29735 (gdb)
29736 @end smallexample
29737
29738
29739 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29740 @findex -exec-run
29741
29742 @subsubheading Synopsis
29743
29744 @smallexample
29745 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29746 @end smallexample
29747
29748 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29749 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29750 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29751 the program has exited exceptionally.
29752
29753 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29754 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29755 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29756 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29757 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29758
29759 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29760 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29761 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29762 (@pxref{Starting}).
29763
29764 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29765
29766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29767
29768 @subsubheading Examples
29769
29770 @smallexample
29771 (gdb)
29772 -break-insert main
29773 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29774 (gdb)
29775 -exec-run
29776 ^running
29777 (gdb)
29778 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29779 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29780 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29781 (gdb)
29782 @end smallexample
29783
29784 @noindent
29785 Program exited normally:
29786
29787 @smallexample
29788 (gdb)
29789 -exec-run
29790 ^running
29791 (gdb)
29792 x = 55
29793 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29794 (gdb)
29795 @end smallexample
29796
29797 @noindent
29798 Program exited exceptionally:
29799
29800 @smallexample
29801 (gdb)
29802 -exec-run
29803 ^running
29804 (gdb)
29805 x = 55
29806 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29807 (gdb)
29808 @end smallexample
29809
29810 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29811 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29812
29813 @smallexample
29814 (gdb)
29815 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29816 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29817 @end smallexample
29818
29819
29820 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29821
29822
29823 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29824 @findex -exec-step
29825
29826 @subsubheading Synopsis
29827
29828 @smallexample
29829 -exec-step [--reverse]
29830 @end smallexample
29831
29832 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29833 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29834 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29835 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29836 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29837 previously executed source line.
29838
29839 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29840
29841 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29842
29843 @subsubheading Example
29844
29845 Stepping into a function:
29846
29847 @smallexample
29848 -exec-step
29849 ^running
29850 (gdb)
29851 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29852 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29853 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29854 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29855 (gdb)
29856 @end smallexample
29857
29858 Regular stepping:
29859
29860 @smallexample
29861 -exec-step
29862 ^running
29863 (gdb)
29864 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29865 (gdb)
29866 @end smallexample
29867
29868
29869 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29870 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29871
29872 @subsubheading Synopsis
29873
29874 @smallexample
29875 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29876 @end smallexample
29877
29878 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29879 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29880 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29881 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29882 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29883 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29884 as well.
29885
29886 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29887
29888 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29889
29890 @subsubheading Example
29891
29892 @smallexample
29893 (gdb)
29894 -exec-step-instruction
29895 ^running
29896
29897 (gdb)
29898 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29899 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29900 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29901 (gdb)
29902 -exec-step-instruction
29903 ^running
29904
29905 (gdb)
29906 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29907 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29908 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29909 (gdb)
29910 @end smallexample
29911
29912
29913 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29914 @findex -exec-until
29915
29916 @subsubheading Synopsis
29917
29918 @smallexample
29919 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29920 @end smallexample
29921
29922 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29923 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29924 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29925 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29926
29927 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29928
29929 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29930
29931 @subsubheading Example
29932
29933 @smallexample
29934 (gdb)
29935 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29936 ^running
29937 (gdb)
29938 x = 55
29939 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29940 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
29941 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29942 (gdb)
29943 @end smallexample
29944
29945 @ignore
29946 @subheading -file-clear
29947 Is this going away????
29948 @end ignore
29949
29950 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29951 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29952 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29953
29954 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29955 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29956
29957 @smallexample
29958 -enable-frame-filters
29959 @end smallexample
29960
29961 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29962 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29963 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29964 request that this functionality be enabled.
29965
29966 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29967
29968 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29969 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29970
29971 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29972 @findex -stack-info-frame
29973
29974 @subsubheading Synopsis
29975
29976 @smallexample
29977 -stack-info-frame
29978 @end smallexample
29979
29980 Get info on the selected frame.
29981
29982 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29983
29984 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29985 (without arguments).
29986
29987 @subsubheading Example
29988
29989 @smallexample
29990 (gdb)
29991 -stack-info-frame
29992 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29993 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29994 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
29995 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29996 (gdb)
29997 @end smallexample
29998
29999 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
30000 @findex -stack-info-depth
30001
30002 @subsubheading Synopsis
30003
30004 @smallexample
30005 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
30006 @end smallexample
30007
30008 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
30009 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
30010
30011 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30012
30013 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
30014
30015 @subsubheading Example
30016
30017 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
30018
30019 @smallexample
30020 (gdb)
30021 -stack-info-depth
30022 ^done,depth="12"
30023 (gdb)
30024 -stack-info-depth 4
30025 ^done,depth="4"
30026 (gdb)
30027 -stack-info-depth 12
30028 ^done,depth="12"
30029 (gdb)
30030 -stack-info-depth 11
30031 ^done,depth="11"
30032 (gdb)
30033 -stack-info-depth 13
30034 ^done,depth="12"
30035 (gdb)
30036 @end smallexample
30037
30038 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
30039 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
30040 @findex -stack-list-arguments
30041
30042 @subsubheading Synopsis
30043
30044 @smallexample
30045 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30046 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30047 @end smallexample
30048
30049 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
30050 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
30051 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
30052 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
30053 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
30054 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
30055 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
30056 which case only existing frames will be returned.
30057
30058 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30059 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30060 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30061 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30062 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30063 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30064
30065 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
30066 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
30067 are still displayed, however.
30068
30069 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
30070 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30071
30072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30073
30074 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
30075 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30076 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30077
30078 @subsubheading Example
30079
30080 @smallexample
30081 (gdb)
30082 -stack-list-frames
30083 ^done,
30084 stack=[
30085 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30086 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30087 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30088 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30089 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30090 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30091 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
30092 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30093 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30094 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30095 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
30096 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30097 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30098 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30099 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
30100 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30101 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30102 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30103 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
30104 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30105 (gdb)
30106 -stack-list-arguments 0
30107 ^done,
30108 stack-args=[
30109 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30110 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30111 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30112 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30113 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30114 (gdb)
30115 -stack-list-arguments 1
30116 ^done,
30117 stack-args=[
30118 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30119 frame=@{level="1",
30120 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30121 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30122 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30123 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30124 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30125 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30126 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30127 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30128 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30129 (gdb)
30130 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30131 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30132 (gdb)
30133 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30134 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30135 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30136 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30137 (gdb)
30138 @end smallexample
30139
30140 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30141
30142
30143 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30144 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30145 @findex -stack-list-frames
30146
30147 @subsubheading Synopsis
30148
30149 @smallexample
30150 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30151 @end smallexample
30152
30153 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30154 following info:
30155
30156 @table @samp
30157 @item @var{level}
30158 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30159 @item @var{addr}
30160 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30161 @item @var{func}
30162 Function name.
30163 @item @var{file}
30164 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30165 @item @var{fullname}
30166 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30167 @item @var{line}
30168 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30169 @item @var{from}
30170 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30171 if the frame's function is not known.
30172 @item @var{arch}
30173 Frame's architecture.
30174 @end table
30175
30176 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30177 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30178 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30179 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30180 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30181 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30182 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30183 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30184 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30185
30186 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30187
30188 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30189
30190 @subsubheading Example
30191
30192 Full stack backtrace:
30193
30194 @smallexample
30195 (gdb)
30196 -stack-list-frames
30197 ^done,stack=
30198 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30199 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
30200 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30201 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30202 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30203 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30204 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30205 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30206 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30207 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30208 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30209 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30210 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30211 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30212 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30213 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30214 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30215 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30216 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30217 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30218 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30219 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30220 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30221 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30222 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30223 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30224 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30225 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30226 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30227 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30228 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30229 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30230 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30231 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30232 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
30233 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30234 (gdb)
30235 @end smallexample
30236
30237 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30238
30239 @smallexample
30240 (gdb)
30241 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30242 ^done,stack=
30243 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30244 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30245 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30246 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30247 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30248 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30249 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30250 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30251 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30252 (gdb)
30253 @end smallexample
30254
30255 Show a single frame:
30256
30257 @smallexample
30258 (gdb)
30259 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30260 ^done,stack=
30261 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30262 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30263 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
30264 (gdb)
30265 @end smallexample
30266
30267
30268 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30269 @findex -stack-list-locals
30270 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30271
30272 @subsubheading Synopsis
30273
30274 @smallexample
30275 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30276 @end smallexample
30277
30278 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30279 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30280 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30281 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30282 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30283 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30284 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30285 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30286 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30287 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30288
30289 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30290 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30291 variables are still displayed, however.
30292
30293 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30294 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30295
30296 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30297
30298 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30299
30300 @subsubheading Example
30301
30302 @smallexample
30303 (gdb)
30304 -stack-list-locals 0
30305 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30306 (gdb)
30307 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30308 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30309 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30310 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30311 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30312 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30313 (gdb)
30314 @end smallexample
30315
30316 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30317 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30318 @findex -stack-list-variables
30319
30320 @subsubheading Synopsis
30321
30322 @smallexample
30323 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30324 @end smallexample
30325
30326 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30327 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30328 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30329 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30330 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30331 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30332 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30333
30334 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30335 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30336 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30337
30338 @subsubheading Example
30339
30340 @smallexample
30341 (gdb)
30342 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30343 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30344 (gdb)
30345 @end smallexample
30346
30347
30348 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30349 @findex -stack-select-frame
30350
30351 @subsubheading Synopsis
30352
30353 @smallexample
30354 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30355 @end smallexample
30356
30357 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30358 the stack.
30359
30360 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30361 option to every command.
30362
30363 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30364
30365 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30366 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30367
30368 @subsubheading Example
30369
30370 @smallexample
30371 (gdb)
30372 -stack-select-frame 2
30373 ^done
30374 (gdb)
30375 @end smallexample
30376
30377 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30378 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30379 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30380
30381 @ignore
30382
30383 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30384
30385 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30386 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30387 used by @code{Insight}.
30388
30389 The two main reasons for that are:
30390
30391 @enumerate 1
30392 @item
30393 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30394
30395 @item
30396 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30397 now).
30398 @end enumerate
30399
30400 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30401 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30402 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30403 hints about their use.
30404
30405 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30406 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30407 least, the following operations:
30408
30409 @itemize @bullet
30410 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30411 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30412 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30413 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30414 @end itemize
30415
30416 @end ignore
30417
30418 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30419
30420 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30421
30422 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30423 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30424 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30425 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30426 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30427 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30428 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30429 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30430 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30431 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30432 object, or to change display format.
30433
30434 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30435 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30436 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30437 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30438 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30439 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30440 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30441 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30442 child will be created.
30443
30444 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30445 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30446 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30447 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30448 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30449
30450 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30451 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30452 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30453 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30454 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30455 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30456 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30457 variables that frontend has created.
30458
30459 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30460 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30461 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30462 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30463 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30464 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30465 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30466 implicitly updated.
30467
30468 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30469 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30470 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30471 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30472 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30473 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30474 frame. Consider this example:
30475
30476 @smallexample
30477 void do_work(...)
30478 @{
30479 struct work_state state;
30480
30481 if (...)
30482 do_work(...);
30483 @}
30484 @end smallexample
30485
30486 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30487 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30488 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30489 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30490 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30491
30492 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30493 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30494 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30495 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30496 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30497 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30498
30499 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30500 access this functionality:
30501
30502 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30503 @item @strong{Operation}
30504 @tab @strong{Description}
30505
30506 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30507 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30508 @item @code{-var-create}
30509 @tab create a variable object
30510 @item @code{-var-delete}
30511 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30512 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30513 @tab set the display format of this variable
30514 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30515 @tab show the display format of this variable
30516 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30517 @tab tells how many children this object has
30518 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30519 @tab return a list of the object's children
30520 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30521 @tab show the type of this variable object
30522 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30523 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30524 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30525 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30526 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30527 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30528 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30529 @tab get the value of this variable
30530 @item @code{-var-assign}
30531 @tab set the value of this variable
30532 @item @code{-var-update}
30533 @tab update the variable and its children
30534 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30535 @tab set frozeness attribute
30536 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30537 @tab set range of children to display on update
30538 @end multitable
30539
30540 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30541 how it can be used.
30542
30543 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30544
30545 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30546 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30547
30548 @smallexample
30549 -enable-pretty-printing
30550 @end smallexample
30551
30552 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30553 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30554 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30555 request that this functionality be enabled.
30556
30557 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30558
30559 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30560 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30561
30562 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30563 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30564
30565 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30566 @findex -var-create
30567
30568 @subsubheading Synopsis
30569
30570 @smallexample
30571 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30572 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30573 @end smallexample
30574
30575 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30576 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30577 register.
30578
30579 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30580 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30581 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30582 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30583 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30584
30585 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30586 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30587 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30588 object must be created.
30589
30590 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30591 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30592
30593 @itemize @bullet
30594 @item
30595 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30596
30597 @item
30598 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30599
30600 @item
30601 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30602 @end itemize
30603
30604 @cindex dynamic varobj
30605 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30606 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30607 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30608 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30609 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30610 compatibility for existing clients.
30611
30612 @subsubheading Result
30613
30614 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30615 are:
30616
30617 @table @samp
30618 @item name
30619 The name of the varobj.
30620
30621 @item numchild
30622 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30623 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30624 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30625
30626 @item value
30627 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30628 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30629 will not be interesting.
30630
30631 @item type
30632 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30633 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30634 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30635 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30636 @emph{declared} one.
30637
30638 @item thread-id
30639 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30640 thread's global identifier.
30641
30642 @item has_more
30643 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30644 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30645
30646 @item dynamic
30647 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30648 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30649 then this attribute will not be present.
30650
30651 @item displayhint
30652 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30653 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30654 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30655 @end table
30656
30657 Typical output will look like this:
30658
30659 @smallexample
30660 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30661 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30662 @end smallexample
30663
30664
30665 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30666 @findex -var-delete
30667
30668 @subsubheading Synopsis
30669
30670 @smallexample
30671 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30672 @end smallexample
30673
30674 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30675 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30676
30677 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30678
30679
30680 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30681 @findex -var-set-format
30682
30683 @subsubheading Synopsis
30684
30685 @smallexample
30686 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30687 @end smallexample
30688
30689 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30690 @var{format-spec}.
30691
30692 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30693 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30694
30695 @smallexample
30696 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30697 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30698 @end smallexample
30699
30700 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30701 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30702 for pointers, etc.).
30703
30704 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30705 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30706 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30707 zero-hexadecimal format.
30708
30709 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30710 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30711
30712 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30713 @findex -var-show-format
30714
30715 @subsubheading Synopsis
30716
30717 @smallexample
30718 -var-show-format @var{name}
30719 @end smallexample
30720
30721 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30722
30723 @smallexample
30724 @var{format} @expansion{}
30725 @var{format-spec}
30726 @end smallexample
30727
30728
30729 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30730 @findex -var-info-num-children
30731
30732 @subsubheading Synopsis
30733
30734 @smallexample
30735 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30736 @end smallexample
30737
30738 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30739
30740 @smallexample
30741 numchild=@var{n}
30742 @end smallexample
30743
30744 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30745 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30746 be available.
30747
30748
30749 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30750 @findex -var-list-children
30751
30752 @subsubheading Synopsis
30753
30754 @smallexample
30755 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30756 @end smallexample
30757 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30758
30759 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30760 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30761 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30762 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30763 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30764 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30765 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30766 and unions.
30767
30768 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30769 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30770 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30771 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30772 reported.
30773
30774 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30775 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30776 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30777 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30778 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30779 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30780 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30781 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30782 the visible items.
30783
30784 For each child the following results are returned:
30785
30786 @table @var
30787
30788 @item name
30789 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30790
30791 @item exp
30792 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30793 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30794
30795 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30796 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30797
30798 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30799 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30800 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30801 type and value are not present.
30802
30803 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30804 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30805 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30806
30807 @item numchild
30808 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30809 0.
30810
30811 @item type
30812 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30813 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30814 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30815 @emph{declared} one.
30816
30817 @item value
30818 If values were requested, this is the value.
30819
30820 @item thread-id
30821 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30822 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30823
30824 @item frozen
30825 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30826
30827 @item displayhint
30828 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30829 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30830 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30831
30832 @item dynamic
30833 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30834 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30835 then this attribute will not be present.
30836
30837 @end table
30838
30839 The result may have its own attributes:
30840
30841 @table @samp
30842 @item displayhint
30843 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30844 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30845 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30846
30847 @item has_more
30848 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30849 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30850 @end table
30851
30852 @subsubheading Example
30853
30854 @smallexample
30855 (gdb)
30856 -var-list-children n
30857 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30858 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30859 (gdb)
30860 -var-list-children --all-values n
30861 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30862 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30863 @end smallexample
30864
30865
30866 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30867 @findex -var-info-type
30868
30869 @subsubheading Synopsis
30870
30871 @smallexample
30872 -var-info-type @var{name}
30873 @end smallexample
30874
30875 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30876 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30877 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30878
30879 @smallexample
30880 type=@var{typename}
30881 @end smallexample
30882
30883
30884 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30885 @findex -var-info-expression
30886
30887 @subsubheading Synopsis
30888
30889 @smallexample
30890 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30891 @end smallexample
30892
30893 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30894 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30895 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30896
30897 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30898 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30899
30900 @smallexample
30901 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30902 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30903 @end smallexample
30904
30905 @noindent
30906 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30907 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30908
30909 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30910 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30911 is of limited use.
30912
30913 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30914 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30915
30916 @subsubheading Synopsis
30917
30918 @smallexample
30919 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30920 @end smallexample
30921
30922 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30923 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30924 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30925 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30926 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30927 watchpoint from a variable object.
30928
30929 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30930 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30931
30932 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30933 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30934 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30935 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30936 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30937 @smallexample
30938 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30939 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30940 @end smallexample
30941
30942 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30943 @findex -var-show-attributes
30944
30945 @subsubheading Synopsis
30946
30947 @smallexample
30948 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30949 @end smallexample
30950
30951 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30952
30953 @smallexample
30954 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30955 @end smallexample
30956
30957 @noindent
30958 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30959
30960 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30961 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30962
30963 @subsubheading Synopsis
30964
30965 @smallexample
30966 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30967 @end smallexample
30968
30969 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30970 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30971 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30972 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30973 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30974 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30975 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30976
30977 @smallexample
30978 value=@var{value}
30979 @end smallexample
30980
30981 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30982 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30983
30984 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30985 @findex -var-assign
30986
30987 @subsubheading Synopsis
30988
30989 @smallexample
30990 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30991 @end smallexample
30992
30993 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30994 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30995 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30996 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30997
30998 @subsubheading Example
30999
31000 @smallexample
31001 (gdb)
31002 -var-assign var1 3
31003 ^done,value="3"
31004 (gdb)
31005 -var-update *
31006 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
31007 (gdb)
31008 @end smallexample
31009
31010 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
31011 @findex -var-update
31012
31013 @subsubheading Synopsis
31014
31015 @smallexample
31016 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
31017 @end smallexample
31018
31019 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
31020 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
31021 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
31022 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
31023 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
31024 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
31025 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
31026 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
31027 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
31028 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
31029 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
31030 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
31031 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
31032
31033 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
31034 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
31035 diagnostic.
31036
31037 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
31038 only the selected range of children will be reported.
31039
31040 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
31041 @samp{changelist}.
31042
31043 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
31044
31045 @table @samp
31046 @item name
31047 The name of the varobj.
31048
31049 @item value
31050 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
31051 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
31052
31053 @item in_scope
31054 @anchor{-var-update}
31055 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
31056
31057 @table @code
31058 @item "true"
31059 The variable object's current value is valid.
31060
31061 @item "false"
31062 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
31063 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
31064 scope.
31065
31066 @item "invalid"
31067 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
31068 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
31069 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
31070 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
31071 objects.
31072 @end table
31073
31074 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
31075 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
31076
31077 @item type_changed
31078 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
31079 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
31080 be @samp{false}.
31081
31082 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
31083 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
31084 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
31085 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
31086 unset.
31087
31088 @item new_type
31089 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
31090 hold the new type.
31091
31092 @item new_num_children
31093 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
31094 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
31095
31096 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
31097 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
31098 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31099 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31100 children which may be available.
31101
31102 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31103 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31104 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31105 only happen at the end of the update range).
31106
31107 @item displayhint
31108 The display hint, if any.
31109
31110 @item has_more
31111 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31112 available outside the varobj's update range.
31113
31114 @item dynamic
31115 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31116 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31117 then this attribute will not be present.
31118
31119 @item new_children
31120 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31121 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31122 be listed in this attribute.
31123 @end table
31124
31125 @subsubheading Example
31126
31127 @smallexample
31128 (gdb)
31129 -var-assign var1 3
31130 ^done,value="3"
31131 (gdb)
31132 -var-update --all-values var1
31133 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31134 type_changed="false"@}]
31135 (gdb)
31136 @end smallexample
31137
31138 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31139 @findex -var-set-frozen
31140 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31141
31142 @subsubheading Synopsis
31143
31144 @smallexample
31145 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31146 @end smallexample
31147
31148 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31149 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31150 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31151 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31152 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31153 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31154 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31155 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31156 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31157 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31158 @code{-var-update} does.
31159
31160 @subsubheading Example
31161
31162 @smallexample
31163 (gdb)
31164 -var-set-frozen V 1
31165 ^done
31166 (gdb)
31167 @end smallexample
31168
31169 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31170 @findex -var-set-update-range
31171 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31172
31173 @subsubheading Synopsis
31174
31175 @smallexample
31176 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31177 @end smallexample
31178
31179 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31180 @code{-var-update}.
31181
31182 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31183 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31184 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31185 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31186
31187 @subsubheading Example
31188
31189 @smallexample
31190 (gdb)
31191 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31192 ^done
31193 @end smallexample
31194
31195 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31196 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31197 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31198
31199 @subsubheading Synopsis
31200
31201 @smallexample
31202 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31203 @end smallexample
31204
31205 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31206
31207 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31208 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31209
31210 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31211 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31212 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31213 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31214 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31215 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31216 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31217
31218 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31219 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31220 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31221 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31222
31223 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31224 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31225 can be used to check this.
31226
31227 @subsubheading Example
31228
31229 Resetting the visualizer:
31230
31231 @smallexample
31232 (gdb)
31233 -var-set-visualizer V None
31234 ^done
31235 @end smallexample
31236
31237 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31238
31239 @smallexample
31240 (gdb)
31241 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31242 ^done
31243 @end smallexample
31244
31245 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31246 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31247
31248 @smallexample
31249 (gdb)
31250 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31251 ^done
31252 @end smallexample
31253
31254 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31255 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31256 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31257
31258 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31259 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31260 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31261 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31262
31263 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31264 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31265
31266 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31267 @c @subheading -data-assign
31268 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31269 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31270 @c set variable
31271 @c @subsubheading Example
31272 @c N.A.
31273
31274 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31275 @findex -data-disassemble
31276
31277 @subsubheading Synopsis
31278
31279 @smallexample
31280 -data-disassemble
31281 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31282 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
31283 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31284 -- @var{mode}
31285 @end smallexample
31286
31287 @noindent
31288 Where:
31289
31290 @table @samp
31291 @item @var{start-addr}
31292 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31293 @item @var{end-addr}
31294 is the end address
31295 @item @var{addr}
31296 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
31297 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
31298 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
31299 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
31300 @item @var{filename}
31301 is the name of the file to disassemble
31302 @item @var{linenum}
31303 is the line number to disassemble around
31304 @item @var{lines}
31305 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31306 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31307 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31308 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31309 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31310 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31311 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31312 are displayed.
31313 @item @var{mode}
31314 is one of:
31315 @itemize @bullet
31316 @item 0 disassembly only
31317 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31318 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31319 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31320 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31321 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31322 @end itemize
31323
31324 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31325 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31326 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31327 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31328 @end table
31329
31330 @subsubheading Result
31331
31332 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31333 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31334 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31335
31336 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31337 following fields:
31338
31339 @table @code
31340 @item address
31341 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31342
31343 @item func-name
31344 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31345
31346 @item offset
31347 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31348
31349 @item inst
31350 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31351
31352 @item opcodes
31353 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31354 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31355
31356 @end table
31357
31358 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31359 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31360
31361 @table @code
31362 @item line
31363 The line number within @samp{file}.
31364
31365 @item file
31366 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31367 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31368 used.
31369
31370 @item fullname
31371 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31372 using the source file search path
31373 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31374 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31375
31376 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31377 present in the debug information.
31378
31379 @item line_asm_insn
31380 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31381 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31382 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31383 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31384 @samp{opcodes}.
31385
31386 @end table
31387
31388 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31389 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31390 adjust its format.
31391
31392 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31393
31394 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31395
31396 @subsubheading Example
31397
31398 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31399
31400 @smallexample
31401 (gdb)
31402 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31403 ^done,
31404 asm_insns=[
31405 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31406 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31407 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31408 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31409 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31410 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31411 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31412 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31413 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31414 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31415 (gdb)
31416 @end smallexample
31417
31418 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31419 @code{main}.
31420
31421 @smallexample
31422 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31423 ^done,asm_insns=[
31424 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31425 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31426 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31427 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31428 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31429 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31430 [@dots{}]
31431 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31432 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31433 (gdb)
31434 @end smallexample
31435
31436 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31437
31438 @smallexample
31439 (gdb)
31440 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31441 ^done,asm_insns=[
31442 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31443 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31444 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31445 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31446 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31447 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31448 (gdb)
31449 @end smallexample
31450
31451 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31452
31453 @smallexample
31454 (gdb)
31455 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31456 ^done,asm_insns=[
31457 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31458 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31459 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31460 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31461 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31462 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31463 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31464 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31465 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31466 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31467 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31468 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31469 (gdb)
31470 @end smallexample
31471
31472
31473 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31474 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31475
31476 @subsubheading Synopsis
31477
31478 @smallexample
31479 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31480 @end smallexample
31481
31482 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31483 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31484 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31485
31486 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31487
31488 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31489 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31490 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31491
31492 @subsubheading Example
31493
31494 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31495 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31496 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31497 output.
31498
31499 @smallexample
31500 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31501 211^done,value="1"
31502 (gdb)
31503 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31504 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31505 (gdb)
31506 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31507 411^done,value="4"
31508 (gdb)
31509 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31510 511^done,value="4"
31511 (gdb)
31512 @end smallexample
31513
31514
31515 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31516 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31517
31518 @subsubheading Synopsis
31519
31520 @smallexample
31521 -data-list-changed-registers
31522 @end smallexample
31523
31524 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31525
31526 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31527
31528 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31529 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31530
31531 @subsubheading Example
31532
31533 On a PPC MBX board:
31534
31535 @smallexample
31536 (gdb)
31537 -exec-continue
31538 ^running
31539
31540 (gdb)
31541 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31542 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31543 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
31544 (gdb)
31545 -data-list-changed-registers
31546 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31547 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31548 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31549 (gdb)
31550 @end smallexample
31551
31552
31553 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31554 @findex -data-list-register-names
31555
31556 @subsubheading Synopsis
31557
31558 @smallexample
31559 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31560 @end smallexample
31561
31562 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31563 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31564 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31565 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31566 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31567 include empty register names.
31568
31569 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31570
31571 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31572 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31573 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31574
31575 @subsubheading Example
31576
31577 For the PPC MBX board:
31578 @smallexample
31579 (gdb)
31580 -data-list-register-names
31581 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31582 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31583 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31584 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31585 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31586 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31587 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31588 (gdb)
31589 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31590 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31591 (gdb)
31592 @end smallexample
31593
31594 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31595 @findex -data-list-register-values
31596
31597 @subsubheading Synopsis
31598
31599 @smallexample
31600 -data-list-register-values
31601 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31602 @end smallexample
31603
31604 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31605 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31606 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31607 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31608 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31609 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31610
31611 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31612
31613 @table @code
31614 @item x
31615 Hexadecimal
31616 @item o
31617 Octal
31618 @item t
31619 Binary
31620 @item d
31621 Decimal
31622 @item r
31623 Raw
31624 @item N
31625 Natural
31626 @end table
31627
31628 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31629
31630 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31631 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31632
31633 @subsubheading Example
31634
31635 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31636 don't appear in the actual output):
31637
31638 @smallexample
31639 (gdb)
31640 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31641 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31642 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31643 (gdb)
31644 -data-list-register-values x
31645 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31646 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31647 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31648 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31649 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31650 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31651 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31652 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31653 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31654 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31655 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31656 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31657 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31658 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31659 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31660 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31661 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31662 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31663 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31664 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31665 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31666 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31667 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31668 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31669 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31670 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31671 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31672 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31673 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31674 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31675 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31676 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31677 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31678 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31679 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31680 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31681 (gdb)
31682 @end smallexample
31683
31684
31685 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31686 @findex -data-read-memory
31687
31688 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31689
31690 @subsubheading Synopsis
31691
31692 @smallexample
31693 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31694 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31695 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31696 @end smallexample
31697
31698 @noindent
31699 where:
31700
31701 @table @samp
31702 @item @var{address}
31703 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31704 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31705 quoted using the C convention.
31706
31707 @item @var{word-format}
31708 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31709 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31710 ,Output Formats}).
31711
31712 @item @var{word-size}
31713 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31714
31715 @item @var{nr-rows}
31716 The number of rows in the output table.
31717
31718 @item @var{nr-cols}
31719 The number of columns in the output table.
31720
31721 @item @var{aschar}
31722 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31723 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31724 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31725 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31726
31727 @item @var{byte-offset}
31728 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31729 @end table
31730
31731 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31732 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31733 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31734 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31735 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31736 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31737 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31738 @samp{addr}.
31739
31740 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31741 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31742 @samp{prev-page}.
31743
31744 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31745
31746 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31747 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31748
31749 @subsubheading Example
31750
31751 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31752 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31753 word. Display each word in hex.
31754
31755 @smallexample
31756 (gdb)
31757 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31758 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31759 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31760 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31761 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31762 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31763 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31764 (gdb)
31765 @end smallexample
31766
31767 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31768 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31769
31770 @smallexample
31771 (gdb)
31772 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31773 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31774 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31775 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31776 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31777 (gdb)
31778 @end smallexample
31779
31780 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31781 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31782 used as the non-printable character.
31783
31784 @smallexample
31785 (gdb)
31786 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31787 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31788 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31789 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31790 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31791 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31792 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31793 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31794 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31795 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31796 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31797 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31798 (gdb)
31799 @end smallexample
31800
31801 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31802 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31803
31804 @subsubheading Synopsis
31805
31806 @smallexample
31807 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31808 @var{address} @var{count}
31809 @end smallexample
31810
31811 @noindent
31812 where:
31813
31814 @table @samp
31815 @item @var{address}
31816 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31817 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31818 quoted using the C convention.
31819
31820 @item @var{count}
31821 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31822 literal.
31823
31824 @item @var{offset}
31825 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31826 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31827 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31828 arithmetics itself.
31829
31830 @end table
31831
31832 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31833 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31834 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31835 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31836 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31837 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31838
31839 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31840 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31841 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31842 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31843 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31844 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31845 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31846 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31847
31848 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31849 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31850 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31851 and has the following fields:
31852
31853 @table @code
31854 @item begin
31855 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31856
31857 @item end
31858 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31859
31860 @item offset
31861 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31862 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31863
31864 @item contents
31865 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31866
31867 @end table
31868
31869
31870
31871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31872
31873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31874
31875 @subsubheading Example
31876
31877 @smallexample
31878 (gdb)
31879 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31880 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31881 end="0xbffff15e",
31882 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31883 (gdb)
31884 @end smallexample
31885
31886
31887 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31888 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31889
31890 @subsubheading Synopsis
31891
31892 @smallexample
31893 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31894 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31895 @end smallexample
31896
31897 @noindent
31898 where:
31899
31900 @table @samp
31901 @item @var{address}
31902 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31903 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31904 be quoted using the C convention.
31905
31906 @item @var{contents}
31907 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31908 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31909
31910 @item @var{count}
31911 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31912 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31913 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31914 @var{count} memory units.
31915
31916 @end table
31917
31918 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31919
31920 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31921
31922 @subsubheading Example
31923
31924 @smallexample
31925 (gdb)
31926 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31927 ^done
31928 (gdb)
31929 @end smallexample
31930
31931 @smallexample
31932 (gdb)
31933 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31934 ^done
31935 (gdb)
31936 @end smallexample
31937
31938 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31939 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31940 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31941
31942 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31943 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31944
31945 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31946 @findex -trace-find
31947
31948 @subsubheading Synopsis
31949
31950 @smallexample
31951 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31952 @end smallexample
31953
31954 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31955 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31956 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31957
31958 @table @samp
31959
31960 @item none
31961 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31962
31963 @item frame-number
31964 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31965 that index.
31966
31967 @item tracepoint-number
31968 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31969 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31970
31971 @item pc
31972 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31973 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31974 address.
31975
31976 @item pc-inside-range
31977 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31978 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31979 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31980
31981 @item pc-outside-range
31982 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31983 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31984 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31985
31986 @item line
31987 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31988 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31989 the specified location.
31990
31991 @end table
31992
31993 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31994 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31995
31996 @table @samp
31997 @item found
31998 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31999 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
32000
32001 @item traceframe
32002 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
32003 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32004
32005 @item tracepoint
32006 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
32007 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
32008
32009 @item frame
32010 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
32011 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
32012 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
32013
32014 @end table
32015
32016 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32017
32018 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
32019
32020 @subheading -trace-define-variable
32021 @findex -trace-define-variable
32022
32023 @subsubheading Synopsis
32024
32025 @smallexample
32026 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
32027 @end smallexample
32028
32029 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
32030 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
32031 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
32032 with the @samp{$} character.
32033
32034 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32035
32036 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
32037
32038 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
32039 @findex -trace-frame-collected
32040
32041 @subsubheading Synopsis
32042
32043 @smallexample
32044 -trace-frame-collected
32045 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
32046 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
32047 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
32048 [--memory-contents]
32049 @end smallexample
32050
32051 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
32052 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
32053 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
32054 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
32055 See the output description table below for more details.
32056
32057 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
32058 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
32059 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
32060 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
32061 memory range and which is a computed expression.
32062
32063 For instance, if the actions were
32064 @smallexample
32065 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
32066 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
32067 @end smallexample
32068
32069 @noindent
32070 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
32071 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
32072 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
32073 objects would be computed expressions.
32074
32075 An example output would be:
32076
32077 @smallexample
32078 (gdb)
32079 -trace-frame-collected
32080 ^done,
32081 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
32082 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
32083 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
32084 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
32085 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
32086 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
32087 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
32088 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
32089 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
32090 ...
32091 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
32092 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
32093 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
32094 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
32095 (gdb)
32096 @end smallexample
32097
32098 Where:
32099
32100 @table @code
32101 @item explicit-variables
32102 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
32103 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
32104 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32105 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32106 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32107 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32108 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32109 arrays, structures and unions.
32110
32111 @item computed-expressions
32112 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32113 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32114 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32115 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32116
32117 @item registers
32118 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32119 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32120 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32121 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32122 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32123
32124 @item tvars
32125 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32126 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32127 current value are returned.
32128
32129 @item memory
32130 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32131 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32132 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32133
32134 @table @code
32135 @item address
32136 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32137
32138 @item length
32139 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32140
32141 @item contents
32142 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32143 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32144
32145 @end table
32146
32147 @end table
32148
32149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32150
32151 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32152
32153 @subsubheading Example
32154
32155 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32156 @findex -trace-list-variables
32157
32158 @subsubheading Synopsis
32159
32160 @smallexample
32161 -trace-list-variables
32162 @end smallexample
32163
32164 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32165 table has the following fields:
32166
32167 @table @samp
32168 @item name
32169 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32170
32171 @item initial
32172 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32173 field is always present.
32174
32175 @item current
32176 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32177 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32178 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32179 presently running.
32180
32181 @end table
32182
32183 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32184
32185 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32186
32187 @subsubheading Example
32188
32189 @smallexample
32190 (gdb)
32191 -trace-list-variables
32192 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32193 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32194 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32195 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32196 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32197 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32198 (gdb)
32199 @end smallexample
32200
32201 @subheading -trace-save
32202 @findex -trace-save
32203
32204 @subsubheading Synopsis
32205
32206 @smallexample
32207 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32208 @end smallexample
32209
32210 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32211 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32212 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32213 to perform the save.
32214
32215 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32216 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32217 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32218
32219 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32220
32221 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32222
32223
32224 @subheading -trace-start
32225 @findex -trace-start
32226
32227 @subsubheading Synopsis
32228
32229 @smallexample
32230 -trace-start
32231 @end smallexample
32232
32233 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32234 have any fields.
32235
32236 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32237
32238 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32239
32240 @subheading -trace-status
32241 @findex -trace-status
32242
32243 @subsubheading Synopsis
32244
32245 @smallexample
32246 -trace-status
32247 @end smallexample
32248
32249 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32250 the following fields:
32251
32252 @table @samp
32253
32254 @item supported
32255 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32256 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32257 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32258 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32259 started. This field is always present.
32260
32261 @item running
32262 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32263 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32264 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32265
32266 @item stop-reason
32267 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32268 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32269 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32270 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32271 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32272 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32273 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32274 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32275 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32276
32277 @item stopping-tracepoint
32278 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32279 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32280 @samp{passcount}.
32281
32282 @item frames
32283 @itemx frames-created
32284 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32285 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32286 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32287 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32288
32289 @item buffer-size
32290 @itemx buffer-free
32291 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32292 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32293
32294 @item circular
32295 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32296 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32297 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32298 and may fill up.
32299
32300 @item disconnected
32301 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32302 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32303 that the trace run will stop.
32304
32305 @item trace-file
32306 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32307 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32308
32309 @end table
32310
32311 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32312
32313 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32314
32315 @subheading -trace-stop
32316 @findex -trace-stop
32317
32318 @subsubheading Synopsis
32319
32320 @smallexample
32321 -trace-stop
32322 @end smallexample
32323
32324 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32325 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32326 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32327
32328 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32329
32330 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32331
32332
32333 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32334 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32335 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32336
32337
32338 @ignore
32339 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32340 @findex -symbol-info-address
32341
32342 @subsubheading Synopsis
32343
32344 @smallexample
32345 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32346 @end smallexample
32347
32348 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32349
32350 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32351
32352 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32353
32354 @subsubheading Example
32355 N.A.
32356
32357
32358 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32359 @findex -symbol-info-file
32360
32361 @subsubheading Synopsis
32362
32363 @smallexample
32364 -symbol-info-file
32365 @end smallexample
32366
32367 Show the file for the symbol.
32368
32369 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32370
32371 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32372 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32373
32374 @subsubheading Example
32375 N.A.
32376
32377
32378 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32379 @findex -symbol-info-function
32380
32381 @subsubheading Synopsis
32382
32383 @smallexample
32384 -symbol-info-function
32385 @end smallexample
32386
32387 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32388
32389 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32390
32391 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32392
32393 @subsubheading Example
32394 N.A.
32395
32396
32397 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32398 @findex -symbol-info-line
32399
32400 @subsubheading Synopsis
32401
32402 @smallexample
32403 -symbol-info-line
32404 @end smallexample
32405
32406 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32407
32408 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32409
32410 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32411 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32412
32413 @subsubheading Example
32414 N.A.
32415
32416
32417 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32418 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32419
32420 @subsubheading Synopsis
32421
32422 @smallexample
32423 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32424 @end smallexample
32425
32426 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32427
32428 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32429
32430 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32431
32432 @subsubheading Example
32433 N.A.
32434
32435
32436 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32437 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32438
32439 @subsubheading Synopsis
32440
32441 @smallexample
32442 -symbol-list-functions
32443 @end smallexample
32444
32445 List the functions in the executable.
32446
32447 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32448
32449 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32450 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32451
32452 @subsubheading Example
32453 N.A.
32454 @end ignore
32455
32456
32457 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32458 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32459
32460 @subsubheading Synopsis
32461
32462 @smallexample
32463 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32464 @end smallexample
32465
32466 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32467 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32468 ascending PC order.
32469
32470 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32471
32472 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32473
32474 @subsubheading Example
32475 @smallexample
32476 (gdb)
32477 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32478 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32479 (gdb)
32480 @end smallexample
32481
32482
32483 @ignore
32484 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32485 @findex -symbol-list-types
32486
32487 @subsubheading Synopsis
32488
32489 @smallexample
32490 -symbol-list-types
32491 @end smallexample
32492
32493 List all the type names.
32494
32495 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32496
32497 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32498 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32499
32500 @subsubheading Example
32501 N.A.
32502
32503
32504 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32505 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32506
32507 @subsubheading Synopsis
32508
32509 @smallexample
32510 -symbol-list-variables
32511 @end smallexample
32512
32513 List all the global and static variable names.
32514
32515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32516
32517 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32518
32519 @subsubheading Example
32520 N.A.
32521
32522
32523 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32524 @findex -symbol-locate
32525
32526 @subsubheading Synopsis
32527
32528 @smallexample
32529 -symbol-locate
32530 @end smallexample
32531
32532 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32533
32534 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32535
32536 @subsubheading Example
32537 N.A.
32538
32539
32540 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32541 @findex -symbol-type
32542
32543 @subsubheading Synopsis
32544
32545 @smallexample
32546 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32547 @end smallexample
32548
32549 Show type of @var{variable}.
32550
32551 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32552
32553 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32554 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32555
32556 @subsubheading Example
32557 N.A.
32558 @end ignore
32559
32560
32561 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32562 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32563 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32564
32565 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32566 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32567
32568 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32569 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32570
32571 @subsubheading Synopsis
32572
32573 @smallexample
32574 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32575 @end smallexample
32576
32577 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32578 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32579 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32580 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32581 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32582 notification.
32583
32584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32585
32586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32587
32588 @subsubheading Example
32589
32590 @smallexample
32591 (gdb)
32592 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32593 ^done
32594 (gdb)
32595 @end smallexample
32596
32597
32598 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32599 @findex -file-exec-file
32600
32601 @subsubheading Synopsis
32602
32603 @smallexample
32604 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32605 @end smallexample
32606
32607 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32608 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32609 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32610 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32611 notification.
32612
32613 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32614
32615 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32616
32617 @subsubheading Example
32618
32619 @smallexample
32620 (gdb)
32621 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32622 ^done
32623 (gdb)
32624 @end smallexample
32625
32626
32627 @ignore
32628 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32629 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32630
32631 @subsubheading Synopsis
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 -file-list-exec-sections
32635 @end smallexample
32636
32637 List the sections of the current executable file.
32638
32639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32640
32641 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32642 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32643 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32644
32645 @subsubheading Example
32646 N.A.
32647 @end ignore
32648
32649
32650 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32651 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32652
32653 @subsubheading Synopsis
32654
32655 @smallexample
32656 -file-list-exec-source-file
32657 @end smallexample
32658
32659 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32660 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32661 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32662 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32663
32664 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32665
32666 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32667
32668 @subsubheading Example
32669
32670 @smallexample
32671 (gdb)
32672 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32673 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32674 (gdb)
32675 @end smallexample
32676
32677
32678 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32679 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32680
32681 @subsubheading Synopsis
32682
32683 @smallexample
32684 -file-list-exec-source-files
32685 @end smallexample
32686
32687 List the source files for the current executable.
32688
32689 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32690 name) of a source file.
32691
32692 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32693
32694 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32695 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32696
32697 @subsubheading Example
32698 @smallexample
32699 (gdb)
32700 -file-list-exec-source-files
32701 ^done,files=[
32702 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32703 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32704 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32705 (gdb)
32706 @end smallexample
32707
32708 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32709 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32710
32711 @subsubheading Synopsis
32712
32713 @smallexample
32714 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32715 @end smallexample
32716
32717 List the shared libraries in the program.
32718 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32719 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32720
32721 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32722
32723 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32724 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32725 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32726 library. Each range has the following fields:
32727
32728 @table @samp
32729 @item from
32730 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32731 @item to
32732 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32733 @end table
32734
32735 @subsubheading Example
32736 @smallexample
32737 (gdb)
32738 -file-list-exec-source-files
32739 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32740 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32741 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32742 (gdb)
32743 @end smallexample
32744
32745
32746 @ignore
32747 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32748 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32749
32750 @subsubheading Synopsis
32751
32752 @smallexample
32753 -file-list-symbol-files
32754 @end smallexample
32755
32756 List symbol files.
32757
32758 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32759
32760 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32761
32762 @subsubheading Example
32763 N.A.
32764 @end ignore
32765
32766
32767 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32768 @findex -file-symbol-file
32769
32770 @subsubheading Synopsis
32771
32772 @smallexample
32773 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32774 @end smallexample
32775
32776 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32777 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32778 produced, except for a completion notification.
32779
32780 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32781
32782 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32783
32784 @subsubheading Example
32785
32786 @smallexample
32787 (gdb)
32788 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32789 ^done
32790 (gdb)
32791 @end smallexample
32792
32793 @ignore
32794 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32795 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32796 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32797
32798 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32799
32800 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32801
32802 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32803
32804 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32805
32806 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32807
32808 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32809
32810 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32811
32812 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32813
32814 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32815 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32816 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32817
32818 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32819
32820 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32821
32822 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32823
32824 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32825 @end ignore
32826
32827
32828 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32829 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32830 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32831
32832
32833 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32834 @findex -target-attach
32835
32836 @subsubheading Synopsis
32837
32838 @smallexample
32839 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32840 @end smallexample
32841
32842 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32843 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32844 group, the id previously returned by
32845 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32846
32847 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32848
32849 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32850
32851 @subsubheading Example
32852 @smallexample
32853 (gdb)
32854 -target-attach 34
32855 =thread-created,id="1"
32856 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32857 ^done
32858 (gdb)
32859 @end smallexample
32860
32861 @ignore
32862 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32863 @findex -target-compare-sections
32864
32865 @subsubheading Synopsis
32866
32867 @smallexample
32868 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32869 @end smallexample
32870
32871 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32872 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32873
32874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32875
32876 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32877
32878 @subsubheading Example
32879 N.A.
32880 @end ignore
32881
32882
32883 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32884 @findex -target-detach
32885
32886 @subsubheading Synopsis
32887
32888 @smallexample
32889 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32890 @end smallexample
32891
32892 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32893 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32894 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32895
32896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32897
32898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32899
32900 @subsubheading Example
32901
32902 @smallexample
32903 (gdb)
32904 -target-detach
32905 ^done
32906 (gdb)
32907 @end smallexample
32908
32909
32910 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32911 @findex -target-disconnect
32912
32913 @subsubheading Synopsis
32914
32915 @smallexample
32916 -target-disconnect
32917 @end smallexample
32918
32919 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32920 generally not resumed.
32921
32922 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32923
32924 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32925
32926 @subsubheading Example
32927
32928 @smallexample
32929 (gdb)
32930 -target-disconnect
32931 ^done
32932 (gdb)
32933 @end smallexample
32934
32935
32936 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32937 @findex -target-download
32938
32939 @subsubheading Synopsis
32940
32941 @smallexample
32942 -target-download
32943 @end smallexample
32944
32945 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32946 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32947
32948 @table @samp
32949 @item section
32950 The name of the section.
32951 @item section-sent
32952 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32953 @item section-size
32954 The size of the section.
32955 @item total-sent
32956 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32957 @item total-size
32958 The size of the overall executable to download.
32959 @end table
32960
32961 @noindent
32962 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32963 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32964
32965 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32966 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32967
32968 @table @samp
32969 @item section
32970 The name of the section.
32971 @item section-size
32972 The size of the section.
32973 @item total-size
32974 The size of the overall executable to download.
32975 @end table
32976
32977 @noindent
32978 At the end, a summary is printed.
32979
32980 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32981
32982 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32983
32984 @subsubheading Example
32985
32986 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32987 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32988
32989 @smallexample
32990 (gdb)
32991 -target-download
32992 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32993 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32994 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32995 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32996 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32997 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32998 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32999 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
33000 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
33001 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
33002 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
33003 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
33004 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
33005 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
33006 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
33007 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
33008 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
33009 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
33010 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
33011 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
33012 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
33013 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
33014 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
33015 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
33016 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
33017 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
33018 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
33019 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33020 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
33021 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
33022 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
33023 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
33024 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
33025 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
33026 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
33027 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
33028 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
33029 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
33030 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
33031 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
33032 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
33033 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
33034 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
33035 write-rate="429"
33036 (gdb)
33037 @end smallexample
33038
33039
33040 @ignore
33041 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
33042 @findex -target-exec-status
33043
33044 @subsubheading Synopsis
33045
33046 @smallexample
33047 -target-exec-status
33048 @end smallexample
33049
33050 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
33051 not, for instance).
33052
33053 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33054
33055 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
33056
33057 @subsubheading Example
33058 N.A.
33059
33060
33061 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
33062 @findex -target-list-available-targets
33063
33064 @subsubheading Synopsis
33065
33066 @smallexample
33067 -target-list-available-targets
33068 @end smallexample
33069
33070 List the possible targets to connect to.
33071
33072 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33073
33074 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
33075
33076 @subsubheading Example
33077 N.A.
33078
33079
33080 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
33081 @findex -target-list-current-targets
33082
33083 @subsubheading Synopsis
33084
33085 @smallexample
33086 -target-list-current-targets
33087 @end smallexample
33088
33089 Describe the current target.
33090
33091 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33092
33093 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
33094 other things).
33095
33096 @subsubheading Example
33097 N.A.
33098
33099
33100 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
33101 @findex -target-list-parameters
33102
33103 @subsubheading Synopsis
33104
33105 @smallexample
33106 -target-list-parameters
33107 @end smallexample
33108
33109 @c ????
33110 @end ignore
33111
33112 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33113
33114 No equivalent.
33115
33116 @subsubheading Example
33117 N.A.
33118
33119 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33120 @findex -target-flash-erase
33121
33122 @subsubheading Synopsis
33123
33124 @smallexample
33125 -target-flash-erase
33126 @end smallexample
33127
33128 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33129
33130 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33131
33132 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33133 addresses and memory region sizes.
33134
33135 @smallexample
33136 (gdb)
33137 -target-flash-erase
33138 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33139 (gdb)
33140 @end smallexample
33141
33142 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33143 @findex -target-select
33144
33145 @subsubheading Synopsis
33146
33147 @smallexample
33148 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33149 @end smallexample
33150
33151 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33152
33153 @table @samp
33154 @item @var{type}
33155 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33156 @item @var{parameters}
33157 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33158 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33159 @end table
33160
33161 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33162 which the target program is, in the following form:
33163
33164 @smallexample
33165 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33166 args=[@var{arg list}]
33167 @end smallexample
33168
33169 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33170
33171 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33172
33173 @subsubheading Example
33174
33175 @smallexample
33176 (gdb)
33177 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33178 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33179 (gdb)
33180 @end smallexample
33181
33182 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33183 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33184 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33185
33186
33187 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33188 @findex -target-file-put
33189
33190 @subsubheading Synopsis
33191
33192 @smallexample
33193 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33194 @end smallexample
33195
33196 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33197 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33198
33199 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33200
33201 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33202
33203 @subsubheading Example
33204
33205 @smallexample
33206 (gdb)
33207 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33208 ^done
33209 (gdb)
33210 @end smallexample
33211
33212
33213 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33214 @findex -target-file-get
33215
33216 @subsubheading Synopsis
33217
33218 @smallexample
33219 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33220 @end smallexample
33221
33222 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33223 on the host system.
33224
33225 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33226
33227 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33228
33229 @subsubheading Example
33230
33231 @smallexample
33232 (gdb)
33233 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33234 ^done
33235 (gdb)
33236 @end smallexample
33237
33238
33239 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33240 @findex -target-file-delete
33241
33242 @subsubheading Synopsis
33243
33244 @smallexample
33245 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33246 @end smallexample
33247
33248 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33249
33250 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33251
33252 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33253
33254 @subsubheading Example
33255
33256 @smallexample
33257 (gdb)
33258 -target-file-delete remotefile
33259 ^done
33260 (gdb)
33261 @end smallexample
33262
33263
33264 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33265 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33266 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33267
33268 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33269 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33270
33271 @subsubheading Synopsis
33272
33273 @smallexample
33274 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33275 @end smallexample
33276
33277 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33278 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33279 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33280
33281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33282
33283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33284
33285 @subsubheading Result
33286
33287 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33288 defined for each exception:
33289
33290 @table @samp
33291 @item name
33292 The name of the exception.
33293
33294 @item address
33295 The address of the exception.
33296
33297 @end table
33298
33299 @subsubheading Example
33300
33301 @smallexample
33302 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33303 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33304 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33305 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33306 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33307 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33308 @end smallexample
33309
33310 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33311
33312 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33313 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33314 Catchpoint Commands}.
33315
33316
33317 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33318 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33319 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33320
33321 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33322 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33323 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33324 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33325
33326 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33327 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33328 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33329
33330 @subsubheading Synopsis
33331
33332 @smallexample
33333 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33334 @end smallexample
33335
33336 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33337
33338 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33339 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33340 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33341 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33342 dash.
33343
33344 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33345
33346 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33347
33348 @subsubheading Result
33349
33350 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33351
33352 @table @samp
33353 @item exists
33354 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33355 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33356
33357 @end table
33358
33359 @subsubheading Example
33360
33361 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33362
33363 @smallexample
33364 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33365 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33366 @end smallexample
33367
33368 @noindent
33369 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33370 to the debugger:
33371
33372 @smallexample
33373 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33374 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33375 @end smallexample
33376
33377 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33378 @findex -list-features
33379 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33380
33381 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33382 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33383 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33384 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33385 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33386 startup.
33387
33388 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33389 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33390 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33391 is given below.
33392
33393 Example output:
33394
33395 @smallexample
33396 (gdb) -list-features
33397 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33398 @end smallexample
33399
33400 The current list of features is:
33401
33402 @ftable @samp
33403 @item frozen-varobjs
33404 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33405 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33406 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33407 @item pending-breakpoints
33408 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33409 command.
33410 @item python
33411 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33412 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33413 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33414 @item thread-info
33415 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33416 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33417 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33418 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33419 @item breakpoint-notifications
33420 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33421 CLI will be announced via async records.
33422 @item ada-task-info
33423 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33424 @item language-option
33425 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33426 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33427 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33428 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33429 @item undefined-command-error-code
33430 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33431 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33432 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33433 @item exec-run-start-option
33434 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33435 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33436 @item data-disassemble-a-option
33437 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
33438 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
33439 @end ftable
33440
33441 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33442 @findex -list-target-features
33443
33444 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33445 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33446 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33447 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33448 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33449 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33450 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33451 Example output:
33452
33453 @smallexample
33454 (gdb) -list-target-features
33455 ^done,result=["async"]
33456 @end smallexample
33457
33458 The current list of features is:
33459
33460 @table @samp
33461 @item async
33462 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33463 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33464 while the target is running.
33465
33466 @item reverse
33467 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33468 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33469
33470 @end table
33471
33472 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33473 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33474 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33475
33476 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33477
33478 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33479 @findex -gdb-exit
33480
33481 @subsubheading Synopsis
33482
33483 @smallexample
33484 -gdb-exit
33485 @end smallexample
33486
33487 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33488
33489 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33490
33491 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33492
33493 @subsubheading Example
33494
33495 @smallexample
33496 (gdb)
33497 -gdb-exit
33498 ^exit
33499 @end smallexample
33500
33501
33502 @ignore
33503 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33504 @findex -exec-abort
33505
33506 @subsubheading Synopsis
33507
33508 @smallexample
33509 -exec-abort
33510 @end smallexample
33511
33512 Kill the inferior running program.
33513
33514 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33515
33516 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33517
33518 @subsubheading Example
33519 N.A.
33520 @end ignore
33521
33522
33523 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33524 @findex -gdb-set
33525
33526 @subsubheading Synopsis
33527
33528 @smallexample
33529 -gdb-set
33530 @end smallexample
33531
33532 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33533 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33534
33535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33536
33537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33538
33539 @subsubheading Example
33540
33541 @smallexample
33542 (gdb)
33543 -gdb-set $foo=3
33544 ^done
33545 (gdb)
33546 @end smallexample
33547
33548
33549 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33550 @findex -gdb-show
33551
33552 @subsubheading Synopsis
33553
33554 @smallexample
33555 -gdb-show
33556 @end smallexample
33557
33558 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33559
33560 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33561
33562 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33563
33564 @subsubheading Example
33565
33566 @smallexample
33567 (gdb)
33568 -gdb-show annotate
33569 ^done,value="0"
33570 (gdb)
33571 @end smallexample
33572
33573 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33574
33575
33576 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33577 @findex -gdb-version
33578
33579 @subsubheading Synopsis
33580
33581 @smallexample
33582 -gdb-version
33583 @end smallexample
33584
33585 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33586
33587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33588
33589 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33590 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33591
33592 @subsubheading Example
33593
33594 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33595 @c box in TeX.
33596 @smallexample
33597 (gdb)
33598 -gdb-version
33599 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33600 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33601 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33602 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33603 ~ certain conditions.
33604 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33605 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33606 ~ details.
33607 ~This GDB was configured as
33608 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33609 ^done
33610 (gdb)
33611 @end smallexample
33612
33613 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33614 @findex -list-thread-groups
33615
33616 @subheading Synopsis
33617
33618 @smallexample
33619 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33620 @end smallexample
33621
33622 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33623 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33624 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33625 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33626 top-level thread groups.
33627
33628 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33629 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33630 available on the target.
33631
33632 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33633 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33634 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33635 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33636 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33637 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33638 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33639 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33640
33641 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33642 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33643 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33644 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33645 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33646 @samp{threads} field.
33647
33648 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33649 the following caveats:
33650
33651 @itemize @bullet
33652 @item
33653 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33654 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33655 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33656
33657 @item
33658 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33659 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33660 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33661 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33662 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33663 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33664
33665 @end itemize
33666
33667 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33668 have the following fields:
33669
33670 @table @code
33671 @item id
33672 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33673 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33674 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33675
33676 @item type
33677 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33678 valid type.
33679
33680 @item pid
33681 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33682 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33683
33684 @item exit-code
33685 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33686 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33687 only if the process is not running.
33688
33689 @item num_children
33690 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33691 absent for an available thread group.
33692
33693 @item threads
33694 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33695 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33696 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33697
33698 @item cores
33699 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33700 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33701 such information is not available.
33702
33703 @item executable
33704 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33705 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33706 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33707
33708 @end table
33709
33710 @subheading Example
33711
33712 @smallexample
33713 @value{GDBP}
33714 -list-thread-groups
33715 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33716 -list-thread-groups 17
33717 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33718 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33719 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33720 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33721 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
33722 -list-thread-groups --available
33723 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33724 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33725 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33726 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33727 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33728 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33729 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33730 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33731 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33732 @end smallexample
33733
33734 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33735 @findex -info-os
33736
33737 @subsubheading Synopsis
33738
33739 @smallexample
33740 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33741 @end smallexample
33742
33743 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33744 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33745 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33746 of data of that type.
33747
33748 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33749 system.
33750
33751 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33752
33753 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33754
33755 @subsubheading Example
33756
33757 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33758 like this:
33759
33760 @smallexample
33761 @value{GDBP}
33762 -info-os
33763 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33764 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33765 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33766 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33767 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33768 col2="CPUs"@},
33769 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33770 col2="File descriptors"@},
33771 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33772 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33773 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33774 col2="Message queues"@},
33775 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33776 col2="Processes"@},
33777 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33778 col2="Process groups"@},
33779 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33780 col2="Semaphores"@},
33781 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33782 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33783 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33784 col2="Sockets"@},
33785 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33786 col2="Threads"@}]
33787 @value{GDBP}
33788 -info-os processes
33789 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33790 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33791 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33792 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33793 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33794 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33795 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33796 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33797 ...
33798 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33799 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33800 (gdb)
33801 @end smallexample
33802
33803 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33804 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33805 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33806 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33807 @code{info os} omits it.)
33808
33809 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33810 @findex -add-inferior
33811
33812 @subheading Synopsis
33813
33814 @smallexample
33815 -add-inferior
33816 @end smallexample
33817
33818 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33819 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33820 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33821 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33822 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33823 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33824
33825 @subheading Example
33826
33827 @smallexample
33828 @value{GDBP}
33829 -add-inferior
33830 ^done,inferior="i3"
33831 @end smallexample
33832
33833 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33834 @findex -interpreter-exec
33835
33836 @subheading Synopsis
33837
33838 @smallexample
33839 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33840 @end smallexample
33841 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33842
33843 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33844
33845 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33846
33847 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33848
33849 @subheading Example
33850
33851 @smallexample
33852 (gdb)
33853 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33854 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33855 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33856 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33857 ^done
33858 (gdb)
33859 @end smallexample
33860
33861 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33862 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33863
33864 @subheading Synopsis
33865
33866 @smallexample
33867 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33868 @end smallexample
33869
33870 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33871
33872 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33873
33874 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33875
33876 @subheading Example
33877
33878 @smallexample
33879 (gdb)
33880 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33881 ^done
33882 (gdb)
33883 @end smallexample
33884
33885 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33886 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33887
33888 @subheading Synopsis
33889
33890 @smallexample
33891 -inferior-tty-show
33892 @end smallexample
33893
33894 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33895
33896 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33897
33898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33899
33900 @subheading Example
33901
33902 @smallexample
33903 (gdb)
33904 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33905 ^done
33906 (gdb)
33907 -inferior-tty-show
33908 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33909 (gdb)
33910 @end smallexample
33911
33912 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33913 @findex -enable-timings
33914
33915 @subheading Synopsis
33916
33917 @smallexample
33918 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33919 @end smallexample
33920
33921 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33922 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33923 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33924 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33925
33926 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33927
33928 No equivalent.
33929
33930 @subheading Example
33931
33932 @smallexample
33933 (gdb)
33934 -enable-timings
33935 ^done
33936 (gdb)
33937 -break-insert main
33938 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33939 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33940 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33941 times="0"@},
33942 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33943 (gdb)
33944 -enable-timings no
33945 ^done
33946 (gdb)
33947 -exec-run
33948 ^running
33949 (gdb)
33950 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33951 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33952 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33953 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
33954 (gdb)
33955 @end smallexample
33956
33957 @node Annotations
33958 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33959
33960 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33961 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33962 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33963 relatively high level.
33964
33965 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33966 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33967
33968 @ignore
33969 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33970 @end ignore
33971
33972 @menu
33973 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33974 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33975 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33976 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33977 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33978 * Annotations for Running::
33979 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33980 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33981 @end menu
33982
33983 @node Annotations Overview
33984 @section What is an Annotation?
33985 @cindex annotations
33986
33987 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33988 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33989 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33990 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33991 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33992 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33993 cannot contain newline characters.
33994
33995 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33996 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33997 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33998 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33999 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
34000 means those three characters as output.
34001
34002 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
34003 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
34004 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
34005 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
34006 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
34007 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
34008 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
34009 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
34010 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
34011
34012 @table @code
34013 @kindex set annotate
34014 @item set annotate @var{level}
34015 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
34016 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
34017
34018 @item show annotate
34019 @kindex show annotate
34020 Show the current annotation level.
34021 @end table
34022
34023 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
34024
34025 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
34026
34027 @smallexample
34028 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
34029 GNU gdb 6.0
34030 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34031 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
34032 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
34033 under certain conditions.
34034 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34035 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
34036 for details.
34037 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
34038
34039 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34040 (@value{GDBP})
34041 ^Z^Zprompt
34042 @kbd{quit}
34043
34044 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34045 $
34046 @end smallexample
34047
34048 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
34049 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
34050 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
34051 output from @value{GDBN}.
34052
34053 @node Server Prefix
34054 @section The Server Prefix
34055 @cindex server prefix
34056
34057 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
34058 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
34059 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
34060 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
34061 a transparent manner.
34062
34063 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
34064 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
34065 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
34066 @code{print} command.
34067
34068 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
34069 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
34070
34071 @node Prompting
34072 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
34073
34074 @cindex annotations for prompts
34075 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
34076 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
34077 over, etc.
34078
34079 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
34080 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
34081 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
34082 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
34083 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
34084 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
34085 features the following annotations:
34086
34087 @smallexample
34088 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
34089 ^Z^Zprompt
34090 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
34091 @end smallexample
34092
34093 The input types are
34094
34095 @table @code
34096 @findex pre-prompt annotation
34097 @findex prompt annotation
34098 @findex post-prompt annotation
34099 @item prompt
34100 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
34101
34102 @findex pre-commands annotation
34103 @findex commands annotation
34104 @findex post-commands annotation
34105 @item commands
34106 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
34107 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34108
34109 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34110 @findex overload-choice annotation
34111 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34112 @item overload-choice
34113 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34114
34115 @findex pre-query annotation
34116 @findex query annotation
34117 @findex post-query annotation
34118 @item query
34119 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34120
34121 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34122 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34123 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34124 @item prompt-for-continue
34125 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34126 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34127 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34128 presence of annotations.
34129 @end table
34130
34131 @node Errors
34132 @section Errors
34133 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34134
34135 @findex quit annotation
34136 @smallexample
34137 ^Z^Zquit
34138 @end smallexample
34139
34140 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34141
34142 @findex error annotation
34143 @smallexample
34144 ^Z^Zerror
34145 @end smallexample
34146
34147 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34148
34149 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34150 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34151 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34152 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34153 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34154 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34155 to the top level.
34156
34157 @findex error-begin annotation
34158 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34159
34160 @smallexample
34161 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34162 @end smallexample
34163
34164 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34165 message.
34166
34167 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34168 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34169 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34170
34171 @node Invalidation
34172 @section Invalidation Notices
34173
34174 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34175 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34176 changed.
34177
34178 @table @code
34179 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34180 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34181
34182 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34183 have changed.
34184
34185 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34186 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34187
34188 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34189 deleted a breakpoint.
34190 @end table
34191
34192 @node Annotations for Running
34193 @section Running the Program
34194 @cindex annotations for running programs
34195
34196 @findex starting annotation
34197 @findex stopping annotation
34198 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34199 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34200
34201 @smallexample
34202 ^Z^Zstarting
34203 @end smallexample
34204
34205 is output. When the program stops,
34206
34207 @smallexample
34208 ^Z^Zstopped
34209 @end smallexample
34210
34211 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34212 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34213
34214 @table @code
34215 @findex exited annotation
34216 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34217 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34218 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34219
34220 @findex signalled annotation
34221 @findex signal-name annotation
34222 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34223 @findex signal-string annotation
34224 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34225 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34226 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34227 annotation continues:
34228
34229 @smallexample
34230 @var{intro-text}
34231 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34232 @var{name}
34233 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34234 @var{middle-text}
34235 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34236 @var{string}
34237 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34238 @var{end-text}
34239 @end smallexample
34240
34241 @noindent
34242 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34243 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34244 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34245 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34246 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34247
34248 @findex signal annotation
34249 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34250 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34251 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34252 terminated with it.
34253
34254 @findex breakpoint annotation
34255 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34256 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34257
34258 @findex watchpoint annotation
34259 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34260 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34261 @end table
34262
34263 @node Source Annotations
34264 @section Displaying Source
34265 @cindex annotations for source display
34266
34267 @findex source annotation
34268 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34269
34270 @smallexample
34271 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34272 @end smallexample
34273
34274 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34275 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34276 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34277 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34278 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34279 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34280 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34281 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34282 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34283 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34284 depend on the language).
34285
34286 @node JIT Interface
34287 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34288 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34289 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34290
34291 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34292 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34293 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34294 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34295
34296 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34297 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34298 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34299 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34300 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34301 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34302
34303 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34304 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34305 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34306 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34307 LLVM JIT.
34308
34309 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34310 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34311 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34312 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34313 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34314 out about additional code.
34315
34316 @menu
34317 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34318 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34319 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34320 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34321 @end menu
34322
34323 @node Declarations
34324 @section JIT Declarations
34325
34326 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34327 implement the interface:
34328
34329 @smallexample
34330 typedef enum
34331 @{
34332 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34333 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34334 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34335 @} jit_actions_t;
34336
34337 struct jit_code_entry
34338 @{
34339 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34340 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34341 const char *symfile_addr;
34342 uint64_t symfile_size;
34343 @};
34344
34345 struct jit_descriptor
34346 @{
34347 uint32_t version;
34348 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34349 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34350 uint32_t action_flag;
34351 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34352 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34353 @};
34354
34355 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34356 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34357
34358 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34359 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34360 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34361 @end smallexample
34362
34363 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34364 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34365 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34366
34367 @node Registering Code
34368 @section Registering Code
34369
34370 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34371
34372 @itemize @bullet
34373 @item
34374 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34375 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34376
34377 @item
34378 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34379 file.
34380
34381 @item
34382 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34383
34384 @item
34385 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34386
34387 @item
34388 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34389 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34390 @end itemize
34391
34392 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34393 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34394 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34395 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34396
34397 @node Unregistering Code
34398 @section Unregistering Code
34399
34400 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34401
34402 @itemize @bullet
34403 @item
34404 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34405
34406 @item
34407 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34408
34409 @item
34410 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34411 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34412 @end itemize
34413
34414 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34415 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34416
34417 @node Custom Debug Info
34418 @section Custom Debug Info
34419 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34420 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34421
34422 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34423 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34424 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34425 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34426 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34427 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34428 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34429 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34430 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34431
34432 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34433 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34434 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34435 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34436 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34437 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34438 compiler.
34439
34440 @menu
34441 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34442 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34443 @end menu
34444
34445 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34446 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34447 @kindex jit-reader-load
34448 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34449
34450 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34451 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34452
34453 @table @code
34454 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34455 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34456 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34457 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34458 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34459 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34460 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34461
34462 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34463 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34464 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34465 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34466 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34467
34468 @item jit-reader-unload
34469 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34470
34471 @end table
34472
34473 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34474 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34475 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34476
34477 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34478 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34479
34480 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34481 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34482 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34483 the system include directory.
34484
34485 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34486 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34487 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34488
34489 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34490 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34491
34492 @findex gdb_init_reader
34493 @smallexample
34494 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34495 @end smallexample
34496
34497 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34498
34499 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34500 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34501 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34502 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34503 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34504 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34505
34506 @smallexample
34507 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34508 @{
34509 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34510 int reader_version;
34511
34512 /* For use by the reader. */
34513 void *priv_data;
34514
34515 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34516 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34517 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34518 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34519 @};
34520 @end smallexample
34521
34522 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34523 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34524
34525 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34526 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34527 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34528 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34529 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34530 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34531 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34532 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34533 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34534 target's address space.
34535
34536 @node In-Process Agent
34537 @chapter In-Process Agent
34538 @cindex debugging agent
34539 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34540 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34541 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34542 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34543 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34544 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34545 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34546 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34547 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34548 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34549 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34550 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34551 behavior without interrupting it.
34552
34553 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34554 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34555 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34556 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34557 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34558 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34559 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34560 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34561 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34562
34563 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34564 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34565 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34566 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34567
34568 @anchor{Control Agent}
34569 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34570 debugging with the following commands:
34571
34572 @table @code
34573 @kindex set agent on
34574 @item set agent on
34575 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34576 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34577 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34578 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34579 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34580 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34581
34582 @kindex set agent off
34583 @item set agent off
34584 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34585 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34586
34587 @kindex show agent
34588 @item show agent
34589 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34590 the in-process agent.
34591 @end table
34592
34593 @menu
34594 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34595 @end menu
34596
34597 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34598 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34599 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34600
34601 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34602 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34603 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34604 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34605 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34606 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34607 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34608 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34609 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34610
34611 @menu
34612 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34613 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34614 @end menu
34615
34616 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34617 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34618 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34619
34620 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34621 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34622
34623 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34624 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34625 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34626 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34627
34628 @enumerate
34629 @item
34630 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34631 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34632 @item
34633 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34634 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34635 the other one.
34636 @end enumerate
34637
34638 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34639
34640 @enumerate
34641 @item
34642 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34643 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34644 @anchor{agent expression object}
34645 @item
34646 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34647 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34648 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34649 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34650 @item
34651 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34652 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34653
34654 @end enumerate
34655
34656 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34657 object:
34658
34659 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34660 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34661 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34662 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34663 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34664 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34665 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34666 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34667 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34668 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34669 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34670 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34671 memory address for collecting.
34672 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34673 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34674 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34675 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34676 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34677 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34678 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34679 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34680 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34681 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34682 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34683 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34684 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34685 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34686 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34687 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34688 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34689 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34690 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34691 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34692 @ref{agent expression object}
34693 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34694 @ref{agent expression object}
34695 @item actions @tab variable
34696 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34697 @end multitable
34698
34699 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34700 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34701 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34702
34703 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34704 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34705
34706 @table @samp
34707
34708 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34709 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34710 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34711 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34712 in IPA finally.
34713
34714 Replies:
34715 @table @samp
34716 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34717 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34718 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34719 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34720 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34721 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34722 @item E @var{NN}
34723 for an error
34724
34725 @end table
34726
34727 @item close
34728 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34729 is about to kill inferiors.
34730
34731 @item qTfSTM
34732 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34733 @item qTsSTM
34734 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34735 @item qTSTMat
34736 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34737 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34738 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34739
34740 Replies:
34741 @table @samp
34742 @item E @var{NN}
34743 for an error
34744 @end table
34745 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34746 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34747 @end table
34748
34749 @node GDB Bugs
34750 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34751 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34752 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34753
34754 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34755
34756 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34757 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34758 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34759 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34760
34761 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34762 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34763
34764 @menu
34765 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34766 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34767 @end menu
34768
34769 @node Bug Criteria
34770 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34771 @cindex bug criteria
34772
34773 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34774
34775 @itemize @bullet
34776 @cindex fatal signal
34777 @cindex debugger crash
34778 @cindex crash of debugger
34779 @item
34780 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34781 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34782
34783 @cindex error on valid input
34784 @item
34785 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34786 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34787 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34788
34789 @cindex invalid input
34790 @item
34791 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34792 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34793 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34794 for traditional practice''.
34795
34796 @item
34797 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34798 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34799 @end itemize
34800
34801 @node Bug Reporting
34802 @section How to Report Bugs
34803 @cindex bug reports
34804 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34805
34806 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34807 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34808 contact that organization first.
34809
34810 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34811 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34812 distribution.
34813 @c should add a web page ref...
34814
34815 @ifset BUGURL
34816 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34817 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34818 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34819 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34820 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34821 be used.
34822
34823 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34824 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34825 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34826 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34827
34828 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34829 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34830 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34831 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34832 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34833 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34834 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34835 bug reports to the mailing list.
34836 @end ifset
34837 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34838 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34839 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34840 @end ifclear
34841 @end ifset
34842
34843 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34844 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34845 fact or leave it out, state it!
34846
34847 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34848 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34849 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34850 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34851 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34852 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34853 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34854 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34855 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34856
34857 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34858 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34859 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34860 self-contained.
34861
34862 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34863 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34864 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34865 bugs properly.
34866
34867 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34868
34869 @itemize @bullet
34870 @item
34871 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34872 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34873 version}.
34874
34875 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34876 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34877
34878 @item
34879 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34880 version number.
34881
34882 @item
34883 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34884 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34885 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34886 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34887
34888 @item
34889 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34890 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34891
34892 @item
34893 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34894 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34895 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34896 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34897 those compilers.
34898
34899 @item
34900 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34901 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34902 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34903 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34904
34905 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34906 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34907
34908 @item
34909 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34910 reproduce the bug.
34911
34912 @item
34913 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34914 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34915
34916 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34917 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34918 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34919 a chance to make a mistake.
34920
34921 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34922 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34923 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34924 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34925 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34926 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34927 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34928 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34929
34930 @pindex script
34931 @cindex recording a session script
34932 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34933 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34934 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34935 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34936
34937 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34938 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34939
34940 @item
34941 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34942 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34943 it by context, not by line number.
34944
34945 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34946 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34947
34948 @end itemize
34949
34950 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34951
34952 @itemize @bullet
34953 @item
34954 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34955
34956 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34957 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34958 changes will not affect it.
34959
34960 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34961 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34962 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34963 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34964
34965 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34966 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34967 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34968 less time, and so on.
34969
34970 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34971 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34972
34973 @item
34974 A patch for the bug.
34975
34976 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34977 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34978 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34979 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34980
34981 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34982 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34983 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34984 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34985
34986 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34987 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34988 help us to understand.
34989
34990 @item
34991 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34992
34993 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34994 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34995 @end itemize
34996
34997 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34998 @c and consists of the two following files:
34999 @c rluser.texi
35000 @c hsuser.texi
35001 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
35002 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
35003 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
35004 @include rluser.texi
35005 @include hsuser.texi
35006 @end ifclear
35007
35008 @node In Memoriam
35009 @appendix In Memoriam
35010
35011 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
35012 contributors:
35013
35014 @table @code
35015 @item Fred Fish
35016 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
35017 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
35018 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
35019
35020 @item Michael Snyder
35021 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
35022 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
35023 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
35024 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
35025 @end table
35026
35027 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
35028 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
35029
35030 @node Formatting Documentation
35031 @appendix Formatting Documentation
35032
35033 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
35034 @cindex reference card
35035 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
35036 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
35037 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
35038 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
35039 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
35040 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
35041
35042 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
35043 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
35044
35045 @smallexample
35046 make refcard.dvi
35047 @end smallexample
35048
35049 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
35050 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
35051 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
35052 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
35053 your @sc{dvi} output program.
35054
35055 @cindex documentation
35056
35057 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
35058 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
35059 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
35060 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
35061 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
35062 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
35063
35064 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
35065 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
35066 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
35067 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
35068 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
35069 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
35070 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
35071 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
35072
35073 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
35074 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
35075 @code{makeinfo}.
35076
35077 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
35078 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
35079 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
35080
35081 @smallexample
35082 cd gdb
35083 make gdb.info
35084 @end smallexample
35085
35086 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
35087 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
35088 Texinfo definitions file.
35089
35090 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
35091 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
35092 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
35093 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
35094 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
35095 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
35096 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
35097
35098 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
35099 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
35100 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
35101 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
35102 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
35103 directory.
35104
35105 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
35106 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
35107 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35108 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35109
35110 @smallexample
35111 make gdb.dvi
35112 @end smallexample
35113
35114 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35115
35116 @node Installing GDB
35117 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35118 @cindex installation
35119
35120 @menu
35121 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35122 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35123 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35124 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35125 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35126 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35127 @end menu
35128
35129 @node Requirements
35130 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35131 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35132
35133 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35134 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35135
35136 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35137 @table @asis
35138 @item ISO C90 compiler
35139 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
35140 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35141
35142 @end table
35143
35144 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35145 @table @asis
35146 @item Expat
35147 @anchor{Expat}
35148 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35149 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35150 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35151 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35152 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35153 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35154
35155 Expat is used for:
35156
35157 @itemize @bullet
35158 @item
35159 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35160 @item
35161 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35162 @item
35163 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35164 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35165 @item
35166 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35167 @item
35168 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35169 @item
35170 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35171 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35172 @end itemize
35173
35174 @item MPFR
35175 @anchor{MPFR}
35176 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35177 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35178 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35179 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35180 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35181 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35182 option to specify its location.
35183
35184 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35185 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35186 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35187 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35188
35189 @item zlib
35190 @cindex compressed debug sections
35191 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35192 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35193 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35194 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35195 information in such binaries.
35196
35197 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35198 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35199 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35200
35201 @item iconv
35202 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35203 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35204 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35205 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35206
35207 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35208 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
35209 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
35210 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
35211
35212 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
35213 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
35214 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
35215
35216 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35217 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35218 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35219 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35220 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35221 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35222 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
35223 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
35224 @end table
35225
35226 @node Running Configure
35227 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35228 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35229 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35230 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35231 build the @code{gdb} program.
35232 @iftex
35233 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35234 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35235 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35236 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35237 @end iftex
35238
35239 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35240 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35241 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35242
35243 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35244 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35245
35246 @table @code
35247 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35248 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35249
35250 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35251 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35252
35253 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35254 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35255
35256 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35257 @sc{gnu} include files
35258
35259 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35260 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35261
35262 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35263 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35264
35265 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35266 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35267
35268 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
35269 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
35270
35271 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
35272 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
35273 @end table
35274
35275 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35276 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35277 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35278
35279 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35280 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35281 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35282 argument.
35283
35284 For example:
35285
35286 @smallexample
35287 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35288 ./configure @var{host}
35289 make
35290 @end smallexample
35291
35292 @noindent
35293 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
35294 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
35295 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
35296 correct value by examining your system.)
35297
35298 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
35299 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
35300 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
35301 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
35302
35303 @need 750
35304 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35305 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35306 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35307
35308 @smallexample
35309 sh configure @var{host}
35310 @end smallexample
35311
35312 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
35313 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
35314 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
35315 @file{configure}
35316 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
35317 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
35318
35319 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35320 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35321 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35322 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35323 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35324 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35325 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35326 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35327 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35328
35329 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
35330 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
35331 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
35332 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
35333 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
35334
35335 @node Separate Objdir
35336 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35337
35338 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35339 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35340 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35341 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35342 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35343 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35344 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35345 program specified there.
35346
35347 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35348 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35349 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35350 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35351 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35352 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35353
35354 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35355 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35356
35357 @smallexample
35358 @group
35359 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35360 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35361 cd ../gdb-sun4
35362 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
35363 make
35364 @end group
35365 @end smallexample
35366
35367 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35368 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35369 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35370 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35371 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35372 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35373
35374 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35375 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35376 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35377 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35378 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35379
35380 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35381 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35382 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35383 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35384 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35385 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35386
35387 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35388 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35389 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35390
35391 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35392 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35393 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35394 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35395 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35396
35397 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35398 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35399 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35400 with each other.
35401
35402 @node Config Names
35403 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35404
35405 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35406 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35407 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35408 of information in the following pattern:
35409
35410 @smallexample
35411 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35412 @end smallexample
35413
35414 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35415 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35416 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35417
35418 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35419 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35420 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35421 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35422 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35423 abbreviations---for example:
35424
35425 @smallexample
35426 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35427 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35428 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35429 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35430 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35431 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35432 % sh config.sub sun4
35433 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35434 % sh config.sub sun3
35435 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35436 % sh config.sub i986v
35437 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35438 @end smallexample
35439
35440 @noindent
35441 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35442 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35443
35444 @node Configure Options
35445 @section @file{configure} Options
35446
35447 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35448 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
35449 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
35450 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
35451
35452 @smallexample
35453 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35454 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35455 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35456 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35457 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
35458 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35459 @var{host}
35460 @end smallexample
35461
35462 @noindent
35463 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35464 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35465 @samp{--}.
35466
35467 @table @code
35468 @item --help
35469 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35470
35471 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35472 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35473 @file{@var{dir}}.
35474
35475 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35476 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35477 @file{@var{dir}}.
35478
35479 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35480 @need 2000
35481 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35482 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35483 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35484 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35485 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35486 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35487 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35488 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35489 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35490 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35491 @var{dirname}.
35492
35493 @item --norecursion
35494 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35495 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35496
35497 @item --target=@var{target}
35498 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35499 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35500 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35501
35502 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35503
35504 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35505 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35506
35507 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35508 @end table
35509
35510 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35511 needed for special purposes only.
35512
35513 @node System-wide configuration
35514 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35515 @cindex system-wide init file
35516
35517 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35518 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35519 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35520
35521 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35522
35523 @table @code
35524 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35525 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35526 @var{file}.
35527 @end table
35528
35529 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35530 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35531
35532 @itemize @bullet
35533 @item
35534 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35535 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35536 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35537 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35538 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35539 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35540
35541 @item
35542 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35543 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35544 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35545 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35546 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35547 @end itemize
35548
35549 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35550 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35551 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35552 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35553 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35554 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35555 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35556 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35557 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35558 reread.
35559
35560 @menu
35561 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35562 @end menu
35563
35564 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35565 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35566 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35567
35568 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35569 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35570 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35571 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35572 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35573 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35574
35575 The following scripts are currently available:
35576 @itemize @bullet
35577
35578 @item @file{elinos.py}
35579 @pindex elinos.py
35580 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35581 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35582 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35583 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35584 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35585 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35586
35587 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35588 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35589 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35590 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35591 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35592 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35593
35594 @end itemize
35595
35596 @node Maintenance Commands
35597 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35598 @cindex maintenance commands
35599 @cindex internal commands
35600
35601 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35602 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35603 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35604 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35605 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35606
35607 @table @code
35608 @kindex maint agent
35609 @kindex maint agent-eval
35610 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35611 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35612 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35613 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35614 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35615 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35616 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35617 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35618 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35619 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35620 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35621 addition and return the sum.
35622 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35623 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35624
35625 @kindex maint agent-printf
35626 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35627 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35628 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35629 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35630 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35631
35632 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35633 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35634 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35635 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35636 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35637 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35638 is shown:
35639
35640 @table @code
35641 @item breakpoint
35642 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35643
35644 @item watchpoint
35645 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35646
35647 @item longjmp
35648 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35649 @code{longjmp} calls.
35650
35651 @item longjmp resume
35652 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35653
35654 @item until
35655 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35656
35657 @item finish
35658 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35659
35660 @item shlib events
35661 Shared library events.
35662
35663 @end table
35664
35665 @kindex maint info btrace
35666 @item maint info btrace
35667 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35668
35669 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35670 @item maint btrace packet-history
35671 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35672 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35673 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35674 recording format.
35675
35676 @table @code
35677 @item bts
35678 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35679 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35680
35681 @table @asis
35682 @item Block number
35683 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35684 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35685 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35686 @end table
35687
35688 @item pt
35689 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35690 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35691 information is printed:
35692
35693 @table @asis
35694 @item Packet number
35695 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35696 @item Trace offset
35697 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35698 @item Packet opcode and payload
35699 @end table
35700 @end table
35701
35702 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35703 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35704 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35705 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35706 needed.
35707
35708 @kindex maint btrace clear
35709 @item maint btrace clear
35710 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35711 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35712
35713 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35714 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35715 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35716 buffer.
35717
35718 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35719 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35720 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35721 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35722 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35723 packet history.
35724
35725 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35726 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35727 @cindex displaced stepping support
35728 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35729 @item set displaced-stepping
35730 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35731 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35732 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35733 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35734 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35735 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35736
35737 @table @code
35738 @item set displaced-stepping on
35739 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35740 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35741
35742 @item set displaced-stepping off
35743 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35744 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35745
35746 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35747 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35748 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35749 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35750 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35751 @end table
35752
35753 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35754 @item maint check-psymtabs
35755 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35756 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35757
35758 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35759 @item maint check-symtabs
35760 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35761
35762 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35763 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35764 Expand symbol tables.
35765 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35766 names matching @var{regexp}.
35767
35768 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35769 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35770 @cindex demangler crashes
35771 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35772 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35773 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35774 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35775 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35776 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35777 option to terminate the current session.
35778
35779 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35780 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35781 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35782
35783 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35784 @item maint cplus namespace
35785 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35786
35787 @kindex maint deprecate
35788 @kindex maint undeprecate
35789 @cindex deprecated commands
35790 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35791 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35792 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35793 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35794 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35795 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35796 the replacement as part of the warning.
35797
35798 @kindex maint dump-me
35799 @item maint dump-me
35800 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35801 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35802 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35803 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35804
35805 @kindex maint internal-error
35806 @kindex maint internal-warning
35807 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35808 @cindex demangler crashes
35809 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35810 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35811 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35812
35813 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35814 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35815 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35816 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35817 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35818 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35819 @value{GDBN} session.
35820
35821 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35822 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35823
35824 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35825
35826 @smallexample
35827 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35828 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35829 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35830 debugging may prove unreliable.
35831 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35832 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35833 (@value{GDBP})
35834 @end smallexample
35835
35836 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35837 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35838 @cindex demangler crashes
35839
35840 @kindex maint set internal-error
35841 @kindex maint show internal-error
35842 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35843 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35844 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35845 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35846 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35847 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35848 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35849 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35850 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35851 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35852 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35853 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35854 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35855 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35856 described in the table below.
35857
35858 @table @samp
35859 @item quit
35860 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35861 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35862
35863 @item corefile
35864 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35865 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35866 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35867 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35868 disabled.
35869 @end table
35870
35871 @kindex maint packet
35872 @item maint packet @var{text}
35873 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35874 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35875 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35876 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35877 checksum.
35878
35879 @kindex maint print architecture
35880 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35881 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35882 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35883
35884 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35885 @item maint print c-tdesc
35886 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35887 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35888 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35889 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35890 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35891 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35892 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35893 modify XML target descriptions.
35894
35895 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35896 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35897 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35898 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35899
35900 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
35901 @kindex maint check libthread-db
35902 @item maint check libthread-db
35903 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
35904 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
35905 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
35906 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
35907 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
35908 on some platforms when debugging core files.
35909
35910 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35911 @item maint print dummy-frames
35912 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35913
35914 @smallexample
35915 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35916 @dots{}
35917 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35918 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35919 58 return (a + b);
35920 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35921 @dots{}
35922 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35923 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35924 (@value{GDBP})
35925 @end smallexample
35926
35927 Takes an optional file parameter.
35928
35929 @kindex maint print registers
35930 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35931 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35932 @kindex maint print register-groups
35933 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35934 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35935 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35936 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35937 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35938 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35939 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35940
35941 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35942 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35943 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35944 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35945 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35946 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35947 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35948 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35949
35950 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35951 write the information.
35952
35953 @kindex maint print reggroups
35954 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35955 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35956 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35957 information.
35958
35959 The register groups info looks like this:
35960
35961 @smallexample
35962 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35963 Group Type
35964 general user
35965 float user
35966 all user
35967 vector user
35968 system user
35969 save internal
35970 restore internal
35971 @end smallexample
35972
35973 @kindex flushregs
35974 @item flushregs
35975 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35976
35977 @kindex maint print objfiles
35978 @cindex info for known object files
35979 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35980 Print a dump of all known object files.
35981 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35982 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35983 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35984
35985 @kindex maint print user-registers
35986 @cindex user registers
35987 @item maint print user-registers
35988 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35989 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35990 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35991 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35992 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35993 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35994 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35995
35996 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35997 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35998 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35999 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
36000 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
36001 matching @var{regexp}.
36002 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
36003 and the full path if known.
36004 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
36005
36006 @kindex maint print statistics
36007 @cindex bcache statistics
36008 @item maint print statistics
36009 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
36010 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
36011 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
36012 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
36013 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
36014 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
36015 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
36016 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
36017 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
36018 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
36019 lengths.
36020
36021 @kindex maint print target-stack
36022 @cindex target stack description
36023 @item maint print target-stack
36024 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
36025 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
36026 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
36027 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
36028 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
36029 address.
36030
36031 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
36032 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
36033
36034 @kindex maint print type
36035 @cindex type chain of a data type
36036 @item maint print type @var{expr}
36037 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
36038 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
36039 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
36040 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
36041 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
36042
36043 @kindex maint selftest
36044 @cindex self tests
36045 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
36046 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
36047 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
36048 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
36049 name will by ran.
36050
36051 @kindex "maint info selftests"
36052 @cindex self tests
36053 @item maint info selftests
36054 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
36055
36056 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36057 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36058 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
36059 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
36060 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
36061 information.
36062
36063 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
36064 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
36065 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
36066 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
36067 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
36068 always see the disassembly form.
36069
36070 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
36071
36072 @smallexample
36073 (gdb) info addr argc
36074 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
36075 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
36076 @end smallexample
36077
36078 For more information on these expressions, see
36079 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
36080
36081 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36082 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36083 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
36084 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
36085 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
36086
36087 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
36088 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
36089 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
36090 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
36091 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
36092 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
36093 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
36094 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
36095 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
36096
36097 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
36098 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
36099 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
36100 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
36101 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
36102
36103 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
36104 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
36105 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
36106 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
36107 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36108 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36109
36110 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36111 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36112 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36113
36114 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36115 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36116 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36117 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36118
36119 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36120 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36121 @kindex maint set profile
36122 @kindex maint show profile
36123 @cindex profiling GDB
36124 @item maint set profile
36125 @itemx maint show profile
36126 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36127
36128 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36129 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36130 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36131 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36132 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36133 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36134 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36135
36136 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36137 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36138
36139 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36140 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36141 @cindex hardware debug registers
36142 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36143 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36144 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36145 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36146 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36147 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36148 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36149
36150 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36151 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36152 @item maint set show-all-tib
36153 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36154 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36155 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36156 command.
36157
36158 @kindex maint set target-async
36159 @kindex maint show target-async
36160 @item maint set target-async
36161 @itemx maint show target-async
36162 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36163 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36164 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36165 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36166
36167 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36168 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36169 @item maint set target-non-stop
36170 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36171
36172 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36173 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36174 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36175 if supported by the target.
36176
36177 @table @code
36178 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36179 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36180 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36181
36182 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36183 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36184 does not indicate support.
36185
36186 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36187 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36188 target supports it.
36189 @end table
36190
36191 @kindex maint set per-command
36192 @kindex maint show per-command
36193 @item maint set per-command
36194 @itemx maint show per-command
36195 @cindex resources used by commands
36196
36197 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36198 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36199
36200 @table @code
36201 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36202 @itemx maint show per-command space
36203 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36204 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36205 took, following the command's own output.
36206 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36207 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36208
36209 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36210 @itemx maint show per-command time
36211 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36212 for each command.
36213 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36214 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36215 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36216 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36217 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36218 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36219 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36220 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36221 spent by the program been debugged.
36222 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36223 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36224
36225 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36226 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36227 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36228 for each command.
36229 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36230
36231 @enumerate a
36232 @item
36233 number of symbol tables
36234 @item
36235 number of primary symbol tables
36236 @item
36237 number of blocks in the blockvector
36238 @end enumerate
36239 @end table
36240
36241 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36242 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36243 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36244 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36245 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36246 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36247 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36248 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36249 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36250 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36251
36252 @kindex maint space
36253 @cindex memory used by commands
36254 @item maint space @var{value}
36255 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36256 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36257
36258 @kindex maint time
36259 @cindex time of command execution
36260 @item maint time @var{value}
36261 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36262 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36263
36264 @kindex maint translate-address
36265 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36266 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36267 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36268 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36269 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36270 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36271 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36272
36273 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36274 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36275 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36276
36277 @end table
36278
36279 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36280 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36281
36282 @table @code
36283 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36284 @kindex set watchdog
36285 @cindex watchdog timer
36286 @cindex timeout for commands
36287 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36288 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36289 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36290
36291 @item show watchdog
36292 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36293 @end table
36294
36295 @node Remote Protocol
36296 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36297
36298 @menu
36299 * Overview::
36300 * Packets::
36301 * Stop Reply Packets::
36302 * General Query Packets::
36303 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36304 * Tracepoint Packets::
36305 * Host I/O Packets::
36306 * Interrupts::
36307 * Notification Packets::
36308 * Remote Non-Stop::
36309 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36310 * Examples::
36311 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36312 * Library List Format::
36313 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36314 * Memory Map Format::
36315 * Thread List Format::
36316 * Traceframe Info Format::
36317 * Branch Trace Format::
36318 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36319 @end menu
36320
36321 @node Overview
36322 @section Overview
36323
36324 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36325 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36326 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36327 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36328
36329 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36330 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36331
36332 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36333 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36334 @cindex remote serial protocol
36335 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36336 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36337 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36338 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36339 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36340
36341 @smallexample
36342 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36343 @end smallexample
36344 @noindent
36345
36346 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36347 @noindent
36348 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36349 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36350 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36351
36352 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36353 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36354
36355 @smallexample
36356 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36357 @end smallexample
36358
36359 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36360 @noindent
36361 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36362 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36363 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36364
36365 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36366 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36367 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36368 retransmission):
36369
36370 @smallexample
36371 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36372 <- @code{+}
36373 @end smallexample
36374 @noindent
36375
36376 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36377 once a connection is established.
36378 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36379
36380 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36381 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36382 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36383 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36384 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36385 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36386 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36387
36388 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36389 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36390 exceptions).
36391
36392 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36393 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36394 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36395 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36396
36397 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36398 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36399 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36400
36401 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36402 @anchor{Binary Data}
36403 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36404 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36405 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36406 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36407 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36408 binary data.
36409
36410 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36411 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36412 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36413 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36414 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36415 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36416 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36417 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36418 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36419 (described next).
36420
36421 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36422 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36423 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36424 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36425 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36426 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36427 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36428 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36429 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36430 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36431 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36432 3}} more times.
36433
36434 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36435 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36436 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36437 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36438 @samp{0*"00}.
36439
36440 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36441 error number. That number is not well defined.
36442
36443 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36444 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36445 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36446 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36447 on that response.
36448
36449 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36450 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36451 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36452 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36453 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36454 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36455
36456 @node Packets
36457 @section Packets
36458
36459 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36460 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36461 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36462 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36463
36464 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36465 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36466 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36467 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36468 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36469 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36470 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36471 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36472 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36473 @var{baz}.
36474
36475 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36476 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36477 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36478 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36479 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36480 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36481 pick any thread.
36482
36483 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36484 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36485 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36486 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36487 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36488 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36489 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36490 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36491 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36492 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36493 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36494 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36495 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36496
36497 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36498 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36499 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36500 more information.
36501
36502 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36503 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36504
36505 Here are the packet descriptions.
36506
36507 @table @samp
36508
36509 @item !
36510 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36511 @anchor{extended mode}
36512 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36513 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36514 debugged.
36515
36516 Reply:
36517 @table @samp
36518 @item OK
36519 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36520 @end table
36521
36522 @item ?
36523 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36524 @anchor{? packet}
36525 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36526 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36527 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36528
36529 Reply:
36530 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36531
36532 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36533 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36534 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36535 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36536 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36537
36538 Reply:
36539 @table @samp
36540 @item OK
36541 The arguments were set.
36542 @item E @var{NN}
36543 An error occurred.
36544 @end table
36545
36546 @item b @var{baud}
36547 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36548 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36549 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36550
36551 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36552 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36553 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36554
36555 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36556 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36557 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36558 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36559 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36560
36561 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36562 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36563 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36564 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36565
36566 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36567 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36568
36569 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36570 @anchor{bc}
36571 @item bc
36572 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36573 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36574
36575 Reply:
36576 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36577
36578 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36579 @anchor{bs}
36580 @item bs
36581 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36582 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36583
36584 Reply:
36585 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36586
36587 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36588 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36589 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36590 is omitted, resume at current address.
36591
36592 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36593 packet}.
36594
36595 Reply:
36596 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36597
36598 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36599 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36600 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36601 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36602
36603 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36604 packet}.
36605
36606 Reply:
36607 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36608
36609 @item d
36610 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36611 Toggle debug flag.
36612
36613 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36614 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36615
36616 @item D
36617 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36618 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36619 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36620 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36621 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36622
36623 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36624 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36625 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36626 big-endian hex string.
36627
36628 Reply:
36629 @table @samp
36630 @item OK
36631 for success
36632 @item E @var{NN}
36633 for an error
36634 @end table
36635
36636 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36637 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36638 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36639 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36640 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36641
36642 @item g
36643 @anchor{read registers packet}
36644 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36645 Read general registers.
36646
36647 Reply:
36648 @table @samp
36649 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36650 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36651 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36652 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36653 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36654 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36655
36656 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36657 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36658 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36659 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36660 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36661 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36662 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36663 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36664
36665 @smallexample
36666 -> @code{g}
36667 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36668 @end smallexample
36669
36670 @item E @var{NN}
36671 for an error.
36672 @end table
36673
36674 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36675 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36676 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36677 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36678
36679 Reply:
36680 @table @samp
36681 @item OK
36682 for success
36683 @item E @var{NN}
36684 for an error
36685 @end table
36686
36687 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36688 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36689 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36690 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36691 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36692 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36693 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36694 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36695 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36696
36697 Reply:
36698 @table @samp
36699 @item OK
36700 for success
36701 @item E @var{NN}
36702 for an error
36703 @end table
36704
36705 @c FIXME: JTC:
36706 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36707 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36708 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36709 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36710 @c described. For example:
36711 @c
36712 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36713 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36714 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36715 @c
36716 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36717 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36718 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36719
36720 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36721 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36722 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36723 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36724 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36725 step starting at that address.
36726
36727 @item I
36728 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36729 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36730 step packet}.
36731
36732 @item k
36733 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36734 Kill request.
36735
36736 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36737
36738 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36739 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36740
36741 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36742
36743 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36744 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36745 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36746
36747 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36748 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36749 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36750
36751 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36752 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36753 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36754 (@pxref{? packet}).
36755
36756 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36757 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36758 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36759 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36760 any particular boundary.
36761
36762 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36763 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36764 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36765 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36766 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36767 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36768 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36769 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36770
36771 Reply:
36772 @table @samp
36773 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36774 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36775 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36776 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36777 @item E @var{NN}
36778 @var{NN} is errno
36779 @end table
36780
36781 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36782 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36783 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36784 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36785 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36786
36787 Reply:
36788 @table @samp
36789 @item OK
36790 for success
36791 @item E @var{NN}
36792 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36793 written).
36794 @end table
36795
36796 @item p @var{n}
36797 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36798 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36799 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36800 register value is encoded.
36801
36802 Reply:
36803 @table @samp
36804 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36805 the register's value
36806 @item E @var{NN}
36807 for an error
36808 @item @w{}
36809 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36810 @end table
36811
36812 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36813 @anchor{write register packet}
36814 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36815 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36816 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36817 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36818
36819 Reply:
36820 @table @samp
36821 @item OK
36822 for success
36823 @item E @var{NN}
36824 for an error
36825 @end table
36826
36827 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36828 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36829 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36830 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36831 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36832 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36833
36834 @item r
36835 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36836 Reset the entire system.
36837
36838 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36839
36840 @item R @var{XX}
36841 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36842 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36843 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36844
36845 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36846
36847 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36848 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36849 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36850 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36851
36852 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36853 packet}.
36854
36855 Reply:
36856 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36857
36858 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36859 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36860 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36861 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36862 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36863
36864 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36865 packet}.
36866
36867 Reply:
36868 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36869
36870 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36871 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36872 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36873 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36874 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36875
36876 @item T @var{thread-id}
36877 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36878 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36879
36880 Reply:
36881 @table @samp
36882 @item OK
36883 thread is still alive
36884 @item E @var{NN}
36885 thread is dead
36886 @end table
36887
36888 @item v
36889 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36890 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36891
36892 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36893 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36894 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36895 The process ID is a
36896 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36897 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36898 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36899
36900 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36901 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36902 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36903 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36904 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36905 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36906 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36907 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36908
36909 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36910
36911 Reply:
36912 @table @samp
36913 @item E @var{nn}
36914 for an error
36915 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36916 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36917 @item OK
36918 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36919 @end table
36920
36921 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36922 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36923 @anchor{vCont packet}
36924 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36925
36926 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36927 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36928 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36929 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36930 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36931 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36932 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36933 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36934 error.
36935
36936 Currently supported actions are:
36937
36938 @table @samp
36939 @item c
36940 Continue.
36941 @item C @var{sig}
36942 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36943 @item s
36944 Step.
36945 @item S @var{sig}
36946 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36947 @item t
36948 Stop.
36949 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36950 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36951 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36952 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36953 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36954 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36955
36956 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36957 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36958 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36959 jumps to @var{start}).
36960
36961 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36962 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36963 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36964
36965 @end table
36966
36967 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36968 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36969 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36970
36971 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36972 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36973 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36974 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36975 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36976 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36977 as an implementation detail.
36978
36979 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36980 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36981 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36982 stopped.
36983
36984 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36985 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36986 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36987
36988 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36989 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36990
36991 Reply:
36992 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36993
36994 @item vCont?
36995 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36996 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36997
36998 Reply:
36999 @table @samp
37000 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
37001 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
37002 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
37003 @item @w{}
37004 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
37005 @end table
37006
37007 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
37008 @item vCtrlC
37009 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
37010 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
37011 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
37012 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
37013 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
37014 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
37015 variant.
37016
37017 Reply:
37018 @table @samp
37019 @item E @var{nn}
37020 for an error
37021 @item OK
37022 for success
37023 @end table
37024
37025 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
37026 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
37027 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
37028 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
37029
37030 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
37031 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
37032 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
37033 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
37034 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
37035 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
37036 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
37037 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
37038 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37039 packet is received.
37040
37041 Reply:
37042 @table @samp
37043 @item OK
37044 for success
37045 @item E @var{NN}
37046 for an error
37047 @end table
37048
37049 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37050 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
37051 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
37052 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
37053 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
37054 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
37055 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
37056 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
37057 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
37058 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
37059 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
37060 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
37061
37062
37063 Reply:
37064 @table @samp
37065 @item OK
37066 for success
37067 @item E.memtype
37068 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
37069 @item E @var{NN}
37070 for an error
37071 @end table
37072
37073 @item vFlashDone
37074 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
37075 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
37076 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
37077 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
37078 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
37079 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
37080 request is completed.
37081
37082 @item vKill;@var{pid}
37083 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
37084 @anchor{vKill packet}
37085 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
37086 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
37087 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
37088 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
37089
37090 Reply:
37091 @table @samp
37092 @item E @var{nn}
37093 for an error
37094 @item OK
37095 for success
37096 @end table
37097
37098 @item vMustReplyEmpty
37099 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
37100 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
37101 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
37102 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
37103
37104 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
37105 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
37106 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
37107 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37108 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37109 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37110
37111 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37112 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37113 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37114 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37115 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37116 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37117 state.
37118
37119 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37120
37121 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37122
37123 Reply:
37124 @table @samp
37125 @item E @var{nn}
37126 for an error
37127 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37128 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37129 @end table
37130
37131 @item vStopped
37132 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37133 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37134
37135 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37136 @anchor{X packet}
37137 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37138 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37139 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37140 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37141 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37142
37143 Reply:
37144 @table @samp
37145 @item OK
37146 for success
37147 @item E @var{NN}
37148 for an error
37149 @end table
37150
37151 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37152 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37153 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37154 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37155 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37156 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37157 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37158
37159 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37160 separately.
37161
37162 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37163 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37164 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37165 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37166 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37167 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37168
37169 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37170 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37171 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37172 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37173 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37174 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37175
37176 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37177 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37178 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37179 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37180 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37181 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37182 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37183 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37184 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37185 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37186 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37187 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37188 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37189
37190 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37191 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37192
37193 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37194 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37195
37196 @table @samp
37197
37198 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37199 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37200 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37201
37202 @end table
37203
37204 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37205 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37206 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37207 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37208 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37209 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37210 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37211
37212 @table @samp
37213
37214 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37215 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37216 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37217
37218 @end table
37219
37220 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37221 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37222 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37223 target, is not defined.}
37224
37225 Reply:
37226 @table @samp
37227 @item OK
37228 success
37229 @item @w{}
37230 not supported
37231 @item E @var{NN}
37232 for an error
37233 @end table
37234
37235 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37236 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37237 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37238 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37239 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37240 address @var{addr}.
37241
37242 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37243 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37244 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37245 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37246
37247 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37248 movement.}
37249
37250 Reply:
37251 @table @samp
37252 @item OK
37253 success
37254 @item @w{}
37255 not supported
37256 @item E @var{NN}
37257 for an error
37258 @end table
37259
37260 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37261 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37262 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37263 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37264 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37265 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37266
37267 Reply:
37268 @table @samp
37269 @item OK
37270 success
37271 @item @w{}
37272 not supported
37273 @item E @var{NN}
37274 for an error
37275 @end table
37276
37277 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37278 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37279 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37280 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37281 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37282 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37283
37284 Reply:
37285 @table @samp
37286 @item OK
37287 success
37288 @item @w{}
37289 not supported
37290 @item E @var{NN}
37291 for an error
37292 @end table
37293
37294 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37295 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37296 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37297 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37298 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37299 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37300
37301 Reply:
37302 @table @samp
37303 @item OK
37304 success
37305 @item @w{}
37306 not supported
37307 @item E @var{NN}
37308 for an error
37309 @end table
37310
37311 @end table
37312
37313 @node Stop Reply Packets
37314 @section Stop Reply Packets
37315 @cindex stop reply packets
37316
37317 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37318 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37319 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37320 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37321 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37322 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37323 @value{GDBN} source code.
37324
37325 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37326 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37327 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37328
37329 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37330 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37331 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37332 components.
37333
37334 @table @samp
37335
37336 @item S @var{AA}
37337 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37338 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37339 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37340
37341 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37342 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37343 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37344 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37345 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37346 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37347 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37348 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37349
37350 @itemize @bullet
37351 @item
37352 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37353 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37354 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37355 two-digit hex number.
37356
37357 @item
37358 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37359 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37360
37361 @item
37362 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37363 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37364
37365 @item
37366 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37367 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37368 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37369 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37370
37371 @item
37372 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37373 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37374 future.
37375 @end itemize
37376
37377 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37378
37379 @table @samp
37380 @item watch
37381 @itemx rwatch
37382 @itemx awatch
37383 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37384 hex.
37385
37386 @item syscall_entry
37387 @itemx syscall_return
37388 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37389 syscall number, in hex.
37390
37391 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37392 @item library
37393 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37394 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37395 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37396
37397 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37398 @item replaylog
37399 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37400 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37401 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37402 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37403 for more information.
37404
37405 @item swbreak
37406 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37407 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37408 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37409 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37410 part must be left empty.
37411
37412 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37413 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37414 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37415 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37416 address.
37417
37418 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37419 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37420 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37421 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37422 indicating support.
37423
37424 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37425
37426 @item hwbreak
37427 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37428 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37429
37430 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37431 apply.
37432
37433 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37434 @item fork
37435 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37436 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37437 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37438 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37439 fork events.
37440
37441 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37442 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37443 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37444 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37445 indicating support.
37446
37447 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37448 @item vfork
37449 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37450 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37451 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37452 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37453 vfork events.
37454
37455 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37456 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37457 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37458 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37459 indicating support.
37460
37461 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37462 @item vforkdone
37463 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37464 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37465 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37466 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37467 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37468
37469 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37470 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37471 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37472 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37473 indicating support.
37474
37475 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37476 @item exec
37477 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37478 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37479 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37480
37481 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37482 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37483 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37484 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37485 indicating support.
37486
37487 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37488 @anchor{thread create event}
37489 @item create
37490 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37491 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37492 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37493 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37494 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37495 @var{r} part is ignored.
37496
37497 @end table
37498
37499 @item W @var{AA}
37500 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37501 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37502 applicable to certain targets.
37503
37504 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37505 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37506 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37507 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37508 hex strings.
37509
37510 @item X @var{AA}
37511 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37512 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37513
37514 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37515 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37516 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37517 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37518 hex strings.
37519
37520 @anchor{thread exit event}
37521 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37522 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37523
37524 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37525 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37526 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37527 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37528
37529 @item N
37530 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37531 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37532 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37533 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37534 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37535 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37536 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37537 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37538 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37539 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37540 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37541 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37542 support.
37543
37544 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37545 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37546 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37547 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37548 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37549
37550 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37551 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37552 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37553 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37554 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37555 system calls.
37556
37557 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37558 this very system call.
37559
37560 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37561 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37562 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37563 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37564 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37565 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37566
37567 @end table
37568
37569 @node General Query Packets
37570 @section General Query Packets
37571 @cindex remote query requests
37572
37573 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37574 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37575 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37576 sending information to and from the stub.
37577
37578 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37579 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37580 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37581 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37582 conventions:
37583
37584 @itemize @bullet
37585 @item
37586 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37587 @item
37588 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37589 letter.
37590 @item
37591 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37592 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37593 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37594 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37595 @end itemize
37596
37597 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37598 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37599 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37600 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37601 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37602 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37603 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37604 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37605 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37606 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37607 packet.}.
37608
37609 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37610 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37611 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37612 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37613 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37614
37615 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37616
37617 @table @samp
37618
37619 @item QAgent:1
37620 @itemx QAgent:0
37621 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37622 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37623
37624 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37625 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37626 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37627 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37628 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37629 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37630 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37631 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37632 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37633 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37634 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37635
37636 @item qC
37637 @cindex current thread, remote request
37638 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37639 Return the current thread ID.
37640
37641 Reply:
37642 @table @samp
37643 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37644 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37645 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37646 @item @r{(anything else)}
37647 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37648 @end table
37649
37650 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37651 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37652 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37653 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37654 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37655 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37656 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37657 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37658
37659 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37660 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37661 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37662 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37663 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37664 detect trailing zeros.
37665
37666 Reply:
37667 @table @samp
37668 @item E @var{NN}
37669 An error (such as memory fault)
37670 @item C @var{crc32}
37671 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37672 @end table
37673
37674 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37675 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37676 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37677 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37678 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37679 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37680 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37681 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37682 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37683 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37684 randomization.
37685
37686 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37687
37688 Reply:
37689 @table @samp
37690 @item OK
37691 The request succeeded.
37692
37693 @item E @var{nn}
37694 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37695
37696 @item @w{}
37697 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37698 by the stub.
37699 @end table
37700
37701 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37702 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37703 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37704 address space randomization.
37705
37706 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37707 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37708 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37709 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37710 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37711 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37712 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37713 inferior using a shell or not.
37714
37715 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37716 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37717 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37718 values are considered an error.
37719
37720 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37721 mode}).
37722
37723 Reply:
37724 @table @samp
37725 @item OK
37726 The request succeeded.
37727
37728 @item E @var{nn}
37729 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37730 @end table
37731
37732 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37733 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37734 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37735 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37736
37737 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37738 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37739
37740 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37741 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37742 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37743 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37744 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37745 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37746 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37747 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37748 environment}).
37749
37750 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37751 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37752 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37753 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37754 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37755 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37756 not be present.
37757
37758 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37759 mode}).
37760
37761 Reply:
37762 @table @samp
37763 @item OK
37764 The request succeeded.
37765 @end table
37766
37767 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37768 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37769 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37770 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37771 inferior.
37772
37773 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37774 @pxref{set environment}.
37775
37776 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37777 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37778 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37779 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37780 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37781 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37782 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37783 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37784
37785 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37786 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37787
37788 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37789 mode}).
37790
37791 Reply:
37792 @table @samp
37793 @item OK
37794 The request succeeded.
37795 @end table
37796
37797 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37798 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37799 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37800 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37801 inferior.
37802
37803 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37804 @pxref{unset environment}.
37805
37806 @item QEnvironmentReset
37807 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37808 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37809 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37810 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37811 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37812 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37813 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37814 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37815 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37816 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37817 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37818
37819 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37820 mode}).
37821
37822 Reply:
37823 @table @samp
37824 @item OK
37825 The request succeeded.
37826 @end table
37827
37828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37830 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37831 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37832 inferior.
37833
37834 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37835 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37836 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37837 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37838 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37839 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37840
37841 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37842 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37843 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37844 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37845 directory to its original, empty value.
37846
37847 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37848 mode}).
37849
37850 Reply:
37851 @table @samp
37852 @item OK
37853 The request succeeded.
37854 @end table
37855
37856 @item qfThreadInfo
37857 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37858 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37859 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37860 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37861 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37862 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37863 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37864 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37865 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37866 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37867
37868 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37869
37870 Reply:
37871 @table @samp
37872 @item m @var{thread-id}
37873 A single thread ID
37874 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37875 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37876 @item l
37877 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37878 @end table
37879
37880 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37881 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37882 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37883 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37884 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37885 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37886 fields.
37887
37888 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37889 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37890 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37891 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37892 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37893
37894 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37895 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37896 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37897 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37898 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37899
37900 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37901 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37902
37903 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37904 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37905 information associated with the variable.)
37906
37907 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37908 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37909 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37910 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37911 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37912 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37913
37914 Reply:
37915 @table @samp
37916 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37917 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37918 local storage requested.
37919
37920 @item E @var{nn}
37921 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37922
37923 @item @w{}
37924 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37925 @end table
37926
37927 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37928 @cindex get thread information block address
37929 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37930 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37931
37932 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37933
37934 Reply:
37935 @table @samp
37936 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37937 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37938 thread information block.
37939
37940 @item E @var{nn}
37941 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37942 address could not be retrieved.
37943
37944 @item @w{}
37945 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37946 @end table
37947
37948 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37949 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37950 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37951 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37952 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37953 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37954 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37955
37956 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37957
37958 Reply:
37959 @table @samp
37960 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37961 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37962 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37963 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37964 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37965 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37966 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37967 @end table
37968
37969 @item qOffsets
37970 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37971 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37972 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37973 image.
37974
37975 Reply:
37976 @table @samp
37977 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37978 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37979 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37980 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37981 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37982 segments by the supplied offsets.
37983
37984 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37985 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37986 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37987
37988 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37989 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37990 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37991 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37992 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37993 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37994 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37995 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37996 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37997 @end table
37998
37999 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
38000 @cindex thread information, remote request
38001 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
38002 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
38003 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
38004 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
38005
38006 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
38007 (see below).
38008
38009 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
38010
38011 @item QNonStop:1
38012 @itemx QNonStop:0
38013 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
38014 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
38015 @anchor{QNonStop}
38016 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
38017 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
38018
38019 Reply:
38020 @table @samp
38021 @item OK
38022 The request succeeded.
38023
38024 @item E @var{nn}
38025 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38026
38027 @item @w{}
38028 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
38029 the stub.
38030 @end table
38031
38032 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38033 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38034 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
38035 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
38036
38037 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
38038 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
38039 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
38040 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38041 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
38042 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
38043 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
38044
38045 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
38046 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
38047 is listed, every system call should be reported.
38048
38049 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
38050 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
38051 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
38052 report the requested syscalls.
38053
38054 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
38055 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38056
38057 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
38058 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
38059 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
38060 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
38061
38062 Reply:
38063 @table @samp
38064 @item OK
38065 The request succeeded.
38066
38067 @item E @var{nn}
38068 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
38069
38070 @item @w{}
38071 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
38072 the stub.
38073 @end table
38074
38075 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
38076 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
38077 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38078 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38079
38080 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38081 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
38082 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38083 @anchor{QPassSignals}
38084 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
38085 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38086 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38087 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
38088 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
38089 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
38090 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
38091 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
38092 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
38093
38094 Reply:
38095 @table @samp
38096 @item OK
38097 The request succeeded.
38098
38099 @item E @var{nn}
38100 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38101
38102 @item @w{}
38103 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
38104 the stub.
38105 @end table
38106
38107 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38108 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38109 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38110 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38111
38112 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38113 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38114 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38115 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38116 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38117 Others should be silently discarded.
38118
38119 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38120 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38121 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38122 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38123 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38124 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38125 signals.
38126
38127 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38128 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38129
38130 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38131 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38132 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38133 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38134 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38135
38136 Reply:
38137 @table @samp
38138 @item OK
38139 The request succeeded.
38140
38141 @item E @var{nn}
38142 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38143
38144 @item @w{}
38145 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38146 by the stub.
38147 @end table
38148
38149 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38150 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38151 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38152 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38153
38154 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38155 @item QThreadEvents:1
38156 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38157 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38158 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38159
38160 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38161 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38162 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38163 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38164 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38165 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38166 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38167 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38168 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38169 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38170
38171 Reply:
38172 @table @samp
38173 @item OK
38174 The request succeeded.
38175
38176 @item E @var{nn}
38177 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38178
38179 @item @w{}
38180 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38181 the stub.
38182 @end table
38183
38184 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38185 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38186
38187 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38188 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38189 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38190 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38191 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38192 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38193 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38194 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38195 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38196
38197 Reply:
38198 @table @samp
38199 @item OK
38200 A command response with no output.
38201 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38202 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38203 @item E @var{NN}
38204 Indicate a badly formed request.
38205 @item @w{}
38206 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38207 @end table
38208
38209 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38210 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38211 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38212 packets.)
38213
38214 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38215 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38216 @ifnotinfo
38217 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38218 @end ifnotinfo
38219 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38220 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38221 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38222 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38223 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38224
38225 Reply:
38226 @table @samp
38227 @item 0
38228 The pattern was not found.
38229 @item 1,address
38230 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38231 @item E @var{NN}
38232 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38233 @item @w{}
38234 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38235 @end table
38236
38237 @item QStartNoAckMode
38238 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38239 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38240 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38241 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38242
38243 Reply:
38244 @table @samp
38245 @item OK
38246 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38247 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38248 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38249 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38250 @item @w{}
38251 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38252 @end table
38253
38254 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38255 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38256 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38257 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38258 @anchor{qSupported}
38259 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38260 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38261 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38262 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38263 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38264 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38265 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38266 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38267 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38268 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38269 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38270 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38271 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38272 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38273
38274 Reply:
38275 @table @samp
38276 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38277 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38278 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38279 possible forms).
38280 @item @w{}
38281 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38282 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38283 @end table
38284
38285 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38286 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38287 are:
38288
38289 @table @samp
38290 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38291 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38292 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38293 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38294 @item @var{name}+
38295 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38296 need an associated value.
38297 @item @var{name}-
38298 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38299 @item @var{name}?
38300 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38301 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38302 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38303 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38304 @end table
38305
38306 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38307 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38308 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38309 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38310 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38311
38312 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38313 are defined:
38314
38315 @table @samp
38316 @item multiprocess
38317 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38318 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38319 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38320 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38321 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38322
38323 @item xmlRegisters
38324 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38325 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38326 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38327 description.
38328
38329 @item qRelocInsn
38330 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38331 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38332 instruction reply packet}).
38333
38334 @item swbreak
38335 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38336 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38337
38338 @item hwbreak
38339 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38340 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38341
38342 @item fork-events
38343 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38344 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38345 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38346 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38347
38348 @item vfork-events
38349 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38350 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38351 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38352 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38353
38354 @item exec-events
38355 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38356 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38357 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38358 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38359
38360 @item vContSupported
38361 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38362 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38363 @end table
38364
38365 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38366 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38367 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38368 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38369 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38370 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38371 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38372 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38373 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38374 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38375 all the features it supports.
38376
38377 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38378 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38379
38380 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38381 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38382 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38383 form response.
38384
38385 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38386 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38387 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38388 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38389
38390 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38391 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38392 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38393 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38394 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38395
38396 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38397
38398 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38399 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38400 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38401 @item Feature Name
38402 @tab Value Required
38403 @tab Default
38404 @tab Probe Allowed
38405
38406 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38407 @tab Yes
38408 @tab @samp{-}
38409 @tab No
38410
38411 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38412 @tab No
38413 @tab @samp{-}
38414 @tab Yes
38415
38416 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38417 @tab No
38418 @tab @samp{-}
38419 @tab Yes
38420
38421 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38422 @tab No
38423 @tab @samp{-}
38424 @tab Yes
38425
38426 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38427 @tab No
38428 @tab @samp{-}
38429 @tab Yes
38430
38431 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38432 @tab No
38433 @tab @samp{-}
38434 @tab Yes
38435
38436 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38437 @tab No
38438 @tab @samp{-}
38439 @tab Yes
38440
38441 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38442 @tab No
38443 @tab @samp{-}
38444 @tab Yes
38445
38446 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38447 @tab No
38448 @tab @samp{-}
38449 @tab No
38450
38451 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38452 @tab No
38453 @tab @samp{-}
38454 @tab Yes
38455
38456 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38457 @tab No
38458 @tab @samp{-}
38459 @tab Yes
38460
38461 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38462 @tab No
38463 @tab @samp{-}
38464 @tab Yes
38465
38466 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38467 @tab No
38468 @tab @samp{-}
38469 @tab Yes
38470
38471 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38472 @tab No
38473 @tab @samp{-}
38474 @tab Yes
38475
38476 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38477 @tab No
38478 @tab @samp{-}
38479 @tab Yes
38480
38481 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38482 @tab No
38483 @tab @samp{-}
38484 @tab Yes
38485
38486 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38487 @tab No
38488 @tab @samp{-}
38489 @tab Yes
38490
38491 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38492 @tab No
38493 @tab @samp{-}
38494 @tab Yes
38495
38496 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38497 @tab No
38498 @tab @samp{-}
38499 @tab Yes
38500
38501 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38502 @tab Yes
38503 @tab @samp{-}
38504 @tab Yes
38505
38506 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38507 @tab Yes
38508 @tab @samp{-}
38509 @tab Yes
38510
38511 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38512 @tab Yes
38513 @tab @samp{-}
38514 @tab Yes
38515
38516 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38517 @tab Yes
38518 @tab @samp{-}
38519 @tab Yes
38520
38521 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38522 @tab Yes
38523 @tab @samp{-}
38524 @tab Yes
38525
38526 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38527 @tab No
38528 @tab @samp{-}
38529 @tab Yes
38530
38531 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38532 @tab No
38533 @tab @samp{-}
38534 @tab Yes
38535
38536 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38537 @tab No
38538 @tab @samp{-}
38539 @tab Yes
38540
38541 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38542 @tab No
38543 @tab @samp{-}
38544 @tab Yes
38545
38546 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38547 @tab No
38548 @tab @samp{-}
38549 @tab No
38550
38551 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38552 @tab No
38553 @tab @samp{-}
38554 @tab No
38555
38556 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38557 @tab No
38558 @tab @samp{-}
38559 @tab No
38560
38561 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38562 @tab No
38563 @tab @samp{-}
38564 @tab No
38565
38566 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38567 @tab No
38568 @tab @samp{-}
38569 @tab No
38570
38571 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38572 @tab No
38573 @tab @samp{-}
38574 @tab No
38575
38576 @item @samp{QAgent}
38577 @tab No
38578 @tab @samp{-}
38579 @tab No
38580
38581 @item @samp{QAllow}
38582 @tab No
38583 @tab @samp{-}
38584 @tab No
38585
38586 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38587 @tab No
38588 @tab @samp{-}
38589 @tab No
38590
38591 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38592 @tab No
38593 @tab @samp{-}
38594 @tab No
38595
38596 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38597 @tab No
38598 @tab @samp{-}
38599 @tab No
38600
38601 @item @samp{tracenz}
38602 @tab No
38603 @tab @samp{-}
38604 @tab No
38605
38606 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38607 @tab No
38608 @tab @samp{-}
38609 @tab No
38610
38611 @item @samp{swbreak}
38612 @tab No
38613 @tab @samp{-}
38614 @tab No
38615
38616 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38617 @tab No
38618 @tab @samp{-}
38619 @tab No
38620
38621 @item @samp{fork-events}
38622 @tab No
38623 @tab @samp{-}
38624 @tab No
38625
38626 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38627 @tab No
38628 @tab @samp{-}
38629 @tab No
38630
38631 @item @samp{exec-events}
38632 @tab No
38633 @tab @samp{-}
38634 @tab No
38635
38636 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38637 @tab No
38638 @tab @samp{-}
38639 @tab No
38640
38641 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38642 @tab No
38643 @tab @samp{-}
38644 @tab No
38645
38646 @end multitable
38647
38648 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38649
38650 @table @samp
38651 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38652 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38653 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38654 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38655 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38656 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38657 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38658 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38659 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38660 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38661
38662 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38663 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38664 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38665
38666 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38667 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38668 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38669
38670 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38671 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38672 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38673
38674 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38675 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38676 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38677
38678 @item qXfer:features:read
38679 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38680 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38681
38682 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38683 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38684 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38685
38686 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38687 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38688 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38689
38690 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38691 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38692 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38693 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38694
38695 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38696 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38697 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38698
38699 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38700 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38701 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38702
38703 @item qXfer:spu:read
38704 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38705 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38706
38707 @item qXfer:spu:write
38708 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38709 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38710
38711 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38712 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38713 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38714
38715 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38716 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38717 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38718
38719 @item qXfer:threads:read
38720 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38721 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38722
38723 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38724 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38725 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38726
38727 @item qXfer:uib:read
38728 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38729 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38730
38731 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38732 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38733 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38734
38735 @item QNonStop
38736 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38737 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38738
38739 @item QCatchSyscalls
38740 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38741 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38742
38743 @item QPassSignals
38744 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38745 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38746
38747 @item QStartNoAckMode
38748 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38749 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38750
38751 @item multiprocess
38752 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38753 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38754 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38755 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38756 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38757 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38758 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38759 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38760 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38761 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38762 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38763
38764 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38765 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38766 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38767
38768 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38769 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38770 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38771 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38772
38773 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38774 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38775 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38776
38777 @item ReverseContinue
38778 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38779 (@pxref{bc}).
38780
38781 @item ReverseStep
38782 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38783 (@pxref{bs}).
38784
38785 @item TracepointSource
38786 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38787 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38788
38789 @item QAgent
38790 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38791
38792 @item QAllow
38793 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38794
38795 @item QDisableRandomization
38796 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38797
38798 @item StaticTracepoint
38799 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38800 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38801
38802 @item InstallInTrace
38803 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38804 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38805
38806 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38807 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38808 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38809 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38810
38811 @item QTBuffer:size
38812 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38813 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38814
38815 @item tracenz
38816 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38817 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38818 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38819
38820 @item BreakpointCommands
38821 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38822 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38823 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38824
38825 @item Qbtrace:off
38826 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38827
38828 @item Qbtrace:bts
38829 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38830
38831 @item Qbtrace:pt
38832 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38833
38834 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38835 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38836
38837 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38838 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38839
38840 @item swbreak
38841 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38842 breakpoints.
38843
38844 @item hwbreak
38845 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38846 breakpoints.
38847
38848 @item fork-events
38849 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38850
38851 @item vfork-events
38852 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38853 and vforkdone events.
38854
38855 @item exec-events
38856 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38857
38858 @item vContSupported
38859 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38860 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38861
38862 @item QThreadEvents
38863 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38864
38865 @item no-resumed
38866 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38867
38868 @end table
38869
38870 @item qSymbol::
38871 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38872 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38873 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38874 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38875
38876 Reply:
38877 @table @samp
38878 @item OK
38879 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38880 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38881 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38882 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38883 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38884 below.
38885 @end table
38886
38887 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38888 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38889
38890 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38891 target has previously requested.
38892
38893 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38894 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38895 will be empty.
38896
38897 Reply:
38898 @table @samp
38899 @item OK
38900 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38901 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38902 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38903 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38904 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38905 @end table
38906
38907 @item qTBuffer
38908 @itemx QTBuffer
38909 @itemx QTDisconnected
38910 @itemx QTDP
38911 @itemx QTDPsrc
38912 @itemx QTDV
38913 @itemx qTfP
38914 @itemx qTfV
38915 @itemx QTFrame
38916 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38917
38918 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38919
38920 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38921 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38922 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38923 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38924 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38925 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38926 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38927 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38928 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38929 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38930 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38931
38932 Reply:
38933 @table @samp
38934 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38935 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38936 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38937 the thread's attributes.
38938 @end table
38939
38940 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38941 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38942 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38943 packets.)
38944
38945 @item QTNotes
38946 @itemx qTP
38947 @itemx QTSave
38948 @itemx qTsP
38949 @itemx qTsV
38950 @itemx QTStart
38951 @itemx QTStop
38952 @itemx QTEnable
38953 @itemx QTDisable
38954 @itemx QTinit
38955 @itemx QTro
38956 @itemx qTStatus
38957 @itemx qTV
38958 @itemx qTfSTM
38959 @itemx qTsSTM
38960 @itemx qTSTMat
38961 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38962
38963 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38964 @cindex read special object, remote request
38965 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38966 @anchor{qXfer read}
38967 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38968 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38969 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38970 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38971 additional details about what data to access.
38972
38973 Reply:
38974 @table @samp
38975 @item m @var{data}
38976 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38977 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38978 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38979 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38980 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38981 request.
38982
38983 @item l @var{data}
38984 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38985 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38986 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38987
38988 @item l
38989 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38990 There is no more data to be read.
38991
38992 @item E00
38993 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38994
38995 @item E @var{nn}
38996 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38997 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38998
38999 @item @w{}
39000 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
39001 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
39002 @end table
39003
39004 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39005 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39006 formats, listed above.
39007
39008 @table @samp
39009 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39010 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
39011 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
39012 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
39013
39014 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39015 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39016
39017 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39018 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
39019
39020 Return a description of the current branch trace.
39021 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
39022 packet may have one of the following values:
39023
39024 @table @code
39025 @item all
39026 Returns all available branch trace.
39027
39028 @item new
39029 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
39030 the last read request.
39031
39032 @item delta
39033 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
39034 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
39035 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
39036 used to stitch traces together.
39037
39038 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
39039 @end table
39040
39041 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39042 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39043
39044 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39045 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
39046
39047 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
39048 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
39049
39050 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
39051 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39052
39053 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39054 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
39055 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
39056 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
39057 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
39058 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
39059 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
39060
39061 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39062 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39063
39064 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39065 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
39066 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
39067 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
39068 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
39069
39070 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39071 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39072
39073 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39074 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
39075 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
39076 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39077 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39078
39079 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
39080 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
39081 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
39082
39083 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39084 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39085
39086 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39087 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
39088 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
39089 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
39090 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
39091 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
39092 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39093 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
39094
39095 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
39096 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
39097
39098 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39099 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39100
39101 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
39102 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
39103 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
39104 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
39105
39106 @table @code
39107 @item start=@var{address}
39108 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39109 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39110 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39111 chosen as the starting point.
39112
39113 @item prev=@var{address}
39114 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39115 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39116 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39117 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39118 exists prior to the starting point.
39119
39120 @end table
39121
39122 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39123 ignored.
39124
39125 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39126 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39127 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39128 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39129 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39130
39131 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39132 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39133
39134 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39135 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39136
39137 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39138 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39139 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39140 Action Lists}.
39141
39142 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39143 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39144 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39145
39146 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39147 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39148 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39149 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39150 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39151
39152 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39153 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39154 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39155
39156 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39157 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39158 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39159 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39160 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39161 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39162 in that context to be accessed.
39163
39164 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39165 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39166 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39167
39168 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39169 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39170 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39171 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39172 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39173
39174 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39175 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39176
39177 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39178 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39179
39180 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39181 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39182 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39183
39184 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39185 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39186
39187 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39188 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39189
39190 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39191 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39192
39193 This packet is not probed by default.
39194
39195 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39196 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39197 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39198 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39199 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39200
39201 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39202 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39203
39204 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39205 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39206 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39207 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39208
39209 @end table
39210
39211 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39212 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39213 @anchor{qXfer write}
39214 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39215 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39216 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39217 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39218 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39219 to access.
39220
39221 Reply:
39222 @table @samp
39223 @item @var{nn}
39224 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39225 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39226
39227 @item E00
39228 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39229
39230 @item E @var{nn}
39231 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39232 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39233
39234 @item @w{}
39235 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39236 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39237 @end table
39238
39239 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39240 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39241 formats, listed above.
39242
39243 @table @samp
39244 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39245 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39246 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39247 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39248 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39249
39250 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39251 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39252 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39253
39254 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39255 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39256 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39257 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39258 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39259 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39260 in that context to be accessed.
39261
39262 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39263 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39264 @end table
39265
39266 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39267 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39268 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39269 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39270 must respond with an empty packet.
39271
39272 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39273 @cindex query attached, remote request
39274 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39275 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39276 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39277 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39278 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39279 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39280 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39281
39282 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39283 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39284 the @code{quit} command.
39285
39286 Reply:
39287 @table @samp
39288 @item 1
39289 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39290 @item 0
39291 The remote server created a new process.
39292 @item E @var{NN}
39293 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39294 @end table
39295
39296 @item Qbtrace:bts
39297 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39298
39299 Reply:
39300 @table @samp
39301 @item OK
39302 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39303 @item E.errtext
39304 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39305 @end table
39306
39307 @item Qbtrace:pt
39308 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39309
39310 Reply:
39311 @table @samp
39312 @item OK
39313 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39314 @item E.errtext
39315 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39316 @end table
39317
39318 @item Qbtrace:off
39319 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39320
39321 Reply:
39322 @table @samp
39323 @item OK
39324 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39325 @item E.errtext
39326 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39327 @end table
39328
39329 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39330 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39331 btrace recording method in bts format.
39332
39333 Reply:
39334 @table @samp
39335 @item OK
39336 The ring buffer size has been set.
39337 @item E.errtext
39338 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39339 @end table
39340
39341 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39342 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39343 btrace recording method in pt format.
39344
39345 Reply:
39346 @table @samp
39347 @item OK
39348 The ring buffer size has been set.
39349 @item E.errtext
39350 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39351 @end table
39352
39353 @end table
39354
39355 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39356 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39357
39358 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39359 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39360 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39361
39362 @menu
39363 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39364 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39365 @end menu
39366
39367 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39368 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39369
39370 @menu
39371 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39372 @end menu
39373
39374 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39375 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39376 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39377
39378 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39379
39380 @table @r
39381
39382 @item 2
39383 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39384
39385 @item 3
39386 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39387
39388 @item 4
39389 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39390
39391 @end table
39392
39393 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39394 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39395
39396 @menu
39397 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39398 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39399 @end menu
39400
39401 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39402 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39403 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39404
39405 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39406 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39407 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39408 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39409 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39410 most-significant -- least-significant.
39411
39412 @table @r
39413
39414 @item MIPS32
39415 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39416 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39417 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39418
39419 @item MIPS64
39420 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39421 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39422 as @code{MIPS32}.
39423
39424 @end table
39425
39426 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39427 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39428 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39429
39430 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39431
39432 @table @r
39433
39434 @item 2
39435 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39436
39437 @item 3
39438 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39439
39440 @item 4
39441 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39442
39443 @item 5
39444 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39445
39446 @end table
39447
39448 @node Tracepoint Packets
39449 @section Tracepoint Packets
39450 @cindex tracepoint packets
39451 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39452
39453 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39454 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39455
39456 @table @samp
39457
39458 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39459 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39460 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39461 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39462 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39463 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39464 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39465 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39466 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39467 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39468 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39469 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39470 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39471 actions.
39472
39473 Replies:
39474 @table @samp
39475 @item OK
39476 The packet was understood and carried out.
39477 @item qRelocInsn
39478 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39479 @item @w{}
39480 The packet was not recognized.
39481 @end table
39482
39483 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39484 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39485 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39486 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39487 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39488 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39489 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39490
39491 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39492 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39493 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39494 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39495 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39496 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39497 tracepoint actions.
39498
39499 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39500 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39501 following forms:
39502
39503 @table @samp
39504
39505 @item R @var{mask}
39506 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39507 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39508 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39509 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39510 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39511
39512 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39513 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39514 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39515 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39516 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39517 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39518 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39519
39520 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39521 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39522 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39523 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39524 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39525 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39526 packet).
39527
39528 @end table
39529
39530 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39531 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39532 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39533 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39534 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39535 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39536 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39537 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39538
39539 Replies:
39540 @table @samp
39541 @item OK
39542 The packet was understood and carried out.
39543 @item qRelocInsn
39544 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39545 @item @w{}
39546 The packet was not recognized.
39547 @end table
39548
39549 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39550 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39551 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39552 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39553 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39554 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39555 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39556 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39557
39558 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39559 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39560 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39561 fit in a single packet.
39562 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39563 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39564
39565 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39566 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39567 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39568 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39569
39570 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39571 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39572 query packets.
39573
39574 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39575 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39576 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39577 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39578 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39579 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39580 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39581 be found.
39582
39583 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39584 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39585 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39586 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39587 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39588 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39589 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39590 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39591 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39592 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39593 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39594 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39595 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39596 variable.
39597
39598 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39599 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39600 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39601 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39602 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39603
39604 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39605 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39606 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39607 one of the following forms:
39608
39609 @table @samp
39610 @item F @var{f}
39611 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39612 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39613 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39614
39615 @item T @var{t}
39616 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39617 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39618
39619 @end table
39620
39621 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39622 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39623 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39624 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39625
39626 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39627 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39628 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39629 is a hexadecimal number.
39630
39631 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39632 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39633 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39634 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39635 numbers.
39636
39637 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39638 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39639 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39640
39641 @item qTMinFTPILen
39642 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39643 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39644 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39645 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39646 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39647 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39648 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39649 arrange for that.
39650
39651 Replies:
39652
39653 @table @samp
39654 @item 0
39655 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39656 @item @var{length}
39657 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39658 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39659 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39660 regardless of size.
39661 @item E
39662 An error has occurred.
39663 @item @w{}
39664 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39665 @end table
39666
39667 @item QTStart
39668 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39669 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39670 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39671 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39672 instruction reply packet}).
39673
39674 @item QTStop
39675 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39676 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39677
39678 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39679 @anchor{QTEnable}
39680 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39681 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39682 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39683 of data from it will resume.
39684
39685 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39686 @anchor{QTDisable}
39687 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39688 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39689 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39690 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39691
39692 @item QTinit
39693 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39694 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39695
39696 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39697 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39698 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39699 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39700 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39701
39702 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39703 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39704 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39705 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39706
39707 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39708 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39709 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39710 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39711 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39712 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39713
39714 @item qTStatus
39715 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39716 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39717
39718 The reply has the form:
39719
39720 @table @samp
39721
39722 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39723 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39724 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39725 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39726
39727 @end table
39728
39729 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39730 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39731
39732 @table @samp
39733
39734 @item tnotrun:0
39735 No trace has been run yet.
39736
39737 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39738 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39739 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39740 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39741 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39742
39743 @item tfull:0
39744 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39745
39746 @item tdisconnected:0
39747 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39748
39749 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39750 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39751
39752 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39753 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39754 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39755 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39756 is hex encoded.
39757
39758 @item tunknown:0
39759 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39760
39761 @end table
39762
39763 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39764 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39765 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39766 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39767 trace.
39768
39769 @table @samp
39770
39771 @item tframes:@var{n}
39772 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39773
39774 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39775 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39776 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39777
39778 @item tsize:@var{n}
39779 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39780
39781 @item tfree:@var{n}
39782 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39783
39784 @item circular:@var{n}
39785 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39786 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39787 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39788 and may fill up.
39789
39790 @item disconn:@var{n}
39791 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39792 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39793 that the trace run will stop.
39794
39795 @end table
39796
39797 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39798 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39799 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39800 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39801 address @var{addr}.
39802
39803 Replies:
39804 @table @samp
39805 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39806 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39807 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39808 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39809 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39810
39811 @end table
39812
39813 @item qTV:@var{var}
39814 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39815 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39816 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39817
39818 Replies:
39819 @table @samp
39820 @item V@var{value}
39821 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39822 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39823 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39824 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39825 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39826 program is running.
39827
39828 @item U
39829 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39830 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39831 was not collected.
39832 @end table
39833
39834 @item qTfP
39835 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39836 @itemx qTsP
39837 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39838 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39839 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39840 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39841 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39842 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39843
39844 @item qTfV
39845 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39846 @itemx qTsV
39847 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39848 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39849 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39850 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39851 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39852 trace state variables.
39853
39854 @item qTfSTM
39855 @itemx qTsSTM
39856 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39857 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39858 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39859 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39860 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39861 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39862 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39863 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39864
39865 Reply:
39866 @table @samp
39867 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39868 A single marker
39869 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39870 a comma-separated list of markers
39871 @item l
39872 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39873 @item E @var{nn}
39874 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39875 @item @w{}
39876 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39877 stub.
39878 @end table
39879
39880 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39881 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39882
39883 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39884 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39885 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39886 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39887 @dfn{last}).
39888
39889 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39890 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39891 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39892 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39893 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39894 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39895 tracepoint markers.
39896
39897 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39898 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39899 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39900 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39901 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39902 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39903
39904 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39905 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39906 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39907 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39908 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39909 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39910 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39911 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39912 available.
39913
39914 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39915 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39916 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39917
39918 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39919 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39920 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39921 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39922 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39923 use whatever size it prefers.
39924
39925 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39926 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39927 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39928 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39929 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39930
39931 @end table
39932
39933 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39934 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39935 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39936 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39937 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39938 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39939 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39940 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39941 it had executed in the original location.
39942
39943 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39944 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39945 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39946 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39947 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39948 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39949 format of the request is:
39950
39951 @table @samp
39952 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39953
39954 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39955 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39956 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39957 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39958 memory starting at @var{to}.
39959 @end table
39960
39961 Replies:
39962 @table @samp
39963 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39964 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39965 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39966 @item E @var{NN}
39967 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39968 relocating the instruction.
39969 @end table
39970
39971 @node Host I/O Packets
39972 @section Host I/O Packets
39973 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39974 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39975
39976 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39977 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39978 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39979 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39980 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39981 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39982 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39983 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39984 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39985 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39986
39987 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39988 its arguments. They have this format:
39989
39990 @table @samp
39991
39992 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39993 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39994 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39995 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39996 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39997 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39998 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39999 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
40000 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
40001
40002 @end table
40003
40004 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
40005
40006 @table @samp
40007
40008 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
40009 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
40010 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
40011 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
40012 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
40013 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
40014 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
40015 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
40016 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
40017 @var{attachment}.
40018
40019 @item @w{}
40020 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
40021
40022 @end table
40023
40024 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
40025
40026 @table @samp
40027 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
40028 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
40029 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
40030 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
40031 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
40032 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
40033 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
40034
40035 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
40036 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
40037 -1 if an error occurs.
40038
40039 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
40040 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
40041 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
40042 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
40043 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
40044 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
40045 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
40046 @var{count} was zero.
40047
40048 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40049 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40050 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40051 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40052 some characters were escaped.
40053
40054 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
40055 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
40056 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
40057 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
40058 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
40059 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
40060 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
40061 error occurred.
40062
40063 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
40064 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
40065 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
40066 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
40067 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
40068 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
40069
40070 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
40071 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
40072 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
40073
40074 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
40075 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
40076 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
40077
40078 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
40079 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
40080 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
40081 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
40082 some characters were escaped.
40083
40084 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
40085 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
40086 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
40087 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
40088 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
40089 inferior(s).
40090
40091 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
40092 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
40093 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
40094 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
40095 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
40096 operation.
40097
40098 @end table
40099
40100 @node Interrupts
40101 @section Interrupts
40102 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
40103 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
40104
40105 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
40106 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
40107 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40108 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40109
40110 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40111 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40112 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40113 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40114 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40115
40116 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40117 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40118 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40119 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40120 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40121 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40122 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40123 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40124
40125 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40126 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40127 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40128
40129 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40130 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40131 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40132 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40133 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40134 @code{0x03}.
40135
40136 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40137 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40138 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40139 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40140 currently-executing threads and processes.
40141 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40142 running program, it should send one of the stop
40143 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40144 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40145 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40146 Interrupts received while the
40147 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40148 it is resumed next time.
40149
40150 @node Notification Packets
40151 @section Notification Packets
40152 @cindex notification packets
40153 @cindex packets, notification
40154
40155 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40156 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40157 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40158 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40159 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40160 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40161 is not a problem.
40162
40163 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40164 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40165 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40166 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40167 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40168 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40169 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40170
40171 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40172 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40173
40174 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40175 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40176 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40177 not they understand it.
40178
40179 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40180 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40181 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40182 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40183 recipients.
40184
40185 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40186 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40187 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40188 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40189 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40190
40191 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40192 @table @samp
40193 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40194 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40195 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40196 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40197 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40198 @item @var{ack}
40199 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40200 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40201 @end table
40202
40203 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40204 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40205
40206 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40207 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40208 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40209 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40210 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40211 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40212 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40213 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40214 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40215 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40216
40217 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40218 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40219 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40220 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40221 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40222 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40223
40224 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40225 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40226 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40227 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40228 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40229
40230 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40231 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40232 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40233 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40234 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40235 normally.
40236
40237 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40238 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40239 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40240 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40241 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40242 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40243 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40244 the process shall be repeated.
40245
40246 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40247 following example:
40248 @smallexample
40249 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40250 @code{...}
40251 -> @code{vStopped}
40252 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40253 -> @code{vStopped}
40254 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40255 -> @code{vStopped}
40256 <- @code{OK}
40257 @end smallexample
40258
40259 The following notifications are defined:
40260 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40261
40262 @item Notification
40263 @tab Ack
40264 @tab Event
40265 @tab Description
40266
40267 @item Stop
40268 @tab vStopped
40269 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40270 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40271 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40272 @value{GDBN}.
40273 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40274
40275 @end multitable
40276
40277 @node Remote Non-Stop
40278 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40279
40280 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40281 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40282 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40283 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40284
40285 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40286 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40287 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40288 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40289 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40290 probe the target state after a mode change.
40291
40292 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40293 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40294 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40295 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40296 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40297 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40298 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40299 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40300 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40301 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40302 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40303
40304 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40305 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40306 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40307 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40308 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40309 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40310 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40311 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40312 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40313 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40314 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40315 @samp{OK}.
40316
40317 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40318 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40319 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40320 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40321 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40322 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40323 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40324 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40325 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40326 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40327 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40328 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40329 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40330
40331 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40332 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40333
40334 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40335 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40336 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40337 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40338 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40339 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40340 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40341
40342 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40343 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40344 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40345 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40346 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40347
40348 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40349 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40350 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40351 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40352
40353 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40354 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40355 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40356 @pxref{qSupported}.
40357 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40358 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40359 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40360 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40361 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40362 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40363 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40364
40365 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40366 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40367 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40368 connection.
40369 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40370 new connection is established,
40371 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40372 for the current connection, once disabled.
40373
40374 @node Examples
40375 @section Examples
40376
40377 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40378 does not get any direct output:
40379
40380 @smallexample
40381 -> @code{R00}
40382 <- @code{+}
40383 @emph{target restarts}
40384 -> @code{?}
40385 <- @code{+}
40386 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40387 -> @code{+}
40388 @end smallexample
40389
40390 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40391
40392 @smallexample
40393 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40394 <- @code{+}
40395 -> @code{s}
40396 <- @code{+}
40397 @emph{time passes}
40398 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40399 -> @code{+}
40400 -> @code{g}
40401 <- @code{+}
40402 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40403 -> @code{+}
40404 @end smallexample
40405
40406 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40407 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40408 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40409
40410 @menu
40411 * File-I/O Overview::
40412 * Protocol Basics::
40413 * The F Request Packet::
40414 * The F Reply Packet::
40415 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40416 * Console I/O::
40417 * List of Supported Calls::
40418 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40419 * Constants::
40420 * File-I/O Examples::
40421 @end menu
40422
40423 @node File-I/O Overview
40424 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40425 @cindex file-i/o overview
40426
40427 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40428 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40429 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40430 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40431 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40432 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40433
40434 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40435 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40436 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40437 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40438 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40439
40440 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40441 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40442 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40443 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40444 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40445 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40446 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40447
40448 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40449 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40450 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40451 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40452 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40453
40454 @smallexample
40455 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40456 <- target requests 'system call X'
40457 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40458 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40459 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40460 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40461 @end smallexample
40462
40463 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40464 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40465 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40466 system are not supported by this protocol.
40467
40468 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40469
40470 @node Protocol Basics
40471 @subsection Protocol Basics
40472 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40473
40474 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40475 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40476 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40477 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40478 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40479 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40480 to call the appropriate host system call:
40481
40482 @itemize @bullet
40483 @item
40484 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40485
40486 @item
40487 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40488 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40489 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40490 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40491
40492 @end itemize
40493
40494 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40495
40496 @itemize @bullet
40497 @item
40498 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40499 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40500 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40501 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40502 packet.
40503
40504 @item
40505 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40506 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40507
40508 @item
40509 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40510
40511 @item
40512 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40513
40514 @item
40515 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40516 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40517 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40518 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40519 packet.
40520
40521 @end itemize
40522
40523 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40524 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40525
40526 @itemize @bullet
40527 @item
40528 Return value.
40529
40530 @item
40531 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40532
40533 @item
40534 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40535
40536 @end itemize
40537
40538 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40539 the latest continue or step action.
40540
40541 @node The F Request Packet
40542 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40543 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40544 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40545
40546 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40547
40548 @table @samp
40549 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40550
40551 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40552 This is just the name of the function.
40553
40554 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40555 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40556 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40557 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40558 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40559 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40560 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40561
40562 @end table
40563
40564
40565
40566 @node The F Reply Packet
40567 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40568 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40569 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40570
40571 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40572
40573 @table @samp
40574
40575 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40576
40577 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40578
40579 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40580 representation.
40581 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40582
40583 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40584 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40585 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40586
40587 @smallexample
40588 F0,0,C
40589 @end smallexample
40590
40591 @noindent
40592 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40593
40594 @smallexample
40595 F-1,4,C
40596 @end smallexample
40597
40598 @noindent
40599 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40600
40601 @end table
40602
40603
40604 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40605 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40606 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40607
40608 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40609 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40610 the target should behave as if it had
40611 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40612 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40613 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40614 packet.
40615
40616 It's important for the target to know in which
40617 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40618
40619 @itemize @bullet
40620 @item
40621 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40622
40623 @item
40624 The system call on the host has been finished.
40625
40626 @end itemize
40627
40628 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40629 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40630 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40631 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40632 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40633 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40634
40635 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40636 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40637 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40638 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40639 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40640 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40641 or the full action has been completed.
40642
40643 @node Console I/O
40644 @subsection Console I/O
40645 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40646
40647 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40648 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40649 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40650 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40651 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40652 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40653 conditions is met:
40654
40655 @itemize @bullet
40656 @item
40657 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40658 @code{read}
40659 system call is treated as finished.
40660
40661 @item
40662 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40663 newline.
40664
40665 @item
40666 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40667 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40668
40669 @end itemize
40670
40671 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40672 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40673 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40674 is stopped at the user's request.
40675
40676
40677 @node List of Supported Calls
40678 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40679 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40680
40681 @menu
40682 * open::
40683 * close::
40684 * read::
40685 * write::
40686 * lseek::
40687 * rename::
40688 * unlink::
40689 * stat/fstat::
40690 * gettimeofday::
40691 * isatty::
40692 * system::
40693 @end menu
40694
40695 @node open
40696 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40697 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40698
40699 @table @asis
40700 @item Synopsis:
40701 @smallexample
40702 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40703 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40704 @end smallexample
40705
40706 @item Request:
40707 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40708
40709 @noindent
40710 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40711
40712 @table @code
40713 @item O_CREAT
40714 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40715 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40716 are concerned.
40717
40718 @item O_EXCL
40719 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40720 an error and open() fails.
40721
40722 @item O_TRUNC
40723 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40724 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40725 truncated to zero length.
40726
40727 @item O_APPEND
40728 The file is opened in append mode.
40729
40730 @item O_RDONLY
40731 The file is opened for reading only.
40732
40733 @item O_WRONLY
40734 The file is opened for writing only.
40735
40736 @item O_RDWR
40737 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40738 @end table
40739
40740 @noindent
40741 Other bits are silently ignored.
40742
40743
40744 @noindent
40745 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40746
40747 @table @code
40748 @item S_IRUSR
40749 User has read permission.
40750
40751 @item S_IWUSR
40752 User has write permission.
40753
40754 @item S_IRGRP
40755 Group has read permission.
40756
40757 @item S_IWGRP
40758 Group has write permission.
40759
40760 @item S_IROTH
40761 Others have read permission.
40762
40763 @item S_IWOTH
40764 Others have write permission.
40765 @end table
40766
40767 @noindent
40768 Other bits are silently ignored.
40769
40770
40771 @item Return value:
40772 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40773 occurred.
40774
40775 @item Errors:
40776
40777 @table @code
40778 @item EEXIST
40779 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40780
40781 @item EISDIR
40782 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40783
40784 @item EACCES
40785 The requested access is not allowed.
40786
40787 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40788 @var{pathname} was too long.
40789
40790 @item ENOENT
40791 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40792
40793 @item ENODEV
40794 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40795
40796 @item EROFS
40797 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40798 write access was requested.
40799
40800 @item EFAULT
40801 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40802
40803 @item ENOSPC
40804 No space on device to create the file.
40805
40806 @item EMFILE
40807 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40808
40809 @item ENFILE
40810 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40811 has been reached.
40812
40813 @item EINTR
40814 The call was interrupted by the user.
40815 @end table
40816
40817 @end table
40818
40819 @node close
40820 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40821 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40822
40823 @table @asis
40824 @item Synopsis:
40825 @smallexample
40826 int close(int fd);
40827 @end smallexample
40828
40829 @item Request:
40830 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40831
40832 @item Return value:
40833 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40834
40835 @item Errors:
40836
40837 @table @code
40838 @item EBADF
40839 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40840
40841 @item EINTR
40842 The call was interrupted by the user.
40843 @end table
40844
40845 @end table
40846
40847 @node read
40848 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40849 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40850
40851 @table @asis
40852 @item Synopsis:
40853 @smallexample
40854 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40855 @end smallexample
40856
40857 @item Request:
40858 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40859
40860 @item Return value:
40861 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40862 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40863 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40864
40865 @item Errors:
40866
40867 @table @code
40868 @item EBADF
40869 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40870 reading.
40871
40872 @item EFAULT
40873 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40874
40875 @item EINTR
40876 The call was interrupted by the user.
40877 @end table
40878
40879 @end table
40880
40881 @node write
40882 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40883 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40884
40885 @table @asis
40886 @item Synopsis:
40887 @smallexample
40888 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40889 @end smallexample
40890
40891 @item Request:
40892 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40893
40894 @item Return value:
40895 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40896 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40897 is returned.
40898
40899 @item Errors:
40900
40901 @table @code
40902 @item EBADF
40903 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40904 writing.
40905
40906 @item EFAULT
40907 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40908
40909 @item EFBIG
40910 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40911 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40912
40913 @item ENOSPC
40914 No space on device to write the data.
40915
40916 @item EINTR
40917 The call was interrupted by the user.
40918 @end table
40919
40920 @end table
40921
40922 @node lseek
40923 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40924 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40925
40926 @table @asis
40927 @item Synopsis:
40928 @smallexample
40929 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40930 @end smallexample
40931
40932 @item Request:
40933 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40934
40935 @var{flag} is one of:
40936
40937 @table @code
40938 @item SEEK_SET
40939 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40940
40941 @item SEEK_CUR
40942 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40943 bytes.
40944
40945 @item SEEK_END
40946 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40947 bytes.
40948 @end table
40949
40950 @item Return value:
40951 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40952 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40953 value of -1 is returned.
40954
40955 @item Errors:
40956
40957 @table @code
40958 @item EBADF
40959 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40960
40961 @item ESPIPE
40962 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40963
40964 @item EINVAL
40965 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40966
40967 @item EINTR
40968 The call was interrupted by the user.
40969 @end table
40970
40971 @end table
40972
40973 @node rename
40974 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40975 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40976
40977 @table @asis
40978 @item Synopsis:
40979 @smallexample
40980 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40981 @end smallexample
40982
40983 @item Request:
40984 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40985
40986 @item Return value:
40987 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40988
40989 @item Errors:
40990
40991 @table @code
40992 @item EISDIR
40993 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40994 directory.
40995
40996 @item EEXIST
40997 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40998
40999 @item EBUSY
41000 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
41001 process.
41002
41003 @item EINVAL
41004 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
41005 of itself.
41006
41007 @item ENOTDIR
41008 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
41009 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
41010 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
41011
41012 @item EFAULT
41013 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
41014
41015 @item EACCES
41016 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41017
41018 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41019
41020 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
41021
41022 @item ENOENT
41023 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
41024
41025 @item EROFS
41026 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41027
41028 @item ENOSPC
41029 The device containing the file has no room for the new
41030 directory entry.
41031
41032 @item EINTR
41033 The call was interrupted by the user.
41034 @end table
41035
41036 @end table
41037
41038 @node unlink
41039 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
41040 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
41041
41042 @table @asis
41043 @item Synopsis:
41044 @smallexample
41045 int unlink(const char *pathname);
41046 @end smallexample
41047
41048 @item Request:
41049 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
41050
41051 @item Return value:
41052 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41053
41054 @item Errors:
41055
41056 @table @code
41057 @item EACCES
41058 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41059
41060 @item EPERM
41061 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
41062
41063 @item EBUSY
41064 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
41065 being used by another process.
41066
41067 @item EFAULT
41068 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41069
41070 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41071 @var{pathname} was too long.
41072
41073 @item ENOENT
41074 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
41075
41076 @item ENOTDIR
41077 A component of the path is not a directory.
41078
41079 @item EROFS
41080 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
41081
41082 @item EINTR
41083 The call was interrupted by the user.
41084 @end table
41085
41086 @end table
41087
41088 @node stat/fstat
41089 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
41090 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
41091 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
41092
41093 @table @asis
41094 @item Synopsis:
41095 @smallexample
41096 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
41097 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
41098 @end smallexample
41099
41100 @item Request:
41101 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
41102 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
41103
41104 @item Return value:
41105 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
41106
41107 @item Errors:
41108
41109 @table @code
41110 @item EBADF
41111 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41112
41113 @item ENOENT
41114 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41115 path is an empty string.
41116
41117 @item ENOTDIR
41118 A component of the path is not a directory.
41119
41120 @item EFAULT
41121 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41122
41123 @item EACCES
41124 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41125
41126 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41127 @var{pathname} was too long.
41128
41129 @item EINTR
41130 The call was interrupted by the user.
41131 @end table
41132
41133 @end table
41134
41135 @node gettimeofday
41136 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41137 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41138
41139 @table @asis
41140 @item Synopsis:
41141 @smallexample
41142 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41143 @end smallexample
41144
41145 @item Request:
41146 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41147
41148 @item Return value:
41149 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41150
41151 @item Errors:
41152
41153 @table @code
41154 @item EINVAL
41155 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41156
41157 @item EFAULT
41158 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41159 @end table
41160
41161 @end table
41162
41163 @node isatty
41164 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41165 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41166
41167 @table @asis
41168 @item Synopsis:
41169 @smallexample
41170 int isatty(int fd);
41171 @end smallexample
41172
41173 @item Request:
41174 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41175
41176 @item Return value:
41177 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41178
41179 @item Errors:
41180
41181 @table @code
41182 @item EINTR
41183 The call was interrupted by the user.
41184 @end table
41185
41186 @end table
41187
41188 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41189 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41190 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41191 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41192 needed.
41193
41194
41195 @node system
41196 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41197 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41198
41199 @table @asis
41200 @item Synopsis:
41201 @smallexample
41202 int system(const char *command);
41203 @end smallexample
41204
41205 @item Request:
41206 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41207
41208 @item Return value:
41209 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41210 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41211 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41212 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41213 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41214 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41215 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41216
41217 @item Errors:
41218
41219 @table @code
41220 @item EINTR
41221 The call was interrupted by the user.
41222 @end table
41223
41224 @end table
41225
41226 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41227 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41228 the host is simplified before it's returned
41229 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41230 is discarded, and the return value consists
41231 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41232
41233 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41234 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41235 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41236
41237 @table @code
41238 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41239 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41240 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41241 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41242
41243 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41244 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41245 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41246 protocol.
41247 @end table
41248
41249 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41250 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41251 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41252
41253 @menu
41254 * Integral Datatypes::
41255 * Pointer Values::
41256 * Memory Transfer::
41257 * struct stat::
41258 * struct timeval::
41259 @end menu
41260
41261 @node Integral Datatypes
41262 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41263 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41264
41265 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41266 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41267 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41268
41269 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41270 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41271
41272 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41273
41274 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41275 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41276
41277 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41278
41279 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41280 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41281 byte order.
41282
41283 @node Pointer Values
41284 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41285 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41286
41287 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41288 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41289 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41290 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41291
41292 @smallexample
41293 @code{1aaf/12}
41294 @end smallexample
41295
41296 @noindent
41297 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41298 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41299 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41300 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41301
41302 @smallexample
41303 @code{123456/d}
41304 @end smallexample
41305
41306 @node Memory Transfer
41307 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41308 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41309
41310 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41311 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41312 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41313 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41314 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41315 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41316 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41317
41318
41319 @node struct stat
41320 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41321 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41322
41323 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41324 is defined as follows:
41325
41326 @smallexample
41327 struct stat @{
41328 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41329 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41330 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41331 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41332 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41333 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41334 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41335 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41336 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41337 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41338 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41339 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41340 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41341 @};
41342 @end smallexample
41343
41344 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41345 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41346 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41347
41348 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41349 range of values.
41350
41351 @table @code
41352
41353 @item st_dev
41354 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41355
41356 @item st_ino
41357 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41358
41359 @item st_mode
41360 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41361 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41362
41363 @item st_uid
41364 @itemx st_gid
41365 @itemx st_rdev
41366 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41367
41368 @item st_atime
41369 @itemx st_mtime
41370 @itemx st_ctime
41371 These values have a host and file system dependent
41372 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41373 support exact timing values.
41374 @end table
41375
41376 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41377 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41378 continuing.
41379
41380 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41381 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41382 get truncated on the target.
41383
41384 @node struct timeval
41385 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41386 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41387
41388 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41389 is defined as follows:
41390
41391 @smallexample
41392 struct timeval @{
41393 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41394 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41395 @};
41396 @end smallexample
41397
41398 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41399 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41400 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41401
41402 @node Constants
41403 @subsection Constants
41404 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41405
41406 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41407 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41408 values before and after the call as needed.
41409
41410 @menu
41411 * Open Flags::
41412 * mode_t Values::
41413 * Errno Values::
41414 * Lseek Flags::
41415 * Limits::
41416 @end menu
41417
41418 @node Open Flags
41419 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41420 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41421
41422 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41423
41424 @smallexample
41425 O_RDONLY 0x0
41426 O_WRONLY 0x1
41427 O_RDWR 0x2
41428 O_APPEND 0x8
41429 O_CREAT 0x200
41430 O_TRUNC 0x400
41431 O_EXCL 0x800
41432 @end smallexample
41433
41434 @node mode_t Values
41435 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41436 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41437
41438 All values are given in octal representation.
41439
41440 @smallexample
41441 S_IFREG 0100000
41442 S_IFDIR 040000
41443 S_IRUSR 0400
41444 S_IWUSR 0200
41445 S_IXUSR 0100
41446 S_IRGRP 040
41447 S_IWGRP 020
41448 S_IXGRP 010
41449 S_IROTH 04
41450 S_IWOTH 02
41451 S_IXOTH 01
41452 @end smallexample
41453
41454 @node Errno Values
41455 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41456 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41457
41458 All values are given in decimal representation.
41459
41460 @smallexample
41461 EPERM 1
41462 ENOENT 2
41463 EINTR 4
41464 EBADF 9
41465 EACCES 13
41466 EFAULT 14
41467 EBUSY 16
41468 EEXIST 17
41469 ENODEV 19
41470 ENOTDIR 20
41471 EISDIR 21
41472 EINVAL 22
41473 ENFILE 23
41474 EMFILE 24
41475 EFBIG 27
41476 ENOSPC 28
41477 ESPIPE 29
41478 EROFS 30
41479 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41480 EUNKNOWN 9999
41481 @end smallexample
41482
41483 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41484 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41485
41486 @node Lseek Flags
41487 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41488 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41489
41490 @smallexample
41491 SEEK_SET 0
41492 SEEK_CUR 1
41493 SEEK_END 2
41494 @end smallexample
41495
41496 @node Limits
41497 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41498 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41499
41500 All values are given in decimal representation.
41501
41502 @smallexample
41503 INT_MIN -2147483648
41504 INT_MAX 2147483647
41505 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41506 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41507 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41508 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41509 @end smallexample
41510
41511 @node File-I/O Examples
41512 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41513 @cindex file-i/o examples
41514
41515 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41516 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41517
41518 @smallexample
41519 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41520 @emph{request memory read from target}
41521 -> @code{m1234,6}
41522 <- XXXXXX
41523 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41524 -> @code{F6}
41525 @end smallexample
41526
41527 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41528 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41529
41530 @smallexample
41531 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41532 @emph{request memory write to target}
41533 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41534 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41535 -> @code{F6}
41536 @end smallexample
41537
41538 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41539 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41540
41541 @smallexample
41542 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41543 -> @code{F-1,9}
41544 @end smallexample
41545
41546 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41547 host is called:
41548
41549 @smallexample
41550 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41551 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41552 <- @code{T02}
41553 @end smallexample
41554
41555 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41556 host is called:
41557
41558 @smallexample
41559 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41560 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41561 <- @code{T02}
41562 @end smallexample
41563
41564 @node Library List Format
41565 @section Library List Format
41566 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41567
41568 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41569 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41570 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41571 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41572 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41573 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41574 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41575 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41576 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41577 are loaded.
41578
41579 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41580 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41581 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41582 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41583
41584 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41585 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41586 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41587 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41588 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41589 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41590
41591 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41592 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41593
41594 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41595 offset, looks like this:
41596
41597 @smallexample
41598 <library-list>
41599 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41600 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41601 </library>
41602 </library-list>
41603 @end smallexample
41604
41605 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41606 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41607
41608 @smallexample
41609 <library-list>
41610 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41611 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41612 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41613 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41614 </library>
41615 </library-list>
41616 @end smallexample
41617
41618 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41619
41620 @smallexample
41621 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41622 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41623 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41624 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41625 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41626 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41627 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41628 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41629 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41630 @end smallexample
41631
41632 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41633 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41634 section for each library.
41635
41636 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41637 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41638 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41639
41640 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41641 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41642 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41643 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41644
41645 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41646 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41647 target, the following parameters are reported:
41648
41649 @itemize @minus
41650 @item
41651 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41652 @code{struct link_map}.
41653 @item
41654 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41655 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41656 @item
41657 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41658 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41659 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41660 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41661 @item
41662 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41663 @end itemize
41664
41665 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41666 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41667 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41668
41669 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41670 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41671
41672 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41673 looks like this:
41674
41675 @smallexample
41676 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41677 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41678 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41679 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41680 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41681 </library-list-svr>
41682 @end smallexample
41683
41684 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41685
41686 @smallexample
41687 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41688 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41689 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41690 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41691 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41692 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41693 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41694 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41695 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41696 @end smallexample
41697
41698 @node Memory Map Format
41699 @section Memory Map Format
41700 @cindex memory map format
41701
41702 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41703 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41704 memory map.
41705
41706 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41707 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41708 lists memory regions.
41709
41710 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41711 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41712
41713 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41714
41715 @smallexample
41716 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41717 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41718 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41719 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41720 <memory-map>
41721 region...
41722 </memory-map>
41723 @end smallexample
41724
41725 Each region can be either:
41726
41727 @itemize
41728
41729 @item
41730 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41731 bytes from there:
41732
41733 @smallexample
41734 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41735 @end smallexample
41736
41737
41738 @item
41739 A region of read-only memory:
41740
41741 @smallexample
41742 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41743 @end smallexample
41744
41745
41746 @item
41747 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41748 bytes in length:
41749
41750 @smallexample
41751 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41752 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41753 </memory>
41754 @end smallexample
41755
41756 @end itemize
41757
41758 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41759 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41760 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41761
41762 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41763
41764 @smallexample
41765 <!-- ................................................... -->
41766 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41767 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41768 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41769 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41770 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41771 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41772 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41773 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41774 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41775 and its type, or device. -->
41776 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41777 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41778 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41779 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41780 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41781 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41782 @end smallexample
41783
41784 @node Thread List Format
41785 @section Thread List Format
41786 @cindex thread list format
41787
41788 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41789 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41790 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41791 the following structure:
41792
41793 @smallexample
41794 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41795 <threads>
41796 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41797 ... description ...
41798 </thread>
41799 </threads>
41800 @end smallexample
41801
41802 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41803 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41804 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41805 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41806 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41807 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41808 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41809 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41810
41811
41812 @node Traceframe Info Format
41813 @section Traceframe Info Format
41814 @cindex traceframe info format
41815
41816 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41817 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41818 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41819 collected in a traceframe.
41820
41821 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41822 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41823
41824 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41825 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41826
41827 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41828
41829 @smallexample
41830 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41831 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41832 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41833 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41834 <traceframe-info>
41835 block...
41836 </traceframe-info>
41837 @end smallexample
41838
41839 Each traceframe block can be either:
41840
41841 @itemize
41842
41843 @item
41844 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41845 @var{length} bytes from there:
41846
41847 @smallexample
41848 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41849 @end smallexample
41850
41851 @item
41852 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41853 collected:
41854
41855 @smallexample
41856 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41857 @end smallexample
41858
41859 @end itemize
41860
41861 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41862
41863 @smallexample
41864 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41865 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41866
41867 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41868 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41869 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41870 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41871 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41872 @end smallexample
41873
41874 @node Branch Trace Format
41875 @section Branch Trace Format
41876 @cindex branch trace format
41877
41878 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41879 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41880 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41881 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41882
41883 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41884 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41885
41886 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41887 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41888
41889 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41890
41891 @smallexample
41892 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41893 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41894 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41895 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41896 <btrace>
41897 block...
41898 </btrace>
41899 @end smallexample
41900
41901 @itemize
41902
41903 @item
41904 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41905 and ending at @var{end}:
41906
41907 @smallexample
41908 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41909 @end smallexample
41910
41911 @end itemize
41912
41913 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41914
41915 @smallexample
41916 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41917 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41918
41919 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41920 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41921 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41922
41923 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41924
41925 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41926
41927 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41928 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41929 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41930 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41931 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41932
41933 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41934 @end smallexample
41935
41936 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41937 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41938 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41939
41940 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41941 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41942 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41943
41944 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41945 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41946
41947 @table @code
41948 @item bts
41949 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41950 @table @code
41951 @item size
41952 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41953 @end table
41954 @item pt
41955 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41956 PT}) format.
41957 @table @code
41958 @item size
41959 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41960 @end table
41961 @end table
41962
41963 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41964 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41965
41966 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41967
41968 @smallexample
41969 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41970 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41971
41972 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41973 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41974
41975 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41976 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41977 @end smallexample
41978
41979 @include agentexpr.texi
41980
41981 @node Target Descriptions
41982 @appendix Target Descriptions
41983 @cindex target descriptions
41984
41985 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41986 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41987 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41988 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41989 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41990 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41991 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41992
41993 @itemize @bullet
41994 @item
41995 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41996 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41997 @item
41998 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41999 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
42000 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
42001 @item
42002 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
42003 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
42004 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
42005 @end itemize
42006
42007 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
42008 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
42009 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
42010 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
42011 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
42012
42013 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
42014 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
42015
42016 @menu
42017 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
42018 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
42019 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
42020 descriptions.
42021 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
42022 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
42023 @end menu
42024
42025 @node Retrieving Descriptions
42026 @section Retrieving Descriptions
42027
42028 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
42029 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
42030 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
42031 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
42032 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
42033 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
42034 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
42035 Format}.
42036
42037 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
42038 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
42039 specify a file are:
42040
42041 @table @code
42042 @cindex set tdesc filename
42043 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
42044 Read the target description from @var{path}.
42045
42046 @cindex unset tdesc filename
42047 @item unset tdesc filename
42048 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
42049 will use the description supplied by the current target.
42050
42051 @cindex show tdesc filename
42052 @item show tdesc filename
42053 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
42054 @end table
42055
42056
42057 @node Target Description Format
42058 @section Target Description Format
42059 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
42060
42061 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
42062 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
42063 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
42064 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
42065 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
42066 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
42067 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
42068
42069 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
42070 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
42071 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
42072 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
42073 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
42074
42075 Here is a simple target description:
42076
42077 @smallexample
42078 <target version="1.0">
42079 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
42080 </target>
42081 @end smallexample
42082
42083 @noindent
42084 This minimal description only says that the target uses
42085 the x86-64 architecture.
42086
42087 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
42088 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
42089 are explained further below.
42090
42091 @smallexample
42092 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42093 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
42094 <target version="1.0">
42095 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
42096 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
42097 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
42098 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
42099 </target>
42100 @end smallexample
42101
42102 @noindent
42103 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
42104 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
42105 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
42106 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
42107 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42108 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42109 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42110 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42111 the version mismatch.
42112
42113 @subsection Inclusion
42114 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42115 @cindex XInclude
42116 @ifnotinfo
42117 @cindex <xi:include>
42118 @end ifnotinfo
42119
42120 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42121 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42122 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42123 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42124 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42125
42126 @smallexample
42127 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42128 @end smallexample
42129
42130 @noindent
42131 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42132 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42133 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42134 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42135 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42136 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42137 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42138 original description.
42139
42140 @subsection Architecture
42141 @cindex <architecture>
42142
42143 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42144
42145 @smallexample
42146 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42147 @end smallexample
42148
42149 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42150 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42151
42152 @subsection OS ABI
42153 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42154
42155 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42156 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42157
42158 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42159
42160 @smallexample
42161 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42162 @end smallexample
42163
42164 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42165 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42166
42167 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42168 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42169
42170 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42171 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42172
42173 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42174
42175 @smallexample
42176 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42177 @end smallexample
42178
42179 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42180 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42181
42182 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42183 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42184 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42185 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42186 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42187 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42188 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42189
42190 @smallexample
42191 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42192 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42193 @end smallexample
42194
42195 @subsection Features
42196 @cindex <feature>
42197
42198 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42199 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42200 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42201 has this form:
42202
42203 @smallexample
42204 <feature name="@var{name}">
42205 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42206 @var{reg}@dots{}
42207 </feature>
42208 @end smallexample
42209
42210 @noindent
42211 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42212 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42213 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42214 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42215
42216 @subsection Types
42217
42218 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42219 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42220 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42221 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42222 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42223 and enum types.
42224
42225 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42226 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42227 Types must be defined before they are used.
42228
42229 @cindex <vector>
42230 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42231 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42232 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42233 @var{count}:
42234
42235 @smallexample
42236 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42237 @end smallexample
42238
42239 @cindex <union>
42240 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42241 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42242 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42243 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42244
42245 @smallexample
42246 <union id="@var{id}">
42247 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42248 @dots{}
42249 </union>
42250 @end smallexample
42251
42252 @cindex <struct>
42253 @cindex <flags>
42254 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42255 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42256 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42257 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42258 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42259 specified.
42260
42261 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42262
42263 @smallexample
42264 <struct id="@var{id}">
42265 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42266 @dots{}
42267 </struct>
42268 @end smallexample
42269
42270 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42271 No implicit padding is added.
42272
42273 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42274
42275 @smallexample
42276 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42277 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42278 @dots{}
42279 </struct>
42280 @end smallexample
42281
42282 @smallexample
42283 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42284 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42285 @dots{}
42286 </flags>
42287 @end smallexample
42288
42289 The @var{name} value is required.
42290 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42291 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42292 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42293
42294 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42295 is optional.
42296 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42297 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42298
42299 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42300 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42301
42302 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42303
42304 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42305 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42306
42307 @itemize @bullet
42308 @item
42309 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42310 @item
42311 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42312 @end itemize
42313
42314 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42315 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42316
42317 @itemize @bullet
42318 @item
42319 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42320
42321 @smallexample
42322 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42323 $1 = 42
42324 @end smallexample
42325
42326 @end itemize
42327
42328 @subsection Registers
42329 @cindex <reg>
42330
42331 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42332
42333 @smallexample
42334 <reg name="@var{name}"
42335 bitsize="@var{size}"
42336 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42337 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42338 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42339 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42340 @end smallexample
42341
42342 @noindent
42343 The components are as follows:
42344
42345 @table @var
42346
42347 @item name
42348 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42349
42350 @item bitsize
42351 The register's size, in bits.
42352
42353 @item regnum
42354 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42355 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42356 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42357 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42358 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42359 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42360 in order of increasing register number.
42361
42362 @item save-restore
42363 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42364 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42365 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42366 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42367 ABI.
42368
42369 @item type
42370 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42371 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42372 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42373 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42374 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42375 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42376
42377 @item group
42378 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42379 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42380 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42381 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42382 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42383 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42384 @code{info registers}.
42385
42386 @end table
42387
42388 @node Predefined Target Types
42389 @section Predefined Target Types
42390 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42391
42392 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42393 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42394 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42395 types. The currently supported types are:
42396
42397 @table @code
42398
42399 @item bool
42400 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42401
42402 @item int8
42403 @itemx int16
42404 @itemx int24
42405 @itemx int32
42406 @itemx int64
42407 @itemx int128
42408 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42409
42410 @item uint8
42411 @itemx uint16
42412 @itemx uint24
42413 @itemx uint32
42414 @itemx uint64
42415 @itemx uint128
42416 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42417
42418 @item code_ptr
42419 @itemx data_ptr
42420 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42421 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42422 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42423 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42424 may be marked as data pointers.
42425
42426 @item ieee_single
42427 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42428
42429 @item ieee_double
42430 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42431
42432 @item arm_fpa_ext
42433 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42434
42435 @item i387_ext
42436 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42437
42438 @item i386_eflags
42439 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42440
42441 @item i386_mxcsr
42442 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42443
42444 @end table
42445
42446 @node Enum Target Types
42447 @section Enum Target Types
42448 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42449
42450 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42451 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42452
42453 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42454
42455 @smallexample
42456 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42457 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42458 @dots{}
42459 </enum>
42460 @end smallexample
42461
42462 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42463
42464 @smallexample
42465 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42466 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42467 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42468 </enum>
42469 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42470 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42471 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42472 </flags>
42473 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42474 @end smallexample
42475
42476 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42477 would be printed as:
42478
42479 @smallexample
42480 (gdb) info register flags
42481 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42482 @end smallexample
42483
42484 @node Standard Target Features
42485 @section Standard Target Features
42486 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42487
42488 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42489 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42490 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42491 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42492 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42493 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42494 can recognize them.
42495
42496 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42497 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42498 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42499 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42500 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42501 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42502 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42503 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42504
42505 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42506 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42507 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42508
42509 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42510 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42511 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42512 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42513
42514 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42515 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42516 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42517
42518 @menu
42519 * AArch64 Features::
42520 * ARC Features::
42521 * ARM Features::
42522 * i386 Features::
42523 * MicroBlaze Features::
42524 * MIPS Features::
42525 * M68K Features::
42526 * NDS32 Features::
42527 * Nios II Features::
42528 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42529 * PowerPC Features::
42530 * S/390 and System z Features::
42531 * Sparc Features::
42532 * TIC6x Features::
42533 @end menu
42534
42535
42536 @node AArch64 Features
42537 @subsection AArch64 Features
42538 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42539
42540 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42541 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42542 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42543
42544 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42545 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42546 and @samp{fpcr}.
42547
42548 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42549 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42550 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42551
42552 @node ARC Features
42553 @subsection ARC Features
42554 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42555
42556 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42557 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42558 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42559 that one of the core registers features is present.
42560 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42561
42562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42563 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42564 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42565 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42566 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42567 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42568 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42569
42570 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42571 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42572 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42573 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42574 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42575 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42576
42577 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42578 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42579 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42580 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42581 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42582 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42583 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42584 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42585 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42586 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42587
42588 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42589 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42590
42591 @node ARM Features
42592 @subsection ARM Features
42593 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42594
42595 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42596 ARM targets.
42597 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42598 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42599
42600 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42601 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42602 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42603 and @samp{xpsr}.
42604
42605 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42606 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42607
42608 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42609 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42610 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42611 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42612
42613 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42614 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42615 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42616 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42617 halves of the double-precision registers.
42618
42619 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42620 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42621 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42622 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42623 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42624 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42625
42626 @node i386 Features
42627 @subsection i386 Features
42628 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42629
42630 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42631 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42632
42633 @itemize @minus
42634 @item
42635 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42636 @item
42637 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42638 @item
42639 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42640 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42641 @item
42642 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42643 @item
42644 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42645 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42646 @end itemize
42647
42648 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42649
42650 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42651 describe registers:
42652
42653 @itemize @minus
42654 @item
42655 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42656 @item
42657 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42658 @item
42659 @samp{mxcsr}
42660 @end itemize
42661
42662 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42663 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42664 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42665
42666 @itemize @minus
42667 @item
42668 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42669 @item
42670 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42671 @end itemize
42672
42673 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42674 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42675
42676 @itemize @minus
42677 @item
42678 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42679 @item
42680 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42681 @end itemize
42682
42683 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42684 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42685
42686 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42687 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42688
42689 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42690 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42691 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42692
42693 @itemize @minus
42694 @item
42695 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42696 @end itemize
42697
42698 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42699
42700 @itemize @minus
42701 @item
42702 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42703 @end itemize
42704
42705 It should
42706 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42707
42708 @itemize @minus
42709 @item
42710 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42711 @item
42712 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42713 @end itemize
42714
42715 It should
42716 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42717
42718 @itemize @minus
42719 @item
42720 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42721 @end itemize
42722
42723 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42724 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42725 valid for i386 and amd64.
42726
42727 @node MicroBlaze Features
42728 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42729 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42730
42731 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42732 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42733 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42734 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42735 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42736
42737 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42738 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42739
42740 @node MIPS Features
42741 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42742 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42743
42744 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42745 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42746 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42747 on the target.
42748
42749 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42750 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42751 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42752
42753 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42754 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42755 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42756 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42757
42758 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42759 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42760 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42761 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42762
42763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42764 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42765 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42766
42767 @node M68K Features
42768 @subsection M68K Features
42769 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42770
42771 @table @code
42772 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42773 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42774 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42775 One of those features must be always present.
42776 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42777 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42778 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42779 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42780
42781 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42782 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42783 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42784 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42785 @end table
42786
42787 @node NDS32 Features
42788 @subsection NDS32 Features
42789 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42790
42791 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42792 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42793 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42794 and @samp{pc}.
42795
42796 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42797 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42798 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42799 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42800
42801 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42802 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42803 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42804 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42805 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42806 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42807 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42808
42809 @node Nios II Features
42810 @subsection Nios II Features
42811 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42812
42813 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42814 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42815 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42816 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42817 @samp{mpuacc}).
42818
42819 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42820 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42821 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42822
42823 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42824 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42825 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42826
42827 @node PowerPC Features
42828 @subsection PowerPC Features
42829 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42830
42831 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42832 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42833 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42834 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42835
42836 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42837 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42838
42839 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42840 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42841 and @samp{vrsave}.
42842
42843 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42844 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42845 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42846 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42847 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42848 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42849
42850 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42851 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42852 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42853 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42854 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42855 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42856 user.
42857
42858 @node S/390 and System z Features
42859 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42860 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42861 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42862
42863 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42864 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42865 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42866 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42867 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42868 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42869 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42870 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42871 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42872
42873 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42874 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42875 @samp{fpc}.
42876
42877 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42878 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42879
42880 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42881 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42882 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42883 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42884 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42885 32-bit wide.
42886
42887 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42888 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42889 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42890
42891 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42892 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42893 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42894 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42895 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42896 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42897 @samp{v31}.
42898
42899 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42900 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42901 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42902
42903 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42904 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42905 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42906
42907 @node Sparc Features
42908 @subsection Sparc Features
42909 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42910 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42911 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42912 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42913
42914 @itemize @minus
42915 @item
42916 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42917 @item
42918 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42919 @item
42920 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42921 @item
42922 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42923 @end itemize
42924
42925 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42926
42927 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42928 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42929
42930 @itemize @minus
42931 @item
42932 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42933 @item
42934 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42935 @end itemize
42936
42937 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42938 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42939
42940 @itemize @minus
42941 @item
42942 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42943 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42944 @item
42945 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42946 for sparc64
42947 @end itemize
42948
42949 @node TIC6x Features
42950 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42951 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42952 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42953 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42954 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42955 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42956
42957 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42958 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42959 through @samp{B31}.
42960
42961 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42962 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42963
42964 @node Operating System Information
42965 @appendix Operating System Information
42966 @cindex operating system information
42967
42968 @menu
42969 * Process list::
42970 @end menu
42971
42972 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42973 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42974 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42975 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42976 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42977 on a different aspect of target.
42978
42979 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42980 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42981 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42982 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42983
42984 @node Process list
42985 @appendixsection Process list
42986 @cindex operating system information, process list
42987
42988 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42989 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42990 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42991 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42992
42993 An example document is:
42994
42995 @smallexample
42996 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42997 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42998 <osdata type="processes">
42999 <item>
43000 <column name="pid">1</column>
43001 <column name="user">root</column>
43002 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
43003 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
43004 </item>
43005 </osdata>
43006 @end smallexample
43007
43008 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
43009 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
43010 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
43011 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
43012 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
43013 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
43014 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
43015
43016 @node Trace File Format
43017 @appendix Trace File Format
43018 @cindex trace file format
43019
43020 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
43021 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
43022
43023 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
43024 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
43025 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
43026 in the future.
43027
43028 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
43029 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
43030 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
43031 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
43032 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
43033 of this section.
43034
43035 @table @code
43036 @item R @var{size}
43037 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
43038 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
43039 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
43040 a single trace file.
43041
43042 @item status @var{status}
43043 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
43044 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
43045 file.
43046
43047 @item tp @var{payload}
43048 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43049 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
43050 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43051 reply packets.
43052
43053 @item tsv @var{payload}
43054 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
43055 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
43056 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
43057 reply packets.
43058
43059 @item tdesc @var{payload}
43060 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
43061 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
43062 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
43063 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
43064 file. Includes are not allowed.
43065
43066 @end table
43067
43068 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
43069 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
43070 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
43071 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
43072 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
43073 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
43074 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
43075 endianness.
43076
43077 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
43078
43079 @table @code
43080 @item R @var{bytes}
43081 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
43082 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
43083 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
43084
43085 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
43086 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
43087 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
43088 @var{length} bytes.
43089
43090 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
43091 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
43092 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
43093
43094 @end table
43095
43096 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
43097 of blocks.
43098
43099 @node Index Section Format
43100 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
43101 @cindex .gdb_index section format
43102 @cindex index section format
43103
43104 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
43105 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
43106 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
43107 description.
43108
43109 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43110 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43111 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43112 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43113 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43114 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43115
43116 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43117
43118 @enumerate
43119 @item
43120 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43121 unless otherwise noted:
43122
43123 @enumerate
43124 @item
43125 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43126 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43127 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43128 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43129 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43130 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43131 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43132
43133 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43134 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43135 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43136 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43137
43138 @item
43139 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43140
43141 @item
43142 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43143 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43144 to the next offset.
43145
43146 @item
43147 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43148
43149 @item
43150 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43151
43152 @item
43153 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43154 @end enumerate
43155
43156 @item
43157 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43158 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43159 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43160 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43161 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43162 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43163 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43164 CU indices.
43165
43166 @item
43167 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43168 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43169 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43170 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43171
43172 @item
43173 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43174 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43175
43176 @enumerate
43177 @item
43178 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43179
43180 @item
43181 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43182 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43183
43184 @item
43185 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43186 @end enumerate
43187
43188 @item
43189 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43190 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43191
43192 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43193 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43194 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43195 constant pool.
43196
43197 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43198 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43199 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43200
43201 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43202 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43203 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43204 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43205 index version:
43206
43207 @table @asis
43208 @item Version 4
43209 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43210
43211 @item Versions 5 to 7
43212 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43213 @end table
43214
43215 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43216
43217 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43218 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43219 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43220 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43221 collision.
43222
43223 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43224 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43225 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43226 the code.
43227
43228 @item
43229 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43230 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43231 strings.
43232
43233 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43234 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43235 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43236 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43237 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43238 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43239
43240 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43241 @end enumerate
43242
43243 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43244 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43245 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43246
43247 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43248 (bit 0 = LSB):
43249
43250 @table @asis
43251
43252 @item Bits 0-23
43253 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43254 @item Bits 24-27
43255 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43256 @item Bits 28-30
43257 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43258
43259 @table @asis
43260 @item 0
43261 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43262 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43263 with previous versions of the index.
43264 @item 1
43265 The symbol is a type.
43266 @item 2
43267 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43268 @item 3
43269 The symbol is a function.
43270 @item 4
43271 Any other kind of symbol.
43272 @item 5,6,7
43273 These values are reserved.
43274 @end table
43275
43276 @item Bit 31
43277 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43278
43279 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43280 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43281 @value{GDBN} sources.
43282
43283 @end table
43284
43285 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43286 global/static attributes in the index.
43287
43288 @smallexample
43289 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43290 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43291 switch (die->tag)
43292 @{
43293 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43294 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43295 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43296 kind = TYPE;
43297 is_static = 1;
43298 break;
43299 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43300 kind = VARIABLE;
43301 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43302 break;
43303 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43304 kind = FUNCTION;
43305 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43306 break;
43307 case DW_TAG_constant:
43308 kind = VARIABLE;
43309 is_static = ! is_external;
43310 break;
43311 case DW_TAG_variable:
43312 kind = VARIABLE;
43313 is_static = ! is_external;
43314 break;
43315 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43316 kind = TYPE;
43317 is_static = 0;
43318 break;
43319 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43320 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43321 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43322 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43323 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43324 kind = TYPE;
43325 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43326 break;
43327 default:
43328 assert (0);
43329 @}
43330 @end smallexample
43331
43332 @node Man Pages
43333 @appendix Manual pages
43334 @cindex Man pages
43335
43336 @menu
43337 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43338 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43339 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43340 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43341 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43342 @end menu
43343
43344 @node gdb man
43345 @heading gdb man
43346
43347 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43348
43349 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43350 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43351 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43352 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43353 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43354 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43355 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43356 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43357 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43358 @c man end
43359
43360 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43361 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43362 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43363 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43364
43365 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43366 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43367
43368 @itemize @bullet
43369 @item
43370 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43371
43372 @item
43373 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43374
43375 @item
43376 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43377
43378 @item
43379 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43380 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43381 @end itemize
43382
43383 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43384 Modula-2.
43385
43386 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43387 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43388 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43389 by using the command @code{help}.
43390
43391 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43392 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43393 executable program as the argument:
43394
43395 @smallexample
43396 gdb program
43397 @end smallexample
43398
43399 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43400
43401 @smallexample
43402 gdb program core
43403 @end smallexample
43404
43405 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43406 to debug a running process:
43407
43408 @smallexample
43409 gdb program 1234
43410 gdb -p 1234
43411 @end smallexample
43412
43413 @noindent
43414 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43415 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43416 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43417
43418 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43419
43420 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43421 @table @env
43422 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43423 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43424
43425 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43426 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43427
43428 @item bt
43429 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43430
43431 @item print @var{expr}
43432 Display the value of an expression.
43433
43434 @item c
43435 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43436
43437 @item next
43438 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43439 function calls in the line.
43440
43441 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43442 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43443
43444 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43445 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43446
43447 @item step
43448 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43449 function calls in the line.
43450
43451 @item help [@var{name}]
43452 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43453 about using @value{GDBN}.
43454
43455 @item quit
43456 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43457 @end table
43458
43459 @ifset man
43460 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43461 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43462 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43463 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43464 @end ifset
43465 @c man end
43466
43467 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43468 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43469 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43470 encountered with no
43471 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43472 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43473 Many options have
43474 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43475 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43476 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43477 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43478 more usual convention.)
43479
43480 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43481 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43482 option is used.
43483
43484 @table @env
43485 @item -help
43486 @itemx -h
43487 List all options, with brief explanations.
43488
43489 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43490 @itemx -s @var{file}
43491 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43492
43493 @item -write
43494 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43495
43496 @item -exec=@var{file}
43497 @itemx -e @var{file}
43498 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43499 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43500 dump.
43501
43502 @item -se=@var{file}
43503 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43504 file.
43505
43506 @item -core=@var{file}
43507 @itemx -c @var{file}
43508 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43509
43510 @item -command=@var{file}
43511 @itemx -x @var{file}
43512 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43513
43514 @item -ex @var{command}
43515 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43516
43517 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43518 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43519 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43520
43521 @item -nh
43522 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43523
43524 @item -nx
43525 @itemx -n
43526 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43527
43528 @item -quiet
43529 @itemx -q
43530 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43531 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43532
43533 @item -batch
43534 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43535 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43536 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43537 commands in the command files.
43538
43539 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43540 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43541 more useful, the message
43542
43543 @smallexample
43544 Program exited normally.
43545 @end smallexample
43546
43547 @noindent
43548 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43549 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43550
43551 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43552 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43553 instead of the current directory.
43554
43555 @item -fullname
43556 @itemx -f
43557 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43558 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43559 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43560 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43561 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43562 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43563 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43564 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43565
43566 @item -b @var{bps}
43567 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43568 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43569
43570 @item -tty=@var{device}
43571 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43572 @end table
43573 @c man end
43574
43575 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43576 @ifset man
43577 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43578 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43579 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43580
43581 @smallexample
43582 info gdb
43583 @end smallexample
43584
43585 @noindent
43586 should give you access to the complete manual.
43587
43588 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43589 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43590 @end ifset
43591 @c man end
43592
43593 @node gdbserver man
43594 @heading gdbserver man
43595
43596 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43597 @format
43598 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43599 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43600
43601 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43602
43603 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43604 @c man end
43605 @end format
43606
43607 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43608 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43609 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43610
43611 @ifclear man
43612 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43613 @end ifclear
43614 @ifset man
43615 Usage (server (target) side):
43616 @end ifset
43617
43618 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43619 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43620 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43621 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43622
43623 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43624 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43625 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43626
43627 @smallexample
43628 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43629 @end smallexample
43630
43631 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43632
43633 @smallexample
43634 @ifset man
43635 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43636 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43637 @end ifset
43638 @ifclear man
43639 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43640 @end ifclear
43641 @end smallexample
43642
43643 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43644 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43645 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43646
43647 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43648
43649 @smallexample
43650 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43651 @end smallexample
43652
43653 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43654 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43655 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43656 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43657 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43658 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43659 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43660 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43661 print an error message and exit.
43662
43663 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43664 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43665
43666 @smallexample
43667 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43668 @end smallexample
43669
43670 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43671 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43672
43673 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43674 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43675 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43676 the program you want to debug.
43677
43678 @smallexample
43679 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43680 @end smallexample
43681
43682 @ifclear man
43683 @subheading Usage (host side)
43684 @end ifclear
43685 @ifset man
43686 Usage (host side):
43687 @end ifset
43688
43689 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43690 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43691 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43692 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43693 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43694 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43695 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43696 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43697 descriptor. For example:
43698
43699 @smallexample
43700 @ifset man
43701 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43702 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43703 @end ifset
43704 @ifclear man
43705 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43706 @end ifclear
43707 @end smallexample
43708
43709 @noindent
43710 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43711
43712 @smallexample
43713 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43714 @end smallexample
43715
43716 @noindent
43717 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43718 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43719 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43720 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43721 `Connection refused'.
43722
43723 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43724 described in
43725 @ifset man
43726 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43727 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43728 @end ifset
43729 @ifclear man
43730 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43731 @end ifclear
43732 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43733
43734 @smallexample
43735 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43736 @end smallexample
43737
43738 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43739 case.
43740 @c man end
43741
43742 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43743 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43744
43745 @itemize @bullet
43746
43747 @item
43748 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43749
43750 @smallexample
43751 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43752 @end smallexample
43753
43754 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43755 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43756 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43757 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43758 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43759 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43760 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43761
43762 @item
43763 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43764 program:
43765
43766 @smallexample
43767 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43768 @end smallexample
43769
43770 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43771 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43772 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43773 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43774
43775 @item
43776 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43777
43778 @smallexample
43779 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43780 @end smallexample
43781
43782 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43783 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43784 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43785 debug several processes in the same session.
43786 @end itemize
43787
43788 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43789
43790 @table @env
43791
43792 @item --help
43793 List all options, with brief explanations.
43794
43795 @item --version
43796 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43797
43798 @item --attach
43799 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43800
43801 @smallexample
43802 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43803 @end smallexample
43804
43805 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43806 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43807
43808 @item --multi
43809 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43810 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43811 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43812 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43813
43814 @smallexample
43815 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43816 @end smallexample
43817
43818 @item --debug
43819 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43820 process.
43821 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43822 the developers.
43823
43824 @item --remote-debug
43825 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43826 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43827 the developers.
43828
43829 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43830 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43831 of debugging output.
43832 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43833
43834 @item --wrapper
43835 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43836 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43837 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43838 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43839
43840 @item --once
43841 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43842 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43843 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43844 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43845
43846 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43847
43848 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43849 @c QDisableRandomization.
43850
43851 @end table
43852 @c man end
43853
43854 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43855 @ifset man
43856 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43857 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43858 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43859
43860 @smallexample
43861 info gdb
43862 @end smallexample
43863
43864 should give you access to the complete manual.
43865
43866 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43867 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43868 @end ifset
43869 @c man end
43870
43871 @node gcore man
43872 @heading gcore
43873
43874 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43875
43876 @format
43877 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43878 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
43879 @c man end
43880 @end format
43881
43882 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43883 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
43884 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
43885 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
43886 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
43887 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
43888 its job the program remains running without any change.
43889 @c man end
43890
43891 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43892 @table @env
43893 @item -a
43894 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43895 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43896 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43897 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43898 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43899
43900 @item -o @var{prefix}
43901 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
43902 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
43903 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
43904 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
43905 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
43906 @end table
43907 @c man end
43908
43909 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43910 @ifset man
43911 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43912 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43913 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43914
43915 @smallexample
43916 info gdb
43917 @end smallexample
43918
43919 @noindent
43920 should give you access to the complete manual.
43921
43922 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43923 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43924 @end ifset
43925 @c man end
43926
43927 @node gdbinit man
43928 @heading gdbinit
43929
43930 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43931
43932 @format
43933 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43934 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43935 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43936 @end ifset
43937
43938 ~/.gdbinit
43939
43940 ./.gdbinit
43941 @c man end
43942 @end format
43943
43944 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43945 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43946 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43947 described in
43948 @ifset man
43949 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43950 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43951 @end ifset
43952 @ifclear man
43953 @ref{Sequences}.
43954 @end ifclear
43955
43956 Please read more in
43957 @ifset man
43958 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43959 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43960 @end ifset
43961 @ifclear man
43962 @ref{Startup}.
43963 @end ifclear
43964
43965 @table @env
43966 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43967 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43968 @end ifset
43969 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43970 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43971 @end ifclear
43972 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43973 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43974 See more in
43975 @ifset man
43976 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43977 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43978 @end ifset
43979 @ifclear man
43980 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43981 @end ifclear
43982
43983 @item ~/.gdbinit
43984 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43985 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43986
43987 @item ./.gdbinit
43988 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43989 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43990 See more in
43991 @ifset man
43992 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43993 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43994 @end ifset
43995 @ifclear man
43996 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43997 @end ifclear
43998 @end table
43999 @c man end
44000
44001 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
44002 @ifset man
44003 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
44004
44005 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44006 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44007 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44008
44009 @smallexample
44010 info gdb
44011 @end smallexample
44012
44013 should give you access to the complete manual.
44014
44015 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44016 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44017 @end ifset
44018 @c man end
44019
44020 @node gdb-add-index man
44021 @heading gdb-add-index
44022 @pindex gdb-add-index
44023 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
44024
44025 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
44026
44027 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
44028 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
44029 @c man end
44030
44031 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
44032 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
44033 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
44034 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
44035 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
44036 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
44037
44038 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
44039 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
44040 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
44041 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
44042 named @code{.debug_*}).
44043
44044 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
44045 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
44046 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
44047 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
44048
44049 See more in
44050 @ifset man
44051 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
44052 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
44053 @end ifset
44054 @ifclear man
44055 @ref{Index Files}.
44056 @end ifclear
44057 @c man end
44058
44059 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
44060 @ifset man
44061 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
44062 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
44063 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
44064
44065 @smallexample
44066 info gdb
44067 @end smallexample
44068
44069 should give you access to the complete manual.
44070
44071 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
44072 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
44073 @end ifset
44074 @c man end
44075
44076 @include gpl.texi
44077
44078 @node GNU Free Documentation License
44079 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
44080 @include fdl.texi
44081
44082 @node Concept Index
44083 @unnumbered Concept Index
44084
44085 @printindex cp
44086
44087 @node Command and Variable Index
44088 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
44089
44090 @printindex fn
44091
44092 @tex
44093 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
44094 % meantime:
44095 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
44096 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
44097 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
44098 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
44099 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
44100 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
44101 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
44102 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
44103 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
44104 \page\colophon
44105 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
44106 @end tex
44107
44108 @bye
This page took 1.613854 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.